Mazak I300stw Parameters Ha12ha0034e
Mazak I300stw Parameters Ha12ha0034e
294060
Original Instructions
PARAMETER LIST
ALARM LIST
M-CODE LIST
.d
ve
INTEGREX i-100 series
er
INTEGREX i-200 series
s
re
INTEGREX i-300 series
ts
INTEGREX i-400 series
gh
HA12HA0034E (1/2)
ri
Manual No.:
ll
.A
NC: MAZATROL SmoothX
N
O
AVANS 294060
TI
Serial No.:
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
Before using this machine and equipment, fully understand the contents of this
al
K
ri
manual to ensure proper operation. Should any questions arise, please ask the
ZA
Se
IMPORTANT NOTICE
A
1. Be sure to observe the safety precautions described in this manual and the contents of the
M
safety plates on the machine and equipment. Failure may cause serious personal injury or
YA
material damage. Please replace any missing safety plates as soon as possible.
3
3. For the purpose of explaining the operation of the machine and equipment, some illustrations
)2
may not include safety features such as covers, doors, etc. Before operation, make sure all
(c
4. This manual was considered complete and accurate at the time of publication, however, due to
yr
our desire to constantly improve the quality and specification of all our products, it is subject
op
to change or modification. If you have any questions, please contact the nearest Technical
C
06.2018
R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Preface
Safety precautions relating to the CNC unit (in the remainder of this manual, referred to simply as
the NC unit) that is provided in this machine are explained below. Not only the persons who
create programs, but also those who operate the machine must thoroughly understand the
contents of this manual to ensure safe operation of the machine.
Read all these safety precautions, even if your NC model does not have the corresponding
functions or optional units and a part of the precautions do not apply.
.
Rule
d
ve
er
1. This section contains the precautions to be observed as to the working methods and states
s
usually expected. Of course, however, unexpected operations and/or unexpected working
re
states may take place at the user site.
ts
During daily operation of the machine, therefore, the user must pay extra careful attention to
gh
its own working safety as well as to observe the precautions described below.
ri
ll
2. Although this manual contains as great an amount of information as it can, since it is not
.A
rare for the user to perform the operations that overstep the manufacturer-assumed ones,
N
not all of “what the user cannot perform” or “what the user must not perform” can be fully
O
TI
covered in this manual with all such operations taken into consideration beforehand.
60
“inexecutable” functions.
PO
29
3. The meanings of our safety precautions to DANGER, WARNING, and CAUTION are as
R
o.
follows:
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
DANGER
K
ZA
life or body.
M
WARNING
YA
3
01
machine damage.
CAUTION
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
HGENPA0102E S-1
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Basics
After turning power on, keep hands away from the keys, buttons, or switches of the
operating panel until an initial display has been made.
WARNING Before proceeding to the next operations, fully check that correct data has been entered
and/or set. If the operator performs operations without being aware of data errors,
unexpected operation of the machine will result.
Before machining workpieces, perform operational tests and make sure that the machine
operates correctly. No workpieces must be machined without confirmation of normal
operation. Closely check the accuracy of programs by executing override, single-block,
and other functions or by operating the machine at no load. Also, fully utilize tool path
d.
check, Virtual Machining, and other functions, if provided.
ve
er
Make sure that the appropriate feed rate and rotational speed are designated for the
s
re
particular machining requirements. Always understand that since the maximum usable
ts
feed rate and rotational speed are determined by the specifications of the tool to be used,
gh
those of the workpiece to be machined, and various other factors, actual capabilities differ
ri
from the machine specifications listed in this manual. If an inappropriate feed rate or
ll
rotational speed is designated, the workpiece or the tool may abruptly move out from the
.A
machine.
N
O
Before executing correction functions, fully check that the direction and amount of
TI
60
correction are correct. Unexpected operation of the machine will result if a correction
A
R
40
Parameters are set to the optimum standard machining conditions prior to shipping of the
R
o.
machine from the factory. In principle, these settings should not be modified. If it becomes
O
N
absolutely necessary to modify the settings, perform modifications only after thoroughly
al
ZA
Se
any program. Unexpected operation of the machine will result if the settings are modified
A
• Cutting conditions that are the result of the MAZATROL Automatic Cutting Conditions
3
Determination Function
01
WARNING
)2
• Cutting conditions for tools that are suggested to be used by the Machining Navigation
ht
Function
ig
yr
Confirm that every necessary precaution in regards to safe machine setup has been taken
op
Confirm that the machine door is securely closed before starting machining.
Failure to confirm safe machine setup may result in serious injury or death.
S-2
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Programming
Fully check that the settings of the coordinate systems are correct. Even if the designated
program data is correct, errors in the system settings may cause the machine to operate
in unexpected places and the workpiece to abruptly move out from the machine in the
WARNING
event of contact with the tool.
During surface velocity hold control, as the current workpiece coordinates of the surface
velocity hold control axes approach zeroes, the spindle speed increases significantly. For
the lathe, the workpiece may even come off if the chucking force decreases. Safety speed
limits must therefore be observed when designating spindle speeds.
Even after inch/metric system selection, the units of the programs, tool information, or
d .
parameters that have been registered until that time are not converted. Fully check these
ve
data units before operating the machine. If the machine is operated without checks being
ser
performed, even existing correct programs may cause the machine to operate differently
re
from the way it did before.
ts
gh
If a program is executed that includes the absolute data commands and relative data
ri
commands taken in the reverse of their original meaning, totally unexpected operation of
ll
the machine will result. Recheck the command scheme before executing programs.
.A
N
If an incorrect plane selection command is issued for a machine action such as arc
O
interpolation or fixed-cycle machining, the tool may collide with the workpiece or part of
TI
60
the machine since the motions of the control axes assumed and those of actual ones will
A
R
40
functions.)
R
o.
The mirror image, if made valid, changes subsequent machine actions significantly. Use
N
the mirror image function only after thoroughly understanding the above. (This precaution
al
K
ri
issued with a correction function remaining made valid, correction may become invalid
K
temporarily. If this is not thoroughly understood, the machine may appear as if it would
ZA
operate against the expectations of the operator. Execute the above commands only after
A
making the corresponding correction function invalid. (This precaution applies only to NC
M
The barrier function performs interference checks based on designated tool data. Enter
3
01
the tool information that matches the tools to be actually used. Otherwise, the barrier
)2
The system of G-code and M-code commands differs, especially for turning, between the
ht
machine operation. Thoroughly understand the system of G-code and M-code commands
op
C
S-3
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
For the machines of INTEGREX i/e-Series, programmed coordinates can be rotated using
an index unit of the MAZATROL program and a G68 command (coordinate rotate com-
mand) of the EIA/ISO program. However, for example, when the B-axis is rotated through
WARNING
180 degrees around the Y-axis to implement machining with the turning spindle No. 2, the
plus side of the X-axis in the programmed coordinate system faces downward and if the
program is created ignoring this fact, the resulting movement of the tool to unexpected
positions may incite collisions.
To create the program with the plus side of the X-axis oriented in an upward direction, use
the mirror function of the WPC shift unit or the mirror imaging function of G-code
command (G50.1, G51.1).
After modifying the tool data specified in the program, be sure to perform the tool path
d.
check function, the Virtual Machining function, and other functions, and confirm that the
ve
er
program operates properly. The modification of tool data may cause even a field-proven
s
machining program to change in operational status.
re
If the user operates the machine without being aware of any changes in program status,
ts
interference with the workpiece could arise from unexpected operation.
gh
For example, if the cutting edge of the tool during the start of automatic operation is
ri
present inside the clearance-including blank (unmachined workpiece) specified in the
ll
.A
common unit of the MAZATROL program, care is required since the tool will directly move
N
from that position to the approach point because of no obstructions being judged to be
O
present on this path.
TI
For this reason, before starting automatic operation, make sure that the cutting edge of
60
A
R
the tool during the start of automatic operation is present outside the clearance-including
40
PO
R
o.
O
N
for each axis, movements to the ending point will not usually become linear. Before using
K
ri
ZA
these functions, therefore, make sure that no obstructions are present on the path.
Se
CAUTION
A
Before starting the machining operation, be sure to confirm all contents of the program
IM
obtained by conversion. Imperfections in the program could lead to machine damage and
K
operator injury.
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
S-4
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Operations
Single-block, feed hold, and override functions can be made invalid using system
variables #3003 and #3004. Execution of this means the important modification that
makes the corresponding operations invalid. Before using these variables, therefore, give
WARNING
thorough notification to related persons. Also, the operator must check the settings of the
system variables before starting the above operations.
If manual intervention during automatic operation, machine locking, the mirror image
function, or other functions are executed, the workpiece coordinate systems will usually be
shifted. When making machine restart after manual intervention, machine locking, the
mirror image function, or other functions, consider the resulting amounts of shift and take
d.
the appropriate measures. If operation is restarted without any appropriate measures
ve
being taken, collision with the tool or workpiece may occur.
ser
Use the dry run function to check the machine for normal operation at no load. Since the
re
feed rate at this time becomes a dry run rate different from the program-designated feed
ts
gh
rate, the axes may move at a feed rate higher than the programmed value.
ri
After operation has been stopped temporarily and insertion, deletion, updating, or other
ll
commands executed for the active program, unexpected operation of the machine may
.A
result if that program is restarted. No such commands should, in principle, be issued for
N
the active program.
O
TI
60
A
During manual operation, fully check the directions and speeds of axial movement.
R
40
PO
29
For a machine that requires manual homing, perform manual homing operations after
R
turning power on. Since the software-controlled stroke limits will remain ineffective until
o.
CAUTION
O
N
manual homing is completed, the machine will not stop even if it oversteps the limit area.
C
al
ZA
Se
Do not designate an incorrect pulse multiplier when performing manual pulse handle feed
A
operations. If the multiplier is set to 1000 times and the handle operated inadvertently,
IM
S-5
Serial No. 294060
The procedure for data storage is detailed in the Operating Manual, Part 3
(OPERATING NC UNIT AND PREPARATION FOR AUTOMATIC
OPERATION), Chapter 10, (DISPLAYS RELATED TO DATA STORAGE).
d.
Always use an initialized USB memory or SD card. The USB connector and
ve
er
the SD card slot are located on the right side of the machine operating panel.
s
re
ts
gh
ri
USB memory SD card
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
On machines with a random ATC feature, each actual ATC operation changes the tool
data (in pocket numbers). Be sure not to run the machine after loading the externally
stored data of the TOOL DATA display without having confirmed the data’s
CAUTION correspondence to the current tooling on the magazine. Otherwise the machine cannot be
be guaranteed to operate normally.
S-6
Serial No. 294060
Limited Warranty
The warranty of the manufacturer does not cover any trouble arising if the NC unit is used for its
non-intended purpose. Take notice of this when operating the unit.
Examples of the trouble arising if the NC unit is used for its non-intended purpose are listed
below.
1. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any commercially available software
products (including user-created ones)
2. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any Windows operating systems
d.
ve
3. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any commercially available computer
er
equipment
s
re
ts
Operating Environment
gh
ri
1. Ambient temperature
ll
.A
During machine operation: 0° to 50°C (32° to 122°F)
N
O
2. Relative humidity
TI
60
A
During machine operation: 10 to 75% (without bedewing)
R
40
PO
deteriorate quickly.
o.
O
N
C
al
Network Setting
ri
ZA
Se
Note 1: Do not change the settings of the following two network adapters. Any changes will
K
S-7
Serial No. 294060
Note 2: Use “Ethernet_PC” to connect the NC to an intra-factory network and other systems.
Do not use, however, the following network addresses: “192.168.100.xxx” and
“192.168.202.xxx”
d .
“How to Change Network Settings”
ve
Magazine display unit for Operating Manual of the Visual Tool ID/Data Management
er
Tool ID (touch panel) “CONNECTING TO THE LOCAL AREA NETWORK”
s
re
ts
Note 3: If you configure network settings for the NC unit, using Internet Information Services
gh
(IIS) on Windows, do not use the following port numbers.
ri
ll
21
.A
683
N
43816
O
55555
TI
60
55556 A
R
40
57400
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
S-8 E
Serial No. 294060
CONTENTS
d .
2-1-2 Precautions ............................................................................................................. 2-2
ve
s er
2-2 Parameter List .................................................................................................... 2-3
re
ts
gh
2-2-1 User parameter ....................................................................................................... 2-3
ri
ll
2-2-2 Machine parameter ............................................................................................... 2-42
.A
N
2-2-3 Data I/O parameter ............................................................................................... 2-79
O
TI
60
A
2-3 Detailed Description ......................................................................................... 2-84
R
40
PO
29
O
N
C
al
ZA
Se
C-1
Serial No. 294060
d .
ve
2-3-20 Data I/O parameter TAPE parameter (TAP) .................................................... 2-586
s er
re
2-3-21 Data I/O parameter DNC parameter (DNC) ..................................................... 2-597
ts
gh
2-3-22 Data I/O parameter OTHER (IOP/DPR/IDD).................................................... 2-605
ri
ll
.A
3 ALARM ................................................................................................. 3-1
N
O
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
3-2-2 No. 1 - No. 99, No. 1000 - No. 1099 (System/Drive error) ...................................... 3-4
M
YA
3-2-3 No. 100 - No. 199, No. 1100 - No. 1199 (CNC machine control error) ................. 3-18
3
01
3-2-4 No. 200 - No. 399, No. 1200 - No. 1399 (PLC machine control error) .................. 3-39
)2
(c
ht
3-2-5 No. 400 - No. 499, No. 1400 - No. 1499 (CNC screen operation error)................ 3-77
ig
yr
3-2-6 No. 500 - No. 599, No. 1500 - No. 1599 (I/O error) ............................................ 3-102
op
C
3-2-7 No. 600 - No. 699, No. 1600 - No. 1699 (MAZATROL program error) ............... 3-117
3-2-8 No. 700 - No. 799, No. 1700 - No. 1799 (MAZATROL program error) ............... 3-133
3-2-9 No. 800 - No. 899, No. 1800 - No. 1899 (EIA/ISO program error) ...................... 3-146
3-2-10 No. 900 - No. 999, No. 1900 - No. 1999 (EIA/ISO program error) ...................... 3-164
C-2
Serial No. 294060
3-2-11 No. 2000 - No. 2099 (3D setup error) ................................................................. 3-180
3-2-13 No. 2200 - No. 2299 (CAM data output error) .................................................... 3-190
4-1 Miscellaneous Functions (M Codes) Upper Turret Commands (TR1 Side) ........ 4-1
d .
ve
er
4-2 Miscellaneous Functions (M Codes) Lower Turret Commands (TR2 Side) ...... 4-15
s
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
C-3
C
op
yr
ig
ht
(c
)2
01
3
YA
M
A Se
ZA
K ri
al
IM
N
A o.
ZA 29
K
C-4 E
40
C
O 60
Serial No. 294060
R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 294060
INTRODUCTION 1
1 INTRODUCTION
This manual describes the meaning and setting of various parameters, and the meaning and
elimination procedure of various alarms used for the MAZATROL Smooth System. This
document also gives the list of M-codes.
For detailed description of the MAZATROL Smooth System, refer to the Operating Manual of the
machine.
Read this manual and the Operating Manual of the machine carefully in order to make the best
use of the possibilities of the MAZATROL Smooth System.
.
d
ve
ser
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
1-1
1
C
op
yr
INTRODUCTION
ig
ht
(c
)2
01
3
YA
M
A Se
ZA
K ri
al
IM
N
A o.
ZA 29
K
1-2 E
40
C
O 60
Serial No. 294060
R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2 PARAMETER
2-1 Outline
1. Scope of this chapter
This chapter describes the parameters you can change as required. How to read the list is
described in the beginning. Always refer to this list to change parameters.
2. Precautions on this chapter
This chapter also gives parameters relating to optional functions. Accordingly, the list
includes parameters which cannot be changed. Check the type of machine purchased by
you and its specifications before you read the list.
.
d
ve
Note 1: The contents of this list are subjected to change without notice, for NC unit or machine
er
improvement.
s
re
Note 2: Any questions about the contents of this list should be communicated to Mazak
ts
Technical Center or Technology Center.
gh
ri
2-1-1 Types of parameters
ll
.A
Parameters, which refer to constants specific to the NC machines and equipment and the data
N
necessary for cutting operations, possess a very important meaning.
O
TI
Parameters can be broadly divided into the following three types according to their meaning.
60
A
R
User parameters
40
PO
29
The data required for processes such as point machining, line machining, plane machining,
R
turning, and EIA/ISO programmed machining, is registered. The USER PARAMETER display
o.
O
N
Machine parameters
ri
ZA
Se
Constants related to the servomotors and spindle motors, machine status data etc. are
A
registered. The MACHINE PARAMETER display is used to register the machine parameters.
IM
The data required for connection to external units such as a CMT unit and a tape unit, is
A
registered. The DATA I/O PARAMETER display which can be selected on the DATA I/O
M
2-1
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
2-1-2 Precautions
1. Details of the parameters may differ according to the machine used, the presence/absence
of an option(s), the production time of the NC machines and equipment, etc. Therefore, do
not use the parameters of other machines.
2. The parameter list is supplied in the form of data sheets within the NC electronic cabinet at
shipment of the machines. Be careful not to lose the list.
3. Before making changes to details of a parameter, make sure that the parameter is the one
to be changed.
4. If details of the parameter to be changed cannot be clearly understood, contact the nearest
Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
d .
5. When changing details of a parameter, maintain records of the old and new data.
ve
er
6. If the particular machine is not used for a long time, then the battery to protect the parameter
s
re
memory will run down. (Battery alarm)
ts
In that case, errors will occur in the parameters and thus machine malfunctions may result.
gh
To prevent this, first check the existing details of the parameters closely against the
ri
separate parameter list and then make the necessary changes to the parameters.
ll
.A
7. In addition to the parameters listed in this document, those related to PLC (Programmable
N
Logic Controller) are also available; refer to the OPERATING MANUAL of the machine for
O
details of the PLC-related parameters and the PLC Parameter List in the ELECTRIC
TI
60
WIRING DIAGRAM. A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-2
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-2 Parameter List
1. POINT (D)
Address
Outline
(bit)
d .
D3 Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom in spot-machining cycle
ve
s er
D4 Maximum allowable spot-chamfering hole diameter element
re
ts
D5 Prehole through speed during inversed spot-facing
gh
ri
D6 Drill-machining cycle setting element
ll
.A
D7 Drill-machining cycle setting element
N
O
TI
D8 Maximum diameter of holes machinable on one drill
60
A
R
40
R
o.
C
al
ZA
Se
Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom for chamfering cutter or spot-machining tool in chamfering
01
D16
cycle
)2
(c
D19 Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom for end milling
C
2-3
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
. d
D30 Number of incomplete threads in tapping cycle
ve
er
D31 Tapper elongation amount for tapping
s
re
ts
D32 Number of spindle revolutions until spindle CCW rotation begins in tapping cycle
gh
ri
D33 Back-boring tool tip relief
ll
.A
D35 Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for reamer (drilling)
N
O
D36 Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for reamer (boring)
TI
60
A
R
40
O
N
C
al
ZA
Se
D40 Number of revolutions during dwell at spot-faced hole bottom for inversed spot-facing
A
IM
D44 Selecting an automatic calculation method for the amount of chamfer with the tapping unit
)2
D48 Feed override for the section to be chamfered in the planetary tapping cycle
D49 Amount of return at hole bottom during the planetary tapping cycle
D50 Auto-set feed rate for pre-hole machining in the planetary tapping cycle
D52 Reduction ratio for the G00-based relief rate during a very-deep-hole drilling cycle
2-4
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Number of times of pecking up to the return of the tool to a position near the starting point of the
D53
very-deep-hole drilling cycle of a drilling or turning-drilling unit
D54 Deceleration rate at cutting start for very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle
D55 Drilling return distance for very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle
Number of revolutions during dwell at chip ejection position and hole bottom for very-deep-hole drilling
D56
cycle/decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle
D57 Return speed for very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle
Feed rate reduction distance ratio at cutting start of a very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental
.
D58
d
very-deep-hole machining cycle
ve
Surface speed reduction ratio at cutting end of a very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole
er
D59
machining cycle
s
re
D60 Automatic setting ratio of axial cutting feed rate during chamfering
ts
gh
D61 Nominal diameter of chamfering cutter, set during automatic tool development for a point machining unit
ri
ll
.A
D62 Maximum number of times automatic pecking is to be performed by MAZATROL programs
N
O
D63 Smooth chamfering (point machining): overlap amount
TI
60
D64
A
Smooth chamfering (point machining): tolerance between the interpolated line segment and the ideal curve
R
40
PO
29
Reduction ratio for the G00 feed rate from the chip ejection position to the return position during a deep-hole
D66
R
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
D91 0 M04 is output/not output after the tool has dwelled at the hole bottom during a tapping cycle.
K
ZA
D91 1 The tool dwells/does not dwell after M04 has been output at the hole bottom during a tapping cycle.
A
M
D91 2 The tool dwells/does not dwell after it has been returned to the R-point during a tapping cycle.
YA
D91 3 If a drill is used in the pre-machining of the centering drill cycle, the R-point height is set to D1 or not.
3
01
)2
D91 4 The finishing tool path is shortened/not shortened during a true-circle processing cycle (end milling).
(c
ht
D91 5 The tool path is shortened/not shortened during a true-circle processing cycle (chamfering).
ig
If a pre-machining tool sequence is included in the same unit, the R-point height of the drill is set/not set to D1
yr
D91 6
or D42.
op
The R-point height of the chamfering cutter during the cycle 2 is set to D42 or not.
C
D91 7 The R-point height of the spot-machining tool during the chamfering cycle (cycle 2) is set to D42 or not.
R-point height selection for smooth chamfering (point machining)
D92 0 During a true-circle processing (end milling) cycle, E17 is used for axial feed or not.
D92 1 The R1-point height of the back spot facing is set to D1 or not.
If a chamfering cutter is included in the premachining tool sequence of the same unit, the R-point height of the
D92 2
reamer is set to D1 or not.
If a chamfering cutter is included in the pre-machining tool sequence of the same unit, the R-point height of
D92 3
the tapping is set to D1 or not.
2-5
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
The position cleared radially or axially by D17 from the workpiece section concerned is subjected to check for
D92 4
interference or not.
D92 5 Dwell time designation for synchronous tapping in a MAZATROL program valid/invalid
D92 6 During planetary tapping, chips are ejected/not ejected automatically prior to the threading process.
Whether or not to generate alarm 650 CHAMFERING IMPOSSIBLE if idle cutting takes place during
D92 7
chamfering in point-machining unit
.
D94 Unidirectional positioning for point-machining
d
ve
er
D95 Auto-setting method for tapping
s
re
D96 0 Surface speed calculation for spot drill used
ts
gh
D96 1 Element that determines the counterboring pattern
ri
ll
.A
D96 2 Setting of the amount of chamfer in the spot drill tool sequence
N
Menu display setting of RGH BCB (inversed faced hole machining), BK-CBORE (back boring) and
O
D96 3 CBOR-TAP (counterbore tapping), as well as BACKSPOT FACER (inversed spot-facing tool) and BACK
TI
60
D96 4 Conditions to determine the CIRC MIL operation for the specification without Y-axis
PO
29
R
o.
D96 5 Setting of the start point Y of the cylindrical surface in the C-axis point machining unit
O
N
D96 6
Switching of the restrictions according to the cutting edge angle of a chamfering tool
ri
ZA
Se
D97 0 Cutting drawing method for circular milling unit on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display
K
ZA
Action to be taken when the number of times pecking has been performed has reached the set maximum
D98 0
A
count
M
YA
D98 1 Execution of the INDEX unit when the PRI.No. is set in the MANUAL PROGRAM
3
01
D106 0 Machine operation when machining units are not preceded by an indexing unit
C
D106 1 Execution of an index command after the second or subsequent work coordinate command in WPC unit
Initial point position in the case where R-point is located outside the clearance around the workpiece at an
D106 3
arbitrary B-axis angle
D106 5 Alarm output timing when the first machining unit is not preceded by an index unit
2-6
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
D106 6 X-axis wear offset direction in the Z offset type milling back face [XY] mode
Selection of the C-axis positioning execution for the workpiece measurement in the WPC workpiece or
D106 7
initial-point scheme
D107 2 Alarm output when 3D coordinate conversion mode cancel is specified in the manual program unit
D107 3 Unit of feed rate for the feed per minute command in manual program units for the inch system
.
D107 4 Calculation method for mill spindle speed when spot chamfering
d
ve
er
D130 Chip ejection distance in deep-hole drilling cycle
s
re
D131 G00 feed-in speed override for deep-hole boring cycle
ts
gh
D141 0 Chip ejection operation during deep-hole drilling cycle
ri
ll
.A
D141 1 Feed-in operation selection for deep-hole boring cycle
N
O
D141 2 Circular milling unit: Circular processing selection method switch
TI
60
PO
29
2. LINE/FACE/3D (E)
o.
O
N
Address
al
Outline
K
(bit)
ri
ZA
Se
E2 Cutting start point and escape point setting element (the first clearance)
K
ZA
E5 Element used to set the cutting start point and escape point (the second clearance)
YA
3
E10 Depth-of-cut-R automatic setting element (Face milling, End milling-top, End milling-step)
E12 Radial interference clearance of face milling unit and angular face milling unit
E14 Depth-of-cut-R automatic setting element (Pocket milling, Pocket milling-mountain, Pocket milling-valley)
2-7
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
E15 Tool path setting element for face milling-top unit (reciprocating short)
E19 Returning feed rate override in case of bidirectional cutting for rough-machining of the end milling-slot unit.
E20 Axial cutting feed override during Z-axial cutting in the pecking mode of face machining
d .
ve
er
E21 Wall-cutting overlap in closed figure
s
re
E22 Override value of automatic corner over-riding
ts
gh
E23 Effective removal allowance (upper limit) of automatic corner overriding
ri
ll
E24 Effective removal allowance (lower limit) of automatic corner overriding
.A
N
E25 Effective angle (upper limit) of automatic corner overriding
O
TI
60
E26 A
Calculation coefficient for the finishing feed of line milling
R
40
PO
29
E27 Radial direction feed rate calculation reference diameter for finish cutting in line machining unit
R
o.
O
N
E28 Finishing feed rate calculation reference feed rate in line machining unit
C
al
K
ri
ZA
E29 Selection of whether the cutting conditions in the shape sequence during VFC mode are to be modified
Se
An element that determines the starting point and escape point of radial cutting when CLOSED is specified
E30
IM
for the wall attributes at the starting point and ending point of open-pattern line machining
K
E31 Element that determines the amount of OPEN attribute wall protrusion in pocket-machining shape units
ZA
A
E32 Element that automatically determines an approaching radius in a Z-direction helical approach scheme
M
YA
E34 Element that automatically determines an approaching distance in a Z-direction tapered approach scheme
)2
(c
E36 Element that automatically determines an escape distance in the Z-direction tapered escape scheme
yr
op
E37 The amount of return of pecking in the Z-axial pecking mode of face machining
C
E38 The returning feed rate of pecking in the Z-axial pecking mode of face machining
Element that automatically determines the depth-of-cut-R (Pocket milling, Pocket milling-mountain, Pocket
E39
milling-valley, End milling-slot)
E41 Amount of in-feed per revolution in the Z-axis direction in helical approach (helical 2)
2-8
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.d
ve
er
E61 3-D, Search length for parallel cutting
s
re
E62 3-D, Search length for right-angle cutting
ts
gh
E63 3-D, Pattern display division segment (FL direction)
ri
ll
E64 3-D, Pattern display division segment (GL direction)
.A
N
E65 3-D, Radial cutting allowance for area check
O
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
E77 3-D, Radial cutting allowance for high-speed rough processing (workpiece size appointment)
Se
E83 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing (offset appointment)
ZA
A
E84 3-D, Region of axial machining during high-speed rough processing (offset appointment)
M
YA
E85 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing: –X (workpiece size appointment)
3
01
E86 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing: +X (workpiece size appointment)
)2
(c
E87 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing: –Y (workpiece size appointment)
ht
ig
E88 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing: +Y (workpiece size appointment)
yr
op
E89 3-D, Region of axial machining during high-speed rough processing (workpiece size appointment)
C
2-9
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
E96 2 Approach method selection for 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting in end milling-slot unit
E96 4 Approach point for 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting in end milling-slot unit
Smooth chamfering (end milling-slot): Switching of restrictions according to the cutting edge angle of the
E96 7
chamfering tool
d .
ve
E98 Cutting method selection for end milling-mountain, pocket milling-valley unit
s er
re
E99 0 Milling feed rate specification range for the shape sequence of the MAZATROL program
ts
gh
E99 1 Bottom/wall simultaneous finishing mode for pocket machining
ri
ll
E99 3 Interference check between the approach point and the cutting starting point of face machining
.A
N
E99 4 Alarm generating condition during the approach or escape for line machining
O
TI
60
Machining start point calculation method after automatic determination of approach point in line machining
PO
E99 6
29
unit
R
o.
E104 0 Cutting method to be used after an approach point is automatically determined during line/face machining
N
C
al
ZA
Se
E104 3 Infeed position when a CLOSED attribute is assigned to the wall of line machining
K
ZA
E104 5 Method of connecting between shapes during wall finish of face machining
3
E105 0 B-axis user-defined angle setting during C-axis central line machining
ig
yr
E105 2 Z-axis sign inversion at ZC/ZY during line/face machining on the MULTIPLEX HD2 side
CW direction selection during line/face machining in the composite program on the MULTIPLEX HD2 side
E105 4
(engraving unit excluded)
E105 5 C-axis angle selection during Y-axis milling on the MULTIPLEX HD2 side
Reference plane for the chamfering program of the LINE RGT/LINE LFT/LINE IN unit in the ZC mode line
E105 6
machining (cylindrical surface)
2-10
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
E105 7 Operation when tool path generation using WID-R specified for pocket milling fails
E106 0 Selection of the initial point as a relay point to be used after TPC approach (line/face machining unit)
E106 1 Selection of a relay point to be used before TPC escapement (line/face machining unit)
Display of a warning message when a corner radius is automatically inserted to a shape during intelligent
E108 0
pocket milling (IPM) path creation
Display of a warning message when an uncut residue remains due to nose R during intelligent pocket milling
E108 1
(IPM) path creation
E108 4 Execution of a full-circle path movement after helical approach in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining
d .
ve
er
E108 5 Operation on failure of tool entry during intelligent pocket milling (IPM)
s
re
E109 Allowable limits of engage angle in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining
ts
gh
E110 Maximum radius of arc inserted for intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining
ri
ll
E111 Element that determines the tool paths in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining (Pocket milling-valley)
.A
N
E112 Maximum wall avoidance distance in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining
O
TI
60
E113 Bottom face avoidance distance/clearance for recovering surface speed in plane machining
A
R
40
PO
29
E115 Magnification factor of the minimum arc of trochoid cycle in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining
R
o.
E116 Feedrate override for non-cutting feed in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining
N
C
al
E129 Amount of overlapping in groove expanding operation in the end milling-slot unit
ri
ZA
Se
E130 Smooth chamfering (end milling slot): tolerance between the interpolated line segments and the ideal curve
IM
K
E141 1 Face milling-/end milling-top unit: Cutting start point determination method at manual approach point setting
ig
yr
op
E141 2 Round bar face milling unit: Approach point/cutting start point before automatic approach point setting
C
E141 3 Round bar face milling unit: Cutting start point after automatic approach point setting
E141 7 Operation upon specifying a figure of eight for free closed pattern of line/face machining unit
2-11
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
3. EIA/ISO (F)
Address
Outline
(bit)
F4 Distance to judge the shape formed by 3 axes under tool tip point control in the 5-axis fairing function
F5 Distance to judge the shape formed by rotary 2 axes in the 5-axis fairing function
d .
ve
er
F6 Minimum allowable height of stepped sections for deceleration in high-speed smoothing control mode
s
re
F7 Fixed value (0)
ts
gh
F8 Corner deceleration speed coefficient for high-speed smoothing control
ri
ll
F9 Circular cutting clamp speed coefficient for high-speed smoothing control
.A
N
F10 Return amount during tap high-speed deep-hole cycle
O
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
F21 Maximum inside-corner angle available with automatic corner override (G62)
yr
op
C
2-12
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
F32 Operation when argument R is omitted from the maximum/minimum spindle speed setting
F33 0 Incorporation of the MAZATROL tool length into the current position counter valid/invalid
F33 3 Selection of check in the course of automatic operation when data is input/output through network
.
F33 4 Selection of restart setting method in the MAZATROL program
d
ve
er
F33 5 Automatic tool identification of turning tools in TOOL EYE manual tool length measurement
s
re
F33 6 Modal indication for G-code group No. 1 in the fixed cycle mode
ts
gh
F33 7 Modal indication on “radius data input for X-axis” in the mode of 3D coordinate conversion (G68.5)
ri
ll
.A
F34 0 Cancellation of the ram spindle offset command (G52.1) when the RESET key is pressed valid/invalid
N
O
F34 1 Representation on the POSITION display for G49 (only for the INTEGREX e Series)
TI
60
F34 2
A
Parts count override in the middle of automatic operation
R
40
PO
29
Tool change command output position of the tool to use in manual program unit when WPC is selected for
F34 3
R
workpiece scheme
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F34 6 Compensating movement for a T-code with a movement command in one block
K
ZA
F34 7 Application of Z-OFFSET and C-OFFSET values for the tape operation mode
A
Selection whether or not multiple material pieces can be arranged on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D
M
F35 0
MONITOR display
YA
Automatic setting of the material model for a MAZATROL program of initial-point scheme on the VIRTUAL
F35 1
3
When assigning G-code for a cutting function not to be represented with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD
)2
F35 2
being selected for automatic operation, operation is continued/alarm state
(c
When a program prepared and stored for the Hard Disk operation is called up as a subprogram with the
ht
F35 3
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being selected for automatic operation, operation is continued/alarm state
ig
yr
F35 4 Representation of cutting-off or parting operation on the VIRTUAL MACHINING and 3D MONITOR displays
op
Movement of traction tailstock or carriage-connection steadyrest during zero-point return operation of all axes
C
F35 5
on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display
Alarming/No alaming when the feed-overriding value has been changed in the flow of automatic operation
F35 7
with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being active
2-13
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
F36 3 Error check function in cases where numerical data is omitted in the EIA program or in MDI mode
Display of the chuck and tailstock areas for an EIA/ISO program on the TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK
F36 4
display
Number of effective decimal digits in the tool axis vector components (I, J, K) for tool tip point control type 2
F36 6
(G43.5) and cutting point command type 2 (G43.9)
.
F37 0 Temporary cancellation of geometry compensation for G0 (rapid traverse) in the mode of tool tip point control
d
ve
er
F37 1 Subprogram call given in manual program unit (for turning machines only)
s
re
F37 2 Tool length compensation in MDI operation
ts
gh
F37 3 Timing of clearing #3006 (stop) message
ri
ll
Selection of the coordinate system for linear interpolation on specification of a rapid traverse command during
.A
F37 4
tool tip point control
N
Operation when running programs in the hard disk or through Ethernet with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
O
F37 5
SHIELD enabled for automatic operation
TI
60
PO
29
F38 0 Options displayed in the tool model type selection window according to the tool type
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F38 2 Font size setting for EIA/ISO PROGRAM display and EIA MONITOR display
A
IM
F39 Plane to be used for an EIA/ISO program (called by a subprogram unit) and a manual program unit
3
01
)2
2-14
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
F70 Availability of multiple-machining and designated number of repetitions in the EIA/ISO subprogram
.
F74 S-code execution time for time study
d
ve
er
F75 T-code execution time for time study
s
re
F76 B-code execution time for time study
ts
gh
F77 Basis rate for tool life judgment
ri
ll
.A
F78 Selection of separating ratio of graphic display
N
O
F79 0 Holding of memory monitor address valid/invalid
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F80 1 Automatic display of the navigation window on the occurrence of an alarm valid/invalid
(c
ht
2-15
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
F81 6 Retaining the program transfer settings valid/invalid
d
ve
er
F81 7 Input error prevention function valid/invalid
s
re
F82 0 Characteristics estimation result graph, displayed/not displayed
ts
gh
Selection of inch/metric representation in POSITION display, TOOL DATA display, and TOOL OFFSET
F82 1
ri
display modes valid/invalid
ll
.A
F82 2 Basis for tool life judgment
N
O
F82 3 —
TI
60
F82 4
A
X-axis diameter display on the POSITION display valid/invalid
R
40
PO
29
F82 5 —
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F83 2 —
YA
F83 3 —
3
01
)2
F83 4 —
(c
ht
F83 5 —
ig
yr
F83 6 —
op
C
F83 7 —
Selection of whether or not the tool offset data is taken into account for the POSITION counter during the
F84 0
execution of EIA/ISO programs
F84 3 Timing to validate new workpiece offset data specified with a system variable
2-16
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
F84 7 Operation executed/not executed when the tool data has not bee set
.
F85 1 Radial interference check
d
ve
er
F85 2 Type of coordinate system for controlling the tool tip point
s
re
F85 3 Tool tip point control scheme
ts
gh
F85 4 Fixed value (0)
ri
ll
.A
F85 5 Reset to cancel G68.2, valid/invalid
N
O
F85 6 Display of surface definition
TI
60
F85 7
A
Output of the B-axis unclamping code before B-axis indexing, valid/invalid
R
40
PO
29
F86 0 Output of M250 (Spindle Speed Confirmation) before a turning feed, valid/invalid
R
o.
O
N
F86 1 Milling-spindle start timing for a milling unit (with MILL&TURN. set under TYPE of UNo. 0)
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
F86 6 Selection of rotary axis reference position for tool tip point control
3
01
)2
F87 0 Selection of whether or not the machine is to be offset by each change only in the deviation vector
(c
Selection of whether or not the check for mismatch of the workpiece origin and table rotation center is to be
ht
F87 1
conducted
ig
yr
F87 5 Common variables (#500 and on) are cleared by resetting or at the program end, invalid/valid
F87 6 Local variables are cleared by resetting or at the program end, invalid/valid
F87 7 Common variables (#100 to #199) are cleared by resetting or at the program end, invalid/valid
2-17
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
F88 Specifications related to the conversion from MAZATROL program into an EIA program
F89 1 [For EIA conversion] G-codes for synchronous tapping: G74/G84 or G84.2/G84.3
.
F89 4 [For EIA conversion] Output destination, standard area/ backup area
d
ve
er
F89 5 —
s
re
F89 6 [For EIA conversion] Returning to the second zero point before tool change (output of G30)
ts
gh
F89 7 Fixed value (0)
ri
ll
.A
F91 0 In response to move command without decimal point, tool moves by 1/tool moves by 10
N
O
F91 1 Coordinate system shift using a MAZATROL program, valid/invalid
TI
60
F91 2
A
Stroke inside check before movement/Stroke outside check before movement
R
40
PO
29
F91 3 —
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F91 7 G33E command is for the number of threads per inch/command is for thread cutting with precise lead
A
M
F92 7 ACT-/NOSE-R in the TOOL DATA display for an EIA/ISO program, invalid/valid
2-18
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
F93 7 Fixed value (0)
d
ve
er
F94 0 Movement to hole-drilling position in fixed-cycle mode
s
re
F94 1 External deceleration signal valid/invalid
ts
gh
F94 2 Tool length offset cancellation upon zero point return by G28/G30 or manual operation, enabled/disabled
ri
ll
.A
F94 3 Modal at power-on or at reset (G01/G00)
N
O
F94 4 Tool command method using T-codes
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F95 4 Wear offset check scheme with the input error prevention function enabled
3
01
)2
F95 5 Alarm display when the slave or adaptor unit is not connected
(c
ht
F95 6 Manual-pulse interrupt amount cancellation with the RESET key, valid/invalid
ig
yr
F95 7 Coordinate system corresponding to G54 set with the RESET key, valid/invalid
op
C
F96 2 Processing for arc command blocks in high-speed machining mode, nonuniform feed/uniform feed
F96 3 —
2-19
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
F96 7 —
F97 Selection of G-code of the coordinates system to be used in the EIA conversion function
Offset amount for the subprogram WNo. to the main WNo. concerned in case of output with subprogram in
.
F99
d
the EIA conversion function
ve
er
F100 Spline cancel length
s
re
F101 Spline cancel angle
ts
gh
F102 Fine spline interpolation curve error (Block including the point of inflection)
ri
ll
.A
F103 Spline interpolation fairing block length, 5-axis spline interpolation small block length
N
Fine spline interpolation curve error (block including no inflection point), 5-axis spline interpolation curve error,
O
F104
5-axis fairing command error
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F111 3 Direction of rotation of the C-axis during C-axial threading with G01.1
YA
Counting all types of use under the same tool number for the tool life management on the TOOL DATA
C
F113 0
display executed/not executed
F113 1 Data handling on the milling tool of a group that has expired in tool life
F113 2 Data handling on the turning tool of a group that has expired in tool life
2-20
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
F114 0 Selection of the maximum C-axial cutting feed rate for the inch system
Selection of the operation occurring during the control of the tool tip point when command G49 is issued
F114 1
(when the tool length offset value is canceled)
B-axis angle check during measurement of the turning tool for which OUT is specified in “section to be
.
F114 2
d
machined”, valid/invalid
ve
er
F114 3 Moving axes by using G49 (tool length cancel) in G43 (tool length offset) mode, valid/invalid
s
re
F114 4 Selecting a rethreading function
ts
gh
F114 5 Output timing of a tool life alarm
ri
ll
.A
F114 6 Initial setting of G53.5
N
O
F114 7 Judging tool life from the count of machined workpieces, valid/invalid
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F119 Runout feed rate for the inside diameter threading cycle
A
IM
Processing of work offset specified with G53.1 for the machine whose table rotary axis is not an axis that
3
F123 1 rotates around the Z-axis on the INTEGREX type (the machine specification featuring both the tool rotary axis
01
F123 2 Shape drawing: Validity of a mirroring command specified in the M CODE unit
(c
ht
F123 3 MDI tool change enable/disable for tools with no tool data
ig
yr
Execution of the workpiece axis offset in association with Z-axis feed in the hobbing mode independently of
op
F123 5
hobbing axis rotating status
C
F124 Permissible data alteration amount 1 for input error prevention function
F125 Permissible data alteration amount 2 for input error prevention function
F126 Maximum wear offset setting with the input error prevention function enabled
F128 5-axis spline interpolation angular error, 5-axis fairing angular error
2-21
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
F136 Amount of offset for dummy workpiece shape on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display
F137 Number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for No. 1 turning spindle
.
F138 Number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for No. 2 turning spindle
d
ve
Angle offset for the jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for the No. 1
er
F139
turning spindle
s
re
Angle offset for the jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for the No. 2
F140
ts
turning spindle
gh
F142 Background color of spindle override window displayed when the external override function is used
ri
ll
Operation when workpiece counting is made valid while the automatic operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY
.A
F143 0
SHIELD is enabled
N
O
F143 1 Status of [STORE WORKPCE MATERIAL] when the power is turned on
TI
60
F143 2 —
A
R
40
PO
29
Setting of the section to cancel the collision check function between the TOOL EYE sensor and the tool with
F143 3
R
O
N
F143 5 X-axis diameter/radius input mode after the G136 command (measurement macro call)
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
F144 1 Selection of table rotary axis reference position for inclined-surface machining
A
M
F144 2 Resetting of a tool life alarm with the alarm clear button
YA
F144 5 Selection of operation by the G49 command immediately after a macro variable command
(c
ht
F144 6 Deletion of unnecessary codes during EIA/ISO conversion for machining centers
ig
yr
F144 7 Deletion of G92.5 blocks during EIA/ISO conversion for machining centers
op
C
Selection of the material model’s part to be taken off (hidden) on the VIRTUAL MACHINING and 3D
F146
MONITOR displays in the flow of turning operation under synchronization of both spindles
F148 Compensation amount for G41/G42 given in a manual program (MANL PRG) unit
F149 Operation between blocks when single block mode is switched from ON to OFF during automatic operation
2-22
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Switching of the material geometry when execution of a program is returned to the head during continuous
F151 2
program run
Valid/invalid of wear offset (mill tool/touch sensor) on the TOOL DATA display when the tool length offset
F151 6
function for turning tools (G43P1) is used
.
F151 7 Time stamp used at the time of read/write command to macro variable #3001 (power-on time)
d
ve
er
F152 Fixed value (0)
s
re
F153 SMART font display, valid/invalid
ts
gh
F154 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited
ri
ll
.A
F155 0 Material geometry display for programs converted into the EIA format
N
O
F155 3 Operation when argument I is omitted from the tap cycle command having argument Q
TI
60
F155 5
A
Setup data editing during automatic GL operation, disabled/enabled
R
40
PO
29
F155 7 Setting of the spindle to be displayed in the results of machining navigation for the mill-turning unit
R
o.
O
N
The operating status and the drawing on the 3D MONITOR display when a cutting command associated with
C
F156 0
al
ZA
The operating status and the drawing on the 3D MONITOR display when a cutting command associated with
Se
F156 1
rotary axis movement is specified with the automatic ISS valid
A
IM
Separation between rotary axis and linear axis when moving axes during workpiece placement error
F156 2
correction
K
ZA
F156 3 Selection of solution to workpiece placement error correction (primary rotary axis sign prioritized)
A
M
F156 4 Pitch division in the case when the arc length exceeds the maximum value during helical/spiral interpolation
YA
F156 5 Single-block stop when the VFC key is pressed with override set to 100%
3
01
)2
MAZATROL table selection unit (2 tables) on the VIRTUAL MACHINING, 3D MONITOR, or 3D SETUP
F157 3
display
Switching of the axis directions for the VTC machine model on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR
F157 4
display
2-23
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
F157 7 Whether or not to set 5-axis spline interpolation tolerance (chord error) specified curve error
F158 1 Output timing of MSTB command after a movement command under geometry compensation
.
F158 3 Drawing mode of the upper and lower turrets during Y-axis turning/pinch-cutting
d
ve
Distinguishing the unit number that matches the selected head by color when the compound type
er
F158 4
MAZATROL program is displayed in the process selection window
s
re
Output of an alarm when a process is selected for the head differing from the selected head in the process
F158 5
ts
selection window where the compound type MAZATROL program is displayed
gh
F158 6 Bar loader schedule function, valid/invalid
ri
ll
Selection of wear offset direction when the tool length compensation and 3D coordinate conversion functions
.A
F158 7
are used together
N
Timing of data creation for the MACHINING NAVIGATION - RESULT display with workpiece counting made
O
F159 0
valid
TI
60
F159 1
A
Modal selection at power on or at reset (G64/G61.1)
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F159 4 Whether or not to display on the POSITION display a spindle output diagram stored in the setting file
A
IM
F159 6 Reflecting tool offset (tool wear offset/tool geometry offset) in the G53.5 mode in the current position
A
M
F159 7 Offset direction judgment selection for steps for workpiece measurement
YA
F160 4 Display of the measured value on the AUTO MEASURE display in O.D./I.D. measurement, diameter/radius
op
Alarm output when the actual measurement of the C-axis coordinate is carried out with the sensor ON
C
F160 5 because it did not go off due to insufficient C-axis return distance after temporary measurement of the C-axis
coordinate
Switching the collision check method during automatic operation with the ISS function set valid when
F160 6
measuring a tool by the TOOL EYE
F160 7 Priority change when erasing the tool path from the TOOL PATH CHECK display or TRACE display
2-24
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
F161 6 C/Z offset when a MAZATROL program is called from an EIA program
.
F161 7 C/Z offset when an EIA program is called from a MAZATROL program
d
ve
Movement/No movement according to the particular amount of offset during independent start of tool tip point
er
F162 0
control
s
re
F162 1 Type of passage of tool tip point through singular point
ts
gh
F162 2 Chamfer/corner R-command address selection
ri
ll
.A
F162 3 Fixed hole-machining cycle return selection
N
O
F162 4 6 digits in T-command for turning
TI
60
F162 5
A
Use of the M Pro scheme as the method of selecting the Length correction axis bit
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F163 1 Incorporation of wear offset data into the current position display in EIA/ISO program mode, valid/invalid
K
ZA
F163 2 Incorporation of wear offset data into the current position display in MAZATROL program mode, valid/invalid
A
M
F163 3 Position of thread turning tool nose on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display
YA
2-25
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
F165 1 X-axis movement to minus side during polar coordinate interpolation, enabled/disabled
F165 3 C-axis indexing when EIA subprogram is called from MAZATROL program
.
F165 5 Conversion of tool set data for milling tool based on head swivel angle when G53.5 is commanded
d
ve
er
F165 6 Behavior of automatic operation of an EIA program when Z-offset is not set
s
re
F165 7 Setting at CONTI. of the end unit during tool path check, valid/invalid
ts
gh
Alteration of tool set value (tool length) on the TOOL DATA display in the automatic operation mode,
F166 0
ri
enabled/disabled
ll
.A
F166 1 Type of wear offset indicated in the milling tool list on the TOOL DATA display
N
O
F166 2 ID No./Tool name selection on the TOOL DATA display
TI
60
F166 3
A
Selection whether the selected plane on the TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK display is to be held
R
40
PO
29
Operation conducted when [RESTART] is tapped following completion of the search in EIA modal restarting
F166 4
R
mode
o.
O
N
F166 5 Tool diameter auto-setting for the end mill, face mill, and ball end mill on the TOOL DATA display
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
F167 1 Handling the diameter/radius of point R during the hole-machining fixed cycle
A
M
F167 4 Connecting the path linearly/Alarm, if the arc internal correction value is greater than the arc radius
(c
ht
F167 7 Updating the current position by a press of the RESET key in manual operation mode
Rotational center offset is added/not added to the tool length when the tool axial tool length offset command
F168 2
(G43.1) is issued.
F168 3 Axis for the milling tool wear correction and TOOL EYE compensation amount for the B-axis rotational turret
2-26
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
The function to restart machine operation after the detection of collision by the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
F169 2
SHIELD function
.
F169 3 Fixed value (0)
d
ve
er
F169 4 Handling of smooth corner control setting width when G61.1 is specified in MAZATROL programs
s
re
F169 5 Calling of the program specified in the end unit upon reaching the target part count, enabled/disabled
ts
gh
F169 7 Fixed value (0)
ri
ll
.A
F170 0 Consideration of the offset amount of dynamic offsetting II at the current position
N
O
F170 2 Tool offset changed in an EIA program in a tool path check
TI
60
F170 3
A
Continuous diameter display of the X-axis coordinates on the POSITION screen
R
40
PO
29
O
N
F242 Threshold for the travel ratio between the tool tip point and machine end point for time study
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
F271 Smooth corner control function: Arc cutting clamp speed coefficient
YA
F272 Smooth corner control function: Arc cutting clamp speed coefficient for high-speed smooth control
3
01
)2
F274 Cutting feedrate override rate in the tool axial direction for the EIA/ISO engraving function
ig
yr
F301 INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD: Tool path accuracy for collision check processing
2-27
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
F304 Alarm wait time during [CUT] restarting search during VIRTUAL MACHINING
F326 Automatic operation intelligent safety shield (ISS)/virtual machining interference check selection
F328 Real time tuning II Number of buffers for calculating the average of optimum time constants
.
F329 2 Mating tool selection function for automatic tool length setting of FLASH tool
d
ve
er
F329 3 Automatic M code output for smooth restart
s
re
F329 4 Operation to return to the restarting position for smooth restart
ts
gh
F330 0 Hobbing selection
ri
ll
.A
F330 1 Hobbing axis (V-axis) clamping speed selection in hobbing II (position controlled hobbing)
N
Machine coordinate display of hobbing axis (V-axis) and workpiece spindle (C-axis) in hobbing II (position
O
F330 2
controlled hobbing)
TI
60
F330 7
A
Life count for multiple tools with the same tool number and different tool names
R
40
PO
29
F331 2 Command unit for thread cutting shift angle (Q command), for the G-code series for machining centers
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
F335 0 Tool nose center speed clamp operation in the cutting point command mode
A
IM
F335 1 Disabling linear axis distortion cancel in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode
K
ZA
F335 2 Disabling rotary axis distortion cancel in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode
A
Action to take when the part count is set using the program with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD enabled
M
F335 7
for automatic operation
YA
F336 0 Control mode selection for rapid feed in the cutting point command mode
3
01
)2
F336 1 Cutting point selection in a singular posture in the cutting point command mode
(c
ht
2-28
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
I5 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable override: Minimum value
I7 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable control area (lower limit side)
I8 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable control area (upper limit side)
I9 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable control area lower limit
.
I10 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable control area upper limit
d
ve
er
I11 Rotary center of a workpiece
s
re
I12 Clamping value for the amount of handle interruption
ts
gh
I13 0 Execution of G28 (reference-point return)
ri
ll
.A
I13 1 Manual zero-point return operation
N
O
I13 2 Axis display when a control axis is removed
TI
60
PO
29
I14 0 Mirror image with respect to the machine zero point, valid/invalid
R
o.
O
N
I14 1 —
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Tool-tip relief after spindle orientation during execution of G75, G76, G86 or point-machining (boring or
I14 3
back-boring), valid/invalid
K
Direction of tool-tip relief after spindle orientation during execution of G75, G76, G86 or point-machining
ZA
I14 4
(boring or back-boring)
A
M
I14 5 —
YA
I14 6 —
3
01
)2
I14 7 —
(c
ht
I17 Amount of work hand rotational error correction (Work hand angle: 0°)
ig
yr
I18 Amount of work hand rotational error correction (Work hand angle: 45°)
op
C
I19 Amount of work hand rotational error correction (Work hand angle: 90°)
2-29
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
5. SYSTEM (SU)
Address
Outline
(bit)
d .
ve
SU6 Axis setting J for plane selection
s er
re
SU7 Axis setting K for plane selection
ts
gh
SU8 Axis setting K for plane selection
ri
ll
SU9 Axis setting K for plane selection
.A
N
SU10 Selection of tool change command output position
O
TI
60
PO
29
SU12 Rotating position specified in the indexing unit after tool change
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
SU14 Tool nose mark display color on the TOOL PATH CHECK display/TRACE display
Se
A
IM
SU16 Movement to C-axis index swivel position when Z-offset scheme is used
ZA
A
M
Selecting the method of axis movement to the tool change command output position or to the position
SU19
)2
Selection of returning operation after the execution of the workpiece transfer unit corresponding to the work
yr
SU21
hand angle to be changed
op
Method of axis movement from the initial point or the escape TPC relay point to the rotating position in the
C
SU22
indexing unit
SU24 Spindle speed multiplication factor in the execution of a composite-type fixed cycle
SU29 Specification of an axis (linear axis) on a plane during polar coordinate interpolation
2-30
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
SU30 Specification of an axis (rotary axis) on a plane during polar coordinate interpolation
Axis movement pattern to the return position set in the end unit of initial-point scheme program for
SU31
multi-tasking machine
.
SU52 Lower-turret retraction function - Tool number of the retraction tool 1
d
ve
er
SU53 Lower-turret retraction function - Tool number of the retraction tool 2
s
re
SU54 Allowable limit of axis movement completion waiting time when a cross machining command is executed
ts
gh
SU55 Wait time for accessing the programs in the hard disk operation area/Ethernet operation area
ri
ll
.A
SU56 For setting SPRINT interface (option), fixed value
N
SU97 -
O
Lower-turret retraction function - Fixed point of the retraction position
TI
SU100
60
SU102
A
Return distance at wall during rough cutting in bar machining or in corner machining of EIA/ISO program
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
SU105 Cut depth (diametral value) for final cut in composite-type thread cutting cycle of EIA/ISO program
A
IM
Minimum cut depth clamping value (radial value) in composite-type thread cutting cycle G276 of EIA/ISO
SU106
program
K
ZA
SU110 -
)2
Lower turret width setting for barrier expansion by the difference in X-axis angle between the upper and lower
ht
SU122
turrets
ig
yr
SU123 Admissible motion range on the primary rotational axis for workpiece placement error correction
op
C
SU124 Admissible motion range on the secondary rotational axis for workpiece placement error correction
SU126 Amount of offset for runout of the B-axis center (BA61) (only for Maza-Check)
SU127 Amount of offset for B-axis - spindle nose distance offset (BA62) (only for Maza-Check)
Retraction position of the upper and lower turrets at the end of the two-workpiece machining sequence
SU128
(X-axis)
2-31
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
Retraction position of the upper and lower turrets at the end of the two-workpiece machining sequence
SU129
(Z-axis)
.
SU134 Chopping clamp speed
d
ve
er
SU135 Acceleration/deceleration time constant during chopping
s
re
SU136 Chopping compensation coefficient
ts
gh
SU137 Chopping tolerance
ri
ll
.A
SU153 0 M-code selection for tapping cycle
N
O
SU153 1 Display of BUFFER on the POSITION display
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
“C-axis Clamp” machining method for MAZATROL programs (line/linear machining for the C-axis CYLIND
SU153 5
Se
mode)
A
IM
“C-axis Clamp” machining method for MAZATROL programs (line/linear machining for the C-axis FACE
ZA
SU153 7
mode)
A
M
Correction timing of the touch sensor tool length during EIA/ISO programmed or MDI operation
SU155 1
(for machining center specifications only)
2-32
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
SU155 3 Judgment method for tool change command output during MAZATROL programmed operation
SU155 4 Tool change command output at the start of MAZATROL programmed operation
SU155 7 Reference value for judging tool breakage during laser tool measurement
.
SU156 4 Type of deep-hole drilling cycle G83/G87
d
ve
er
SU156 5 Fixed value (0)
s
re
Execution of the restarting search for a block in the mode of G68 when tool length compensation (G43/G44)
SU156 6
ts
remains valid with a turning tool mounted
gh
SU156 7 Execution of the restarting search for a block after the cancellation of the cross command
ri
ll
The scheme of axis movement during an approach and during movement to the tool change command output
.A
SU157 1
position for machining at the work hand side
N
O
SU157 2 Conditions for returning to the tool change command output position in the manual program unit (MANL PRG)
TI
60
SU157 3
A
Movement to the tool rotating position for tool change command for the same TNo.
R
40
PO
29
SU157 4 Operation to be performed if either TURN POS X, Y, or Z of the indexing unit is left blank.
R
o.
O
N
Preparatory C-axis positioning to 0° for a manual program unit (MANL PRG) with a milling tool after a turning
C
SU157 5
unit
al
K
ri
ZA
SU157 6 Selection of Y-axis movement to the zero point when a turning tool is mounted
Se
A
IM
Selection of whether or not the B-axis rotation radius is to be included into the “clearance position” for
SU157 7
changing the indexed cutting edge on one and the same FLASH tool
K
ZA
SU158 1 Conditions for wear compensation of turning tools in manual program unit
YA
Checking the rotational axes’ correction values in workpiece placement error correction for MAZATROL
SU158 2
3
programs
01
)2
SU159 1 Selection of whether or not to consider the tool length for tip position memory on the WORK OFFSET display
SU165 0 Current position display for milling tool with B-axis angle reflected in manual operation mode
2-33
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
6. TURNING (TC)
Address
Outline
(bit)
Cut depth reduction rate for rough cutting in bar machining unit, corner machining unit, and copy machining
TC1
unit
TC2 Acceleration rate in up-going taper for rough cutting in bar machining unit
TC3 Acceleration rate in up-going wall slope (90°) for rough cutting in bar machining unit
Selection of chamfering pattern in rough external turning cycle G71 (G271) or rough edge-machining cycle
TC4
G72 (G272)
TC5 Deceleration rate in down-going taper for rough cutting in bar machining unit
.d
ve
TC6 Deceleration rate in down-going wall slope (90°) for rough cutting in bar machining unit
er
s
re
TC7 Acceleration rate on outside stock contour for rough cutting in copy machining unit
ts
gh
TC8 Acceleration pitch error ratio in thread cutting unit
ri
ll
TC9 Rough cutting residue ratio in cutting off cycle in groove cutting unit
.A
Cut depth allowable incremental rate for rough cutting in groove cutting unit, edge machining unit and copy
N
TC10
O
machining unit
TI
60
PO
R
o.
TC13 Deceleration rate at rough cutting start in bar machining unit and copy machining unit
N
C
al
TC14 Maximum permissible rate of increase of the initial cutting depth during roughing
ri
ZA
Se
TC15 Deceleration clearance at start of rough cutting in bar machining unit and copy machining unit
IM
K
TC16 Tolerance for escape in high speed rough cutting cycle of bar machining unit
ZA
A
TC21 Incomplete threading portion length calculation coefficient for turning-tap tip
ig
yr
op
TC23 Thread height calculation coefficient for outside diameter, face/rear thread cutting (metric)
TC24 Thread height calculation coefficient for inside diameter thread cutting (metric)
TC25 Thread height calculation coefficient for outside diameter, face/rear thread cutting (inch)
TC26 Thread height calculation coefficient for inside diameter thread cutting (inch)
2-34
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
d.
ve
er
TC34 Recessing depth for #6
s
re
TC35 Lower limit for thrust ratio
ts
gh
TC37 Safety contour clearance — Outside diameter clearance (radial value)
ri
ll
TC38 Safety contour clearance — Inside diameter clearance (radial value)
.A
N
TC39 Safety contour clearance — Front clearance
O
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
TC50 Number of times that the feed rate is to be reduced during the #4 and #5 cutting-off cycles of a grooving unit
yr
op
TC51 Dwell at the hole bottom during non-through hole drilling cycle of the turning-drilling unit
C
TC52 Dwell (specification of spindle rotation number) at groove bottom in groove cutting unit
TC54 Cut depth per cycle for machining inside diameter in bar machining unit
2-35
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
TC62 Selection of tool change command output position for FLASH tool
.
TC63 Amount of relief after transfer using the workpiece transfer unit (Spindle mode 0 to 5)
d
ve
er
TC64 Amount of relief after transfer using the workpiece transfer unit (Spindle mode 6 and 7)
s
re
TC65 Specification of first M-code for parts catcher control
ts
gh
TC66 Minimum index angle of the FLASH tool
ri
ll
Return distance (radial value) in X-axis at wall during rough cutting in bar cutting unit, in corner machining unit
.A
TC67
or in mill-turning unit of MAZATROL programs
N
Return distance in Z-axis at wall during rough cutting in bar cutting unit, in corner machining unit or in
O
TC68
mill-turning unit of MAZATROL programs
TI
60
TC69
A
Number of revolutions during dwell for pecking of grooving
R
40
PO
29
TC70 FLASH tool — Number of cutting edges to be used for the tool not registered in the tool file
R
o.
O
N
TC71 Feed stopping rotation dwell time during the chip cutting cycle
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
TC72 Number of times of roughing in the composite-type fixed cycle (G273, G73)
A
IM
TC73 Return speed at pecking portion in groove cutting unit and turning-drilling unit
K
ZA
TC75 Overlap distance for machining wide groove in groove cutting unit
YA
TC78 Cut depth (radial value) for final cut in thread cutting unit of MAZATROL programs
ig
yr
TC79 Minimum cut depth clamping value (radial value) in thread cutting unit of MAZATROL programs
op
C
TC81 Final finishing repeat times in the composite-type fixed cycle (G276, G76)
TC82 Chamfering data calculation coefficient in thread cutting unit and thread cutting cycle (G276/G292, G76/G92)
Number of cutting operations to be performed on finishing allowance corresponding to standard pattern (#0)
TC83
of threading unit
2-36
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
TC85 - TC94 Specification of the pocket for the long boring bar
.
TC99 ATC operation after machining when not specified in the end unit
d
ve
er
TC101 Selection of droop sampling axis
s
re
TC102 Selection of cycle counter sampling axis
ts
gh
TC103 Amplitude limit of table vibration
ri
ll
.A
TC104 Clearance for rechucking using the workpiece transfer unit
N
O
TC105 Fixed value (0)
TI
60
TC106
A
Designation of MOVE C in a workpiece transfer unit of a program of workpiece scheme (only for the
R
40
TC107 Overshoot in the longitudinal direction with the workpiece for inside machining
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
TC109 Reference length for the display of bar materials on the BL SCHEDULE display
A
IM
TC111 -
CUTTING CONDITON LEARN display — Workpiece length range
TC113
K
TC114 -
ZA
TC120 -
)2
TC141 0 Use/disuse of acceleration in up-going slope during rough cutting cycle in bar machining unit
ig
yr
TC141 1 Use/disuse of deceleration in down-going slope during rough cutting cycle in bar machining unit
op
C
TC141 2 Selection between use/disuse of acceleration distance check at start of thread cutting unit
TC141 3 Selection between start position shift/start angle shift for thread number offset in thread cutting unit
2-37
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
TC141 7 Whether to make the partition plate and the workpiece barrier valid
Selecting an inter-unit relief path when a succession of I.D. turning units using the same tool exist and there is
TC142 1
no movement to the rotating position of the tool
.
TC142 4 Turning spindle stop M code output in end unit
d
ve
Selection whether an alarm is to be issued if the ending position of workpiece pressing is reached during
er
TC142 5
transfer of the workpiece
s
re
X-axis retraction position during workpiece transfer as specified in the workpiece transfer unit of the
TC142 6
ts
MAZATROL program
gh
TC142 7 Upper turret retraction during machining with the lower turret (for MULTIPLEX series)
ri
ll
.A
TC143 Whether the end tool of the long boring bar can be changed
N
O
TC144 0 Automatic selection of the relief path for the continuous I.D. machining
TI
60
TC144 1
A
Workpiece transfer axis motion for opposed turret specification lathes
R
40
PO
29
TC144 2 C-axis clamping during workpiece transfer with C-axis positioning, valid/invalid
R
o.
O
N
TC144 3 Automatic output of spindle rotation command when turning tool is used in the manual program unit
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
TC144 4 ATC and RETURN of the end unit after single-process operation
A
IM
TC144 5 ATC and RETURN of the end unit for repetition (CONTI. = 1)
K
ZA
TC144 7 Handling when no tools are specified for the manual program unit
YA
TC145 3 Mode selection after C-axis transfer using the workpiece transfer unit
op
C
TC145 5 Output of maximum spindle speed command specified in the common unit
Alarm display when tools different in shape (infeed angle, nose angle and nose R) are designated for the
TC145 6
upper and lower turret in balanced cutting
TC145 7 Operation of the path inversed with respect to the traveling direction of the tip (only for copy machining)
TC146 0 Selection of the turning spindle rotation timing when the relay point for the turning approach is specified
2-38
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
TC146 2 Tool path when the infeed angle or the relief angle is 0° or less
C-axis command output for the second workpiece transfer unit onward when workpiece transfer units of a
TC146 3
BAR moving pattern exist in succession
Automatic setting of M8 as an M-code to be outputted at the beginning of a unit which is selected for the
TC146 5
single-process operation
.
TC146 6 C-offset values to be used on HD1 and HD2 for a two-workpiece machining unit
d
ve
er
Whether or not to modify the numeric positional indication with respect to the workpiece coordinate system
TC146 7
according to the tool offset setting in the TPC data
s
re
Modal condition about diameter/radius value input for the unit succeeding a manual program or subprogram
TC147 0
ts
unit
gh
ri
TC147 1 Z/C offset value to be used in the EIA/ISO subprogram after workpiece transfer in the MAZATROL program
ll
.A
TC147 3 Tool change position at RETURN in end unit when FLASH tool is mounted
N
O
TC147 4 Whether pressing is to be made selectable for workpiece transfer units of a BAR moving pattern
TI
60
TC147 5
A
Tool nose position of an inside-turning grooving tool for machining on the back side
R
40
PO
29
TC147 6 Handling of nose R in the retraction path during grooving #4, 5 (cutting off)
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
TC148 5 Selection of movement from the clearance area to a clearance point during O.D. turning
K
ZA
TC148 6 Selection of movement from the clearance area to a clearance point during face/rear turning
A
M
TC149 0 Selection of the zone where spindle override is fixed to 100% during thread cutting cycle
3
01
)2
TC149 1 Cutting edge offset when a milling drill rotates at the same time in turning-drilling unit (blind hole)
(c
ht
TC149 4 Spindle rotation during turning when an S-code is specified in TPC data
ig
Machine operation on tool path check of a program for which workpiece scheme is selected and T. CENTER
yr
TC149 5
is specified for X and Y, but Z is left blank in the basic coordinates system unit (WPC)
op
C
Alarm output when the directions of rotation of the turning tool of the manual program unit and the spindle do
TC149 7
not match
TC150 2 Alarm stop if a program that performs 2 workpiece machining with only one spindle is executed
TC150 5 Selection of surface speed to be output to the screen during constant surface speed control
2-39
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
TC155 Cut depth per cycle for machining external diameter in bar machining unit
TC156 Tool load avoidance distance in reciprocating grooving operation (side wall)
TC160 -
.
Retraction distance from wall in reciprocating grooving operation
d
TC161
ve
er
TC162 Wall clearance in uni-directional grooving
s
re
TC251 INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER function (IBA): Imbalance multiplication parameter
ts
gh
TC252 INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER function (IBA): Imbalance factor parameter
ri
ll
.A
TC253 INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER function (IBA): Imbalance droop offset
N
O
TC254 INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER function (IBA): Imbalance rotary speed offset
TI
60
TC255
A
Intelligent Balance Analyzer function (IBA): Imbalance slope parameter
R
40
PO
29
Considering C1 and C2 values in the workpiece travel unit in an FRM workpiece scheme program in the tool
TC289 0
R
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
7. SOLID (SD)
K
ZA
Address
Outline
A
(bit)
M
YA
SD53 Smoothness selection for arcs in the tool path check/shape check
yr
op
2-40
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
SD165 1 Tool data setting using QUICK MAZATROL
d
ve
er
SD166 0 Fixed value
s
re
SD167 0 Display method for the jaws set on the 3D SETUP display in the turning mode
ts
gh
ri
SD167 1 Sampling data automatic save function on occurrence of an INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD (ISS) alarm
ll
.A
8. DISPLAY STRUCTURE (US)
N
O
Address
TI
Outline
60
(bit) A
R
40
PO
R
o.
US1 1 Selection of operation for automatic determination of cutting conditions when tool data is not input
O
N
C
al
ZA
Se
US1 5 Project function in the WORK No. SELECT window/PROGRAM FILE display
K
ZA
US39 Automatic determination of cutting conditions Element that automatically determines “FR” (DRILL)
3
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Element that automatically determines “FR” (BOR BAR, B-B
01
US40
BAR and BCK FACE)
)2
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Element that automatically determines “FR” (FCE MILL, END
US41
(c
MILL)
ht
ig
US42 Automatic determination of cutting conditions Reference shank diameter (BAR, CPY, CORNER)
yr
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Tool nose radius when tool data is not input (BAR, CPY,
op
US43
CORNER and FACING)
C
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Tool width when tool data is not input (BAR, CPY and
US44
CORNER)
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Tool nose angle when tool data is not input (BAR, CPY,
US45
CORNER and FACING)
US46 Automatic determination of cutting conditions Tool nose width when tool data is not input (T.GROOVE)
2-41
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
J41 - J80 M-code macroprogram call (J44, J48, J52, J56, J60: Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited)
.
J108 Maximum number of retrials to update the model with the SAFETY SHIELD function
d
ve
er
J109 - J112 Barrier setup chuck reference position 1 on the No. 2 spindle side/NC tailstock position
s
re
J113 - J116 Barrier setup chuck reference position 2 on the No. 2 spindle side
ts
gh
J119 - J120 Barrier-setting/cancelling M-code to be used for barrier teaching
ri
ll
Amount of offset for height axis rotational center offset (K124, K128) of the rotary axis for the tool (tool tip
.A
J121
point control)
N
O
J124 M codes for SPRINT control [Option]
TI
60
J125 - J126
A
SPRINT control enable signal ON/OFF delay time [Option]
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
Setting the M-code for making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid during automatic
J131 - J140
operation
K
Selecting whether to output the M-code for making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid
ZA
J141
during automatic operation
A
Selecting whether to output the M-code for making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid
M
J142 0
during automatic operation
YA
Selecting whether to output the M-code for making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid
J142 1
3
Output selection of M codes for temporarily disabling/canceling disabled status of INTELLIGENT SAFETY
)2
J142 2
SHIELD function in automatic operation
(c
Output selection of M codes for temporarily disabling/canceling disabled status of INTELLIGENT SAFETY
J142 3
ht
Method to handle the tool offset data when the program is returned to a MAZATROL program with the tool
yr
J143 0
offset function set valid in an EIA/ISO subprogram
op
C
J143 1 Selection of the lower turret tool teaching data input method
In reference point return operation (G28, G30, G30.1), tool change command is executed with or without
J143 2
waiting the completion of middle-point return
2-42
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
J235 Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis offset for OD (both sides), X-axis offset for protrusion width)
.
J236 Workpiece measurement offset (Y-axis offset for OD (both sides), Y-axis offset for protrusion width)
d
ve
er
J237 Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis offset for ID (both sides), X-axis offset for groove width)
s
re
J238 Workpiece measurement offset (Y-axis offset for ID (both sides), Y-axis offset for groove width)
ts
gh
J239 Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis offset for protrusion width, offset for ID protrusion width)
ri
ll
.A
J240 Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis offset for groove width, offset for ID groove)
N
O
J251 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the separating direction (1st set of axes)
TI
60
J252
A
Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the separating direction (2nd set of axes)
R
40
PO
29
J253 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the separating direction (3rd set of axes)
R
o.
O
N
J254 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the separating direction (4th set of axes)
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Amount of correction for height axis rotational center offset (K233, K237) of the tool control rotary axis (tool tip
ht
J531
point control)
ig
yr
M code setting for temporarily disabling/canceling disabled status of INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD
C
J550 - J551
function in automatic operation
2. MEASURE (K)
Address
Outline
(bit)
2-43
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
K7 Unbalanced axis
K8 Waiting time for speed attainment ON during override variable thread cutting
.
K12 Fixed value (0)
d
ve
er
K13 Measurement skip feed rate (X-axis, Z-axis)
s
re
K14 Measurement approach speed (X-axis, Z-axis)
ts
gh
K15 Measurement skip speed (C-axis)
ri
ll
.A
K16 Measurement approach speed (C-axis)
N
O
K17 Specification of measuring tolerance (lower limit) [valid only for L106 bit 6 = 1]
TI
60
K18
A
Specification of measuring tolerance (upper limit) [valid only for L106 bit 6 = 1]
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
K21 Coefficient to determine rotation angle when retrying measurement C reference face
A
IM
K29 Simultaneous control: Delay counter for automatic correction of synchronizing errors
3
01
)2
2-44
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
K40 Work number called during second auxiliary function macroprogram appointment
.
K43 G31.2 skipping speed
d
ve
er
K44 G31.3 skipping speed
s
re
K45 G31.4 skipping speed
ts
gh
K46 Excessive pressing error spread (Amount of drooping)
ri
ll
.A
K47 M-code for external workpiece measurement
N
O
K48 Spindle FB alarm detection method
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
K52
A
IM
2-45
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
Coordinate system with reference to which the offset amounts are to be used in tool length offset for the
K68 0
selected machining surface (For machines of five-surface machining by angular tools)
.
K68 3 Fixed value (0)
d
ve
er
K68 4 Fixed value (0)
s
re
K68 5 Override/dryrun speed valid/invalid when the G31 command is issued
ts
gh
Whether all the barrier cancel data in the program is to be cleared by executing the MMS unit in a
K68 7
ri
MAZATROL program
ll
.A
K69 0 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-2
N
O
K69 1 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-10
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
2-46
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
K71 7 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-14
d
ve
er
K72 G31.4 skip conditions
s
re
K73 G4 skip conditions
ts
gh
K74 Emergency stop contactor cutoff time (Safety supervisory function)
ri
ll
.A
K75 Contactor control output device 1 (Safety supervisory function)
N
O
K76 Contactor control output device 2 (Safety supervisory function)
TI
60
K77
A
Door switch input device (Safety supervisory function)
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K79 Supervisory speed filtering time during servo-off (Safety supervisory function)
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
K84 Maximum allowable amount of compensation for workpiece thermal expansion in each interpolating cycle
3
01
)2
K94 0 Selection of whether menu function is to be made invalid after operation has been stopped by [ATC STOP]
2-47
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
K94 2 Program editing on the EIA MONITOR display during multi-system operation
Indexing in cases where the next machining is started without specifying an index unit after a measurement
K94 4
unit has been executed
K94 5 Display/no display of a block start interlock alarm if tool life of a tool specified in the block has expired
Selection whether the difference in angle between the upper and lower turrets is to be incorporated into the
K95 0
current C-axis position display of HD2
.
K95 1 Fixed value (0)
d
ve
er
K95 2 Tool position compensation during T-command execution, performed/not performed
s
re
K95 3 Coordinate system update during handle pulse interrupt, performed/not performed
ts
gh
K95 4 Fixed value (0)
ri
ll
.A
K95 5 Acceleration/deceleration time constant for handle pulse feed
N
O
K95 6 Software limits for G30 execution valid/invalid
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
K96 4 Suppression of lost motion in modes other than the G1 command mode, valid/invalid
A
M
2-48
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Compensation method for the sensing tool’s eccentricity and stylus radius in workpiece measurement and
K102 3
coordinate measurement, M Pro compatible/New scheme
K102 4 Z-axis direction for setting the TPC relay points of a measurement unit
K102 5 Selection of setup data (jaw data and tailstock position) to be used in EIA/ISO programs
K102 6 Setting the direction of rotation for milling tools mounted on the turret
.
K102 7 Fixed value (0)
d
ve
er
K103 0 Handling of the sign assigned to hobbing address D
s
re
K103 1 Synchronous control error auto-correction valid/invalid
ts
gh
K103 2 Fixed value
ri
ll
.A
K103 3 DDB micron unit
N
O
K103 4 Fixed value
TI
60
PO
29
K103 6 —
R
o.
O
N
K103 7 Whether FIXED PT can be selected at RETURN of the end unit of the MAZATROL program
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
K104 0 Output of a laser measurement B-axis 0-degree command after ATC, valid/invalid
A
IM
K104 1 Direction of the laser axis of the laser measuring instrument (L16/K104 bit 2)
K
ZA
K104 2 Direction of the laser axis of the laser measuring instrument (Parallel to the Y-axis/X-axis)
A
M
K104 6 Rapid feed command when cutting feed override is set to 0%, operation is executed/alarm state
ig
yr
K104 7 Feed rate for an approach to the starting point in EIA modal restarting mode
op
C
2-49
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
K106 3 Fixed value
d
ve
er
K106 4 Fixed value (0)
s
re
K106 5 Fixed value (0)
ts
gh
K106 6 Fixed value (0)
ri
ll
.A
K106 7 Fixed value (0)
N
O
K107 0 Fixed value (0)
TI
60
K107 4
A
Corner judgment halfway through a block during polar coordinate interpolation where rotary axis shape
R
40
correction is valid
PO
29
K107 5 Motion distance in the manual pulse feed mode for the axis whose position is displayed in diameter value
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
K114 Axis number of the horizontal axis in the rectangular coordinate system
(c
ht
K115 Axis number of the vertical axis in the rectangular coordinate system
ig
yr
K116 Axis number of the height axis in the rectangular coordinate system
op
C
K122 Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis
K123 Vertical axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis
K124 Height axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis
2-50
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
K126 Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis
K127 Vertical axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis
K128 Height axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis
.
K130 Position deviation 2 of the first rotary axis
d
ve
er
K131 Position deviation 1 of the second rotary axis
s
re
K132 Position deviation 2 of the second rotary axis
ts
gh
K133 X-axis position deviation at the spindle center position
ri
ll
.A
K134 Y-axis position deviation at the spindle center position
N
O
K135 Angle deviation 1 of the first rotary axis centerline
TI
60
K136
A
Angle deviation 2 of the first rotary axis centerline
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
K226 Axis number of the horizontal axis in the rectangular coordinate system (2nd set of axes)
YA
K227 Axis number of the vertical axis in the rectangular coordinate system (2nd set of axes)
3
01
)2
K228 Axis number of the height axis in the rectangular coordinate system (2nd set of axes)
(c
ht
K230 Axis number of the first rotary axis (2nd set of axes)
op
C
K231 Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis (2nd set of axes)
K232 Vertical axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis (2nd set of axes)
K233 Height axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis (2nd set of axes)
K234 Axis number of the second rotary axis (2nd set of axes)
K235 Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis (2nd set of axes)
2-51
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
K236 Vertical axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis (2nd set of axes)
K237 Height axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis (2nd set of axes)
.
K243 M code number of the forward rotation command for orbit machining
d
ve
er
K244 M code number of the reverse rotation command for orbit machining
s
re
K245 M code number of the rotation stop command for orbit machining
ts
gh
K246 Permissible error at involute interpolation end point
ri
ll
.A
K247 Involute interpolation permissible acceleration
N
O
K248 Involute interpolation minimum feedrate
TI
60
PO
29
K250 Wait time before turning ON of zero-speed signal upon ending hobbing II (position controlled hobbing)
R
o.
O
N
K251 Threshold value for singular posture in the cutting point command mode (for other than rapid feed)
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
K253 Angle that sets the mill spindle tool tip in the +X-axis direction in orbit machining
K
ZA
K254 Threshold value for singular posture in the cutting point command mode (for rapid feed)
A
M
2-52
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
K280 2 Fixed value
d
ve
er
K280 6 Fixed value
s
re
K281 0 Laser tool length/diameter measurement on an arbitrary axis
ts
gh
ri
3. TABLE (L)
ll
.A
Address
Outline
N
(bit)
O
TI
L1 Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (X-component)
60
A
R
40
R
o.
C
al
ZA
Se
Tool-breakage restoration mode for TBR function (for M35 external tool breakage detection or tool
A
L7
measurement unit)
M
YA
L13 Allowable angle for parallelism and right angle in manual measurement
2-53
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
L22 Data of the tool nose measurement sensor, Sensor width along the X-axis
L23 Data of the tool nose measurement sensor, Sensor width along the Z-axis
.
L24 Tool nose measurement sensor reference position, X-axis
d
ve
er
L25 Tool nose measurement sensor reference position, Z-axis
s
re
L26 Tool nose measurement sensor reference position, Y-axis
ts
gh
L27 Timer setting for manual TOOL EYE measurement
ri
ll
.A
L28 Amount of Z-axial retreat from the approach point for TOOL EYE measurement
N
O
L29 Machine efficiency
TI
60
L30
A
Selection of machining navigation case introduction messages
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
L44 Selection of automatic setting on/off for nose position correction of a drilling tool
ig
yr
2-54
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
L56 Method of measurement of coordinates by tool edge memorizing function (TEACH)
d
ve
er
L57 Rewriting of tool data during automatic operation
s
re
L58 Head index angle indication system
ts
gh
L59 Input selection for HEAD OFFSET display
ri
ll
.A
L60 Head quantity
N
O
L61 Output timing of AHC and APC
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
L67 Length between the end surface of the spindle and the center of head rotation
A
M
L72 5-axis spline interpolation geometry compensation software acceleration/deceleration filter 2 time constant
op
C
L75 Time constant for pre-interpolational linear control during cutting feed rate acceleration/deceleration
2-55
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
L78 Amount of X-axial retreat from the approach point for TOOL EYE measurement
.
L83 Spindle head radius
d
ve
er
L84 Correction value of alignment deviation X (Upper face)
s
re
L85 Correction value of alignment deviation Y (Upper face)
ts
gh
L86 Correction value of alignment deviation X (0-degree face)
ri
ll
.A
L87 Correction value of alignment deviation Y (0-degree face)
N
Correction value of alignment deviation X (90-degree face)
O
L88
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (X-component for B-axis at 90-degree position) (for INTEGREX series)
TI
60
L89
A
Correction value of alignment deviation Y (90-degree face)
R
40
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (Y-component for B-axis at 90-degree position) (for INTEGREX series)
PO
29
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (X-component for B-axis at 180-degree position) (for INTEGREX series)
o.
O
N
L91
al
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (Y-component for B-axis at 180-degree position) (for INTEGREX series)
K
ri
ZA
Se
L96 Amount of shifting during offset number auto-setting for EIA-programmed tool measurement
3
01
)2
L97 M-code to be output when selecting menu function for the MDI tool designation
(c
ht
L99 Cycle time for saving the operational status management data
op
C
2-56
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Selection of whether workpiece measurement results and tool measurement results are to be stored into tool
L106 3
data of the lower turret
.
L106 4 Selection of whether to enable or disable the fixed amount compensation function
d
ve
B-axis user-defined angle setting in the coordinate measurement unit and workpiece measurement unit
er
L106 5
invalid/valid
s
re
Non-compensation area for the tool measurement and execution timing of tool and workpiece measurement
L106 6
ts
operation
gh
L106 7 Selection of laser measuring menu display
ri
ll
.A
L107 0 Tool path drawing
N
O
L107 1 Tailstock function valid/invalid
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
L107 4 LBB No. setting for the grooving I.D. tool, threading I.D. tool, or touch sensor, valid/invalid
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
L107 5 XYZ-axis operation for the first T-command after cycle start
A
IM
L107 6 A-axis operation for the first T-command after cycle start
K
ZA
Incorporating the C-axis coordinate into the TOOL PATH CHECK, TRACE, and SHAPE CHECK displays of
C
L108 5
the VRX machine
L108 7 Displaying the milling tool nose in the MAZATROL program of the TOOL PATH CHECK display
Axial direction of the two axes to be checked by the software limit relative position check function
L109 0
(1st set of axes)
Axial direction of the two axes to be checked by the software limit relative position check function
L109 1
(2nd set of axes)
2-57
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
Axial direction of the two axes to be checked by the software limit relative position check function
L109 2
(3rd set of axes)
Axial direction of the two axes to be checked by the software limit relative position check function
L109 3
(4th set of axes)
L109 4 Formula selection for calculating horsepower and thrust on the TOOL DATA display with [AUTO SET]
L109 5 Teaching when the lower turret is selected in the basic coordinate system unit (WPC)
.
L109 7 Fixed value
d
ve
er
L110 0 Opposed-spindle lathe specifications
s
re
L110 1 Vertically inverted spindle specifications
ts
gh
L110 2 Axis name of the secondary spindle
ri
ll
.A
L110 3 Whether to disable or enable the display of “section to be machined” in the milling tool sequence
N
O
L110 4 RAM spindle specification
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
L111 5 T-code in the index unit to be executed before the pallet change unit
A
IM
L111 7 Whether interference check is executed or not while tailstock pushing state is released
A
M
L112 5 —
L112 6 —
L112 7 —
L113 Software limit relative position check – Check reference axis (1st set of axes)
L114 Software limit relative position check – Check reference axis (2nd set of axes)
2-58
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
L115 Software limit relative position check – Check reference axis (3rd set of axes)
L116 Software limit relative position check – Check reference axis (4th set of axes)
L117 Software limit relative position check – Check target axis (1st set of axes)
L118 Software limit relative position check – Check target axis (2nd set of axes)
L119 Software limit relative position check – Check target axis (3rd set of axes)
.
L120 Software limit relative position check – Check target axis (4th set of axes)
d
ve
er
L121 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the approaching direction (1st set of axes)
s
re
L122 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the approaching direction (2nd set of axes)
ts
gh
L123 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the approaching direction (3rd set of axes)
ri
ll
.A
L124 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the approaching direction (4th set of axes)
N
O
L125 Rotational axis prefiltering time constant
TI
60
L126
A
Positioning direction of the head rotation - -axis for oblique plane indexing
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
Tool control rotary axis offset First rotary axis horizontal offset
L133
A
L134
01
<For tool tilt type> Tool control rotary axis offset First rotary axis height offset
L135
ht
<For table tilt type> (A-(B-)axis rotation center displacement (Z-axis direction)
ig
L136 <For tool tilt type> Tool rotational axis offset, horizontal axis offset amount for the 2nd rotational axis
yr
op
L137 <For tool tilt type> Tool rotational axis offset, vertical axis offset amount for the 2nd rotational axis
C
L138 <For tool tilt type> Tool rotational axis offset, height axis offset amount for the 2nd rotational axis
L140 Waiting time for the completion signal of M35 (tool breakage detection) from PLC
L141 Software limit relative position check (for auxiliary equipment axis) – Task delay period
2-59
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
L145 Smooth corner control function: Cutting feed rate for pre-interpolational acceleration/deceleration control
L147 Smooth corner control function: Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1 time constant (1st stage)
L148 Smooth corner control function: Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1 time constant (2ndt stage)
.
L150
d
(involving rotary axis) during tool tip point control
ve
er
L151 Small-diameter table thickness
s
re
L171 1 Selection of [PALLET No.SET] menu item display
ts
gh
Feedrate for clamping the acceleration in orbit machining
ri
L270
ll
.A
L271 Time constant for clamping the acceleration in orbit machining
N
O
4. FEED VEL. (M)
TI
60
A
R
Address
40
Outline
PO
(bit)
29
R
o.
C
al
ZA
Se
2-60
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
M17 0 —
.
M17 4 Type of axis
d
ve
er
M17 5 Rotational direction of servo motor (for movement in (+) direction)
s
re
M17 6 —
ts
gh
M17 7 Alarm/No alarm with axis removed
ri
ll
.A
M18 0 Spindle C-axis
N
O
M18 2 Machine zero-point position
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
Setting prohibited
01
)2
M20 2 Method of jog/rapid feed stopping when the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD is valid
2-61
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
M20 6 Switching between zero-point shift amount and grid shift amount
.
M21 3 Rapid-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Exponential acceleration/linear deceleration
d
ve
er
M21 4 Cutting-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Linear acceleration/deceleration
s
re
M21 5 Cutting-feed acceleration/deceleration type. First-order lag
ts
gh
M21 6 Cutting-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Second-order lag
ri
ll
.A
M21 7 Cutting-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Exponential acceleration/linear deceleration
N
O
M22 0 Deceleration time constant for rapid-feed exponential acceleration/linear deceleration
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
M22 3 —
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
M22 4 —
A
IM
M22 5 —
K
ZA
M22 6 —
A
M
M22 7 —
YA
2-62
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
M38 Interference check distances for INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD, primary check distance
d
ve
er
M39 Interference check distances for INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD, secondary check distance
s
re
M40 Ram spindle stored stroke end, upper limit
ts
gh
M41 Ram spindle stored stroke end, lower limit
ri
ll
.A
M42 Interference check distance for INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD during automatic operation
N
O
M45 Selection of a door for signal input on the drive side (servo) in safety supervisory mode
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
Address
01
Outline
(bit)
)2
(c
N7 OT time
2-63
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
d .
ve
N18 Servo amplifier rotary switch number
s er
re
N19 Axis system number
ts
gh
N21 0 Linear-type rotational axis
ri
ll
N21 1 Rotational axis shortcut Invalid/Valid
.A
N
N21 2 Fixed value (0)
O
TI
N21 3 Fixed value
60
A
R
40
PO
R
o.
C
al
ZA
Se
Axis selection for 3D interference check during automatic operation and for positioning on the VIRTUAL
N22 0
K
MACHINING display
ZA
N22 1 Turret C-axis specification (for 3D interference check during automatic operation and for virtual machining)
A
M
N22 2 Axis for which the axis name is specified with a comma
YA
3
N29 Time constant for shape correction rapid feed acceleration/deceleration filter
2-64
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
N36 Multi-turn counter increment with absolute position rotary-type rotational axis in special gear ratio
Rotational speed after multi-turn counter increment with absolute position rotary-type rotational axis in special
N37
.
gear ratio
d
ve
N38 Fixed value
s er
re
N57 Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, maximum value
ts
gh
N58 Real time tuning II Minimum inertia ratio
ri
ll
N60 Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, minimum value
.A
N
N61 Real time tuning II Maximum inertia ratio
O
TI
N63 Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, range of change
60
A
R
40
PO
R
o.
C
al
ZA
Se
A
IM
6. ANOTHER (S)
K
Address
ZA
Outline
(bit)
A
M
S3 Feed forward gain for the MAZAK Precision Rapid Boring Tornado Option
YA
S7 Upper limit (on Z-axis) of machining range for table rotating machining
yr
op
S12 Axis of rotation of the tilting table (Used for the automatic program origin calculation function)
2-65
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
S19 Tool change completion position of the long boring bar end tool
d .
ve
er
S20 APC completion position
s
re
S21 Completion position of gantry robot operation
ts
gh
S22 Cutting feed clamping speed during tool tip point control
ri
ll
S23 Reference workpiece zero point
.A
N
S24 Long milling tool ATC complete position
O
TI
Central position on the upper surface of the tilt table (VARIAXIS)
60
S25 A
Central position of table upper surface (other machining centers)
R
40
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
Center of the workpiece to be directly mounted on the table of the machines equipped with an additional table
ZA
S28
Se
S29 Position of the work hand rotating axis in relation to the machine zero point
IM
K
S30 Distance from the axis of rotation of the work hand to the reference position of the vice for the work hand
ZA
A
S32 Rapid traverse speed for the mode of tool tip point control
3
01
Reference position X for the TEACH function, to be used for setting the LENGTH B item of an angular tool
S33
(For machines of five-surface machining by angular tools)
)2
(c
S34 Amount of offset for rotary head misalignment (only for Maza-Check)
ht
ig
S36 Position of the center of the second additional table on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display
C
S38 Time-out period for releasing the emergency stop status during powering on
Turning spindle number of the table control mechanism that features switching of servo C-axis and turning
S39
spindle
S40 Offset amount from the turning spindle 0position to the servo C-axis machine zero point
2-66
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
S52 Rapid feed overlap function G0 in-position width (for tool tip point control and cutting point command)
S53 Rapid feed overlap function G1 in-position width (for tool tip point control and cutting point command)
d .
ve
er
S70 Fixed value
s
re
S71 0 Smart safety monitoring alarm (for servo axis)
ts
gh
ri
7. SPINDLE (SA)
ll
.A
Address
Outline
N
(bit)
O
TI
SA1 - SA8 Maximum spindle speed in each speed range (range 1 to 8)
60
A
R
40
SA9 - SA16 Constants for calculating each gear speed of the spindle (range 1 to 8)
PO
29
R
o.
C
al
ZA
Se
SA30 Load meter reference output base rotational speed (high-speed coil)
K
ZA
SA32 Load meter reference output base rotational speed (low-speed coil)
YA
3
SA33 - SA40 Acceleration/deceleration time constant for the synchronous tapping (range 1 to 8)
01
)2
Spindle speed range changing method, in relation to switching the torque factors for auto-pecking of the
SA45 0
cutting load detection type
Spindle speed range changing method, in relation to switching the torque factors for auto-pecking of the
SA45 1
cutting load detection type 2
2-67
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
.d
ve
er
SA46 3 Synchronous tapping position control changeover type
s
re
SA46 4 Z-phase detection direction
ts
gh
SA46 5 C-axis homing direction
ri
ll
.A
SA46 6 C-axis homing direction
N
O
SA46 7 Synchronous tapping command polarity
TI
60
SA47 0 —
A
R
40
PO
29
SA47 1 —
R
o.
O
N
SA47 2 —
al
K
ri
ZA
SA47 3 —
Se
A
IM
SA47 4 —
K
ZA
SA47 5 —
A
M
SA47 6 —
YA
SA53 Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — L coils
SA54 Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — H coils
SA55 Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Spindle gear position 3
2-68
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
SA56 Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Spindle gear position 4
SA57 Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 1
SA58 Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 2
SA59 Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 3
SA60 Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 4
.
SA61 Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 1
d
ve
er
SA62 Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 2
s
re
SA63 Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 3
ts
gh
SA64 Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 4
ri
ll
.A
SA65 Cutting force calculation filter for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type
N
O
SA66 Maximum permissible speed of the rotational axis for polygonal/hobbing machining
TI
60
SA67 - SA73
A
Rotational speed in the following spindle output diagrams: MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT/MACHINING
R
40
NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION/Monitoring Functions/POSITION
PO
29
NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION/Monitoring Functions/POSITION
o.
O
N
SA81 Spindle limit speed selection for spindle position control time constants — Limit speed 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
SA82 Spindle limit speed selection for spindle position control time constants — Limit speed 2
A
IM
SA83 Spindle limit speed selection for spindle position control time constants — Limit speed 3
K
ZA
2-69
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
SA97 Reduction ratio of the synchronous tapping time constant for high-speed synchronous tapping
SA100 - Rotational speed in the following spindle output diagrams at continuous rating: MACHINING
d .
SA106 NAVIGATION-RESULT/MACHINING NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION/Monitoring Functions/POSITION
ve
SA107 - Output in the following spindle output diagrams at continuous rating: MACHINING
er
SA113 NAVIGATION-RESULT/MACHINING NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION/Monitoring Functions/POSITION
s
re
SA114 Spindle speed supervisory mode 2 for safety supervision
ts
gh
SA115 Spindle speed supervisory mode 3 for safety supervision
ri
ll
.A
SA116 Spindle safety clamping mode 2 for safety supervision
N
O
SA117 Spindle safety clamping mode 3 for safety supervision
TI
60
SA118
A
Selecting the spindle door of the spindle whose speed is to be monitored
R
40
PO
29
SA119 Deceleration judgment coefficient on safety speed clamping of the spindle to be supervised for safety
R
o.
O
N
SA120 PLG pulse rate for spindle index gear tooth correction
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
SA121 Amount of branching [1] point correction for spindle index gear tooth
A
IM
SA122 Amount of branching [2] point correction for spindle index gear tooth
K
ZA
SA123 Amount of branching [3] point correction for spindle index gear tooth
A
M
SA124 Amount of branching [4] point correction for spindle index gear tooth
YA
SA125 Amount of branching [5] point correction for spindle index gear tooth
3
01
)2
SA126 Amount of branching [6] point correction for spindle index gear tooth
(c
ht
SA127 Amount of branching [7] point correction for spindle index gear tooth
ig
yr
SA128 Amount of branching [8] point correction for spindle index gear tooth
op
C
2-70
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
SA135 Rotational speed change width while override variable thread cutting is valid
SA136 Selection of signal input door on the safety monitor drive side (spindle)
.
SA140 Turret indexing gear ratio at the motor side (only for MULTIPLEX)
d
ve
er
SA142 0 Initial C-axis position control changeover with deceleration to stop setting
s
re
SA143 0 Relationship between spindle rotation commands (M code) and direction of spindle rotation
ts
gh
SA143 1 Waiting for phase compensation completion at the start of high-speed synchronous tapping
ri
ll
.A
SA143 2 Simultaneous output of a gear shift M code and a turning spindle speed command
N
O
SA143 3 Spindle speed for the orient command given during spindle rotation
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
SA144 0 Spindle winding coil selection function while override variable thread cutting is valid
A
IM
SA144 1 Spindle winding coil selection while override variable thread cutting is valid
K
ZA
SA144 3 Warning check for alarm 67 HI-SPEED SYNCTAP AXIS ALARM (for spindle C-axis)
A
M
Spindle speed fluctuation function M code number for enabling the spindle speed fluctuation synchronous
yr
SA231
mode
op
Spindle speed fluctuation function M code number for disabling the spindle speed fluctuation synchronous
C
SA232
mode
SA233 Spindle speed fluctuation function M code number for enabling spindle speed fluctuation
SA234 Spindle speed fluctuation function M code number for disabling spindle speed fluctuation
SA243 0 INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER function (IBA): Measured data rotation direction
2-71
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
8. BARRIER (BA)
Address
Outline
(bit)
BA1 Chuck outside diameter (for chuck barrier) — No. 1 turning spindle
. d
ve
BA3 Chuck inside diameter (for chuck barrier) — No. 1 turning spindle
ser
re
BA4 EIA program workpiece outside diameter
ts
gh
BA5 Chuck outside diameter (for chuck barrier) — No. 2 turning spindle
ri
ll
BA6 Chuck width (for chuck barrier) — No. 2 turning spindle
.A
N
BA7 Chuck inside diameter (for chuck barrier) — No. 2 turning spindle
O
TI
60
PO
R
o.
C
al
BA11 Length with tail spindle at back end (for tail barrier)
ri
ZA
Se
BA19 Distance from the Z-axis machine zero point to the spindle edge — No. 1 turning spindle
C
BA20 Distance from the Z-axis machine zero point to the spindle edge — No. 2 turning spindle
BA21 Jaw number for EIA program barrier — No. 1 turning spindle
BA22 Jaw number for EIA program barrier — No. 2 turning spindle
2-72
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
BA29 Tool holder width in Z-axis direction — Type 1
d
ve
er
BA30 Tool holder mounting position — Type 2
s
re
BA31 Tool holder width in X-axis direction — Type 2
ts
gh
BA32 Tool holder width in Z-axis direction — Type 2
ri
ll
.A
BA33 Tool holder mounting position — Type 3
N
O
BA34 Tool holder width in X-axis direction — Type 3
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
2-73
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
BA56 Turning spindle number for polygonal machining (D2)
d
ve
er
BA57 Turning spindle number for polygonal machining (D3)
s
re
BA58 Turning spindle number for polygonal machining (D4)
ts
gh
BA59 Spindle forward rotation M-code for tapping cycle
ri
ll
.A
BA60 Spindle reverse rotation M-code for tapping cycle
N
O
BA61 Amount of runout of the B-axis center
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
2-74
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
BA95 Tool nose measurement, sensor width along the X-axis
d
ve
er
BA96 Tool nose measurement, sensor width along the Z-axis
s
re
BA97 Tool nose measurement, X-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point
ts
gh
BA98 Tool nose measurement, Y-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point
ri
ll
.A
BA99 Tool nose measurement, Z-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point
N
O
BA100 Tool nose measurement, X-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point (for lower turret/HD2)
TI
60
BA101
A
Tool nose measurement, Y-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point (for lower turret/HD2)
R
40
PO
29
BA102 Tool nose measurement, Z-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point (for lower turret/HD2)
R
o.
O
N
BA103 Tool nose measurement, sensor width along the X-axis (for lower turret/HD2)
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
BA104 Tool nose measurement, sensor width along the Z-axis (for lower turret/HD2)
A
IM
BA107 Filter
YA
BA109 Offset amount (X) during automatic tool setting value calculation
(c
ht
BA110 Offset amount (Z) during automatic tool setting value calculation
ig
yr
BA111 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M881)
op
C
BA112 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M882)
BA113 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M883)
BA114 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M884)
BA115 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M885)
BA116 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M886)
2-75
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
BA122 Turret reference position X (for VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display)
d
ve
er
BA123 Turret reference position Z (for VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display)
s
re
BA124 Fixed value (0)
ts
gh
BA125 0 EIA tailstock barrier, tailstock usage valid/invalid
ri
ll
.A
BA125 1 Tailstock present/absent
N
O
BA125 2 EIA tool barrier, tool holder present/absent
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
BA125 5 Output of spindle revolution M-code specified in same block as synchronous tapping, valid/invalid
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
BA125 6 Alarm stop when [BARRIER CANCEL] is selected at the start of the automatic operation, valid/invalid
A
IM
BA125 7 Alarm stop when jaw Nos. are not specified at the start of the automatic operation, valid/invalid
K
ZA
BA126 7 Shape of the tailstock center for Virtual Machining, single stage/twin stage
M249 command for preparing for tool change before moving the tool to the tool change position using a
BA127 0
MAZATROL program, output/no output
BA127 1 For programs of Z-offset scheme: Fixed value (1) For other programs: Invalid
2-76
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Type of the clamping and unclamping M-codes that the NC automatically output for machines equipped with a
BA127 5
spindle head of swiveling type
BA127 6 —
Whether or not to read the current settings (tailstock position) on the SET UP MANAG. display at the
BA127 7
beginning of the execution of each program
.
BA128 0 NC tailstock pushing direction
d
ve
er
BA128 1 Method of automatic determination of the virtual nose point for a tool measuring unit
s
re
BA128 2 Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for the AFC function in the first set of tool data (BA43, BA44)
ts
gh
BA128 3 Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for the AFC function in the second set of tool data (BA45, BA46)
ri
ll
.A
BA128 4 TOOL EYE measurement approach selection with turret-equipped machines
N
O
BA128 5 Hobbing on the machine without tool rotary axis or table tilt axis
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
BA129 0 Output of tool change preparation M code (M109/M249) when executing tool change
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
BA129 3 Selection of whether or not to measure the milling tool length with the tool measuring unit
A
M
Handling of measurement speed of 1 in/min or higher during laser tool length/diameter measurement with
BA129 5
3
inch-specification machines
01
)2
BA131 5 Switching of the approach pattern in TOOL EYE measurement (MAZATROL program)
2-77
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
MS125 0 Spindle speed fluctuation function Spindle speed fluctuation mode Initial value
. d
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-78
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-2-3 Data I/O parameter
Address
Outline
(bit)
.
TAP4 Output of CR during ISO code punching
d
ve
er
TAP5 DC code parity
s
re
TAP6 Feed section DC code output
ts
gh
TAP7 DSR output flow control selection
ri
ll
.A
TAP9 “[” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA
N
O
TAP10 “]” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
TAP26 0 Data transfer of a paper tape program which has been punched by M2
3
01
)2
TAP26 1 Types of data to be punched onto paper tape during all punching
(c
TAP26 5 Setup data to add when outputting an EIA/ISO program through tape I/O
TAP27 Bit parameter related to program end code (M) for paper tape reader
TAP30 Number of characters in the space between O-number and program for paper tape puncher
2-79
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
TAP31 Number of characters in the space between programs for paper tape puncher
Address
Outline
(bit)
d .
ve
DNC3 Terminator code 2
ser
DNC5 DC code parity
re
ts
DNC9 Number of NC transmission retries during DNC file transfer
gh
ri
DNC10 Number of NC reception retries during DNC file transfer
ll
.A
N
DNC11 Number of NC transmission/reception retries during DNC command message transfer
O
TI
DNC12 @ waiting time during DNC transmission
60
A
R
40
PO
R
o.
C
al
ZA
Se
Type of processing to be executed if the tool quantity data within the NC memory mismatches that which has
ig
DNC25 0
been transferred from the DNC memory
yr
op
DNC25 1 —
C
DNC25 2 Handling of tool data and tool files in the M PLUS format, valid/invalid
DNC25 3 —
DNC25 4 —
DNC25 5 —
DNC25 6 —
2-80
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
DNC25 7 —
DNC26 0 After program reception, a search is made/not made for the work number of that program.
Loading of programs having the same work number as that of the registered program in NC becomes
DNC26 2
impossible or not.
DNC26 3 The function of the PROGRAM LOCK/ ENABLE switch is released or not.
.
DNC26 4 —
d
ve
er
DNC26 5 Three digit G-format and G10 format codes input/output for MAZAK data transfer protocol
s
re
DNC26 6 Binary to ASCII format input/output of MAZAK data transfer protocol
ts
gh
All programs having work numbers smaller than No. 9000 are erased/not erased at the start of program
DNC26 7
ri
reception.
ll
.A
DNC27 0 Interpretation of message for DNC macro variable transmission
N
O
DNC29 Number of retry times with detection of a physical error
TI
60
PO
29
DNC31 Waiting time for a response from the COM port driver
R
o.
O
N
C
al
3. Other (IOP/DPR/IDD)
ri
ZA
Se
Address
A
Outline
(bit)
IM
K
IOP2 0 Handling of TPC data when loading programs created with the MATRIX series
ZA
A
IOP2 1 Handling of TPC data when loading programs created with the MATRIX series
M
YA
Overwriting registration judgment criteria when entering tool data text with machines allowing registration of
ig
IOP4 3
multiple tools
yr
op
Selection of the sign for the start point Z of point machining (XC, XY mode) when loading a Z offset scheme
IOP5 2
program
IOP5 6 Overwriting associated with loading of the program of the same work number
IOP5 7 Overwriting associated with loading of the tool model of the same name
2-81
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Address
Outline
(bit)
IOP6 4 Commenting out blocks containing variable numbers and operators upon EIA conversion
IOP7 0 Serial port used for communication with the magazine-side display unit
IOP7 1 Serial port used for communication with the magazine-side display unit
.
IOP7 2 Fixed value
d
ve
er
IOP7 3 Fixed value
s
re
IOP7 4 (Magazine-side display unit) ID amplifier type
ts
gh
IOP7 5 (Magazine-side display unit) ID amplifier type
ri
ll
.A
IOP7 6 (Magazine-side display unit) Tool mounting/removing timing
N
O
IOP7 7 (Magazine-side display unit) Tool mounting/removing timing
TI
60
IOP8 0
A
(Magazine-side display unit IN/OUT) Tool count/time data clear setting
R
40
PO
29
IOP8 1 (Magazine-side display unit IN/OUT) Tool life count/time data clear setting
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
2-82
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
. d
ve
er
s
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-83
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
. d
ve
[4]
s er
re
[3] [9]
ts
gh
Program type [5]
ri
Conditions [6]
ll
.A
Unit [7]
N
Setting range [8]
O
TI
60
O
N
Bit input type parameters have the bit No. shown in the parentheses below address.
C
al
Example :
ri
ZA
Se
P1 P1
K
(bit 0)
ZA
Bit 0
Bit 1
A
M
Bit 2
YA
Bit 3
Bit 4
3
Bit 5
01
Bit 6
)2
Bit 7
(c
2-84
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
[6] Conditions under which a changed parameter becomes valid
Example 1: “Immediate” designates that new parameter value becomes effective upon
parameter change.
Example 2: “At power on” designates that new parameter value will become effective after
procedure below.
1. Change parameter setting value.
(By procedure similar to changing of ordinary data)
2. Shut off power supply to the NC.
3. Press power on button on the operation panel.
d .
ve
Example 3: If “At I/O startup” is specified
er
The system operates at the parameter data entered before the start of I/O. If the
s
re
parameter data is modified during I/O operation, the new data will not become
ts
valid until the I/O operation has been completed.
gh
Example 4: If “After stop of movement” is specified
ri
When the movement of the machine is completed, the program will operate with
ll
.A
the new parameter value. Changing the parameter during the machine movement
N
will not make the new parameter value valid during the movement.
O
TI
Example 5: If “Next block” is specified
60
A
When the next block is loaded, the program will operate with the new parameter
R
40
value. Changing the parameter while the block is being loaded will not make the
PO
29
O
N
Example 6: If “After resetting” is specified: The new parameter setting takes effect after
C
al
resetting.
K
ri
ZA
Se
[8] Allowable range of data (for an effective data range, refer to “Description” column.)
[9] Details or meaning of the parameter
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-85
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Initial point
D1
Second R-point
d .
ve
MPL001
er
Height of the second R-point during point
s
machining The height of the R-point during point machining is basically D41,
re
however, it is changed to D1 under the following conditions.
D1
ts
Tool sequence Conditions
gh
Bit 6 of parameter D91 is set to 1 (D1 valid).
ri
Drill There is a spot drill in the pre-machining tool
ll
sequence of the same unit.
.A
Bit 2 of parameter D92 is set to 1 (D1 valid).
N
O
Reamer There is a chamfering cutter in the
TI
pre-machining tool sequence of the same
60
A unit.
Program type M
R
40
Conditions Immediate
case of a drilling tool sequence, the height is changed to D42.
R
(D42)
O
N
ZA
Example :
A
IM
20.
ZA
D2
D2
A
M
YA
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit mm/0.1 in
)2
Setting range 0 to 99
(c
Z-axis feed dwell time at the hole bottom in a spot-machining cycle. Set
ht
Number of revolutions during dwell at hole the hole bottom, the Z-axis will firstly stop
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Revolutions
(Stops at hole bottom.)
Setting range 0 to 9 MPL002
2-86
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
Chamfering
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in MPL003
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99
ts
The feed rate of a tool as it is being passed through the prehole during an
gh
inversed spot-facing cycle
ri
Note : 0.5 mm/rev if this parameter setting is 0.
ll
Prehole through speed during inversed
.A
spot-facing
N
D5
O
TI
At the feedrate of D5
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
MPL004
R
o.
Setting range 0 to 99
al
ZA
tool development
Se
A
IM
DEPTH
Drilling cycle D6
ZA
D6 DIA
D7
A
D6 < D7
drilling cycle DIA
YA
Program type M
DEPTH
3
DIA
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0 to 9
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-87
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit mm/0.1 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99
ts
gh
ri
ll
Maximum diameter of holes machinable on
.A
two drills
N
D9
O
TI
60
Program type M
A
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
Unit mm/0.1 in
o.
O
N
Setting range 0 to 99
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
D10
ZA
A
M
Program type M
YA
Conditions Immediate
3
Unit mm/0.1 in
01
Setting range 0 to 99
)2
(c
Through-hole/tap-prehole machining
C
DEPTH DEPTH
overshoot
D11
D11 D11
MPL005
Example :
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP
Program type M 1 CTR-DR 10. 10. 21.
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in (DEPTH + D11)
Setting range 0 to 99 Note : See also parameter D30 for tapping units.
2-88
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
DEPTH
Stop-hole machining hole-bottom clearance
MPL006
D12 D12
Example :
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP
d .
1 DRILL 10. 10.
ve
19.
Program type M
er
(DEPTH – tool tip compensation – D12)
s
Conditions Immediate
re
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in Note :
ts
Setting range 0 to 99 This parameter is invalid when the residual hole diameter is not 0.
gh
Hole diameter is automatically set during automatic tool development
ri
when spot-chamfering is not to be performed.
ll
.A
D13
N
Spot-machining hole diameter
O
(fixed value)
TI
60
D13 A MPL007
R
40
PO
29
Example :
R
O
N
10.
al
ZA
Setting range 0 to 99
Se
AL in article MAT. 6
M
D14
YA
3
01
Program type M
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit 0.1
ht
Setting range 0 to 10
ig
yr
op
C
D15
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1
Setting range 0 to 10
2-89
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Z-axis feed dwell time at the hole bottom in the chamfering cycle of
chamfering cutter or spot-machining tool. Set this time in spindle
revolutions.
Number of revolutions during dwell at hole When the chamfering cutter reaches the
bottom for chamfering cutter or hole bottom, the Z-axis will firstly stop
spot-machining tool in chamfering cycle moving until the spindle makes D16
revolutions, and then return to the original
D16
position at the rapid feed rate.
Note :
This parameter is invalid for
.
Program type M
d
chamfering with true-circle processing.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit Revolutions
s
(Stops at hole bottom.)
re
Setting range 0 to 9 MPL008
ts
The clearance in order to prevent tool interference with a wall of the
gh
workpiece or with the hole bottom during a chamfering cycle
ri
Use in the case of D92 bit 4 = 0:
ll
The safety clearance (D17) is radially or axially used only when an
.A
interference could actually occur.
N
Note :
O
A tip of the tool is allowed to enter the safety clearance area as long as
TI
60
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
Interferes.
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
Interferes. MPL009
D17
A
M
for interference.
01
Note :
)2
D17 D17
ht
ig
yr
op
C
Judged as an
interference
D17
Program type M D17
MPL009’
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
Setting range 0 to 99
2-90
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
The feed rate at which the tool is returned from the hole bottom during
reaming or boring.
D18
Return feed rate for reaming or boring
(cycle 3)
D18 MPL010
Note :
1. Valid only when the setting of DEPTH for the reamer (tool
.
sequence) is G01.
d
Program type M
ve
2. Valid only when the setting of PRE-DIA for the boring tool (tool
Conditions Immediate
er
sequence) is CYCLE 3.
s
Unit 100 mm/min / 10 in/min 3. If this parameter is 0, the tool is returned at the same feed rate as
re
Setting range 0 to 9 that of cutting.
ts
Z-axis feed dwell time at the hole bottom in an end milling cycle. Set this
gh
time in spindle revolutions.
ri
ll
When the end mill reaches the hole
.A
Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom, the Z-axis will firstly stop
bottom for end milling moving until the spindle makes D19
N
revolutions, and then return to the
O
D19 original position at the rapid feed rate.
TI
60
A
R
40
Note :
PO
Program type M
29
O
N
ZA
Element used to automatically set the radial depth-of-cut per end milling
Se
operation
A
IM
milling
Example :
D20
A
M
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
corresponds to the roughness level of the end milling (tool sequence). The
yr
this parameter, and the values for all other roughness levels are set using
C
Reference bottom-finishing allowance for the expressions listed in the table below.
end milling
Roughness Bottom-finishing allowance
D21 0 to 3 0.0
4 D21
5 D21 × 0.7
Program type M 6 D21 × 0.7 × 0.7
7 D21 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
Conditions Immediate
8 D21 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in 9 D21 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
Setting range 0 to 99
2-91
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Dwell time at the hole bottom or at the R-point. This value is valid when 1
is set for bit 0, 1 or 2 of parameter D91.
D22
d .
This parameter is valid only when the setting for roughness (RGH) of
ve
Conditions Immediate
tapping (tool sequence) is FIX.
er
Unit 0.01 s
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99
ts
The excess amount of prehole diameter over nominal diameter that is
gh
used to specify whether the Z-axis is to be moved at a rapid feed rate or at
a cutting feed rate during true-circle processing with the end mill
ri
ll
.A
Prehole clearance for end milling
D23 D23
N
D23
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Unit mm/0.1 in
O
N
Setting range 0 to 99
al
Z-axis feed dwell time at the hole bottom in a boring cycle. Set this time in
ri
ZA
spindle revolutions.
Se
D24 performed.
A
Note :
M
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit Revolutions
)2
The amount of relief provided for the tip of a boring bar to be kept clear of
the hole wall after spindle orientation
ig
yr
D25
op
C
D25
2-92
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
The distance which the boring or back-boring tool is returned at the same
feed rate and milling spindle speed as for the preceding operation after
the tool has reached the hole bottom
D26
D26
MPL015
[1] Has reached the [2] Returned at the [3] Returned at a
Program type M
d .
hole bottom. same feedrate. rapid feedrate.
ve
Conditions Immediate Note :
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in Not valid if the setting for the roughness (RGH) of the boring (tool
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99 sequence) is 1.
ts
The distance which the boring bar is fed in at 70% of the original feed rate
gh
and milling spindle speed to finish the hole bottom
ri
ll
.A
Bottom-finishing amount of boring
N
D28
O
D28
MPL016
TI
60
A
The feed rate is reduced to 70% of the original value before the hole
R
40
Note :
Conditions Immediate
R
Not valid if the setting for the roughness (RGH) of the boring (tool
o.
sequence) is 1.
N
Setting range 0 to 99
al
The time required for a chip removal tool to complete a chip removal
ri
ZA
Se
D29
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit
)2
s
Setting range 0 to 99
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-93
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
D11 MPL017
ve
Example :
s er
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP
re
Program type M
1 DRILL 10. 10. 19.
ts
Conditions Immediate
{DEPTH + D11 + (D30 × pitch)}
gh
Unit Thread
[Related parameter]
ri
Setting range 0 to 9 D43: Number of incomplete threads in tapping cycle for piped screws
ll
Excess amount of tool return due to elongation of the tapper during
.A
tapping cycle
N
Set this value in spindle revolutions.
O
TI
60
R-point
29
R
o.
O
N
Program type M
al
Conditions Immediate
ri
ZA
Se
Setting range 0 to 9
IM
The number of inertial turns in tapping cycle that the spindle has rotated
K
clockwise during the time from output of a spindle CCW rotation command
ZA
D32
3
01
Program type M
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit Revolutions
ht
Setting range 0 to 99
ig
yr
The amount of relief provided for a back-boring tool tip to be kept clear of
op
the prehole walls as it is being passed through the prehole in the oriented
state of the spindle
C
D33
Back-boring tool tip relief
D33
2-94
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
Example :
er
Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE-
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999 1 DRILL 10. 10. (DIA – D35)
ts
Element used to automatically set the prehole-drilling diameter during
gh
automatic tool development of the reamer unit (When the pre-machining
process is boring.)
ri
DIA
ll
Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for
.A
reamer (boring)
N
D36
O
DIA – D36
TI
60
A
R
40
MPL020
PO
Program type M
29
K
ri
DIA
Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for
K
2-95
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
MPL021
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
Example :
er
Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE-
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999 1 BOR BAR 10. 10. (DIA – D38)
ts
2. In automatic tool development of the reamer unit, if the pre-machining
gh
process is end milling:
ri
DIA
ll
.A
First end milling hole diameter
Reamer-prehole diameter setting element = DIA – D39
N
for end milling
O
Second end milling hole diameter
D39
TI
= DIA – D38
60
A MPL022
R
40
PO
29
Example :
R
Program type M
o.
Conditions Immediate
1 END MILL 15. 20. (DIA – D39)
al
21.
ZA
Z-axis feed dwell time at the spot-faced hole bottom in an inversed spot
IM
Number of revolutions during dwell at reaches the hole bottom, firstly the
spot-faced hole bottom for inversed Z-axis will stop moving until the
A
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit Revolutions
ht
Setting range 0 to 9
ig
yr
op
C
2-96
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
Initial point
R-point height during point-machining
D41 R-point
D41
Machining surface
MPL024
d .
Program type M
ve
Note :
Conditions Immediate
er
For the inversed spot-facing unit or the back-boring unit, this parameter
Unit mm/0.1 in
s
can also be used for setting the clearance amount at the hole bottom.
re
Setting range 0 to 99 (D1, D42)
ts
Height of the third R-point
gh
ri
ll
Initial point
.A
N
D42
O
TI
Third R-point
60
A
R
40
MPL001
PO
29
machining
N
D42
al
K
ri
ZA
cutter
M
cycle.
YA
D11 MPL017
Program type M Example :
Conditions Immediate SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP
Unit Thread 1 DRILL 10. 10. 19.
2-97
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Select an automatic calculation method for the amount of chamfer with the
tapping unit.
0: Following calculation expression is used:
Selecting an automatic calculation method (MAJOR- + 2 × PITCH) – PRE-DIA
for the amount of chamfer with the tapping Amount of chamfer = 2
unit
1: Following calculation expression is used (same as M32):
D44
MAJOR- – PRE-DIA
Amount of chamfer = 2
Note :
Program type M
.
Select 1 if a loss of the threaded section is likely due to overchamfering
d
ve
Conditions Immediate as compared with a small TAP-DEP value.
er
Unit — Example : Sheet metal tapping
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
gh
q1 1st time
ri
ll
.A
N
i-th time
O
Drilling
TI
qi
depth
60
q1
A
R
40
PO
29
q2
R
O
N
D45
al
qi
K
ri
ZA
b
Se
qn
A
IM
K
ZA
1 2 i n Number of
q1: 1st drilling depth times
A
qi = b (If qi < b)
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
However, if the residual hole depth is smaller than D46, actual drilling
yr
D46
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in
(D45)
Setting range 0 to 9999
2-98
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
.
Example :
d
ve
Conditions Immediate SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP
er
Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in 1 DRILL 10. 10. 21. (DEPTH + D47)
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
Feed override for the section to be chamfered in the planetary tapping
gh
cycle
Chamfering feed =
ri
Pre-hole machining feed in tapping tool sequence × D48/100
ll
Feed override for the section to be
.A
chamfered in the planetary tapping cycle
N
D48
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
Chamfering section
R
o.
Unit %
O
N
The amount of return at hole bottom during the planetary tapping cycle
ri
ZA
D49
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
The feed rate for pre-hole machining will be auto-set to D50 when the
planetary tapping cycle is selected.
ig
yr
op
Auto-set feed rate for pre-hole machining SNo. TOOL NOM- No.HOLE- HOLE-DEP PRE-DIA PRE-DEP RGH DEPTH C-SP FR M M
in the planetary tapping cycle
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
0.01 mm/rev
Unit
0.001 in/rev
Setting range 0 to 9999
2-99
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
The feed rate will be auto-set to D51 when the planetary tapping cycle is
selected.
SNo. TOOL NOM- No.HOLE- HOLE-DEP PRE-DIA PRE-DEP RGH DEPTH C-SP FR M M
Auto-set feed rate for planetary tapping 1 TAP M10. 10. 23.7 PLANET 0.15 FIX P1.5 50 0.04
cycle
D51
D51
Program type M
.
Conditions Immediate
d
ve
0.01 mm/rev
Unit
er
0.001 in/rev
s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999
ts
Set the reduction ratio for the G00-based relief rate during the
gh
very-deep-hole drilling in a drilling or turning-drilling unit.
ri
Cutting feed
ll
Reduction ratio for the G00-based relief rate
.A
during a very-deep-hole drilling cycle Rapid feed (G00)
N
D52
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
O
N
ZA
tool to a position near the starting point of the very-deep-hole drilling cycle
Se
Example : If D53 = 3:
Cutting feed
K
Rapid feed
ZA
A
Starting
M
point
YA
Ending point
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Times
Setting range 0 to 9999
2-100
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
D54
F’= F × 100 F : Specified feed rate
F' : Feed rate at cutting start
Drill D
d .
ve
Deceleration rate at cutting start for
er
very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental
very-deep-hole machining cycle
s
re
D54
ts
gh
Feed rate at F' over distance from the NM211-00268
programmed start point
ri
ll
D
.A
= (0° < < 180°)
2 × tan/2
N
=0 ( 180°)
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
G1
Drilling return distance for very-deep-hole
K
machining cycle
D55
A
P2 P1
M
YA
D4 D3 D2 D1
Program type M
3
Set the number of revolutions of the milling spindle during dwell time at
ig
the chip ejection position and the hole bottom for the very-deep-hole
yr
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Revoluitons
Setting range 0 to 255
2-101
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the return speed for the very-deep-hole drilling cycle or the
decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle.
Program type M
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
0.001 mm/rev
Unit
er
0.0001 in/rev
s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999
ts
Set the feed rate reduction distance from the reference point at cutting
gh
start of a very-deep-hole drilling cycle (blind hole, through hole) during the
point machining. Specify the ratio with respect to the drill diameter.
ri
If the nominal diameter of the drill is D, the feed rate reduction distance L
ll
.A
at cutting start is calculated using the following calculation expression:
L = D × D58/100
N
O
The feed rate is reduced by the ratio specified in D54 (feed rate reduction
TI
ratio at cutting start) by the distance L from the reference point (R).
60
D58
R
o.
R
O
N
Clearance
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
distance ratio
IM
Program type M
K
ZA
Unit %
M
If the surface speed during drilling is S, the surface speed S’ at cutting end
)2
S’ = S × D59/100
ht
Surface speed reduction ratio at cutting end immediately before the hole bottom” (hb specified in the program).
yr
hole)
D59
C
Distance to the
hole bottom
hb
Program type M
Conditions After movement stop
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 100
2-102
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
Set the ratio between automatic setting value for the feed rate in the axial
cutting and that in the radial cutting during chamfering in the point
machining.
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions After movement stop
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 0 to 100
ts
Set the nominal diameter of a chamfering cutter that is automatically set
gh
during automatic tool development for a point machining unit of
MAZATROL programs.
ri
Nominal diameter of chamfering cutter, set
ll
.A
during automatic tool development for a
point machining unit
N
D61
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
ZA
by MAZATROL programs.
Se
programs
ZA
D62
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Note :
yr
D63
Overlap path D63 Chamfering
path
Program type M Y
Conditions Immediate
Cutting start point Z
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
Setting range 0 to 999
2-103
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the tolerance between the interpolated line segment and the ideal
curve for smooth chamfering (point machining).
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999
ts
Sets the reduction ratio for the G00 feed rate used for axis travel from the
gh
chip ejection position to the return position during a deep-hole
drilling/very-deep-hole drilling cycle.
ri
When either 0 or 100 is set, the feed rate is not reduced.
ll
.A
N
Start
O
point
Retraction feed rate = G00 feed rate D52 / 100
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
D66
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
Program type M
Conditions Immediate Cutting feed
3
01
Specify DEP-Z range for the end mill and the face mill from the learning
ht
When learning data on the condition that DEP-Z is in the following range
yr
D73
unit of 0.1%).
to 0 to D73 .................. DEP-Z range (for end mill) 1
D77 D73 to D74 .............. DEP-Z range (for end mill) 2
D74 to D75 .............. DEP-Z range (for end mill) 3
Program type M For a DEP-Z range of the face mill, set a value of “DEPTH” (at a unit of
Conditions Immediate 0.1 mm or 0.01 in).
Unit 0.1% (0.1 mm/0.01 in) 0 to D76 .................. DEP-Z range (for face mill) 1
D76 to D77 .............. DEP-Z range (for face mill) 2
Setting range 0 to 1000
2-104
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
Specify WID-R range for the boring bar, back boring bar and end mill from
the learning data of cutting conditions.
When learning data on the condition that WID-R is in the following range
has been stored in the memory, learning is not effectuated again.
Learning of cutting conditions For a WID-R range of the boring bar and back boring bar, set a value of
D78 (WID-R range)
“DEPTH” (at a unit of 0.1 mm/0.01 in).
to 0 to D78 .................. WID-R range (for boring bar and back boring bar) 1
D82 D78 to D79 .............. WID-R range (for boring bar and back boring bar) 2
For a WID-R range of the end mill, set a value of “DEPTH/NOM-” (at a
d .
unit of 0.1%).
Program type M
ve
0 to D80 .................. WID-R range (for end mill) 1
er
Conditions Immediate
D80 to D81 .............. WID-R range (for end mill) 2
s
Unit 0.1% (0.1 mm/0.01 in) D81 to D82 .............. WID-R range (for end mill) 3
re
Setting range 0 to 1000
ts
gh
76543210 (1: Execution, 0: No execution)
ri
M04 is output after the tool has dwelled at the
ll
.A
hole bottom during a tapping cycle.
The tool dwells after M04 has been output at the
N
hole bottom during a tapping cycle.
O
TI
The tool dwells after it has been returned to the
60
ZA
D42.
3. R-point height selection for smooth
3
01
Unit —
ig
1: Used
op
0: Not used
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
2-105
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Setting range 0, 1
1: Set
0: Not set
D92
(bit 1)
. d
ve
Program type M
er
Conditions Immediate
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 0, 1
gh
1: Set
ri
0: Not set
ll
.A
If a chamfering cutter is included in the
pre-machining tool sequence of the same
N
unit, the R-point height of the reamer is
O
set/not set to D1
TI
D92
60
(bit 2)
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M
R
o.
Conditions Immediate
N
Unit —
al
K
ri
Setting range 0, 1
ZA
Se
1: Set
A
IM
0: Not set
set to D1
M
D92
YA
(bit 3)
3
01
Program type M
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
1: Subjected
yr
0: Not subjected
op
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-106
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
1: Valid
0: Invalid
Note :
Dwell time designation for synchronous Timing of dwell execution of bit 5 is determined by settings in bit 0 to 2 of
tapping in the MAZATROL program parameter D91.
D92
(bit 5)
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
1: Ejected
gh
0: Not ejected
ri
ll
During planetary tapping, chips are
.A
ejected/not ejected automatically prior to
the threading process
N
D92
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
1: Generate
ri
ZA
Se
0: Do not generate
A
IM
(bit 7)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
— DRILL (Drill)
REAMER (Reamer)
D93
TAP (Tap)
BCK FACE (Inversed spot-facing tool)
BOR BAR (Boring tool)
Program type M
B-B BAR (Back-boring tool)
Conditions Immediate
CHAMFER (Chamfering cutter)
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-107
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits
ts
Selection of the auto-setting method to be used for the MAZATROL
gh
program data items of the tapping unit (TAPPING and CBOR-TAP) and
the diameter item of pipe taps on the TOOL DATA display.
ri
76543210
ll
.A
For pipe-tapping items
N
0: Conventional method
O
1: The text file concerned is referred to for the
TI
auto-setting of pipe-tapping data items in a
60
0: Conventional method
O
N
thread).
A
IM
Program type M
auto-setting of the pre-hole diameter
Conditions Immediate
A
Unit — thread).
YA
D96
yr
(bit 0)
op
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-108
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
The amount of chamfer in the spot drill tool sequence
gh
0: Cannot be specified
ri
1: Can be specified
ll
Setting of the amount of chamfer in the spot
.A
drill tool sequence
N
D96
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit
O
—
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
point-machining unit.
faced hole machining), BK-CBORE (back
IM
boring) and CBOR-TAP (counterbore BACKSPOT FACER (inversed spot-facing tool) and BACK BORING BAR
tapping), as well as BACKSPOT FACER (back boring) are displayed in the tool menu for tool sequence data in the
K
point-machining unit.
ZA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
without Y-axis
yr
Conditions to determine the CIRC MIL 1: Machining in Cycle 1 HOLE- ≥ Tool diameter
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-109
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Setting of the start point Y of the cylindrical surface in the C-axis point
machining unit
0 : Impossible
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Switching of the restrictions according to the cutting edge angle of a
gh
chamfering tool used for Smooth chamfering (C-POINT MACH-ING)
0: Enables machining only when the cutting edge angle is 45.
ri
Smooth chamfering (C-POINT MACH-ING): (Alarm if the cutting angle edge is not 45.)
ll
.A
Switching of the restrictions according to 1: Enables machining even when the cutting edge angle is not 45.
the cutting edge angle of a chamfering tool (Conventional scheme)
N
D96
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Used to select the mode of operation when the cutting depth is not
ri
ZA
tapping cycle.
IM
D96
(bit 7)
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
Select the cutting drawing method for circular milling unit on the VIRTUAL
MACHINING display.
ig
yr
0: Detailed drawing
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-110
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
Program type M, E
. d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set if the INDEX unit is executed or not.
gh
0: Not executed (Conventional scheme)
ri
1: Executed
ll
Execution of the INDEX unit when the
.A
PRI.No. is set in the MANUAL PROGRAM
N
D98
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Fixed value
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
—
K
ZA
D100
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions —
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
ht
0: Radius value
ig
1: Diameter value
yr
op
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-111
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
. d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select whether or not to generate alarm 1602 SET INDEX UNIT BEFORE
gh
MACHINING when the following unit is not preceded by an index unit.
[Units]
ri
Point machining, line machining, chamfering, face machining, C-axis
ll
Machine operation when the first machining
.A
point machining, C-axis line machining, C-axis chamfering, turning,
unit is not preceded by an index unit
EIA/ISO subprogram, manual program, MMS, pallet change, workpiece
N
D106 measurement, tool measurement
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
0: No alarm A
R
1: Alarm
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
0: Do not execute
ri
ZA
Se
1: Execute
A
IM
D106
A
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Output
yr
1: Do not output
op
end unit
D106
(bit 2)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-112
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
Initial point position when the specified R-point is located outside the
workpiece clearance area at an arbitrary B-axis angle other than 0, 90 and
180 degrees in the MAZATROL program of the WPC workpiece scheme.
Initial point position in the case where 0: Intersection point of the extended lines from the R-point and from the
R-point is located outside the clearance corner of the clearance area around the workpiece
around the workpiece at an arbitrary B-axis
D106 angle 1: Same position as R-point
(bit 3)
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Selection of rotational axis command system by table selection
gh
ri
0: Table selection invalid
ll
Selection of rotational axis command 1: Table selection valid
.A
system by table selection Specify the rotational axis in the table selection unit when table
N
D106 selection is valid.
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Alarm output timing when the first 1: Alarm output immediately after the cycle start button is pressed
machining unit is not preceded by an index
K
ZA
unit
D106
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Set whether the offset direction of the X-axis wear offset/TOOL EYE
ig
adjusting amount offset in the Z offset type milling back face [XY] mode
yr
0: Follows
X-axis wear offset direction in the Z offset
C
type milling back face [XY] mode 1: Does not follow (offset is made in the direction opposite to the direction
D106 set at F168 bit 3)
(bit 6) * This parameter is valid only for the B-axis rotary type turret.
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-113
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
D107
N
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
ZA
centers and G69.5 for turning centers) is specified in the manual program
Se
D107
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
0 : 0.01 [in/min]
ig
1 : 1 [in/min]
yr
op
inch system
D107
(bit 3)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-114
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
.
D107 1: Calculating based on C-SP in the tool sequence and the diameter at
d
ve
the cutting position (NOM- (1/2))
(bit 4)
er
< With mm specification >
s
–1
Mill spindle speed (min ) =
re
Surface speed (m/min) 1000 / (Nominal diameter (mm) 1/2 )
ts
< With inch specification >
gh
–1
Mill spindle speed (min ) =
ri
Surface speed (ft/min) 12 / (Nominal diameter (in) 1/2 )
ll
.A
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
N
O
Unit —
TI
Setting range 0, 1
60
A
R
40
C
al
K
ri
D130
A
R-point
IM
D130
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
Program type M
(c
2-115
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Sets the override for the G00 feed-in speed to the previous cutting point in
pecking during the deep-hole boring cycle.
G00
.
F302
d
G00 feed-in speed override for deep-hole
ve
boring cycle
er
D131
s
re
ts
gh
Note :
ri
1. When “0” is set, the override is set to 100%.
ll
.A
2. The D131 setting does not apply to any other G00 than that for the
feed-in operation.
N
O
TI
60
Program type M A
[Related parameters]
R
40
Conditions Immediate
PO
Unit %
R
o.
Used to select whether the chip ejection distance set for parameter D130
al
ZA
1: Used
Chip ejection operation during deep-hole
IM
drilling cycle
D141
K
ZA
(bit 0)
A
M
Program type M
YA
Conditions Immediate
3
Unit —
01
Setting range 0, 1
)2
0 : G00
ht
ig
1 : G01
yr
1. When D141 bit 1 = “0”, the G00 feed-in speed override can be set
(bit 1) with D131.
2. When D141 bit 1 = “1”, the G01 feed-in speed can be set with F303.
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-116
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT
Select the circular processing selection method for circular milling unit.
0 : Automatic selection based on “HOLE-”, “PRE-DIA” and “DEPTH” in
tool sequence data of the program
1 : Circular processing B
Circular milling unit: Circular processing
selection method switch
D141
(bit 2)
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Invalid
gh
1: Valid
ri
ll
.A
WPC unit/WPC shift unit
D143
N
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-117
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Element used to set cutting start point and escape point for closed-pattern
line- or face-machining
Example :
Defined closed pattern Defined closed
Closed-pattern cutting start point and pattern
escape point setting element SRV-R
E1 E2 E2
. d
ve
E1 Cutting Escape E1
er
start point point MPL026
s
Program type M
re
Conditions Immediate [Applicable units]
ts
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in LINE OUT, LINE IN, CHMF OUT and CHMF IN
gh
Setting range 0 to 999 Wall finishing of STEP, POCKET, PCKT MT and PCKT VLY
ri
ll
Element used to set the cutting start point and escape point for line- or
.A
face-machining (the first clearance)
N
Example :
O
NOM-/2 SRV-R
TI
60
A E2
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
SRV-R
N
E2
start point
al
E2
A
E2
IM
K
ZA
[Applicable units]
YA
Face-machining units other than FCE MILL, TOP EMIL, and SLOT
01
Note :
)2
Conditions Immediate 2. Positioning of E2 at the escape point can be selected using E95, but
ht
2-118
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
. d
5 E4 × 0.7
ve
6 E4 × 0.7 × 0.7
s er
Program type M 7 E4 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
re
Conditions Immediate 8 E4 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
ts
9 E4 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
gh
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
ri
Setting range 0 to 999
ll
Element used to set the cutting start point and escape point (the second
.A
clearance)
N
E2 is used generally as a clearance on the X-Y plane, however, E5 is used
O
when the condition meets both of 1. and 2. mentioned below.
TI
Element used to set the cutting start point 1. There is pre-machining in the same unit.
60
E5
PO
[Applicable units]
29
LINE OUT, LINE IN, STEP, POCKET, POCKT MT, PCKT VLY
R
o.
[Related parameters]
N
Program type M
E91 bit 3, E92 bit 3, E93 bit 3, E94 bit 3, E95 bit 7
al
Conditions Immediate
ri
value of this parameter, and the values for all other roughness levels are
M
Roughness FIN-Z
01
E6 0 to 3 0.0
)2
4 E6
(c
5 E6 × 0.7
ht
6 E6 × 0.7 × 0.7
ig
yr
2-119
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
[Related parameters]
Program type M
d .
E91 bit 2, E92 bit 2, E93 bit 2, E94 bit 2, E95 bit 6, E96 bit 1, E97 bit 2
ve
Conditions Immediate
* Parameter that effectuates E7 in the applicable unit.
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99
ts
The amount of clearance that prevents interference of the chamfering
gh
cutter with the walls during face-machining
ri
E8
ll
Radial interference clearance of chamfering
.A
cutter
N
E8
O
TI
Interferes.
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
K
ri
Element used to set the position in which the cutting feed in axial direction
ZA
Se
is to be started after the line- or face-machining tool has been moved from
A
Example :
Allowance of axial-cutting start position
K
E9
A
E9
M
SRV-Z
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
NOM- × E10
WID-R =
op
NOM- × E10
Program type M 10
Conditions Immediate
Unit 10%
Setting range 0 to 9
2-120
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
E11 E11
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 40
ts
The amount of clearance that prevents interference between the tool and
gh
the figure during face milling
ri
Example :
ll
Escape point Defined figure
Radial interference clearance of face milling
.A
unit and angular face milling unit
N
E12
O
TI
60
A
R
40
start point
Conditions Immediate E12 E12
R
MPL031
o.
K
ri
Element used to set the tool path internal to the figure for end milling-top
ZA
Se
unit
A
Example :
IM
unit
ZA
10
Program type M
Defined figure
3
MPL032
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 10%
(c
Setting range 1 to 9
ht
NOM-× E14
WID-R =
op
NOM-× E14
Program type M 10
Conditions Immediate
Unit 10%
Setting range 0 to 9
2-121
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Element used to set the tool path external to the defined figure for
reciprocating-short machining with face milling unit
Example :
Tool path setting element for face
milling-top unit
Tool diameter × E15
(reciprocating short) 10
E15
Program type M
Tool diameter × E15
d .
Conditions Immediate 10
ve
Unit 10% Defined figure MPL033
s er
Setting range 1 to 9
re
Override value of the idle-cutting feed rate at which tool of end milling-
ts
mountain unit is to be moved around the outer form of the workpiece
gh
Note : Valid only when bit 0 of E91 is 1 and its bit 7 is 0.
ri
Example :
Peripheral-cutting feed rate override for end
ll
Defined figure
.A
milling-mountain unit
N
E16
O
E16
FR × 10
TI
FR
60
Program type M
A
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
O
N
Setting range 1 to 20
C
al
ZA
Note :
1. Valid only when ZFD (or AFD) of tool sequence is G01.
K
E17 Example :
A
M
YA
3
FR × E9 SRV-Z
Conditions Immediate 10
)2
surface
Setting range 0 to 9 MPL035
ht
ig
Example :
C
E18
MPL036
Note :
Program type M
Overriding for overall width cutting is not valid when this parameter is 0.
Conditions Immediate
[Applicable units]
Unit 10% Rough-machining of POCKET, PCKT MT, PCKT VLY and STEP
Setting range 0 to 9
2-122
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit %
s
Setting range 0 to 999
re
This parameter indicates the feed override value for axial pecking
ts
movement to the surface to be machined using a face-machining unit
gh
excepting a face milling unit.
ri
Axial cutting feed override during Z-axial E20
ll
Feed rate during pecking operation = FR × 10
cutting in the pecking mode of face
.A
machining
N
E20 Note :
O
TI
1. Valid only when G01 or a numeric value is set for ZFD (or AFD) and
60
A
[PECKING] is selected for TYPE in the tool sequence.
R
40
Program type M 2. The feed override function is invalid when “0” is assigned to this
PO
29
Unit 10%
o.
O
N
Setting range 0 to 40
C
al
ZA
Example :
IM
E21
A
M
E21 point
Program type M MPL037
3
[Applicable units]
01
Conditions Immediate
LINE OUT, LINE IN, CHMF OUT and CHMF IN
)2
Example :
yr
FR × E22
op
10
Override value of automatic corner
C
over-riding FR
E22
MPL038
Note : Automatic corner overriding is invalid when this parameter is 0.
Program type M
[Applicable units]
Conditions Immediate LINE RGT, LINE LFT, LINE OUT, LINE IN, STEP, POCKET, PCKT MT
Unit % and PCKT VLY
Setting range 0 to 99
2-123
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Effective removal allowance (upper limit) of Tool E24 Removal Tool E23
automatic corner overriding diameter × 100 allowance diameter × 100
E23
Removal allowance
Program type M
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 1 to 99
MPL039
ts
gh
ri
ll
Effective removal allowance (lower limit) of Machining Removal allowance
.A
automatic corner overriding
Line-rough machining (SRV-R) – (FIN-R)
N
E24
O
Face-rough machining (WID-R)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
O
N
Setting range 1 to 99
al
ZA
Se
The automatic corner overriding becomes valid when the following line- or
A
E25
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Unit °
)2
(c
Set the changing ratio of the axial feed rate with respect to the radial feed
yr
rate.
op
E26
Calculation coefficient for the finishing feed Axial feed rate = Radial feed rate × 100
C
of line milling
Tool
E26
Axial feed rate
Work-
Program type M Radial feed rate piece
Conditions Immediate
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 999
2-124
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
These parameters, the roughness code, etc. determine the finishing feed
rate.
d .
Kf : Roughness coefficient (Refer to the list below)
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Z : Number of teeth
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535 Roughness Roughness Roughness
Kf Kf Kf
code code code
ts
gh
–3 3
K0 × 0.8 K0 K0 × 0.8
ri
1 4 7
ll
–2 4
Finishing feed rate calculation reference K0 × 0.8 K0 × 0.8 K0 × 0.8
.A
2 5 8
feed rate in line machining unit
–1 2 5
K0 × 0.8 K0 × 0.8 K0 × 0.8
N
3 6 9
E28
O
K0=Standard data 0.5
TI
60
Program type M
A
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
0.001 mm/rev
o.
Unit
O
0.0001 in/rev
N
K
ri
ZA
Select whether the cutting conditions in the shape sequence during VFC
Se
Selection of whether the cutting conditions 1: No modification of the cutting conditions in the shape sequence
K
are to be modified modified. In the case of 1, both the cutting conditions in the tool sequence
E29
A
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-125
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
An element that determines the starting point and escape point of radial
cutting when CLOSED is specified for the wall attributes at the starting
point and ending point of open-pattern line machining.
When OPEN is specified, E2 is used.
<CLOSED specified>
d .
ve
Radial clearance for wall attributes during
er
line machining E30 E30
s
E30
re
<OPEN specified>
ts
gh
E2 E2
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
ZA
only)
IM
Protrusion Protrusion
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
Protrusion
OPEN attribute wall protrusion for
)2
2-126
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
.
d
Element that automatically determines an Approaching radius
ve
approaching radius in a Z-direction helical × (E33/100)
er
approach scheme
s
re
E32
ts
Clearance Z
gh
ri
ll
.A
Clearance Z
+
N
Cutting allowance Z
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Unit %
O
N
K
ri
Distance in Z-direction
A
Distance in XY-plane
IM
K
Approaching radius
A
× (E33/100)
M
YA
3
Clearance Z
01
E33
ht
Clearance Z
+
ig
Cutting allowance Z
yr
op
C
Approaching radius
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit %
Setting range 1 to 999
2-127
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Clearance Z
ser
Clearance Z
re
+
Program type M Cutting allowance Z
ts
gh
Conditions After stop of movement
ri
Unit %
Approaching distance
ll
Setting range 1 to 999
.A
Approaching gradient value for a Z-direction tapered approach scheme
N
O
Distance in Z-direction
TI
Distance in XY-plane
60
A
R
40
PO
× (E35/100)
O
E35
N
C
al
Clearance Z
ri
ZA
Se
Clearance Z
A
+
IM
Program type M
Cutting allowance Z
Conditions After stop of movement
K
ZA
Unit %
Approaching distance
1 to 999
A
Setting range
M
100
escape scheme
(c
E36
ht
ig
yr
Conditions Immediate
C
2-128
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
E37
E37
.
E37
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in MPL058
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Set the returning feed rate of the pecking in the Z-axial pecking mode
gh
during the face machining.
ri
[1] Feed rate
[1] Cutting (G1) F command
ll
Returning feed rate of pecking in the Z-axial
.A
[2] [2] Pecking (G1) E38
pecking mode of face machining [3]
[3] Cutting (G1) F command
N
O
E38
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
0.01 mm/rev
O
Unit
N
0.001 in/rev
C
al
ZA
Se
depth-of-cut-R (Pocket milling, Pocket (CW/CCW) is selected for the tool sequence method.
ZA
Program type M
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
E40
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
Setting range 0 to 999
2-129
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
Set the magnification factor of surface speed in helical approach.
gh
ri
Surface speed during helical approach = Surface speed in tool
ll
sequence E43/100
.A
Magnification factor of surface speed in
helical approach * If a value outside the setting range is set, E43 = 100 is assumed.
N
O
E43
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
K
ri
ZA
unit
A
IM
Example :
3-D
K
10 10
E55
A
E59
M
YA
Depth of cut
Program type M
3
01
Setting range 0 to 9
ht
0: No alarm
C
3-D 1: Alarm
Inversion check of curved-surface pattern
Example :
E56
The curved surface of a +Z
defined pattern points in
the – Z direction
Program type M +X
Conditions Immediate MPL042
Setting range 0, 1
2-130
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
E57
Note :
Program type M
d .
1. This parameter is invalid during high-speed rough processing.
ve
Conditions Immediate
2. The operation time becomes long if this parameter is set to 1.
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
This parameter is used to select whether or not 3-D tool-diameter
gh
compensation according to tool data is to be made for the curved surface
of a defined pattern
ri
0: Diameter compensation made
ll
3-D
.A
1: Diameter compensation not made
Tool-diameter compensation
Example :
N
Pattern Pattern
E58
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Element used to set the position in which the cutting feed in axial direction
Se
is to be started after the tool has been moved from the initial point toward
A
3-D Example :
K
E59
E59
A
Material height
M
E59
YA
The 3-D finish processing (cutting) allowance in the direction of the normal
ig
Example :
op
E60
C
3-D
Normal cutting allowance
E60
E60
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in MPL045
Setting range 0 to 999
2-131
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
gh
ri
ll
3-D
.A
Search length for right-angle cutting
N
E62
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
3-D Example :
K
(FL direction)
E63
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit — GL or normal to FL
(c
Note :
ig
the pattern displayed may slightly differ from the actual pattern of the
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 999
2-132
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
The allowance of cutting a workpiece along the wall of the area which has
been set using the area check function
Example :
3-D
Radial cutting allowance for area check
E65
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate E66
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
E66
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
Pattern
gh
Min. E65 Max.
ri
E65
ll
3-D
.A
MPL047
Axial cutting allowance for area check
N
E66
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
#T 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
3-D Address E67 E68 E69 E70 E71 E72 E73 E74 E75
K
Example :
to
A
M
E75
YA
Program type M
3
Curved-surface
01
Conditions Immediate #T
pattern
)2
The override value which becomes valid in case that the depth-of-cut in a
ig
radial direction becomes equal to the entire width (diameter) of the tool
yr
Example :
op
3-D
C
Entire-width override
E76
Program type M
E76
Conditions Immediate Tool-sequence feed × MPL049
10
Unit 10% Note : Entire-width overriding is not valid when this parameter is 0.
Setting range 0 to 9
2-133
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate Defined pattern
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in E77 E77 MPL050
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
0: 100%
gh
ri
ll
3-D
.A
Multiplying factor set for tolerance
N
E78
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
K
ri
ZA
direction
IM
3-D Region to be
Region of radial machining during machined
K
appoint-ment)
E83
A
Material height
M
Curved-surface
YA
pattern
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
3-D Example :
C
E84
Program type M
E83
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in Curved-surface pattern MPL052
Setting range 0 to 9999
2-134
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
3-D
Region of radial machining during E88
high-speed rough processing: –X
(workpiece size appointment)
E85
E85 E86
d .
pattern
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
+Y
re
Setting range 0 to 9999
ts
gh
E87
+X
ri
Region to be machined
3-D
ll
Region of radial machining during MPL053
.A
high-speed rough processing: +X
N
(workpiece size appointment)
E86
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
3-D
Region of radial machining during
K
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
3-D
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
Setting range 0 to 9999
2-135
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
E89
ve
er
+X
Program type M
s
re
Conditions Immediate E85 E86
ts
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
gh
MPL054
Setting range 0 to 9999
ri
ll
76543210
.A
0: Machining from inside to outside
N
1: Machining from outside to inside
O
0: Cutting direction inversed
TI
1: Cutting direction fixed
60
respectively.
o.
O
N
E2.
al
ZA
Se
Tool-path pattern selection for end 1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9
milling-mountain unit
K
Note :
YA
Bit 4 = 0 Bit 4 = 1
ht
ig
E9 Initial point
yr
E7
op
C
1st cutting
Program type M
2nd cutting
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
MPL055
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-136
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
76543210
0: Machining from inside to outside
1: Machining from outside to inside
Tool-path pattern selection for pocket 0: The R-point height is set always to E9.
milling unit 1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when
there is or isn’t pre-machining in the same unit,
E92 respectively.
0: The clearance on X-Y plane is set always to
E2.
Program type M 1: The clearance on X-Y plane is set to E5 or E2
d .
when there is or isn’t pre-machining in the
ve
Conditions Immediate
same unit, respectively.
er
Unit —
1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9
s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits
ts
76543210
gh
ri
0: Machining from inside to outside
1: Machining from outside to inside
ll
.A
0: Cutting direction inversed
Tool-path pattern selection for pocket 1: Cutting direction fixed
N
O
milling-mountain unit
0: The R-point height is set always to E9.
TI
E93 1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when
60
respectively.
PO
29
E2.
o.
Conditions Immediate
K
ZA
Unit —
1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9
Se
76543210
K
ZA
respectively.
(c
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-137
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
In case of a collision in the line-machining
approach path:
0: Machining not aborted (conventional method)
1: Machining aborted
For the 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting:
0: Not via the approach point
1: Via the approach point
For the 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting:
0: Escape to the Z-axis initial point
d.
1: No escape on the Z-axis
ve
1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9
er
1: Escape is set to a point where the tool comes
s
re
out of the removal allowance.
The R-point height for central, right hand, left
ts
hand, outside and inside linear machining is:
gh
0: Set always to E9
ri
1: Set to E7 or E9 when there is or isn’t
ll
pre-machining in the same unit, respectively.
.A
The X-Y plane clearance for outside and inside
N
linear machining is:
O
0: Set always to E2
TI
1: Set to E5 or E2 when there is or isn’t
60
Bit 2
PO
29
Bit 2 = 1 Bit 2 = 0
R
o.
Initial point
N
machining unit
C
al
E95
K
ri
ZA
Se
Bit 3
A
Bit 3 = 0
Initial point
3
01
)2
MPL502
ig
yr
Bit 5
op
Bit 5 = 0 Bit 5 = 1
C
E2
Escape point E2
WID-R MPL503
Program type M
Note :
Conditions Immediate
1. Bit 3 valid only for inside/outside line machining unit.
Unit — 2. When bit 3 is set to 1, “no escape on the Z-axis” is selected
Setting range Binary, eight digits regardless of bit 2 of parameter E104.
2-138
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
For the 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting:
gh
0: Not via the approach point
ri
1: Via the approach point
ll
Approach method selection for 2nd and
.A
subsequent rounds of cutting in end
milling-slot unit
N
E96
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
E96
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-139
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
76543210
gh
0: The R-point height is set always to E9
ri
1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when
ll
Tool-path pattern selection for end there is or isn’t pre-machining in the same
.A
milling-top unit unit, respectively.
N
1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9
E97
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
K
ri
ZA
76543210
Se
A
IM
pocket valley-machining.
milling-mountain, pocket milling-valley unit
ZA
E98
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Milling feed rate specification range for the shape sequence of the
ig
MAZATROL program
yr
Milling feed rate specification range for the 1: Valid for finishing
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-140
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Interference check between the approach point and the cutting starting
gh
point of face machining
ri
0: Invalid
Interference check between the approach
ll
1: Valid
.A
point and the cutting starting point of face
machining
N
E99
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Set whether or not to display alarm 705 APPROACH POINT ERROR and
ri
ZA
stop operation when the amount of tool movement is 0 for the command in
Se
E99
(bit 4)
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
operation
E99
(bit 5)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-141
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Used to select the calculation method of the machining start point after
automatic determination of the approach point in line machining units.
0: Conventional scheme
Machining start point calculation method 1: Start machining near the automatically determined approach point
after automatic determination of approach
point in line machining unit
E99
(bit 6)
Program type M
.d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Same operation before and after automatic determination
gh
1: Operation by manual input after automatic determination
ri
Cutting method to be used after an
ll
.A
approach point is automatically determined
during line/face machining
N
E104
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Tool retraction position after each cutting plunge in the Z-axis direction in
ri
ZA
Se
0: R-point
IM
1: Initial point
K
E104
M
(bit 1) R-point
E104 bit 1 = 0
YA
Conditions Immediate
(c
ht
Unit —
ig
Setting range 0, 1
yr
op
C
2-142
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
Tool retraction position after each cutting plunge in the Z-axis direction in
the line machining unit
0: R-point
1: Initial point
Approach point Escape point
E104 bit 2 = 1 Initial point
Returning position during line machining.
E104 E104 bit 2 = 0 R-point
(workpiece top face + E9)
(bit 2)
.d
ve
1st removal allowance
er
2nd removal allowance
s
re
ts
Program type M Note :
gh
When bit 3 of parameter E95 is set to 1, “no escape on the Z-axis” is
Conditions Immediate
selected.
ri
Unit —
ll
.A
Setting range 0, 1
N
0: Starting or ending point of shape + Tool radius + E30
O
1: Starting or ending point of shape
TI
60
line machining
E104
R
o.
(bit 3)
O
N
C
al
K
ri
Program type M
ZA
Se
Conditions Immediate
A
IM
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-143
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate XY Circular
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
gh
ri
Pattern
ll
Method of connecting between shapes Pattern
.A
during wall finish of face machining
E104
N
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
scheme)
IM
E104
(bit 6)
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
Outputting of a tool change command when the next tool is the same tool.
ht
0: Not output
ig
yr
1: Output
op
E104
(bit 7)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-144
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
0: Specifiable
1: Not specifiable
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select the surface on which to describe a line machining shape with a
gh
Z-axis offset in the ZC mode.
ri
0: Surface defined by SHIFT-R
ll
1: Surface defined by SHIFT-R + SRV-A
Machining shape specification method in
.A
line machining in ZC mode/on C-axis
N
E105 Select the surface on which to describe a C-axis line machining of the
O
(bit 1) WPC workpiece scheme.
TI
60
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Invalid
ZA
Se
HD2 side
E105
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Invalid
ig
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-145
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: C-axis angle in the opposite direction to the machining direction on the
gh
HD1 side during the following:
ri
Point machining in the ZY mode on the HD2 side;
ll
C-axis angle selection during Y-axis milling Engraving unit in the ZY mode on the HD2 side;
.A
in the composite program on the Point machining in the XY mode on the HD2 side;
MULTIPLEX HD2 side
N
E105 Line/face machining in the XY mode on the HD2 side
O
(bit 5) 1: C-axis angle same as the machining direction on the HD1 side during
TI
the following:
60
A
R
Point machining in the ZY mode on the HD2 side;
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
R
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Select the reference plane for the program when developing chamfering
Se
(bit 6)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Sets the operation when tool path generation using WID-R specified for
ig
2-146
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
Select whether or not to go through the initial point after TPC approach
relay point during line/face machining in a program of initial-point scheme.
0: Do not go through
Selection of the initial point as a relay point 1: Go through
to be used after TPC approach (line/face
* Valid only with the machines equipped with ATC-type turret and
machining unit)
E106 swiveling-type spindle head
(bit 0)
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select the operation to perform before moving to the TPC escape relay
gh
point at the end of machining during line/face machining in a program of
initial-point scheme.
ri
0: Initial point → TPC escape relay point
ll
Selection of a relay point to be used before
.A
TPC escapement (line/face machining unit) 1: R-point → TPC escape relay point
N
E106 * Valid only with the machines equipped with ATC-type turret and not
O
equipped with swiveling-type spindle head
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Not displayed
IM
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Not displayed
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-147
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
If two geometries are too close to each other and the tool cannot enter
gh
while executing intelligent pocket milling (IPM);
ri
0: Generates an alarm 706 ILLEGAL FIGURE DATA and continues
operation.
ll
Operation on failure of tool entry during
.A
intelligent pocket milling (IPM) 1: Generates an alarm 704 TOOL INTERFERENCE and stops operation.
N
E108
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Set the maximum difference in the radius between the start and end points
Se
E109
YA
3
01
)2
Engage angle
(c
Conditions Immediate
ig
Unit %
yr
2-148
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
E110
d .
ve
er
s
re
Program type M E110
ts
Conditions Immediate
gh
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
ri
Setting range 0 to 99999
ll
.A
This determines the following conditions in intelligent pocket milling (IPM)
machining (Pocket milling-valley)
N
O
Maximum amount of tool protrusion in valley-shape machining
TI
Element that determines the tool paths in Amount of clearance in approaching into valley shape
60
(Pocket milling-valley)
offset inward by “E111 + Tool radius”
PO
E111
29
R
o.
O
N
Program type M
al
K
ri
ZA
Conditions Immediate
Se
Unit %
IM
Set the maximum distance to avoid the wall in intelligent pocket milling
ZA
(IPM) machining.
In intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining, when a tool passes the wall
A
M
E112
01
)2
(c
Program type M
ht
Conditions Immediate
ig
yr
2-149
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999
ts
Set the magnification factor of the minimum arc of trochoid cycle in
gh
intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining.
ri
ll
Magnification factor of the minimum arc of
.A
trochoid cycle in intelligent pocket milling
(IPM) machining
N
E115
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
Setting range 5 to 50
al
K
ri
ZA
avoidance operation.
A
E116
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
Set the amount of overlapping for expanding the groove width in the end
ig
milling-slot unit.
yr
op
C
E129
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 10%
Setting range 0 to 9
2-150
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
Tolerance between the interpolated line segment and the ideal curve for
smooth chamfering
* When 0 is set, it is regarded as 1. When a negative value or a value of
Smooth chamfering: tolerance between the 10000 or greater is set, it is also regarded as 1.
interpolated line segment and the ideal
Interpolated line
curve
segment
E130 End
E130 or less point
Ideal curve
Program type M Start point
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999
ts
This is the element used for automatically determining the depth-of-cut R
gh
in the tool sequence in the line machining unit.
ri
(The set value is invalid for the LINE CTR unit.)
ll
Element that automatically determines
.A
depth-of-cut-R (line machining)
N
E131
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 10%
N
Setting range 0 to 9
al
K
ri
ZA
E132
A
E132
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
Program type M
E132 Wall
yr
Conditions Immediate
op
2-151
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
When a helical approach is set, the tool changes its surface speed to the
value set in the tool sequence after moving the distance set for parameter
E133 away from the hole bottom.
E133
Program type M
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
Sets the clearance from the machining face when carrying out the
gh
machining for an engraving unit in a MAZATROL program.
ri
ll
Clearance in the tool axial direction in
.A
E134
engraving units
N
Machining
E134
O
face
Depth
TI
60
HoleA
bottom
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
K
ri
E141
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
1: Determine the starting point based on the quadrant near the approach
yr
point
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-152
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D
0: Lower left (X/+Y) of the shape, viewed from the end face (back face)
direction
1: Determine the approach point based on the specified shape
Round bar face milling unit
Approach point/cutting start point before
automatic approach point setting
E141
(bit 2)
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Determine the cutting start point at the lower left (X/+Y) of the shape
gh
when E141bit2 = 0
ri
Or determine the cutting start point from the specified shape when
ll
Round bar face milling unit E141bit2 = 1
.A
Cutting start point after automatic approach 1: Determine the cutting start point near the approach point.
N
point setting
E141
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
0: After the helical approach to the hole bottom, the tool moves the
A
distance set for E113 away from the hole bottom and changes its
IM
surface speed.
Surface speed change mode selection in
K
helical approach 1: After the helical approach to a position the distance set for E133 away
ZA
from the hole position, the tool changes its surface speed at that
E141
position.
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-153
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
F1
.
Note :
d
ve
The assigned value is invalid if minus. If 0 is assigned, the deceleration
er
Program type M, E coefficient will be regarded as 100, or if more than 500 is assigned, the
s
Conditions Immediate deceleration coefficient will be regarded as 500.
re
Unit %
ts
gh
Setting range 0 to 500
ri
When (L74/L75) × (F2/100) is assigned as the allowable acceleration
attained before arc radius speed clamping is started, the theoretical value
ll
.A
Vc of the arc radius clamping speed in G61.1 will be changed to the
following Vc’ value:
N
O
G61.1 arc-clamping speed coefficient (%)
TI
Vc’ = Vc × (F2/100)
60
F2
A
R
40
PO
Note :
29
Program type M, E
o.
Unit %
ri
ZA
F3
3
01
Program type E
)2
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1, 3
ig
yr
op
C
2-154
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Distance to judge the shape formed by 3 Example : When the setting is F4 = 5000 [0.5 mm (0.02 in)]
axes under tool tip point control in the 5-axis
fairing function
Point to be modified
F4 0.15 mm (0.006 in) 0.1 mm (0.004 in)
.
0.15 mm (0.006 in) 0.15 mm (0.006 in)
d
0.2 mm (0.01 in)
ve
0.2 mm (0.01 in)
er
Succeeding Preceding 0.2 mm (0.01 in)
s
distance distance
re
Z
Program type E 0.5 mm 0.5 mm
Y (0.02 in) (0.02 in)
ts
Conditions Immediate
gh
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in X
ri
Setting range 0 to 999999
ll
.A
Set the distance, succeeding and preceding the point to be modified, to
judge the shape formed by the rotary 2 axes in the 5-axis fairing function
N
O
Note : When 0 is set, the distance is regarded as 1°.
TI
Distance to judge the shape formed by
60
PO
29
F5
R
o.
O
N
Program type E
al
Conditions Immediate
ri
ZA
Se
Unit 0.0001°
A
Specify the minimum height of stepped sections at which the axis feed is
K
F6
01
)2
(c
Program type E
ht
2-155
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
F7
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Corner deceleration speed Vo determined by the optimal corner
gh
deceleration function is adjusted using the value set in this parameter.
ri
F8
Vo = Vo × 100
ll
.A
Corner deceleration speed coefficient for
The speed is not adjusted if 0 is set here. (Setting is handled as 100.)
high-speed smoothing control
N
Setting more than 2000 is disposed as 2000.
O
F8
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
K
ri
ZA
Circular cutting clamp speed Vc is adjusted using the value set in this
Se
parameter.
A
IM
F9
Vc = Vc × 100
Circular cutting clamp speed coefficient for
K
high-speed smoothing control The speed is not adjusted if 0 is set here. (Setting is handled as 100.)
ZA
F9
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
cycle
yr
op
C
F10 F10
Pecking
Program type M, E F10
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-156
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
(I, J, K) I d
Machining x = x0 + ×
d F11 2
pattern
Vector J d
y = y0 + ×
Vector constant for 3-D tool-diameter normal F11 2
compensation to face K d
z = z0 + ×
F11 2
F11
Coordinates of
Coordinates of tool center
program (x0, y0, z0) (x, y, z) MPL057
Program type —
. d
Conditions Next block
ve
F11 = I2+J2+K2 if this parameter is 0.
er
0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Unit
(0.001°)
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Return amount of pecking in drill high-speed deep-hole cycle or in G73
gh
tool path
ri
ll
.A
Return amount of pecking in drill
high-speed deep-hole cycle or in G73
N
O
F12
TI
F12
60
A
R
40
PO
29
O
N
MPL058
al
ZA
The allowance amount provided for the tool to stop moving at rapid-feed
Se
F13
M
F13
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
Program type —
Conditions At power on
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
2-157
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type —
. d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
ts
Vector of coordinate rotation (axis of abscissa)
gh
ri
ll
.A
Horizontal length of coordinate rotation
N
F16
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
ZA
Se
A
IM
F17
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions At power on
01
F18
Program type —
Conditions At power on
Unit 0.001°
Setting range 0 to ±180000
2-158
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
d .
Center
ve
Conditions Next block
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in Start point MPL060
s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999
ts
That fixed value of the scaling factor which becomes valid in the case that
gh
no value is set (using the address P) in the same block as that of G51.
b
ri
Scaling factor =
Machining a
ll
pattern
.A
Fixed value of scaling factor
b
N
F20
O
a
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit 1/1000000
O
N
The automatic corner override using the G62 code becomes valid when
ri
ZA
F21
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
The area in which automatic corner overriding using the G62 code occurs
ig
yr
F22
op
F22
Program type E
Conditions Next command
Overriding occurs here. MPL063
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Unit
(0.0001°)
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-159
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 9
ts
Set chamfering angle at thread portion in thread cutting cycle.
gh
G276 and G292 are used for thread cutting cycle, if F30 is set to 0.
G76 and G92 are used for thread cutting cycle, if F30 is set to 1.
ri
ll
.A
Threading chamfering angle
F28
N
F28
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
O
N
Unit °
C
al
ZA
The override value of automatic corner overriding using the G62 code
Se
A
IM
F29
F× Specified feed rate F
100
Override value of automatic corner
K
ZA
overriding (G62)
F29
A
M
YA
MPL064
Program type E Note :
3
01
Conditions Next command The automatic corner overriding is invalid when this parameter is 0.
)2
Unit %
(c
F30 Note :
Do not disturb the default setting. It is a fixed value for your machine
model.
Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit Decimal number
Setting range 0, 1
2-160
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
.
layout 3: Rearranging each tool with priority given to the same tool (with
d
ve
roughing/finishing tool distinction)
F31
er
4: Rearranging a roughing tool, a normal tool, and a finishing tool, in that
order
s
re
Further rearranging normal tools in the order of spot drilling drilling
end milling chamfering boring reaming back spot facing
ts
back boring tapping
gh
5: Rearranging a roughing tool, a normal tool, and a finishing tool, in that
ri
order
ll
Further rearranging normal tools in the order of spot drilling drilling
.A
end milling chamfering boring reaming back spot facing
Program type M
N
back boring tapping
O
Conditions After stop of movement In addition, for the manual programming unit, assigning priority
TI
Unit Decimal number numbers, judged from the tools to be used
60
A
R
40
Setting range 0 to 5
PO
29
O
N
0: Alarm
C
ZA
setting
Se
F32
IM
K
ZA
Program type E
A
Conditions Immediate
M
Unit —
YA
Setting range 0, 1
3
F33 1: Invalid
yr
(bit 0)
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-161
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Check during automatic operation
gh
1: Do not check during automatic operation
ri
* When “Do not check during automatic operation” is selected, data that
ll
Selection of check in the course of cannot be altered in the course of automatic operation can be altered via
.A
automatic operation when data is network.
input/output through network
N
F33
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
MAZATROL program
ZA
F33
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Automatic tool identification from the B-axis angle and the milling spindle’s
ig
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-162
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: The indication at the G68.5 mode selection remains as it is.
gh
1: G122.1 (radius data input for X-axis ON) is indicated during the G68.5
ri
mode.
ll
Modal indication on "radius data input for
.A
“X-axis” in the mode of 3D coordinate
conversion (G68.5)
N
F33
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
1: Valid
A
IM
pressed, valid/invalid
F34
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
The data number and value for tool length offset on the POSITION display
ig
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-163
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set the tool change command output position of the tool to use in manual
gh
program unit when WPC is selected for workpiece scheme.
ri
0: Always output at the machining end position of the previous unit.
ll
Tool change command output position of
1: Set the output position in manual program unit.
.A
the tool to use in manual program unit when
(“RETURN” is automatically set at the same time as default.)
WPC is selected for workpiece scheme
N
F34
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
machining
ZA
F34
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
1).
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-164
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Application of the Z-OFFSET and C-OFFSET values prepared for the
gh
program that is currently selected from the STANDARD PROGRAM
ri
storage area for the automatic operation
ll
1: No application of the Z-OFFSET and C-OFFSET values prepared on
.A
Application of Z-OFFSET and C-OFFSET the SETUP INFORMATION display
values for the tape operation mode
N
F34
O
TI
(bit 7)
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
display
F35
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
display.
op
Program type M
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-165
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Machine status when a program prepared and stored for the Hard Disk
gh
operation is called up as a subprogram with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
SHIELD being selected for automatic operation.
ri
Machine status when a program prepared
and stored for the Hard Disk operation is 0: Continuing the operation by canceling the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
ll
.A
called up as a subprogram with the SHIELD for automatic operation
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being 1: Alarm stop
F35
N
selected for automatic operation
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
O
F37 bit 5
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
0: No representation
IM
Taking off a material model’s part on the (Cut-off part remains shown in its original place and undergoes the
VIRTUAL MACHINING and 3D MONITOR
K
interference check.)
displays
ZA
F35 1: Representation
(Cut-off part is hidden and excluded from the interference check.)
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
Traction tailstock or traction work rest operation when [ALL AXIS ZERO
RET] is selected on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display
ig
yr
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-166
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Tool offset in the current position display in the G52.5 coordinate system
gh
0: Do not consider
ri
1: Consider
ll
Current position display in the G52.5
.A
coordinate system * This parameter is valid for automatic operation and virtual machining, but
N
F36 not valid in tool path check.
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
mode
A
Automatic M-code setting in EIA/ISO 1: Set automatically (up to six M-codes preceding immediately)
K
F36
A
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
mode
yr
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-167
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Example :
Error check function in cases where If numerical data is omitted, such as “G90G0X”, alarm 807 ILLEGAL
numerical data is omitted in the EIA
FORMAT is displayed.
program or in MDI mode
F36
(bit 3)
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Whether or not the chuck and tailstock areas are to be displayed for an
gh
EIA/ISO program on the TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK display
ri
0: Not displayed
Display of the chuck and tailstock areas for
ll
1: Displayed
.A
an EIA/ISO program on the TRACE or
TOOL PATH CHECK display
F36
N
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Offset in the XY direction at the time when the tool offset of the touch
ri
ZA
a turning tool) for geometry offset X/Y on the TOOL OFFSET display
IM
0: Invalid
K
1: Valid
The X-/Y-/Z-axis offset is valid.
A
F36 Y-axis
YA
X-axis
(bit 5)
3
01
Z-axis
)2
(c
Geometry offset Z
ht
Conditions Immediate
yr
Setting range 0, 1
C
2-168
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type E
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Invalid
gh
1: Valid
ri
ll
.A
Rotational axis prefiltering
F36
N
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
0: Invalid
ri
ZA
Se
1: Valid
A
IM
point control
ZA
F37
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: No alarming
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-169
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Z-axis movement immediately after ATC during MDI operation when the
MAZATROL tool length is valid (bit 3 of parameter F93 is set to 1)
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select the timing of clearing the message that is displayed at #3006
gh
(stop).
ri
0: At the end of automatic operation
ll
1: At the execution of the next block
.A
Timing of clearing #3006 (stop) message
N
F37
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Set the coordinate system to be used for linear interpolation when a rapid
Se
traverse command has been specified during tool tip point control.
A
IM
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
automatic operation.
op
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD enabled 1: Depend on the setting of bit 3 of parameter F35
F37 for automatic operation
(bit 5)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
[Related parameters]
Unit —
F35 bit 3
Setting range 0, 1
2-170
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Set the operation pattern when “ATC” is not set in end unit
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Options displayed in the tool model type selection window are limited
gh
according to the selected tool type (milling tool or turning tool).
ri
0: Not set
ll
Options displayed in the tool model type 1: Set
.A
selection window according to the tool type
N
F38
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Tool index number and that of the tool to change when [TOOLDATA
ZA
Se
F38
A
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Large
ig
1: Small
yr
op
Program type E
Conditions At power back on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-171
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Input method in automatic setting of 1: By tapping the [OK] button after tapping [AUTO SET]
LENGTH/TOOL SET value
F38
(bit 3)
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Negative tool diameter setting in tool data
gh
0: Impossible
ri
If a negative value is input, alarm 402 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT
occurs.
ll
.A
Negative tool diameter setting 1: Possible
N
F38
O
(bit 4) * When this parameter is set to “1”, alarm 654 TOOL DATA ERROR will
TI
occur if a tool to which a negative tool diameter is input is used in the
60
A
MAZATROL program.
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Displayed
ZA
Se
1: Not displayed
A
IM
Reverse pattern display/hidden for milling * This parameter is valid when bit 6 of parameter K102 is set to 1 (milling
K
F38
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
unit.
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2
2-172
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
0: Tape operation
1: Hard disc operation
3: Ethernet operation
F40
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1, 3
ts
Set a threading termination waiting time.
gh
F41 = 0
No waiting time
ri
ll
F41 = 1 to 255
.A
Setting × 1.7 ms
N
X-axis
O
F41 < F41’ < F41”
TI
60
processing
PO
29
F41
R
F41
o.
F41’
N
F41”
al
Z-axis
K
ri
ZA
on the Z-axis
A
Note :
IM
Program type M An excessively high setting may cause the thread of the run-out section
K
to be destroyed.
ZA
Conditions Immediate
Unit 1.7 ms
A
M
measurement (G37)
ht
F42
ig
yr
op
Program type E
C
2-173
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
G37 Z_ R_ Dd F_;
Measurement area d during Z-axis
(G37)
measurement
F43
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Measuring speed (f)
gh
This data is used when argument F is omitted in G37 command format.
ri
G37 Z_ R_ D_ Ff;
ll
.A
Measuring speed f (G37)
N
F44
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
K
ri
The name of the variable specified by the user macro SETVN is displayed
ZA
Se
Common variable name
K
to
A
F66
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions —
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
0: L74/L75
ht
ig
smaller of the rates for the axes set for parameters M1/N1.
With modal G01, all the axes are accelerated/decelerated at the
op
G53.1 acceleration selection during smaller rate between those for the axes set for parameters M3/N2.
C
pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration
F68 Note :
(bit 0) When F68 bit 0 = 1, the composite acceleration/deceleration speed for
G53.1 changes if either of the following conditions is satisfied.
G61.1 command
Program type E
G61.2 command
Conditions Immediate
G64 command (only for modal G00 while constant G00 inclination
Unit — control is enabled)
Setting range 0, 1
2-174
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type E
.d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
This parameter is used to select the method of specifying the EIA/ISO
gh
program restarting position. Two methods are available:
ri
0: The whole program, including the subprograms, is subjected to this
processing. Set the sequence number, block number and number
ll
.A
EIA/ISO program restart method of times of repetition as searched from the beginning part of the
main program.
N
F69 1: The subprogram including the desired restart position can be
O
specified. After setting the work number of the corresponding
TI
60
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
ineffective.
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
F71
Program type M
MPL065
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-175
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
The tool-path check time study time that is accumulated each time an
ts
M-code is output.
gh
ri
ll
.A
M-code execution time for time study
N
F73
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.01 s
O
N
The tool-path check time study time that is accumulated each time an
ri
ZA
S-code is output.
Se
A
IM
F74
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit 0.01 s
)2
The tool-path check time study time that is accumulated each time a
ht
T-code is output.
ig
yr
op
F75
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.01 s
Setting range 0 to 10000
2-176
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
The tool-path check time study time that is accumulated each time a
B-code is output.
F76
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.01 s
s
re
Setting range 0 to 10000
ts
The basis rate for the NC to judge whether the tool is to be displayed in
gh
reverse display mode on the TOOL DATA display to indicate that the life
of that tool is approaching expiry.
ri
If bit 2 in F82 is 0:
ll
.A
Basis rate for tool life judgment When the rate of the operation time to the estimated life exceeds the
setting of the F77 parameter, the NC will judge the tool to be approaching
N
expiry.
F77
O
TI
If bit 2 in F82 is 1:
60
When the residual life decreases below the setting of the F77 parameter,
A
the NC will judge the tool to be approaching expiry.
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
Note :
o.
Unit %, min The above judgment function is invalid if this parameter is set to 0.
N
K
ri
ZA
Selection of separation ratio between side view and front view (or rear
Se
view) when two split plane indication mode has been selected.
A
F78 = 0 .......................1:1
IM
F78 = 1 .......................2:1
Selection of separating ratio of graphic F78 = 2 .......................5:1
K
display
ZA
Example : F78 = 1
F78
A
Graphic display
M
YA
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit — NM211-00217
2:1
(c
Setting range 0, 1, 2
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-177
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
Holding of memory monitor address
0: No
1: Yes
Selection of menu display
0: Menu for machining centers
1: Menu for turning centers
Key history function
0: Yes
1: No
Tool search method
d .
0: In order of TNo.
ve
—
1: In order of TNo. of tools currently in use
er
* Only bit 3 becomes valid after power-on.
s
F79
re
Selection of tap gear
0: M32 system
ts
1: M640M Pro system
gh
(M640M/M PLUS system)
ri
Display of tools currently in use
ll
0: No
.A
1: Yes
Initial value of synchronous/asynchronous tapping
N
during tapping tool registration
O
TI
0: Synchronous tapping
60
A 1: Asynchronous tapping
Program type M, E * This parameter is valid only when a sync
R
40
Conditions
29
0: Yes
o.
Unit —
O
1: No
N
K
ri
ZA
0: Valid
IM
occurrence of an alarm
ZA
0: Display off
1: Display on
A
M
1: Displayed
3
0: Not displayed
—
)2
1: Displayed
Automatic display of the GRAPHIC
(c
alarm
ig
0: Display off
yr
1: Display on
op
1: Valid
Editing on the CUTTING CONDITION LEARN
display
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Destination of spare tool correction by the
Program type M, E workpiece measurement
0: Tool length and tool diameter of the TOOL
Conditions Immediate DATA display
Unit — 1: Tool length and tool diameter correction of the
TOOL DATA display
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-178
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
76543210
Program management function
0: Normal
1: Editing prohibited (in 9000’s)
Program management function
0: Normal
1: Displaying prohibited (in 9000’s)
Fixed value (0)
Add-in MAZATROL
.
— 0: Invalid
d
ve
1: Valid
F81
er
Program management function
s
0: Normal
re
1: Editing prohibited (in 8000, 9000’s)
ts
Program management function
gh
0: Normal
ri
1: Displaying prohibited (in 8000, 9000’s)
ll
Retaining the program transfer settings
.A
0: Invalid
1: Valid
N
O
Program type M, E Input error prevention function
TI
Conditions At power on 0: Invalid
60
Unit —
A 1: Valid
R
40
PO
76543210
o.
O
N
K
ri
display modes
IM
0: Invalid 1: Valid
Basis for tool life judgment
K
parameter
M
0: Invalid 1: Valid
01
operation
yr
0: Impossible 1: Possible
op
Note :
C
2-179
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits
ts
Select whether or not the tool offset data is taken into account for the
gh
POSITION counter during automatic operation or virtual machining with
EIA/ISO programs
ri
Selection of whether or not the tool offset 0: Not taken into account
ll
data is taken into account for the POSITION
.A
1: Taken into account
counter during the execution of EIA/ISO
N
F84 programs
O
* In the tool path check, the tool offset value is not taken into account
(bit 0)
TI
disregarding the setting of this parameter.
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: B is used.
A
1: J is used.
IM
cycle
ZA
F84
A
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
programs
F84
(bit 2)
Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-180
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: M32, M PLUS, M640M, or M640M Pro system
gh
1: M2 system
ri
ll
.A
Machine coordinate system (G92) selection
N
F84
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
F84
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-181
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
When no tool data has been set during EIA/ISO program execution with
the MAZATROL tool diameter data enabled (parameter F92 bit 7 = 1) or
the MAZATROL tool length data enabled (parameter F93 bit 3 = 1):
0: Operation is executed.
Operation executed/not executed when the
1: Causes alarm 953 TOOL DATA INPUT PROCESS ERROR
tool data has not bee set
F84
(bit 7)
Note :
Whether the alarm 953 TOOL DATA INPUT PROCESS ERROR occurs
Program type E
.
or not in the MDI mode depends on the setting of bit 3 of parameter
d
ve
Conditions At power on F123.
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Sets the condition where machining with table rotation is possible.
gh
0: Always possible
ri
1: Possible outside the area only
ll
.A
Table rotational machining
F85
N
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
0: Enabled
A
1: Disabled
IM
When 0 is set, the operation on detecting interference can be set for bit 5
ZA
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
Sets the type of coordinate system for controlling the tool tip point.
ig
the tool tip point 1: The work coordinate system is defined as the programming coordinate
F85 system.
(bit 2)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-182
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
When 0 is set:
d .
RC1
by the arrow.
ve
The tool attitude vector moves in
R1 a plane including R1 and R2.
er
Tool tip
Z
s
re
ts
Tool tip point control scheme
Face horizontal to R1 and R2
gh
X
F85
ri
(bit 3)
ll
.A
When 1 is set:
N
O
TI
In the case of joint interpolation,
60
RC2
The tool attitude vector moves
PO
R2
29
R1
O
N
Tool tip Z
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Program type M, E
A
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
K
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
A
—
01
F85
)2
(bit 4)
(c
ht
ig
Program type —
yr
Conditions —
op
Unit —
C
Setting range —
2-183
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d.
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
Sets whether surface definition is to be displayed.
ts
gh
0 : Not displayed
ri
1 : Displayed
ll
.A
Display of surface definition
F85
N
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
indexing.
Se
0: To output
IM
F85 (Valid only for MAZATROL programs of the INTEGREX and INTEGREX-e
(bit 7) series.)
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
0: Not output
yr
1: Output
op
valid/invalid
F86
(bit 0)
Program type M
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-184
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Milling-spindle start timing for a milling unit (with MILL&TURN. set under
TYPE of UNo. 0)
0: After tool change
Milling-spindle start timing for a milling unit 1: At the initial point
(with MILL&TURN. set under TYPE of
UNo. 0)
F86
(bit 1)
Program type M
d.
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Makes the override function valid for the movement of the tool tip
gh
point.
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
control
PO
29
F86 1: Makes the override function valid for the clamping speed at the
R
(bit 2)
O
ZA
Se
Program type E
ZA
Conditions At power on
A
M
Unit —
YA
Setting range 0, 1
A clamp command is or is not output when indexing the B-axis
3
01
0: Output
)2
1: Not output
(c
B-axis
F86
ig
yr
(bit 3)
op
C
Program type M
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-185
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
The plane for the display on the PART SHAPE window is:
0: X-Y plane
1: X-Z plane
Program type M
.
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
0: Override valid for the movement of the tool tip point
ts
gh
1: Override valid for the clamping speed at the machine control point
ri
ll
Override scheme for G1 during tool tip point
.A
control
F86
N
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
A
IM
F86
ZA
(bit 6)
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-186
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
76543210
d .
1: Invalid
ve
Data alteration checking function (tool-related
er
function)
s
re
0: Invalid
1: Valid
ts
gh
Select a feed rate display method for the
superposition system.
ri
0: Display in terms of moving speed of actual
ll
axis
.A
— 1: Display in terms of relative speed with respect
N
to the workpiece
O
F87 Single-block mode cancellation during fixed cycle
TI
0: Invalid (single-block stop occurs)
60
PO
0: Invalid
O
N
1: Valid
C
al
ZA
program end.
Se
0: Invalid
A
1: Valid
IM
0: Invalid
1: Valid
A
M
Note :
YA
Variables for tool path check are not cleared even if Bit 5, 6 or 7 in F87
is set to 1.
3
Program type M, E
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
ht
2-187
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
0: Not to output
d
ve
1: To output
Output of tool diameter correction G-code
er
0: Not to output G-code
s
re
1: To output G-code
Tool path modification caused by tool diameter
ts
correction
gh
0: Correction is not included in path
1: Correction is included in path
ri
Fixed value (0)
ll
.A
Fixed value (1)
N
O
Note :
TI
When bit 0 of F88 is set to 1 on converting to the EIA program, the line
60
A
machining, groove machining, face machining portions in the
R
40
Example :
R
Note :
o.
—
O
N
Common unit
al
ZA
EIA program.
[2]
A
with parameter.
1: To make subprogram
A
F88 bit 0
0: Not to make subprogram
M
Conversion into
YA
EIA program
Main program Subprogram
3
01
(WNo.1001); N1(UNo.2FACE-MILL);
G17G0G40G54G64G90G94;
)2
G0X5.Y2.;
G80; G1X50.; Unit of
(c
units
M98P1001H1; M99;
ig
G1Z-2;
yr
N2(UNo.3LINE-CTR);
M98P1001H1; G2X10.Y10.R5.;
op
[2] [5]
N2(UNo.3LINE-CTR); G2X40.Y10.R5.; units
M98P1001H2; M99;
G0Z-2; %
N3(UNo.4END);[3]
M30;
%
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate Note : Bit 2 and 3 of F88 are valid only for machining centers.
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-188
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
76543210
Output of shape data
0: Not to output
1: To output
Synchronous tapping G-code
0: G74/G84
1: G84.2/G84.3
Output of F command
d .
0: To output
ve
— 1: Not to output
er
Whether to generate an output for EIA conversion
s
F89 of the mill-turning unit
re
0: Alarm (No output)
ts
1: Output of the path shifted through a distance
gh
equivalent to the tool radius
ri
EIA conversion output destination
ll
0: Standard area
.A
1: Backup area
N
Returning to the second zero point before tool
O
change (output of G30)
TI
0: Not to return
60
A 1: To return
Program type M, E
R
40
Conditions Immediate
29
Unit —
o.
O
N
76543210
ri
ZA
point:
A
program:
ZA
0: Invalid
A
1: Valid
M
point:
ht
increments.
yr
0: G00 interpolation
1: G00 non-interpolation
C
2-189
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
Modal at power-on or at reset (Initial G18)
0: G17 or G19
1: G18
Modal at power-on or at reset (Initial G19)
0: G17 or G18
1: G19
Dwell command method
0: Modal
1: Always based on the time command
.
Tool-length compensation (G43, G44) axis for
d
ve
milling tools
0: X-, Y-, Z-axes (Note)
er
— 1: Z-axis fixed
s
re
Tool-diameter compensation (G41 or G42) start
F92 up/cancel type
ts
0: Type A
gh
1: Type B
ri
Tool-diameter compensation (G41 or G42)
ll
interference check
.A
0: Alarm stop occurs to prevent overcutting.
1: Tool path is changed to prevent overcutting.
N
O
Fixed-cycle hole-drilling axis
TI
0: Plane selection using G17, G18 or G19
60
A 1: Z-axis fixed
R
40
EIA/ISO program
29
0: Invalid
R
Program type M, E
o.
1: Valid
O
N
Conditions At power on
C
Note :
al
Unit —
K
In the case of tool offset type C, the value set for each axis on the TOOL
ri
ZA
Setting range Binary, eight digits OFFSET display is used for compensation.
Se
F93
M
YA
(bit 0)
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions At power on
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-190
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Tool length of tool data for an EIA/ISO program
gh
0: Invalid
ri
1: Valid
ll
Tool length of tool data for an EIA/ISO
.A
program
F93
N
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
F93
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
F93
(bit 5)
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-191
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type E
.
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Fixed value (0)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
F93
N
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
ZA
Se
fixed-cycle mode
ZA
F94
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
F94
(bit 1)
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-192
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
0: Cancel
1: Do not cancel
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: G01 (linear interpolation)
gh
1: G00 (positioning)
ri
ll
.A
Modal at power-on or at reset (G01/G00)
F94
N
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
F94
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
—
C
F94
(bit 5)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-193
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
—
F94
(bit 6)
Program type —
. d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
0: Offsets on the TOOL OFFSET display enabled
gh
1: EIA/ISO offsets on the TOOL DATA display enabled
ri
ll
Tool offset amount effectuated in an
.A
EIA/ISO program
F94
N
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
0: Invalid
A
1: Valid
IM
instruction, valid/invalid
ZA
F95
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
0: Handled as interruption
yr
call
F95
(bit 1)
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-194
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
G00 (positioning) command feed rate for dry run
gh
0: Rapid feed rate
ri
1: Feed rate for dry run
ll
G00 (positioning) command feed rate for
.A
dry run
N
F95
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Window scheme
ZA
Se
1: Alarm scheme
A
IM
error prevention function enabled F81 bit 7: Input error prevention function valid/invalid
ZA
F95 F125: Permissible data alteration amount 2 for input error prevention
A
(bit 4) function
M
F126: Maximum wear offset setting with the input error prevention
YA
function enabled
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Displayed
yr
1: Not displayed
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-195
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
With the RESET key
gh
0: Coordinate system corresponding to G54
ri
1: Coordinate system unchanged
ll
G54 coordinate system with the RESET
.A
key, valid/invalid
N
F95
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
76543210
Se
amount
0: 16001 to 16512, 17001 to 17512
K
Fairing function
0: Invalid
A
1: Valid
M
machining mode
— 0: Nonuniform feed
3
01
1: Uniform feed
F96
)2
blocks
ig
2-196
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Coordinates Coordinates
Selection of G-code of the coordinates Setting value Setting value
system system
system to be used in the EIA conversion
function 1 G54 5 G58
F97 2 G55 6 G59
3 G56
4 G57 Others G54
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate Note : F97 is valid only for machining centers.
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
To specify the number of a macro variable to be used in the EIA
gh
conversion function.
If any macro variable is not used, set to 0.
ri
ll
In case of output with a subprogram in the EIA conversion, the height of
.A
cutting face is set with a macro variable. Set to F98 the number of the
macro variable to be used.
N
O
(M)
TI
(M) (S) (M)
(S)
60
A (S)
R
40
(S) (S)
(M)
PO
(S)
(S) (S) (S) (S) Subprogram
R
(S)
o.
(M)
O
Rapid feed
N
(S)
C
(M) (S)
ri
ZA
(S) MPL504
Se
(S)
A
IM
F98
ZA
N_(_);
To the height of
G01Z_;
A
cutting face
#_=_; G00Z_; Return on Z-axis
M
Height of
X_Y_; Moves to the start point
YA
cutting face
of the next machining
Macro variable (F98) G01Z#_; on Z-axis
3
M98P_H_; XY_;
01
Machining on Z-axis
M99;
)2
FCE MILL (cutting in one direction), TOP EMIL, POCKET, PCKT MT,
yr
PCKT VLY
op
Note :
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
100 to 199
Setting range
500 to 999
2-197
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 1 to 99999998
ts
If the commanded distance in a block exceeds the spline cancel length
gh
(F100), spline interpolation is not realized in this block even in the spline
interpolation mode.
ri
ll
Curve with spline interpolation
.A
Spline cancel length
N
F100
O
P3 P4
TI
P2
60
Program type E P6
Straight line when the
PO
29
MPL505
C
K
ri
If the angle formed by two blocks exceeds the value set by the parameter
ZA
Se
F101, spline interpolation is not realized in these blocks even in the spline
A
interpolation mode.
IM
3 P4 P4
4
YA
P3 P3
Cornered
Spline cancel angle 2 P5 P5
3
4 F101 P2
01
F101 P2
5 P6 P6
)2
(c
P1 6 P7 P1 P7
ht
ig
P4
yr
P3
P5
C
P2
Program type E P6
Conditions Immediate
P1 P7
Unit °
MPL506
Setting range 0 to 179
2-198
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
During block checking in the fine spline interpolation mode, if the spline
curve of a specific block is judged to include an inflection point and the
maximum chord error between the spline curve and the block is larger
than the value of F102, the shape of the curve will be modified to reduce
Fine spline interpolation curve error the maximum chord error below the value of F102.
(Block including the point of inflection)
F102 Original spline curve
Program type E A B
d .
F102 or less
ve
Conditions Immediate
D735S0001
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
If a block whose length is less than the value of F103 is detected during
gh
fine spline interpolation, that block will be skipped and integrated (faired)
into the preceding and succeeding blocks to create a spline curve.
ri
Suppose that the i-th block in the fine spline interpolation mode has a
ll
.A
block length of li:
If Ii – 1 is greater than F103 × 2
N
Ii is equal to or less than F103
O
TI
Ii + 1 is greater than F103 × 2
60
A
then the ending point of the “i – 1” th block and the starting point of the “i +
R
40
1” th block will be modified to the middle point of the i-th block and this
PO
block will be deleted. A spline curve will be created from the sequence of
29
Ii F103
N
Ii – 1 > F103 × 2
5-axis spline interpolation small block Ii + 1 > F103 × 2
al
length
ri
ZA
F103
Se
After-modification
IM
of relay points
Created spline curve
K
ZA
A
M
D735S0002
YA
If the length of the starting block or ending block in the fine spline
interpolation mode is smaller than the value of F103, processing will
3
01
Program type E If the distance between blocks is less than the value of F103 in the 5-axis
ht
Conditions Immediate spline interpolation mode, the 5-axis spline interpolation mode will be
ig
canceled only between these blocks. When F103 is set to 0, the value of
yr
2-199
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
During block checking in the fine spline interpolation mode, if the spline
curve of a specific block is judged to include no inflection point and the
maximum chord error between the spline curve and the block is larger
than the value of F104, the shape of the curve will be modified to reduce
the maximum chord error below the value of F104.
A B
d .
F104 or less
ve
er
D735S0003
s
re
During block checking in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode, if the
ts
maximum chord error between the spline curve and the block is larger
gh
Fine spline interpolation curve error than the value of F104, the shape of the curve will be modified to reduce
the maximum chord error below the value of F104.
ri
(Block including no inflection point)
When F104 is set to 0, if the block is judged to include an inflection point,
ll
.A
the spline curve of the block will be modified to be linear, and if it is judged
5-axis spline interpolation curve error
to include no inflection point, it will not be modified (spline interpolation is
N
F104 realized).
O
5-axis fairing command error
TI
60
A
In 5-axis fairing, if the error between the command point and the point
R
40
after fairing for the tool tip 3 axes is larger the value of F104, the point
PO
after fairing is modified to reduce the error below the value of F104.
29
When F104 is set to 0, the point after fairing will not be modified.
R
o.
O
N
C
al
ZA
(with modification)
Se
F104 or less
A
IM
K
ZA
Z
Y Point after fairing
A
M
(without modification)
X
YA
Program type E
: Paths after fairing
3
achieved by excluding the small block and then judging the total corner
yr
angle.
op
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
This parameter is valid when bit 4 of F96 is 1.
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-200
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
F108
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit °
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Set the number of common variables which can be read and written
gh
between the turrets.
ri
Example :
ll
If 10 is set in F109
Number of common variables between
.A
turrets (#100 onward) #100 to #109: Common variables that are valid for both turrets
N
#110 to #199: Common variables that are valid only for one turret
F109
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
Set the number of common variables which can be read and written
ZA
Se
Example :
Number of common variables between If 10 is set in F110
K
turrets (#500 onward) #500 to #509: Common variables that are valid for both turrets
ZA
F110 #510 to #999: Common variables that are valid only for one turret
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
F111 (bit 1) = 0:
ig
F111 (bit 1) = 1:
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-201
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
F111 (bit 2) = 0:
The feed hold function causes the threading operation to stop after the
completion of chamfering at the thread end point.
F111 (bit 2) = 1:
Use/disuse of feed hold during thread The feed hold function starts chamfering at the position where the feed
cutting hold button is pressed and stops the threading operation at the completion
F111 of chamfering.
(bit 2)
Note :
With TC82 = 0, the same operation as that for setting 0 will occur even if
Program type M, E 1 is set for F111 bit 2.
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select the direction of rotation of the C-axis during C-axial threading
gh
based on G01.1.
ri
F111 (bit 3) = 0:
The C-axis rotates CW (forward).
ll
Direction of rotation of the C-axis during
.A
F111 (bit 3) = 1:
C-axial threading with G01.1
The C-axis rotates CCW (backward).
N
F111
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Select whether the wear correction data on the TOOL DATA display is to
ZA
Se
be added during execution of the EIA/ISO program when using the tool
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
F111 (bit 6) = 0:
yr
The fixed turning cycle is executed for each block (G66 type).
op
F111 (bit 6) = 1:
Execution mode selection for a fixed turning
C
The fixed turning cycle is executed only for movement blocks (G66.1
cycle
F111 type).
(bit 6)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-202
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type E
.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Selection of printout items in measurement data printout
gh
76543210 (0: Not printout 1: Print out)
ri
ll
Selection of measurement data items to be Work No., Unit No.
.A
printed out Tool index number, work counter
N
F112 Measurement mode
O
Target data
TI
60
A Measured data
R
40
Unit —
O
N
F113 (bit 0) = 0:
ri
ZA
Se
Counting each type of use under the same tool number individually.
A
IM
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
F113 (bit 1) = 0:
ig
F113 (bit 1) = 1:
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-203
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
F113 (bit 2) = 0:
Operation will be continued.
F113 (bit 2) = 1:
Data handling on the turning tool of a group Operation will be stopped.
that has expired in tool life
F113
(bit 2)
Program type M, E
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select whether the FLASH tool that has been registered under the same
gh
tool number for the tool life management function is to be included in
spare tools.
ri
ll
F113 (bit 3) = 0:
.A
Tool life management of the FLASH tool The FLASH tool will be included in spare tools.
N
F113
O
F113 (bit 3) = 1:
(bit 3)
TI
The FLASH tool will not be included in spare tools.
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Select whether the life time on the TOOL DATA display is to be included
ZA
Se
in the life judgment items listed for the tool life management function.
A
IM
F113 (bit 4) = 0:
The life time will be included in the life judgment items.
Tool life management – Life time
K
ZA
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Select whether the maximum available wear offset data X on the TOOL
ig
DATA display is to be included in the life judgment items listed for the tool
yr
Maximum available wear offset data X The maximum available wear offset data X will be included in the life
F113 judgment items.
(bit 5) F113 (bit 5) = 1:
The maximum available wear offset data X will not be included in the life
judgment items.
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-204
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Select whether the maximum available wear offset data Y on the TOOL
DATA display is to be included in the life judgment items listed for the tool
life management function.
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select whether the maximum available wear offset data Z on the TOOL
gh
DATA display is to be included in the life judgment items listed for the tool
life management function.
ri
ll
Tool life management – F113 (bit 7) = 0:
.A
Maximum available wear offset data Z The maximum available wear offset data Z will be included in the life
N
F113 judgment items.
O
(bit 7)
TI
F113 (bit 7) = 1:
60
The maximum available wear offset data Z will not be included in the life
A
judgment items.
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Specify the maximum C-axial cutting feed rate that can be selected for the
ZA
Se
inch system.
A
IM
F114 (bit 0) = 0:
–1
Selection of the maximum C-axial cutting The maximum selectable C-axial cutting feed rate is 88 min .
K
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Select the type of operation occurring during the control of the tool tip
ig
point when command G49 is issued (when the tool length offset value is
yr
canceled).
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-205
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
F114 (bit 2) = 0:
B-axis angle check during measurement of During measurement for OUT turning tool, alarm 653 ILLEGAL TOOL
the turning tool for which OUT is specified in DESIGNATED occurs if the B-axis angle is not 90°.
“section to be machined”
F114
F114 (bit 2) = 1:
(bit 2)
The measurements for OUT turning tool are possible irrespective of the
B-axis angle.
Program type M, E
.
Turning tools for which IN or EDGE is specified in “section to be
d
ve
Conditions At power on machined” can be measured irrespective of the B-axis angle.
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Moving axes by using G49 (tool length offset cancel) in G43 (tool length
gh
offset) mode
ri
F114 (bit 3) = 0:
Moving axes by using G49 (tool length
ll
Valid
.A
offset cancel) in G43 (tool length offset)
mode F114 (bit 3) = 1:
F114
N
Invalid
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
F114 (bit 4) = 0:
A
IM
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
F114 (bit 5) = 0:
yr
F114 (bit 5) = 1:
F114 When the program ends.
(bit 5)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-206
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
F114 (bit 6) = 0:
Invalid. Initially, the G50-specified coordinate system is selected.
F114 (bit 6) = 1:
Valid. Initially, the MAZATROL coordinate system (G53.5) is selected.
Initial G53.5
F114
(bit 6)
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
F114 (bit 7) = 0:
gh
The life of the tool is judged from its machining count.
ri
F114 (bit 7) = 1:
ll
Judging tool life from the count of machined The life of the tool is not judged from its machining count.
.A
workpieces
F114
N
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Specify the X-axial feed rate for the runout of the threading cycle.
ri
ZA
Se
A quarter (1/4) of the rapid traverse (as set in parameter M1) applies when
A
Feed rate of the threading runout – X-axis In case of M1 < F116, the feed rate will be clamped with the M1 value.
K
ZA
F116
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit mm/min
)2
Specify the Y-axial feed rate for the runout of the threading cycle.
ig
A quarter (1/4) of the rapid traverse (as set in parameter M1) applies when
yr
Feed rate of the threading runout – Y-axis In case of M1 < F117, the feed rate will be clamped with the M1 value.
C
F117
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 240000
2-207
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the Z-axial feed rate for the runout of the threading cycle.
A quarter (1/4) of the rapid traverse (as set in parameter M1) applies when
this parameter is set to zero (0).
Feed rate of the threading runout – Z-axis In case of M1 < F118, the feed rate will be clamped with the M1 value.
F118
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit mm/min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 240000
ts
Specify the runout feed rate for the inside diameter threading cycle.
gh
This parameter is valid only when chamfering is not specified in the inside
ri
diameter threading unit of the MAZATROL program.
ll
Runout feed rate for the inside diameter A quarter (1/4) of the rapid traverse (as set in parameter M1) applies when
.A
threading cycle this parameter is set to zero (0).
N
F119 In case of M1 < F119, the feed rate will be clamped with the M1 value.
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit mm/min
O
N
ZA
Se
A
IM
X-axis
ZA
F120
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit mm/min
)2
Y-axis
F121
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-208
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit mm/min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Processing of work offset specified with G53.1 (tool axis direction control)
gh
for the machine whose table rotary axis is not an axis that rotates around
Processing of work offset specified with the Z-axis on the INTEGREX type (the machine specification featuring
ri
G53.1 for the machine whose table rotary both the tool rotary axis and the table rotary axis)
ll
axis is not an axis that rotates around the
.A
0: Includes a holder length.
Z-axis on the INTEGREX type (the machine
F123 1: Does not include a holder length.
N
specification featuring both the tool rotary
O
(bit 1) axis and the table rotary axis)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
shape drawing
Se
0: Not considered
IM
(bit 2)
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
Enables/disables tool change operation in the MDI mode for tools whose
ht
tool data has not been set, when bit 7 of parameter F84 is set to “1”.
ig
yr
0: Stop operation with the alarm 953 TOOL DATA INPUT PROCESS
ERROR displayed
op
1: Single block stop after completing tool change with the alarm 1107
C
MDI tool change enable/disable for tools INCOMPLETE TOOL DATA displayed
with no tool data
F123
(bit 3) Note :
1. When bit 7 of parameter F92 is set to “1”:
The above mentioned alarm will be generated if the tool
diameter is not set for the specified tool.
Program type E
2. When bit 3 of parameter F93 is set to “1”:
Conditions Immediate The above mentioned alarm will be generated if the tool
Unit — diameter, tool diameter A/B, or tool set X/Y is not set for the
Setting range 0, 1 specified tool.
2-209
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
The workpiece axis offset in association with Z-axis feed during hobbing is
executed
0: In the hobbing (G114.3) mode and only while the hobbing axis is
Execution of the workpiece axis offset in
rotating.
association with Z-axis feed in the hobbing
mode independently of hobbing axis 1: Disregarding whether the hobbing axis is rotating or not as long as the
F123 rotating status current mode is the hobbing (G114.3) mode.
(bit 5)
Program type E
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
Unit —
ser
Setting range 0, 1
re
Sets the output position of sequence numbers during EIA conversion.
ts
0: Output the sequence number after completing machining with each
gh
tool sequence/shape sequence and immediately before the first tool
ri
change command
ll
EIA conversion sequence number output 1: Output the sequence number after completing machining with each
.A
F123 tool sequence/shape sequence
N
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
The data input in the following items are checked based on the
ri
ZA
TOOL DATA:
A
TOOL OFFFSET:
ZA
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
3
01
The data input in the following items are checked based on the
ht
TOOL DATA:
yr
WEAR COMP.
F125
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-210
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
When the absolute value of the value input for the following data exceeds
the setting of this parameter, either a window prompting a check on the
input value is displayed or the input value is discarded with an alarm
generated, according to the setting of F95 bit 4.
Maximum wear offset setting with the input TOOL DATA: WEAR COMP.
error prevention function enabled
TOOL OFFFSET: WEAR COMP.
F126
[Related parameters]
F81 bit 7: Input error prevention function valid/invalid
Program type M, E
.
F95 bit 4: Wear offset check scheme with the input error prevention
d
ve
Conditions Immediate function enabled
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
Setting range 0 to 99999999
re
During rotary axis checking in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode, if the
ts
error between the line that connects the start point and the end point and
gh
the spline curve is larger than the value of F128, the shape of the curve
ri
will be modified to reduce the error below the value of F128.
ll
When F128 is set to 0, the angular spline shape will not be modified.
.A
Angle Original spline
N
curve
O
TI
60
A Time t
Modified spline
R
40
curve
PO
Modification
29
F128 or less
O
N
Start point
al
angle
ri
ZA
Se
During rotary axis checking in the 5-axis fairing mode, if the error between
K
5-axis fairing angular error the point after fairing and the command point is larger than the value of
ZA
F128 F128, the point after fairing will be modified to reduce the error below the
value of F128.
A
M
When F128 is set to 0, the point after fairing will not be modified.
YA
(without modification)
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
(with modification)
C
F128 or less
Angle
: Paths after fairing
Program type E : Paths of command points
Time
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001°
Setting range 0 to 3600000
2-211
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Vo’ = Vo × F129/100
5-axis spline interpolation corner
deceleration coefficient The assigned value is invalid if minus. If 0 is assigned, it will be regarded
as 100, or if a value greater than 2000 is assigned, it will be regarded as
F129 2000.
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit %
s
Setting range 0 to 2000
re
Arc radius clamping speed in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode is
ts
changed to the following Vc’ with respect to the theoretical value Vc.
gh
Vc’ = Vc × (F130/100)
ri
ll
5-axis spline interpolation arc-clamping
.A
The assigned value is invalid if minus.
speed coefficient
If 0 is assigned, it will be regarded as 100, or if a value greater than 500 is
N
F130 assigned, it will be regarded as 500.
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
O
N
ZA
MONITOR display
Se
progressively.
Tool-drawing accuracy on the VIRTUAL
K
F135
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0 to 9
(c
F136
MONITOR display
F136
Workpiece displayed in
F136
solid display mode
Program type M
X
Conditions Immediate
This offset function is valid for both
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in X-axial and Y-axial directions.
Setting range –99999999 to 99999999
2-212
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
er
Unit Jaws
s
Setting range 0 to 9
re
Specify the number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D
ts
MONITOR display automatically. If 0 is entered, three jaws will be
gh
displayed as standard.
ri
ll
Number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL
.A
MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for
No. 2 turning spindle
N
F138
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit Jaws
N
Setting range 0 to 9
al
K
ri
ZA
Specify the amount of C-axial angle offset for the jaws indicated on the
Se
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.1°
(c
Specify the amount of C-axial angle offset for the jaws indicated on the
ig
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1°
Setting range 0 to 3599
2-213
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 3
ts
Operation when workpiece counting is made valid while the automatic
gh
operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD (ISS) is enabled.
ri
<Manual setting on the POSITION screen>
0: Workpiece counting is activated while the ISS is disabled, and the
ll
.A
automatic operation continues.
1: Workpiece counting is not activated, the alarm 1129 MEMORY
N
PROTECT (SAFETY SHIELD) is displayed and the automatic
O
operation continues.
TI
60
stops.
C
al
Note :
K
ri
ZA
F143 bit 0 upon overwriting the part count from the program while
A
IM
overwriting the part count from the program while executing ISS
ZA
Program type M, E (automatic), regardless of the setting of F143 bit 0, and automatic
A
turned on.
)2
0: Disabled
(c
(The condition of the material model cut with the ISS enabled is not
Status of [STORE WORKPCE MATERIAL]
ht
maintained.)
when the power is turned on
ig
F143 1: Enabled
yr
(The condition of the material model cut with the ISS enabled is
(bit 1)
op
maintained.)
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-214
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Invalid
—
F143
(bit 2)
d .
Program type —
ve
Conditions —
s er
Unit —
re
Setting range —
ts
gh
Setting of the section to cancel the collision check function between the
TOOL EYE sensor and the tool with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD
ri
being selected
ll
Setting of the section to cancel the collision
.A
During manual TOOL EYE measurement
check function between the TOOL EYE
0 : Canceling the collision check function between the TOOL EYE
N
sensor and the tool with the INTELLIGENT
F143 sensor and the tool (cutter, shank)
O
SAFETY SHIELD being selected
TI
(bit 3) 1 : Canceling the collision check function between the TOOL EYE
60
Program type M, E Canceling the collision check function not only between the TOOL
R
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 0, 1
ri
ZA
Program type E
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
ig
machining
op
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-215
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Cancel or hold G43 when the RESET key is pressed in G43 (tool length
compensation) mode.
0: Cancel
Program type M, E
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Selection of table rotary axis reference position for inclined-surface
gh
machining
ri
0: Table rotary axis start position as the reference
ll
Selection of table rotary axis reference 1: Table rotary axis 0-degree position as the reference
.A
position for inclined-surface machining
N
F144
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Not reset
A
IM
1: Reset
Resetting of a tool life alarm with the alarm
K
clear button
ZA
F144
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Invalid
yr
1: Valid
op
Setting a minus value for argument Q in * If a minus value is set for argument Q in hobbing, while 0 is set for F144
C
hobbing, valid/invalid bit 3, alarm 809 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT will be caused.
F144
(bit 3)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-216
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
G49 command immediately after the macro variable command when bit 3
of parameter F114 is set to 1 (no axis movement by the G49 command)
0: No axis movement
Selection of operation by the G49 command 1: Axis movement
immediately after a macro variable
command
F144
(bit 5)
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
G92.5 block, #3090 = 1, and G10.9 block in the EIA/ISO program
gh
converted for machining centers (parameter F30 is set to 0)
ri
0: Output
ll
Deletion of unnecessary codes during 1: Do not output
.A
EIA/ISO conversion for machining centers Note :
N
F144 For G92.5 block only, the setting at bit 7 of parameter F144 is used.
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Output
IM
conversion for machining centers * Same as when bit 6 of parameter F144 is set to 1
ZA
F144
A
(bit 7)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
The rapid feed rate override is reduced to the value set here, when data
ig
alteration is detected.
yr
detected
F145
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 100
2-217
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
2: Representation by taking-off the material from the 1st spindle, with the
ve
material remaining on the 2nd spindle
er
(Cut-off part is hidden and excluded from the interference check.)
Program type M, E
s
3: Representation with the material opposite the head that operates as
re
Conditions Immediate
the master side in synchronization left and the material at the other
ts
Unit — side cut off
gh
(Cut-off part is hidden and excluded from the interference check.)
Setting range 0 to 3
ri
Reference data for the calculation of compensation amount for G41/G42
ll
given in a manual program unit
.A
F148 = 0:
N
NOSE-R setting on the TOOL OFFSET display
O
Compensation amount for G41/G42 given
TI
F148 = 1:
in a manual program (MANL PRG) unit
60
PO
29
R
o.
Program type M
N
Conditions Immediate
al
K
ri
ZA
Unit —
Se
Setting range 0, 1
A
IM
Operation between blocks in the single block signal status when single
block mode is switched from ON to OFF during automatic operation
K
ZA
When the single block signal is When the single block signal is turned
turned from ON to OFF from OFF to ON and then to OFF
A
M
ON ON OFF
YA
F149=0
3
ON OFF ON OFF
ht
ig
blocks blocks
C
ON OFF ON OFF
Program type M, E F149=2 Execution block Next block Execution block Next block
Conditions Immediate No stop No stop
between blocks between blocks
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2
2-218
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Example :
1. When F150 = 0 2. When F150 = 352
Output side Output side
Output data offset of NC basic information
Data output to
for field network NC basic information slave/adaptor
F150
.
d
ve
Data output to NC basic information
slave/adaptor
s er
re
Note :
ts
If a value set for F150 is out of the setting range or is an odd value,
gh
Program type M, E
alarm 528 FIELDNETWORK SETTING ERROR (4, , ) occurs and the
ri
Conditions Immediate communication stops. NC basic information will not be output.
ll
Unit —
.A
Setting range 0 to 352
N
Validity of registration of multiple tools if the turning function is valid when
O
registering a tool on the TOOL DATA display
TI
60
0: Valid A
R
40
multiple tools
F151
R
o.
O
N
(bit 0)
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Program type M, E
Se
Conditions Immediate
IM
Unit —
K
Setting range 0, 1
ZA
—
3
01
F151
)2
(bit 1)
(c
ht
Program type —
ig
yr
Conditions —
op
Unit —
C
Setting range —
2-219
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
.
Conditions Immediate
d
ve
Unit —
er
Setting range 0, 1
s
re
0: Invalid
ts
1: Valid
gh
ri
Rotary axis fairing for the 5-axis fairing
function
ll
.A
F151
(bit 5)
N
O
TI
Program type E
60
Conditions Immediate
A
R
40
PO
Unit —
29
Setting range 0, 1
o.
O
N
Set valid/invalid of wear offset (mill tool/touch sensor) on the TOOL DATA
C
display when the tool length offset function for turning tools (G43P1) is
al
used.
ri
ZA
Se
Valid/invalid of wear offset (mill tool/touch When the parameters are set as F111 bit 5 = 1 and F94 bit 7 = 0, tool
sensor) on the TOOL DATA display when
K
F151 0: Invalid
tools (G43P1) is used
A
1: Valid
(bit 6)
M
YA
When the parameter is set as F111 bit 5 = 1, tool wear offset on the TOOL
01
Unit —
ig
Setting range 0, 1
yr
op
C
2-220
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
.
1 Not changed Reset to 0
d
ve
Program type E
er
Conditions Immediate [Related macro variable]
s
re
Unit — #3040 : Power-on time in the ACCUMULATED TIME window (read only)
ts
Setting range 0, 1
gh
Fixed value (0)
ri
ll
.A
N
—
O
TI
F152
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type —
R
o.
Conditions —
N
Unit —
al
K
ri
Setting range —
ZA
Se
0: Invalid
1: Valid
K
ZA
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
Setting prohibited
op
C
F154
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-221
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Operation when argument I is omitted from the tap cycle command having
ts
argument Q
gh
0: Operation as a deep-hole cycle
ri
1: Operation as a high-speed deep-hole cycle
ll
Operation when argument I is omitted from
.A
the tap cycle command having argument Q
F155
N
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
OPERATION) occurs)
IM
Setup data editing during automatic GL 1: Editing enabled (only during single-block stop or feed hold stop)
K
operation, disabled/enabled
F155
ZA
(bit 5)
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
0: Milling spindle
yr
1: Turning Spindle
results of machining navigation for the
C
mill-turning unit
F155
(bit 7)
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-222
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
.
F156 bit 0
d
with material cutting with alarm message
Program type M, E
ve
1 disabled 1139 ILLEGAL
er
Conditions Immediate COMMAND (SAFETY
SHIELD) displayed
s
Unit —
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
gh
The operating status and the switching of the drawing on the 3D
MONITOR display when a cutting command associated with rotary axis
ri
movement is specified with the automatic ISS valid.
ll
The operating status and the drawing on
.A
the 3D MONITOR display when a cutting
F156 bit 1
N
command associated with rotary axis
O
movement is specified with the automatic 0 1
F156
TI
ISS valid Continue operation with material cutting enabled
60
(bit 1) A 0
only at the end position
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
o.
SHIELD) displayed
al
Unit —
K
ri
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
Se
Separation between rotary axis and linear axis when moving axes during
IM
(bit 2)
3
01
Program type E
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-223
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Pitch division in the case when the arc length exceeds the maximum value
during helical/spiral interpolation
0: Invalid
Pitch division in the case when the arc 1: Valid
length exceeds the maximum value during
helical/spiral interpolation
F156 Remark :
(bit 4) Arc length [mm] = diameter [mm] pitch [times]
Maximum arc length: 107374.1824 mm
Program type E
d.
* When this parameter is invalid, alarm 814 INTERPOLATION
ve
Conditions Immediate
OVERFLOW will occur if the arc length has exceeded the maximum
er
Unit — length.
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Set a stop at the end of execution of a tool sequence block when the VFC
ts
key is pressed with override set to 100% during automatic operation.
gh
0: Single-block stop does not occur
ri
1: Single-block stop occurs
ll
Single-block stop when the VFC key is
.A
pressed with override set to 100%
F156
N
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
A
IM
—
K
F156
ZA
(bit 6)
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions —
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
0: Invalid
ig
yr
1: Valid
op
F156
(bit 7)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-224
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
—
F157
(bit 0)
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
Setting range —
re
The tolerance (chord error) specified function is made valid or invalid.
ts
gh
0: Invalid
ri
1: Valid
ll
Geometry compensation/modal spline
.A
tolerance (chord error), valid/invalid
F157
N
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
0: Invalid
EIA tip position memory 1: Valid
K
ZA
F157
(bit 2) * This parameter is valid when parameter F30 is set to 0 and bit 3 of
A
M
Program type E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
0: Invalid
ig
1: Valid
yr
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-225
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
The direction of the set axes X/Z for the additional table of the machine
model and that of the machine axes are:
0: Opposite direction
Switching of the axis directions for the VTC 1: Same direction
machine model on the VIRTUAL
MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display
F157
(bit 4)
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Add-in EIA function
gh
0: Invalid
ri
1: Valid
ll
.A
Add-in EIA function
F157
N
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
0: Invalid
ri
ZA
Se
1: Valid
A
IM
F157
A
(bit 6)
M
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
Whether or not to update the tolerance specified value for 5-axis spline
interpolation to the value of parameter F104
ig
yr
0: Updated
op
setting
F157
(bit 7)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-226
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
0: Invalid
Tool length/tool diameter check function 1: Valid
after tool change
F158
Note :
(bit 0)
1. With F158 bit 0 = 1, if no tool data exists, the machine stops with the
alarm 193 NO TOOL IN MAGAZINE generated.
2. When F158 bit 0 = 1, if no tool data has been set with the
d .
Program type E
ve
MAZATROL tool diameter data enabled (F92 bit 7 = 1) or the
Conditions Immediate MAZATROL tool length data enabled (F93 bit 3 = 1), the machine
er
Unit — stops with the alarm 1107 INCOMPLETE TOOL DATA generated.
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Output timing of MSTB command after a movement command under
gh
geometry compensation
ri
0: Before completing axis movement
ll
Output timing of MSTB command after a
.A
1: After completing axis movement
movement command under geometry
N
compensation
F158
O
* When an MSTB command is specified in one of the consecutive cutting
TI
(bit 1) feed blocks such as G1 → G1M3, the operation will be equivalent to
60
that with F158 bit 1 = 0 and M3 will be output during movement initiated
A
R
40
by G1 before M3.
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions Immediate
o.
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 0, 1
K
ri
ZA
0: Displayed
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
turning/pinch-cutting
yr
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-227
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
When a process is selected for the head, that differs from the selected
gh
head, in the process selection window where the compound type
MAZATROL program is displayed:
ri
Output of an alarm when a process is
selected for the head differing from the 0: No alarm
ll
.A
selected head in the process selection 1: Causes alarm 1477 INCORRECT PROCESS SELECTION
window where the compound type
F158
N
MAZATROL program is displayed
O
(bit 5) * This parameter is valid only for the MULTIPLEX series.
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
0: Invalid
A
1: Valid
IM
F158
A
(bit 6)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
Select the direction in which the wear offset data of the Mazatrol tool data
is applied when both the tool length compensation and 3D coordinate
ig
coordinate conversion functions are used 1: Virtual axes (Program coordinate system)
F158 together
(bit 7)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-228
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Modal selection at power on or at reset
gh
0: G64
ri
1: G61.1
ll
Modal selection at power on or at reset
.A
(G64/G61.1)
F159
N
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Fixed value
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
—
K
ZA
F159
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions —
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
ht
Fixed value
ig
yr
op
—
C
F159
(bit 3)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-229
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
Program type M, E Note :
ve
This parameter is available only to models that allow the operator to
er
Conditions Immediate
switch between load meter ratings and are capable of displaying a
s
Unit —
re
spindle output diagram on the POSITION display.
Setting range 0, 1
ts
gh
C-axis clamping speed selection in hobbing
ri
ll
0: Clamp at the rapid feed rate (parameter M1). (Conventional operation)
.A
Workpiece spindle (C-axis) clamping speed 1: Clamp at the cutting feed rate (parameter M3).
N
selection in hobbing
O
F159
TI
(bit 5)
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type E
R
Conditions Immediate
o.
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 0, 1
ri
ZA
Reflects tool offset (tool wear offset and tool geometry offset) in the G53.5
Se
0: Reflects
Reflecting tool offset (tool wear offset/tool 1: Does not reflect
K
current position
F159
A
*1 This parameter is valid only for the models for which the G code type
M
Program type E on the TRACE and TOOL PATH CHECK displays are given
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Compare the magnitudes of the start position and end position using
ig
1: Compare the magnitudes of the start position and end position using
unsigned integers.
C
2-230
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Set how the feedrate is displayed on the POSITION screen during tool tip
point control.
0: Composite feedrate of the machine axes
1: Feedrate at the tool tip in reference to the workpiece
Feedrate display during tool tip point control
F160
(bit 1)
Program type E
. d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
F160
N
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
0: Not used
ri
ZA
Se
1: Used
A
IM
F160
A
(bit 3)
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-231
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Switching the collision check method during automatic operation with the
gh
ISS function set valid when measuring a tool by the TOOL EYE
ri
0: Conforms to the setting at parameter F143 bit 3 during the execution of
Switching the collision check method during a measuring cycle.
ll
automatic operation with the ISS function
.A
1: Collision check is made invalid during the execution of a measuring
set valid when measuring a tool by the
F160 cycle.
N
TOOL EYE
O
(bit 6) (During the execution of a measuring cycle means the movement starting
TI
from the “approach point” and ending at the “approach point after
60
measurement”.)
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Priority when erasing the tool path from the TOOL PATH CHECK display
ri
ZA
or TRACE display
Se
0: Drawing first
IM
Priority change when erasing the tool path After the tool path is erased, the geometry will be drawn correctly.
from the TOOL PATH CHECK display or However, the tool path erasing time will be longer than that in the
K
F160
1: Erasing time first
A
(bit 7)
M
The tool path erasing time will be shorter than that in the case when
the setting value is “0”. However, after the tool path is erased, the
YA
Program type M, E color of overlapping lines may change from the one before erasure.
3
Conditions At power on
01
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-232
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
d .
T-code command
ve
1: When T-code command is executed
er
Tool offset vector handling if reset function is
s
executed
re
0: Vector cleared
ts
1: Vector not cleared
gh
Shape offset handling if offset number 0 is entered
ri
— 0: Offset cleared
ll
1: Offset not cleared
.A
F161 Simplified wear offset
0: Invalid
N
O
1: Valid
TI
C/Z offset when a MAZATROL program is called
60
valid
1: C/Z offset set in the EIA program is valid
R
o.
O
N
MAZATROL program
al
ZA
valid
A
IM
F161 bit 0:
K
T command:
ZA
Conditions Immediate
For offset number non-separation
YA
Unit —
Offset number is used for both shape offset and wear offset.
Setting range Binary, eight digits
3
01
(bit 0)
C
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-233
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: The same primary rotary axis angle sign as that existing during the
start of tool tip point control is selected as the angle of the rotary axis
for implementing the tool axial vector specified during tool tip point
control.
Example :
B = positive B=0 B = positive
d .
B
ve
s er
re
C=0 C = 180
ts
1: The angle that provides a smaller amount of rotational movement of
gh
the secondary rotary axis on a singular point is selected as the angle
Type of passage of tool tip point through of the rotary axis for implementing the tool axial vector specified during
ri
singular point tool tip point control.
ll
F162 (Both positive and negative signs are available for the primary rotary
.A
(bit 1) axis.)
N
Example :
O
B = positive B=0 B = negative
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
C=0 C=0
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
Program type M, E
A
Unit —
YA
Setting range 0, 1
3
01
F162
yr
op
(bit 2)
C
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-234
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movemen
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
6 digits in T-command for turning
ts
gh
0: Invalid
ri
1: Valid
ll
.A
6 digits in T-command for turning
F162
N
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Use of the M Pro scheme as the method of selecting the Length correction
ri
ZA
axis bit
Se
0: Invalid
IM
(bit 5)
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
0: Valid
ig
yr
1: Invalid
op
Z-offset, valid/invalid
F162
(bit 6)
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-235
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Invalid
gh
1: Valid
ri
ll
.A
Bar feeder scheduling function
N
F163
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
0: Invalid
ri
ZA
Se
1: Valid
A
IM
Incorporation of wear offset data into the *1 This parameter is valid only for the models for which the G code type
current position display in EIA/ISO program
K
for machining centers (F30 = 0) is set and those equipped with the
mode, valid/invalid
ZA
Program type E
3
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
0: Invalid
ig
1: Valid
yr
op
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-236
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Invalid
gh
1: Valid
ri
ll
Barrier check on the VIRTUAL
.A
MACHINING display valid/invalid
F163
N
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
0 : Hidden
ri
ZA
Se
1 : Displayed
A
IM
displayed/hidden
ZA
F163
A
(bit 6)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
0 : Hidden
ig
1 : Displayed
yr
op
displayed/hidden
F163
(bit 7)
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-237
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Enabled
1: Disabled
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
When the layout has been saved on the PROGRAM LAYOUT display, the
gh
saved layout is retained or not if the WNo. is changed on the PROGRAM
display or the program is edited.
ri
0: Do not retain
ll
PROGRAM LAYOUT display save function
.A
selection 1: Retain
F164
N
O
(bit 2) Note :
TI
When F164 bit 2 = 1, the priority number cannot be written in the save
60
A
enabled status. The priority number cannot be written when the WNo.
R
40
Program type M on the PROGRAM display is changed in the save enabled status.
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
0: Enabled
ri
ZA
Se
1: Disabled
A
IM
Invalid tools
ZA
F164
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Enabled
ig
1: Disabled
yr
op
C
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-238
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
0: Enabled
1: Disabled
.
M
d
Program type
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Enabled
gh
1: Disabled
ri
ll
.A
Automatic tool data setting conditions
Life warning tools
N
F164
O
TI
(bit 7)
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M
R
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 0, 1
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-239
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
High-speed synchronous tapping function
0: Valid
1: Invalid
X-axis movement to minus side during polar
coordinate interpolation
0: Enabled
1: Disabled
Polar coordinate interpolation of the C-axis
d .
0: Specification in terms of radius value
ve
1: Specification in terms of diameter value
er
C-axis indexing when EIA subprogram is called
s
from MAZATROL program
re
0: Not executed
ts
1: Executed
gh
Modal or non-modal state of Q command in
ri
deep-hole drilling cycle
ll
0: Modal
.A
1: Non-modal
N
Conversion of tool set data for milling tool based on
O
— head swivel angle when G53.5 is commanded
TI
60
A 0: Disabled
F165 1: Enabled
R
40
PO
29
0: Z-offset = 0
N
1: Alarm stop
al
ZA
check
Se
0: Invalid
IM
1: Valid
Supplemental explanation of F165 Bit 4
K
ZA
This bit is used to select whether the depth of infeed per pass (address Q
command) in deep-hole drilling cycles (G83, G283, and G287 for G-code
A
0: Modal
YA
occurs.
(c
1: Non-modal
ht
Program type M If the Q setting is omitted, or if the Q value is set to 0, the workpiece is
ig
Conditions After stop of movement cut to the preset infeed depth in a single pass.
yr
Unit —
op
2-240
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
0: Possible
1: Impossible
.
M, E
d
Program type
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Cutting edge offset
gh
1: Wear offset
ri
ll
.A
Type of wear offset indicated in the milling
tool list on the TOOL DATA display
N
F166
O
TI
(bit 1)
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M, E
R
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 0, 1
ri
ZA
0: IDNo.
Se
1: Name
IM
K
DATA display
F166
A
M
(bit 2)
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
Unit —
(c
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
0: Same plane
yr
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-241
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
M, E
d
Program type
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Automatic adjustment to nominal diameter
gh
1: No automatic adjustment
ri
ll
Tool diameter auto-setting for the end mill,
.A
face mill, and ball end mill on the TOOL
N
DATA display
F166
O
TI
(bit 5)
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M, E
R
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 0, 1
ri
ZA
0: Invalid
Se
1: Valid
IM
K
ZA
(bit 7)
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
Unit —
(c
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr
op
C
2-242
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
76543210
Threading (by turning) shift angle (Q-command) unit
0: 1/1000° 1: 1°
Handling the diameter/radius of point R during the
hole-machining fixed cycle
0: Based on the settings for the X-axis
1: Fixed at the radius value
Handling the tool measured using the G137H
command
0: Regarding the tool as broken
d .
1: Not regarding the tool as broken
ve
Handling the single-process mode when operation
er
— is completed/reset
s
0: Not holding the mode
re
F167 1: Holding the mode
ts
If the arc internal correction value is greater than
gh
the arc radius
ri
0: Connecting the path linearly
ll
1: Regarding the status as an alarm
.A
Handling the X-axis command in G68.5
N
0: Radius value
O
1: Diameter value
TI
Wear correction direction in the lathe-based
60
A machine model
R
40
Program type M
R
ZA
Se
0: Perform
1: Do not perform
K
F168
M
(bit 0)
YA
3
Program type E
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
Select whether the rotational center offset is to be added to the tool length
yr
when the tool axial tool length offset command (G43.1) is issued
op
F168 (bit 2) = 0:
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-243
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Select axis for the milling tool wear correction and TOOL EYE
compensation amount for the B-axis rotational turret.
F168 (bit 3) = 0:
Axis for the milling tool wear correction and
Virtual axis
TOOL EYE compensation amount for the
B-axis rotational turret F168 (bit 3) = 1:
F168
(bit 3) Actual axis
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Convert the 3D coordinate conversion (G68/G68.5) into inclined-surface
gh
machining (G68.2 or G68.4).
ri
0: Invalid
ll
Conversion of 3D coordinate conversion 1: Valid
.A
into inclined-surface machining
F168
N
* When G68 is replaced with G68.2 (or G68.4) by setting bit 4 of
O
(bit 4) parameter F168 to 1, 5-axis machining function (inclined-surface
TI
machining, workpiece placement error correction) can be used at the
60
A
same time.
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Select whether to hold the amount of shift in spite of pressing the RESET
ri
ZA
F168 (bit 5) = 0:
IM
interruption
ZA
(bit 5)
M
The same operation as that of the M640T can be selected. This parameter
YA
is valid when F95 bit 6 = 0 (holds the amount of manual handle pulse
Program type M, E interruption, in spite of the RESET key operation/M30/M02).
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
F168 (bit 6) = 0:
op
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-244
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Rapid feed overlapping function
gh
0 : Invalid
ri
1 : Valid
ll
.A
Rapid feed overlapping function
F169
N
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
0 : Invalid
IM
F169
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
—
C
F169
(bit 3)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-245
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Calling of the program specified in the end unit upon reaching the target
ts
part count
gh
0: Not called
ri
Calling of the program specified in the end 1: Called (compatible with T PLUS/M640T/M640MT/M640MTPro)
ll
.A
unit upon reaching the target part count,
enabled/disabled
F169
N
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
A
IM
—
K
F169
ZA
(bit 7)
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions —
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
position
ig
0: Considered
yr
op
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-246
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Reflecting the tool offset changed in an EIA program in a tool path check
0: Does not reflect
1: Reflects
Tool offset changed in an EIA program in a
tool path check
F170
(bit 2)
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Continuous diameter display of the X-axis coordinates on the POSITION
ts
screen
gh
0: Invalid
ri
1: Valid
ll
.A
Continuous diameter display of the X-axis
N
coordinates on the POSITION screen Note :
F170
O
F170 bit 3 is enabled only when F82 bit 4 is set to 1. When the diameter
TI
(bit 3) display is enabled, the coordinates are displayed as diameter values
60
A
even in the milling mode.
R
40
PO
29
F82 (bit 4) 0 1
R
O
N
Conditions Immediate
C
Unit —
K
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
Se
Operation when address P is omitted in 1: All axes in the specified systems (same operation as when P1
G297/G298 command specified)
A
F241 specified)
YA
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit —
ht
During the tool center point control (G43.4, G43.5), the feedrate used for
yr
at the machine end point to that at the tool tip point if the travel ratio
C
between the tool tip point and machine end point (travel at the machine
Threshold for the travel ratio between the
end point/travel at the tool tip point) exceeds the value set for F242.
tool tip point and machine end point for time
study When 0 is set, 5 is assumed.
F242 When a value beyond 20 is set, 20 is assumed.
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 20
2-247
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Sets the corner rounding offset used in the cutting point command mode.
* This parameter is enabled when F92 bit 7 = 0 and F94 bit 7 = 0.
F268
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate F92 (bit 7)
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in F94 (bit 7)
s
Setting range 0 to 99999999
re
Fixed value
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
F269
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
Set the setting width used when the Smooth corner control function is
ri
ZA
valid.
Se
The value set at this parameter is used when the R command is not
IM
Setting width
ZA
* When the set value is modified, the new value is made valid when
F270 G61.1 or G61.2 is executed after the modification.
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Set the arc cutting clamp speed coefficient used when the Smooth corner
ht
F271
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 500
2-248
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Sets the arc cutting clamp speed coefficient used when both the smooth
corner control function and the high-speed smooth control function are
enabled.
Smooth corner control function:
Arc cutting clamp speed coefficient for
high-speed smooth control
F272
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate F9
er
Unit %
s
Setting range 0 to 500
re
Set the Smooth corner control function cancellation angle.
ts
gh
Corner deceleration is not performed at a point where two blocks are
joined at an angle smaller than the angle obtained by the following math
ri
calculation.
ll
Smooth corner control function:
.A
Cancellation angle
Cancellation angle = F273 Number of feed axes/2
N
F273
O
TI
* If “0” is set, default operation applies.
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit °
O
N
Setting range 0 to 90
al
Sets the ratio of the cutting feedrate in the tool axial direction with respect
ri
ZA
Cutting feedrate override rate in the tool Cutting feedrate in the tool axial direction F’ = F F274/100
axial direction for the EIA/ISO engraving When 0 is set, 100 is assumed.
K
function
ZA
Program type E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit %
)2
Sets the character depth used during execution of the EIA/ISO engraving
ht
function
F275
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-249
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Sets the character height used during execution of the EIA/ISO engraving
function if specification of the height (address H) is omitted in the program.
Character height for the EIA/ISO engraving When a value smaller than 0 is set, 0 is assumed.
function When 0 is set, the alarm 1914 TEXT HEIGHT INVALID OF ENGRAV.
occurs.
F276
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
Setting range 0 to 99999999
re
Sets the retract height used during execution of the EIA/ISO engraving
ts
function if specification of the retraction height (address R) is omitted in
gh
the program.
ri
When a value smaller than 0 is set, 0 is assumed.
ll
Retraction height for the EIA/ISO engraving
.A
function
N
F277
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
ZA
A
IM
Cutting accuracy
ZA
F300
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit 0.0001 mm
)2
Set the tool path accuracy to be taken into consideration for the collision
ht
processing
F301
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range 1000 to 20000
2-250
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Set the allowance when stopping axis feed above the previously reached
depth for the execution of a deep-hole boring cycle or a cycle shown
below.
G85/G285, G89/G289, G75, G76, G78, G79, G86, G88, G89
.
G01
d
ve
Program type M, E F302
s er
Conditions Immediate
re
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
ts
Setting range 0 to 99999
gh
Sets the feed rate per minute for G01 re-entry for a deep-hole boring cycle
ri
or for G85/G285, G89/G289, G75, G76, G78, G79, G86, G88 and G89.
ll
.A
N
G01 feed-in speed for deep-hole boring Note :
O
cycle If “0” or a value outside the setting range is set, re-entry is executed at
TI
the machining feed rate.
60
F303 A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M, E
o.
O
N
Conditions Immediate
C
al
ZA
Sets the wait time when an alarm is detected during restarting search
IM
alarm is canceled within the set wait time or stopped with alarm 2120
ZA
Alarm wait time during [CUT] restarting RESTART PT SEARCH INTERRUPTED generated if it is not canceled
search during VIRTUAL MACHINING
A
F304
YA
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit ms
ht
2-251
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
automatic ISS
ve
2: Rounding process for rotary axes enabled in interference check during
er
automatic ISS and in virtual machining
s
re
Automatic operation intelligent safety shield
ts
(ISS)/virtual machining interference check Example :
gh
selection Change in machining shape due to rounding process with respect to the
ri
F326 ZC plane
ll
.A
Before applying the After applying the
rounding process rounding process
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Note :
Se
Program type M, E Applying the rounding process to two or more axes including a rotary
IM
axis may change the cutting shape and cause interference. Therefore,
Conditions Immediate restrict the use of this parameter to machining in which no interference
K
Setting range 0 to 2
A
Note :
Real time tuning II Number of buffers for
3
F328
(c
ht
ig
Program type M, E
yr
op
Conditions Immediate
C
Unit —
Setting range 1-5
2-252
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Function to select the mating tool when setting the tool length
gh
automatically for a FLASH tool on the TOOL DATA display.
0: Invalid
ri
ll
Mating tool selection function for automatic 1: Valid
.A
tool length setting of FLASH tool
F329
N
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
0: Output automatically
IM
F329
ZA
(bit 3)
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
Select the operation of the axes for which no movement is specified in the
ht
program when returning the axes to the restarting position for the smooth
ig
restart function.
yr
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-253
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Switches the hobbing mode between standard hobbing and hobbing II.
0: Hobbing
1: Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing)
Hobbing selection
F330
(bit 0)
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Selects the clamping speed of the hobbing axis (V-axis) in hobbing II.
ts
gh
0: Clamping at the rapid feed rate (parameter M1)
ri
1: Clamp at the cutting feed rate (parameter M3).
Hobbing axis (V-axis) clamping speed
ll
.A
selection in hobbing II (position controlled
hobbing)
F330
N
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
0: Not displayed
IM
(bit 2)
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
Counting of use count and time of use for multiple tools with the same tool
ht
0: Invalid
yr
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-254
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
Command unit setting of Q command for G32 (thread cutting) for the
G-code series for machining centers (parameter F30 = 0)
Program type E
.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Shape sequence specification at restart in a MAZATROL program
ts
gh
0: Invalid
ri
1: Valid
ll
Shape sequence specification at restart in
.A
a MAZATROL program The shape sequence can be specified only for point machining units or
F331
N
the C-axis point machining unit.
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
F335
ZA
(bit 0)
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
F335
(bit 1)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-255
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type E
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
Unit —
er
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Action to take when the part count is set using the program (#3901,
ts
#3902) during automatic operation with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
gh
SHIELD (ISS) enabled for automatic operation
ri
Action to take when the part count is set
0: Follow the setting of parameter F143 bit 0 (operation upon overwriting
using the program with the INTELLIGENT
ll
the part count during automatic operation with IIS enabled).
.A
SAFETY SHIELD enabled for automatic
F335 operation 1: Set the part count and continue automatic operation with ISS enabled.
N
(bit 7)
O
TI
60
Program type E
A
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
[Related parameters]
Unit —
R
o.
F143bit0
O
Setting range 0, 1
N
C
al
Control mode for rapid feed in the cutting point command mode
K
ri
ZA
F336
ZA
(bit 0)
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
Cutting point specification when the tool is set in a singular posture in the
ht
Cutting point selection in a singular posture 1: The cutting point is made the point on the face that is closest to the
op
F336
(bit 1)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-256
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Variable acceleration control
ts
gh
0 : Invalid
ri
1 : Valid
ll
.A
Variable acceleration control
F336
N
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Super-high-speed machining
ri
ZA
Se
0 : Invalid
A
1 : Valid
IM
Super-high-speed machining
K
function is valid.
(bit 7)
A
* When the set value is modified, the new value is made valid when
M
Program type E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-257
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
I1
d
ve
ser
re
Final setting position MPL091
Program type M, E
ts
Note :
gh
Conditions After stop of movement
For the axes which operate in submicrons in the case of submicron
ri
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Unit machine specifications, the setting unit of this parameter is reduced to
(0.0001°)
ll
1/10 times.
.A
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
N
The parameter used to define the machine working zone in order to
O
prevent machine interference with the workpiece or jigs. Set the
TI
coordinate values of the machine coordinate system.
60
Example :
A
R
40
PO
+Y Machine
R
coordinate system
o.
I2 M8
N
(Y-axis) +X
al
I3 (X-axis)
K
ri
ZA
Se
Program type M, E
A
M9
Conditions After stop of movement
IM
(Y-axis)
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in I2 (X-axis)
Unit
K
(0.0001°)
ZA
M9 (X-axis) M8 (X-axis)
YA
If the machine is likely to overstep its working zone, an alarm will occur
(c
Note :
ig
Program type M, E
2. These parameters are invalid if I2 = I3.
op
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in machine specifications, the setting unit of this parameter is reduced
Unit
(0.0001°) to 1/10 times.
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
2-258
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT
Override
(%)
Program type M, E I5
0
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
I9 I7 I8 Axis position
Unit %
er
I10
s
Setting range 0 to 100
re
Note :
ts
1. When I7 = 0, the G0 speed variable control function is invalid.
gh
2. When I8 = 0, the variable control area width (upper limit side and
ri
lower limit side) is determined by parameter I7.
ll
.A
Function for making the G0 speed variable Override
N
Variable control area (lower limit side) (%)
O
TI
I7
60
100
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M, E 50
o.
O
N
Conditions Immediate I5
C
0
al
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
K
(0.0001°) I9 I7 I8
ZA
Se
Note :
1. When I7 = 0, the G0 speed variable control function is invalid.
K
ZA
2. When I8 = 0, the variable control area width (upper limit side and
lower limit side) is determined by parameter I7.
A
M
I8
01
)2
100
(c
ht
Program type M, E 50
ig
Conditions Immediate I5
yr
0
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
op
Override
2-259
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Override
(%)
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
I9 I7 I8 Axis position
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
er
I10
Setting range 0 to 99999999
s
re
Override
ts
gh
(%)
ri
Function for making the G0 speed variable
ll
Variable control area upper limit
.A
100
I10
N
O
50
TI
60
Program type M, E I5
A
0
R
40
Conditions Immediate
PO
I9 I7 I8 Axis position
29
I10
o.
Set the rotary center of a workpiece at a table angle of 0° for each axis in
al
the machine coordinate system. (Valid only with dynamic offset function
ri
ZA
I11
K
ZA
Note :
A
Program type E
M
interruption
op
I12
C
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-260
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT
Program type M, E
d.
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Manual zero-point return operation
gh
0: Memory-type zero-point return (After power-on, however,
ri
watchdog-type zero-point return)
ll
1: Watchdog-type zero-point return
.A
Manual zero-point return operation
N
I13
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
—
O
Unit
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Not displayed
A
IM
1: Displayed
I13
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Not removed
yr
1: Removed
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-261
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
Mirror image with respect to the machine
zero-point
0: Invalid
1: Valid
User software limits (I2, I3)
— 0: Valid
1: Invalid
I14
Tool-tip relief after spindle orientation during
d .
execution of G75, G76, G86 or point-machining
ve
(boring or back-boring)
er
0: Required
s
1: Not required
re
Program type M, E Direction of the relief mentioned above
ts
0: Plus
gh
Conditions After stop of movement 1: Minus
ri
Unit —
ll
Setting range Binary, eight digits
.A
Enter the error between the zero point of the actual workpiece and the
N
FRM zero point that has been automatically calculated as a result of the
O
workpiece transfer unit (with work hand angle of 0°).
TI
60
X A X
Automatically calculated workpiece position
R
40
I17
R
o.
O
N
C
al
I17 (X)
ri
ZA
Program type M, E
Se
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)
K
Enter the error between the zero point of the actual workpiece and the
A
FRM zero point that has been automatically calculated as a result of the
M
I18
)2
(c
I18 (X)
ht
Program type M, E
ig
Setting range –32768 to 32767 (Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)
2-262
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT
Enter the error between the zero point of the actual workpiece and the
FRM zero point that has been automatically calculated as a result of the
workpiece transfer unit (with work hand angle of 90°).
X Automatically calculated workpiece position X
Amount of work hand rotational error Z Actual workpiece position Y
correction (Work hand angle: 90°)
d .
Program type M, E I19 (Z)
ve
I19 (Y)
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
re
(Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)
Setting range –32768 to 32767
ts
Specify the position of the fixed point which is used when 9 is specified in
gh
parameter SU10 or that [USER 1 (I21)] is specified in “Change position” of
ri
the manual program unit.
ll
.A
Fixed point 1 specified by the user
N
O
I21
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M
29
Conditions Immediate
o.
O
N
ZA
Specify the position of the fixed point which is used when 9 is specified in
Se
I22
M
YA
3
Program type M
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
2-263
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Axis setting for selecting the plane used in circular interpolation, cutter
radius compensation, tool nose radius compensation, cylindrical
interpolation and polar coordinate interpolation.
Base axis Parallel axis 1 Parallel axis 2
Axis setting I for plane selection
I SU1 SU2 SU3
SU1 J SU4 SU5 SU6
K SU7 SU8 SU9
d .
Enter the ASCII code for the axis name as a decimal number for the
ve
Program type M, E parameters.
er
Conditions After stop of movement (Example: 88 for the X-axis)
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 0 to 255 When a plane selection command (G17, G18, G19) is specified, the
gh
horizontal and vertical axes are determined according to the axis address
specified in the same block as the plane selection command.
ri
When there are multiple axis addresses that can be candidates for the
ll
.A
horizontal and vertical axes of the plane, the axes are selected in this
order of priority: “base axis > parallel axis 1 > parallel axis 2”. If there are
N
Axis setting I for plane selection
no axis addresses that can be candidates for the horizontal and vertical
O
axes specified in the same block as the plane selection command, the
TI
SU2
base axes are selected.
60
A
R
40
PO
The G17 plane takes I in the above table as the horizontal axis and J as
29
Program type M, E
the vertical axis.
R
The G18 plane takes K in the above table as the horizontal axis and I as
N
Unit —
C
Setting range 0 to 255 The G19 plane takes J in the above table as the horizontal axis and K as
ri
ZA
A
IM
K
SU3
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
SU4
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 255
2-264
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
SU5
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
For details, refer to the explanation of parameters SU1 to SU3.
gh
ri
ll
.A
Axis setting J for plane selection
N
SU6
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
ZA
Se
A
IM
SU7
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Unit —
)2
SU8
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 255
2-265
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
SU9
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-266
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Selection of tool change command output Specify tool change command output position from [0] through [10] below.
position
M5 Z-axis
[6] [1] [3] I21/I22 Z-axis Zc : Stock material edge projection length
Dmax : Stock material maximum outside
diameter
x : Tool turning clearance (X-axis) SU50
M5 X-axis
Machine zero point + B-axis spindle edge offset value
[4] BA62
+ Spindle tool length
z : Tool turning clearance (Z-axis) SU51
d .
Fixed point
ve
[5] [0] [2]
er
I21/I22 X-axis
s
[9/10]
re
x
ts
[7] [8]
gh
User-specified
ri
Dmax fixed point 1/2
ll
.A
Setting X-axis Z-axis
N
Zc z 0 Clearance position Clearance position
O
1 Machine zero point Clearance position
TI
60
PO
Note :
K
As shown here, if the longest tool comes into the hatched portion,
M
determined by SU51.
3
01
)2
SU51
(c
ht
ig
Stock material
Stock material edge protrusion
yr
length length
op
Program type M
C
Conditions Immediate 2. The turret type of turret conducts tool turning at the tool change
Unit — command output position. The ATC type of turret moves from the
tool change command output position to the ATC position.
Setting range 0 to 10
2-267
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Selection of tool change command output Specify tool change command output position from [0] through [11] below.
position
.
[2]
d
[5] [0] X-axis
ve
User-specified
[9/10]
er
fixed point 1/2
2nd zero point
s
x
re
[7] [8]
ts
Setting X-axis Z-axis
gh
0 Clearance position Clearance position
Dmax
1 Machine zero point Clearance position
ri
2 Clearance position Machine zero point
ll
3 Machine zero point Machine zero point
.A
Zc z
4 2nd zero point 2nd zero point
3rd zero point
N
End point of previous
5 Clearance position
O
machining
TI
INTEGREX e-V M6 End point of previous
6 Machine zero point
60
X-axis A machining
I21/I22
R
End point of previous
40
M5 zero point
29
I21/I22 9
M5 point 1 point 1
C
Z-axis [4]
Z-axis
al
10
[9/10] point 2 point 2
ri
ZA
z
ZA
[11] Note :
A
SU51
Program type M
Stock material
Stock material
Conditions Immediate length
edge protrusion
length
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 11
2-268
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
d .
ve
1: The Y-axis, Z-axis and X-axis move in order.
Program type M
er
<Supplementary description>
s
Conditions Immediate This parameter is valid only when “workpiece scheme” is selected in the
re
Unit — common unit. If “initial-point scheme” is selected, three axes move
ts
simultaneously, irrespective of setting of this parameter.
Setting range 0, 1
gh
ri
Select the rotating position specified in the index unit after tool change.
ll
0: After the tool change, rotation occurs at the position specified in the
.A
index unit. For the movement from the completing position of the
tool change to the rotating position of the index unit, three axes (X,
N
Rotating position specified in the index unit Y, Z) move at the same time.
O
after tool change
TI
1: After the tool change, rotation occurs at the position specified in the
60
SU12 index unit. For the movement from the completing position of the
A
R
40
tool change to the rotating position of the index unit, the X-axis and
PO
movement.
R
Program type M
o.
Conditions Immediate
C
Unit —
ri
ZA
Setting range 0, 1, 2
Se
SU13
YA
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
Unit —
ht
Set the display color for the tool nose marks in each system indicated on
op
0: Red (default)
1: Green
Tool nose mark display color on the TOOL 2: Blue
PATH CHECK display/TRACE display 3: Yellow
SU14 4: Pink
5: Cyan
6: White
Program type M, E
* Invalid when the 3D mode is valid.
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 6
2-269
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the name of the axis used as the thrust axis for the servo axis.
SU15
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
0: The tool moves to the approach position set in the machining program,
gh
without moving to the indexed swivel position.
ri
1: The tool moves to the index swivel position and after C-axis indexing, it
moves to the approach position.
ll
Movement to C-axis index swivel position
.A
when Z-offset scheme is used
N
SU16
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Green (default)
A
1: Red
IM
2: Green
3: Blue
K
SU17 5: Pink
A
6: Cyan
M
7: White
YA
8: Black
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 8
ht
0: Black (default)
yr
1: Red
op
2: Green
C
2-270
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
SU19 = 0:
Three axes (X, Y, Z) are simultaneously moved to the tool change
command output position specified in SU10 and TC62 or to the position
designated at RETURN of the end unit.
* When the tool nose is present at a position internal to the position of
(workpiece diameter + safety profile clearance), the axes pass through
the clearance point.
SU19 = 1:
Following the X-axis, the Y- and Z-axes are simultaneously moved to the
tool change command output position specified in SU10 and TC62 or to
.
the position designated at RETURN of the end unit.
d
Selecting the method of axis movement to
ve
the tool change command output position or * When the tool nose is present at a position internal to the position of
er
to the position designated at RETURN of (workpiece diameter + safety profile clearance), only the X-axis passes
s
the end unit through the clearance point. The Z-axis does not pass.
SU19
re
Note :
ts
This parameter is valid only when the program is of the workpiece
gh
scheme (WPC setting) or the Z-offset scheme.
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
SU20
Coefficient for polygonal machining spindle Spindle acceleration × 100
K
acceleration
Note :
ZA
SU20 This value will be handled as100 if a negative value, 0 or a value more
A
<Supplementary description>
Program type E If during polygonal machining alarm 43 SPINDLE MALFUNCTION 2
3
(52, , ) occurs for the milling spindle, set a value less than 100 in this
Conditions Immediate
01
(acceleration is decreased).
Setting range 0 to 100
(c
ht
Specify the axis to be returned home after the execution of the workpiece
transfer unit corresponding to the work hand angle to be changed, and the
ig
returning sequence.
yr
corresponding to the work hand angle to be 1: XYZ axes simultaneous homing B-axis homing
changed 2: X-axis homing YZ axes simultaneous homing B-axis homing
SU21
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2
2-271
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
(parameter BA48 0)
ve
Select the sequence of movement from the initial point and the escape
er
TPC relay point to the head rotating position in the indexing unit. If the
s
workpiece scheme is selected for the program type, select the
re
movement sequence from the machining end position and the escape
ts
TPC relay point to the head rotating position in the indexing unit. (The
gh
sequence of movement from the tool change completing position to
the head rotating position in the indexing unit is specified in parameter
ri
SU12.)
ll
.A
When the machine is not equipped with a spindle head of swiveling
type (parameter BA48 = 0, L21 = 0, 1, 2)
N
Method of axis movement from the initial Select the sequence of movement from the initial point, the escape
O
point or the escape TPC relay point to the TPC relay point and the tool change completing position to the rotating
TI
rotating position in the indexing unit
60
PO
29
SU22=1
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
SU22=0
Se
Z Workpiece
ZA
Y
A
M
SU22=1
YA
X
3
01
)2
TPC relay
point SU22=0
(c
Conditions Immediate
yr
Workpiece
Unit —
op
Setting range 0 to 2
C
2-272
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Initial-point scheme
SU22 = 1
Head rotating
SU22 = 2 position in the
indexing unit
.
Z
d
ve
Workpiece
Y
s er
re
SU22 = 1
X
ts
gh
SU22 = 0
ri
ll
TPC relay point
.A
SU22 = 2
Head rotating
position in the
N
indexing unit
O
Method of axis movement from the initial Workpiece
TI
point or the escape TPC relay point to the
60
SU22
PO
29
Material scheme
R
o.
Head rotating
O
N
position in the
C
indexing unit
al
ZA
position
Se
SU22 = 0
IM
K
ZA
SU22 = 1
Head rotating
A
position in the
M
indexing unit
YA
SU22 = 2
3
SU22 = 1
(c
ht
X
ig
Program type M
yr
Conditions Immediate
op
Y Z
C
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2
2-273
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the feed rate reduction rate for in-feed paths for the execution of a
composite-type fixed cycle.
The setting “0” is regarded as a setting of 100%.
SU23
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99
ts
Set the spindle speed multiplication factor for the execution of a
gh
composite-type fixed cycle.
ri
ll
Spindle speed multiplication factor in the The setting “0” is regarded as a setting of 100%.
.A
execution of a composite-type fixed cycle
N
SU24
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
K
ri
A
IM
This parameter specifies the chopping axis when no chopping axis is set
by the system variable for the chopping start M-code command.
K
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Set the name of an axis (linear axis) on a plane used during polar
ig
SU29
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range &0 to &7F
2-274
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Set the name of an axis (rotary axis) on a plane used during polar
coordinate interpolation by ASCII code (hexadecimal).
SU30
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range &0 to &7F
ts
Sets the axis movement pattern when returning to the return position set in
gh
the end unit during the execution of an initial-point scheme program on a
multi-tasking machine, except for VTC machines, whose turret type is ATC
ri
(BA47 = 0) and whose rotating head axis name is set (BA48).
ll
.A
Axis movement pattern to the return 0 : After X-axis movement, the Y-axis and the Z-axis move at the same
position set in the end unit of initial-point time.
N
scheme program for multi-tasking machine
O
1 : After Z-axis movement, the X-axis and the Y-axis move at the same
SU31
TI
time.
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M
o.
[Related parameters]
O
N
Conditions Immediate
C
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
Se
SU49
YA
3
01
Program type M
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit 0.001 s
ht
2-275
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0
.
Program type M
d
Dmax
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535 NM211-00220
ts
gh
Dmax: Stock material maximum outside diameter
ri
0: Stock material edge projection length
ll
.A
Tool turning clearance in Z-axis
N
SU51
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Set the tool to be retracted to the fixed position for the automatic
ri
ZA
Se
lower-turret retraction function. Specify the tool number of the lower turret.
A
SU52
A
SU53
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
2-276
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Sets the allowable limit of axis movement completion waiting time when a
cross machining command is executed
Alarm 159 CROSS MACHINING IMPOSSIBLE (0x0400) occurs if axis
movement does not complete within the set allowable limit.
F Command
FB
.
machining command is executed
d
t
ve
SU54 SU54
ser
re
* The length of time required to end outputting droop when a moving axis
ts
stops.
gh
ri
Note :
ll
.A
1. Execution of a cross-control command, if specified during axis
Program type M, E movement, does not start until axis movement is completed.
N
Conditions Immediate 2. If 0 is set, the waiting time is infinite.
O
TI
Unit s 3. If a value larger than 999 is set, it is regarded as 999.
60
Sets the wait time for the response to a request to access the programs in
PO
29
the hard disk operation area and Ethernet operation area in automatic
R
operation
o.
O
N
hard disk operation area/Ethernet operation response is received within the set time after requesting for
A
area an access
IM
SU55
K
Note :
ZA
Program type E response, set a value of 10 or larger when changing the setting of
Conditions Immediate this parameter. If a value less than 10 is set, the alarm 1835 FILE
3
—
C
SU56
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-277
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the position where the turret is to be retracted for the turret retraction
function. Specify coordinates in the machine coordinate system based on
the machine zero point.
Fixed point 2
Fixed point 1
SU100
.
SU99
d
SU98
SU97
ve
Lower-turret retraction function
er
SU97 Fixed point of the retraction position Machine zero point
s
to
re
SU100
ts
SU97: X-axis retraction point – Fixed point 1
gh
SU98: Z-axis retraction point – Fixed point 1
SU99: X-axis retraction point – Fixed point 2
ri
SU100: Z-axis retraction point – Fixed point 2
ll
.A
Specify a minus value if the fixed point of the retraction position is located
in a minus direction when viewed from the zero point of the machine
N
coordinates.
O
TI
60
Note : Set this parameter for the system of the lower turret.
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-278
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Example :
1. Standard type cutting
Prior to cutting up along the wall in the end of final cycle, escape will
be made by specified distance.
SU102
d .
ve
Return distance at walls during rough
cutting in bar machining or in corner
er
machining of an EIA/ISO program SU102
s
re
SU102
2. High speed rough cutting
ts
Escape will be made by SU102 specified distance during return after
gh
reaching the wall.
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A SU102
R
40
PO
Program type E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
SU102
o.
K
ri
ZA
If a cutting depth has not been specified in the program, operation will
Se
SU103
SU103
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Tool
Pecking return distance in grooving
C
Program type E
Conditions Immediate NM211-00248
2-279
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.d
NM211-00247
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
* For MAZATROL programs refer to TC78.
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
Clamping will follow the setting of SU106 if the calculated value of the cut
gh
depth with the composite type thread cutting cycle G276 is smaller than
the setting of SU106. This parameter is valid only for the infeed operation
ri
of the fixed volume chip production scheme.
Minimum cut depth clamping value (radial
ll
.A
value) in composite-type thread cutting
cycle G276 of EIA/ISO program * For MAZATROL programs refer to TC79.
N
SU106
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Set the spindle safety clamp speed of a tool whose diameter (nominal
ri
ZA
diameter) is not specified in the tool data. This clamp speed is invalid for
Se
the tools with tool diameter (or nominal diameter, if diameter cannot be
IM
SU107
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
–1
Unit min
)2
3
60 × 10 2E –1
Safeguarding strength N= m (min )
C
D
Tool diameter D (mm):
SU108
ACT- in MAZATROL tool data
(For a tool whose tool diameter cannot be registered in tool data:
Nominal diameter)
Program type M Safeguarding strength E (J): Parameter SU108
Conditions Immediate Tip mass m (kg): Parameter SU109/1000
Unit J
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-280
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Set the tip mass used to calculate the spindle safety clamp speed.
Tip mass
SU109
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit g
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Set the desired data range.
gh
Note :
ri
Although entered data is checked for the range that has been set in
ll
SU110 - SU113, the check is conducted only when the “Tool length
.A
setting range check function” is valid (SU154 bit 1 = 1).
N
Example of setting (SU111 = 0):
O
TI
60
PO
to
al
ZA
Se
SU110
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Lower turret width setting for barrier expansion by the difference in X-axis
angle between the upper and lower turrets
ig
yr
op
X1
XY plane
C
Lower turret
width SU122
Program type M
Conditions Immediate X2
Expansion
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in Lower turret in the barrier
2-281
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
Program type M
ve
er
Conditions Immediate
s
Unit 0.0001°
re
Setting range 0 to 1799999
ts
gh
Set the limit for the amount of motion on the secondary rotational axis for
workpiece placement error correction.
ri
ll
.A
Admissible motion range on the secondary Note :
rotational axis for workpiece placement
N
Set zero (0) in SU124 if no restriction is to be imposed on the range of
error correction
O
correcting motion on the secondary rotational axis for workpiece
SU124
TI
placement error correction.
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M
29
Conditions Immediate
o.
O
N
Unit 0.0001°
C
al
ZA
Fixed value
Se
A
IM
K
—
ZA
SU125
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
BA61
C
SU126
* Set a minus value to perform offset in the same direction as BA61 when
the B-axis rotational center position is located above the tool center
position as shown in the figure.
Program type M, E
* Runout of B-axis center = BA61 + SU126
Conditions Immediate * This parameter can be altered by using system variable #6020.
Unit 0.001 mm * This parameter is valid on the machines with the capability of
Setting range –1000 to 1000 Maza-Check.
2-282
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
SU127 BA62
.
d
Fig. 1 When offsetting in the same direction as BA62
ve
(a plus value is set at SU127)
er
Amount of offset for B-axis - spindle nose
s
re
distance offset (BA62)
ts
SU127 B-axis - spindle
gh
nose distance
ri
offset
ll
.A
SU127
N
O
BA62
TI
Fig. 2 When offsetting in the opposite direction as BA62
60
PO
29
* Set a minus value to perform offset in the opposite direction to the B-axis
R
o.
Program type M, E
C
Conditions Immediate * This parameter can be altered by using system variable #6021.
ri
ZA
Se
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in * This parameter is valid on the machines with the capability of
A
Maza-Check.
Setting range –10000 to 10000
IM
Set the X- and Z-axis retraction positions of the upper and lower turret in
K
and lower turrets are placed in a queue in this position after the
two-workpiece machining sequence.
A
M
YA
SU129 (#1)
3
SU129
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-283
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the reference point, top dead point, bottom dead point, and feed rate
for chopping.
These parameters (SU130 to SU133) specify the chopping conditions
when no conditions are set by the system variables for the chopping start
Chopping reference point M-code command.
SU130
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
Rapid feed
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in Start
s
Reference point
re
Setting range ±99999999 SU130
ts
gh
Top dead point
SU132
ri
Chopping speed
ll
(SU133)
Bottom dead point
.A
Chopping top dead point
SU131
N
O
SU131
TI
Workpiece zero point
60
A
R
40
SU130:
PO
Program type E
29
Conditions Immediate Set the chopping reference point by specifying an incremental value from
R
o.
SU131:
al
Set the chopping top dead point by specifying an absolute value in the
ri
ZA
SU132:
A
IM
Set the speed of moving between the top dead point and the bottom dead
SU132
A
Conditions Immediate
)2
Chopping speed
SU133
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 1 mm/min / 0.1 in/min
Setting range 0 to 200000
2-284
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
The chopping axis feed rate is clamped with this parameter during
chopping.
When this parameter is set to 0, the feed rate will be clamped according to
Chopping clamp speed parameter M3.
SU134
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit 1 mm/min / 0.1 in/min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 200000
ts
Set the acceleration/deceleration time constant during chopping.
gh
ri
When this parameter is set to 0, parameter N2 becomes valid.
ll
.A
Acceleration/deceleration time constant
during chopping
N
O
SU135
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit ms
N
C
al
ZA
SU136
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
Chopping tolerance
SU137
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-285
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
turning milling
d
ve
Program type E If 0 is set in BA59, 3 will be regarded as having been set, and M03 will
er
Conditions After stop of movement be output.
s
If 0 is set in BA60, 4 will be regarded as having been set, and M04 will
re
Unit —
be output.
ts
Setting range 0, 1
gh
Display of BUFFER/REMAIN/POSITION on the POSITION display
ri
0: Display in the machine axial direction
ll
1: Display in the axial direction in the coordinates system that has been
.A
converted by the inclination of the B-axis
N
O
TI
Actual axis X
60
A Virtual axis Z
R
40
Virtual axis X
PO
display
R
o.
SU153 display
al
ZA
(bit 3)
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr
op
C
2-286
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
d .
Automatic retraction of the lower turret for SU153 bit 4 = 1: Retraction
ve
MAZATROL programs Movement to the position of automatic
er
SU153 Without retraction retraction as below.
s
commands
re
(bit 4) MULTIPLEX: X/Z = 2nd zero point
(M5)
ts
Others: X/Y/Z = Machine zero point
gh
(M4)
ri
ll
Note : Set this parameter for the system of the lower turret.
.A
N
O
TI
60
Program type M A
R
40
Conditions Immediate
PO
29
Unit —
R
o.
Setting range 0, 1
N
ZA
Se
CYLIND mode)
ZA
(bit 5)
A
M
YA
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
0: Output of M210
ig
1: No output of M210
yr
clamped (M210)
C
SU153
(bit 6)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-287
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Do not display
gh
1: Display
ri
ll
.A
Displaying tool-setting values for ATC-type
turret
N
SU154
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
0 : Invalid
Se
1 : Valid
A
IM
K
SU154
A
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Actual axis
ig
1: Virtual axis
yr
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-288
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
0: Actual axis
1: Virtual axis
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Actual axis
gh
1: Virtual axis
ri
ll
.A
Displaying the “current position” during
execution of G18.2/G18.3/G18.4
N
SU154
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
0: Actual axis
Se
1: Virtual axis
A
IM
SU154
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Actual axis
ig
1: Virtual axis
yr
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-289
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Actual axis
1: Virtual axis
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Fixed value (1)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
SU155
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
Select the timing in which the tool length of the touch sensor is to be made
ZA
Se
Correction timing of the touch sensor tool F93 bit 3 = 1 (using MAZATROL tool length)
length during EIA/ISO programmed or MDI
K
SU155 (for machining center specifications only) 0: When a move command is executed for any controlled axis (X, Y, Z, or
rotational axis)
A
(bit 1)
M
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Executed
op
MAZATROL program
SU155
(bit 2)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-290
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Program type M
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select whether the tool change command is to be output during
gh
MAZATROL programmed operation when the machining unit is executed
for the first time.
ri
0: Output of the tool change command except for the same tool
ll
Tool change command output at the start of
.A
1: Unconditional output of the tool change command
MAZATROL programmed operation
SU155
N
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
SU155
A
(bit 7)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-291
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
When the group number is selected for tool command system, select
either group number or tool number to use for each turret.
0: Group number
1: Tool number
* When group number is used in the EIA/ISO program, bit 3 of parameter
SU156, bit 4 of parameter F94, and bit 2 of parameter F84 must be set to
0.
SU156 (bit 3) 0 1
d .
ve
Tool command scheme for each turret F94 (bit 4) 0 1 0 1
er
SU156 F84 (bit 2) 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
s
re
(bit 3) L51 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
ts
EIA/ISO G T
gh
MDI T G T
ri
ll
G Group number
.A
N
T Tool number
O
[Related parameters]
TI
F94 (bit 4) Tool command system (0: group number, 1: tool number)
60
Program type E A
R
40
Conditions Immediate F84 (bit 2) Spare tool search (0: group number, 1: tool number)
PO
29
Unit — L51 Tool command system in MDI operation (0: tool number, 1: group
R
number)
o.
Setting range 0, 1
N
K
ri
ZA
0: Normal type
Se
1: High-speed type
A
IM
(bit 4)
A
M
Program type E
YA
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
—
C
SU156
(bit 5)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-292
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Execution of the restarting search for a block in the mode of G68 when
tool length compensation (G43/G44) remains valid with a turning tool
mounted.
Execution of a restarting search for a block
in the mode of G68 when tool length 0: Alarm
compensation (G43/G44) remains valid 1: Possible (however, the return to the restarting position is not
SU156 with a turning tool mounted conducted)
(bit 6)
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Execution of the restarting search for a block after the cancellation of the
gh
cross command
ri
0: Alarm
ll
Execution of a restarting search for a block 1: Possible (however, the return to the restarting position is not
.A
after cancellation of the cross command conducted)
N
SU156
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Conditions for moving to the tool change only when the tool need not be changed for another one, nor in the
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-293
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Response to a tool change command for the same tool number (TNo.)
Program type M
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select the kind of operation to be performed if either TURN POS X, Y, or Z
gh
of the indexing unit is left blank (only when a tool change is not conducted
in immediate front of the indexing unit).
ri
ll
Operation to perform if either TURN POS X, 0: The unspecified axis moves to the position of the third home position
.A
Y, or Z is left blank in index unit (M6) before the B/C-axes are swiveled. (Conventional operation)
N
SU157 1: The B/C-axes are swiveled without any motion having been conducted
O
on the unspecified axis. (New operation)
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
C
al
Setting range 0, 1
K
ri
ZA
turning mode
SU157
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
When a turning tool is mounted, move it to the Y-axis zero point before
ig
0: Do not move
op
1: Move
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-294
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Select whether or not the B-axis rotation radius is to be included into the
“clearance position,” a component of the tool change position (when TC62
= 0, 1, 2, 5 or 7) for changing the indexed cutting edge on one and the
Selection of whether or not the B-axis
same FLASH tool.
rotation radius is to be included into the
“clearance position” for changing the 0: Included
indexed cutting edge on one and the same
SU157 1: Not included
FLASH tool
(bit 7)
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
When executing tool measurement, use the TOOL EYE tool change
ts
position (SU118 to SU121) for tool change.
gh
0: Invalid
ri
1: Valid
ll
Tool change position during TOOL EYE
.A
measurement
SU158
N
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
SU158
A
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Invalid
ig
1: Valid
yr
Note :
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-295
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Handling of G43P0 tool length * However, this is always used for tool length compensation for milling
compensation with a touch sensor tools when bit 7 of parameter F94 is set to 0 and bit 1 of parameter
SU158 SU155 is set to 0.
(bit 3)
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Fixed value (0)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
SU158
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
ZA
Set the speed to use when returning from the chopping top dead point to
Se
0: Chopping speed
IM
reference point
ZA
SU158
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Invalid
ig
1: Valid
yr
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-296
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Selects whether to reflect the B-axis angle when displaying the current
gh
position of the milling tool in the manual operation mode.
ri
0: Not displayed
ll
Current position display for milling tool with 1: Displayed
.A
B-axis angle reflected in manual operation
mode
N
SU165
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-297
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d.
ve
Program type M
er
Conditions Immediate
s
re
Unit %
ts
Setting range 0 to 100
gh
ri
ll
F2 b
.A
F1
N
Acceleration rate in up-going taper for a
O
rough cutting in bar machining unit
TI
TC2
60
NM211-00262
A
R
40
PO
TC2 b
Program type M F2 = F1 × × F2 : Increased feed rate
100 a
R
o.
Conditions Immediate
N
K
ri
TC3
M
NM211-00263
YA
TC3
F2 = F1 × 100
3
Program type M
01
TC4 = 0: 45°
yr
(TC3)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2
2-298
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
a
b F3
F1
Deceleration rate in down-going taper for
rough cutting in bar machining unit
TC5 NM211-00264
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate This is effective only when TC141 (bit 0) = 1.
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 0 to 500
ts
gh
F1 : Feed rate for rough cutting
F3
ri
F3 : Reduced feed rate
F1
ll
Deceleration rate in down-going wall slope
.A
(90°) for rough cutting in bar machining unit
N
TC6 NM211-00265
O
TI
TC6
F3 = F1 ×
60
A 100
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Unit %
N
K
ri
ZA
F2
IM
TC7
M
F2 = F1 ×
100
YA
NM211-00266
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
TC8 TC8
L = L0 { – n ( 1000 ) – 1 + 1000 }
yr
op
L : Acceleration distance
Acceleration pitch error ratio in thread
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1%
Setting range 0 to 100
2-299
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
PS
PS : Programmed start point
[1] PE : Programmed end point
: Groove machining depth
Rough cutting residue ratio in cutting off [2]
d = PS・PE
cycle in groove cutting unit
d : Rough cutting residue
PE
TC9 TC9
d=×
100
NM211-00267
.
Program type M [1] Cutting at rough cutting feed rate to a point short of end point PE by
d
ve
Conditions Immediate distance d
er
Unit % [2] Cutting off at finish cutting feed rate to end point PE
s
re
Setting range 0 to 100
ts
Used to calculate minimum cutting frequency in groove cutting unit, edge
gh
machining unit and copy machining unit
ri
100 + TC10
d’ = d ( 100 )
ll
Cut depth allowable incremental rate for
.A
rough cutting in groove cutting unit, edge d : Cut depth per cycle
machining unit and copy machining unit d’ : Allowable maximum cut depth
N
TC10
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
TC11
ri
ZA
F’ = F × 100
Se
TC11
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
NM211-00268
programmed start point
C
Program type M D
= (0° < < 180°)
Conditions Immediate 2 × tan/2
Unit % =0 ( 180°)
Setting range 0 to 100
2-300
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
TC12
F’ = F × 100
F : Specified feed rate
F' : Feed rate at cutting start
Programmed Programmed
end point start point
End point
.
d
turning-drilling unit
ve
er
TC12 Drill D
s
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
Feed rate at F' to the point distant by NM211-00269
.A
from the end point
N
O
Program type M D D
= + 10 (0° < < 80°)
TI
2 × tan/2
Conditions Immediate
60
Unit %
A D
= 10 ( 180°)
R
40
PO
R
o.
O
N
F F’
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Deceleration clearance
A
(TC15)
IM
TC13
ZA
NM211-00270
A
TC13
M
F’ = F × 100
YA
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
2-301
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
This parameter is valid during initial cutting in a bar roughing cycle. If the
remainder obtained by dividing the thickness of cutting during the roughing
cycle by the corresponding cutting depth stays within the range specified
by this parameter, that value will be added to the initial cutting depth to
reduce the cutting repeat times.
Example :
1. TC14 = 0 2. TC14 = 10%
(R-depth.: 5) (R-depth.: 5)
.
5
d
5.1
ve
Maximum permissible rate of increase of
the initial cutting depth during roughing 10.1
er
10.1 5
s
TC14 5
re
0.1
ts
gh
ri
ll
Cutting to a depth of 10.1 Cutting at a depth setting of 5 results
.A
is executed in 3 rounds of in a final cutting depth of 0.1. Since
cutting (5, 5, and 0.1). 10% of the depth setting of 5 is 0.5
N
and this value is larger than the final
O
cutting depth, this final cutting depth is
TI
added to the initial cutting depth.
60
Program type M
A
R
40
PO
Unit %
o.
regarded as 0.
O
N
ZA
Se
F F’
A
F F’ (Feedrate decelerated
IM
machining unit
TC15
ZA
TC15
A
M
NM211-00256
YA
(TC13)
Setting range 0 to 65535
(c
TC16 Escape
ht
P1
ig
yr
op
P3 d : Distance in cutting
TC16 direction between P1
d and P2
NM211-00257
Program type M
Conditions Immediate If TC16 d, tool escape from the workpiece.
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in If TC16 < d, tool doesn’t escape from the workpiece.
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-302
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate Ideal pitch = Starting pitch of threading ([1]) + TC17
er
Unit 0.001 mm
s
re
Setting range 0 to 40
ts
Fixed value (0)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
TC18
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
—
O
Unit
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
TC19
d1 = D × 100
A
IM
TC19
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
F1
ig
yr
op
P2 P1
Reamer return speed calculation coefficient
C
TC20
F2 = F 1 × 100 F1 : Specified feed rate
Program type M F2 : Return speed
P1 : Start point
Conditions Immediate P2 : End point
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 999
2-303
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
TC21
=P× 10
Programmed Programmed
end point start point
P : Tapping pitch
Incomplete threading portion length : Incomplete thread
portion length Tap
calculation coefficient for turning-tap tip
TC21
.
Program type M NM211-00273
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit Pitch/10
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99
ts
TC22
gh
=P× 10 Normal state
Tap
ri
P : Tapping pitch
ll
Turning-tapper elongation calculation : Tapper elongation Pressed state
.A
coefficient Tap during cutting, etc.
N
TC22
O
TI
60
A NM211-00274
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit Pitch/10
N
Setting range 0 to 99
al
K
ri
ZA
TC23
Se
h = P × 10000
A
IM
h : Thread height
Thread height calculation coefficient for P : Thread pitch
outside diameter, face/rear thread cutting
K
ZA
(metric)
TC23
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.01%
(c
TC24
ig
h = P × 10000
yr
h : Thread height
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.01%
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-304
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
TC25
h = P × 10000
h : Thread height
Thread height calculation coefficient for P : Thread pitch
outside diameter, face/rear thread cutting
(inch)
TC25
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.01%
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
TC26
gh
h = P × 10000
ri
h : Thread height
ll
Thread height calculation coefficient for P : Thread pitch
.A
inside diameter thread cutting (inch)
N
TC26
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.01%
N
<#1>
ri
ZA
Se
P
IM
TC28
Recessing width for #1 to #3
K
TC27
ZA
NM211-00277
TC27
A
<#2>
M
TC28
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
<#3>
yr
op
C
Recessing depth #1 to #3
TC28 TC27 P
TC28
2-305
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
<#4>
TC29 NM211-00280
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
P: Programmed end point
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
Recessing depth for #4
N
TC30
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
<#5>
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
TC32
Recessing width for #5
K
ZA
TC31
A
M
YA
Program type M
TC31
3
Conditions Immediate
01
P
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
)2
NM211-00278
ht
ig
TC32
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-306
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
<#6>
TC33 TC33 P
TC34
.
Program type M
d
NM211-00279
ve
Conditions Immediate TC34 TC33
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
P: Programmed end point
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
Recessing depth for #6
N
TC34
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Sets the lower limit for the ratio of the workpiece pressing thrust for
ri
ZA
Se
If a value smaller than the one set for this parameter is set for the CHUCK
IM
generated.
ZA
generated.
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit %
)2
2-307
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Dmin
.
Program type M Stock material shape
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
TC38
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
Dmax
ts
0
gh
ri
ll
Safety contour clearance NM211-00221
.A
― Inside diameter clearance (radial value)
Dmax: Stock material maximum outside diameter
N
TC38 Dmin: Stock material minimum inside diameter
O
0:
TI
Stock material edge projection length
60
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
― Front clearance
ZA
TC39
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
― Back clearance
TC40
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-308
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
<OUT>
TC41
d .
ve
Programmed shape
s er
Thread cutting
re
acceleration distance
ts
NM211-00222
gh
<IN>
ri
ll
Programmed shape Thread cutting
.A
acceleration distance
N
O
TI
60
TC41
A
R
40
PO
NM211-00223
R
o.
TC41
O
<FCE>
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Programmed TC41
A
shape
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
Thread cutting
acceleration
3
distance NM211-00224
01
<BAK>
)2
Thread cutting
(c
acceleration distance
ht
ig
yr
op
C
TC41
Program type M
Conditions Immediate Programmed shape
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
NM211-00225
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-309
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
<OUT>
Tool path Outside diameter
clearance TC37
d .
TC42
ve
Groove cutting clearance (radial value) in
X-axis
er
s
TC42
re
NM211-00226
ts
<IN>
gh
Front clearance
ri
TC39
ll
Tool path
.A
N
O
TI
TC42
60
Program type M
A
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
NM211-00227
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
R
o.
<FCE>
N
clearance TC37
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
Front clearance
3
TC43
)2
TC43 <BAK>
(c
Outside diameter
clearance TC37
ht
Tool path
ig
yr
op
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate Back clearance
TC40 TC43
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in NM211-00229
2-310
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
TC44
TC44
Workpiece transfer position NM211-00231
.
Program type M
d
No. 2 spindle traverses by rapid feed rate to a position distant from
ve
Conditions Immediate transfer position by clearance distance, and then transfer operation is
er
initiated.
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
(TC57, TC58, TC59)
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
After edge-machining unit, this parameter works instead of safety contour
gh
clearance FCE parameter TC39.
ri
If, however, TC45 is zero, then TC39 is used.
ll
.A
Amount of the edge clearance after
edge-machining
N
O
TC45
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
D
Se
dn di d1
IM
Cut depth
K
ZA
d1 End Start
point point
A
M
di
3
01
unit b
(c
TC46 dn
ht
ig
1 2 i n Number of
yr
cutting in
op
NM211-00251
C
D : Drilling depth
d1 : Cut depth in 1st cycle
di : Cut depth in i-th cycle
d1 – TC46 × (i – 1) (di b)
Program type M b (di < b)
Conditions Immediate b : Drilling depth clamping value (TC48)
2-311
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
G1
Pecking return distance in turning-drilling
unit G0
TC47
P2 P1
Program type M D4 D3 D2 D1
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate NM211-00252
P1: Start point
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in P2: End point
s
Dn (n = 1 to 4) = Cut depth
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
Minimum turning-drilling cut depth is set.
gh
ri
ll
Drilling cut depth clamp value in
.A
turning-drilling unit
N
TC48
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
If 0 or 1 is set up in TC50:
ri
ZA
This value will be used as the spindle speed clamp value in cutting off
Se
cycle (#4/#5).
IM
Immediately before the cutting off area (*) is reached during the cutting off
cycle (GRV)
ZA
cycle, this value will be used as the spindle speed clamp value. Within the
TC49 cutting off area, however, machining will be executed at the speed
A
The spindle speed will be clamped with the RPM value in the common
Conditions Immediate
)2
unit.
–1
Unit min If RPM is zero, the spindle speed will be clamped with the value of
(c
2-312
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
The staring feed value for cutting-off is a feed value that has been
designated in unit data, and the ending feed value for cutting-off is a feed
value that has been designated in sequence data. The feed rate from the
start of machining to the end is reduced in steps according to the number
of times that has been designated here.
Example :
Number of times that the feed rate is to be Feed rate set at feed item in unit data = 0.5
reduced during the #4 and #5 cutting-off Feed rate set at roughness item in sequence data = 0.1
cycles of a grooving unit TC50 = 3
TC50 Feed rate: 0.5
d.
ve
er
Feed rate: 0.3
s
re
Workpiece Workpiece
ts
gh
Program type M Feed rate: 0.1
ri
Conditions Immediate
ll
Unit Times
.A
Setting range 0 to 65535 When 0 or 1 is set for TC50, the feed rate is unchanged.
N
Set the number of revolutions of the spindle during dwell time at the
O
bottom of a hole when the #0 - #4 non-through hole drilling cycle is
TI
60
PO
TC51
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Program type M
A
Conditions Immediate
IM
Unit Revolutions
K
Tool will stop at groove bottom while spindle rotates N times when TC52 is
A
unit
TC52
)2
(c
ht
ig
Program type M
Remaining at groove bottom until
yr
Unit Revolutions
C
2-313
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
For escape by very short distance, G01 feed speed will be faster than G00
to complete the operation. (If G00 is used, smoothing 0 detection will be
made at the end position.)
Therefore, for escape very short distance, use G01 command, and set the
feed speed of this command as parameter.
Example :
Escape in finish Escape in rough cutting
cutting of edge-machining unit of bar machining unit
[1]
d .
ve
Feed rate for escape by short distance
s er
TC53
re
[1]
ts
[1]: Feed speed in this block
gh
specified by G01 (TC53)
ri
Escape distance
ll
.A
NM211-00238
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
(TC67, TC68)
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
ZA
Se
TC54 TC54
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
NM211-00241
3
01
2-314
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Example :
Outside diameter machining in normal (– Z-axis) direction
dr: Reverse feed
Reverse feed tolerance for contour contour data
machining Contour
TC55
dr
NM211-00243
Program type M
d .
dr TC55 ........ No alarm
ve
Conditions Immediate dr > TC55 ........ Alarm
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
gh
PS PE TC56
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
PE A PS
Overtravelling in X-axis direction in edge TC56
R
40
NM211-00244
o.
O
N
Note :
al
ZA
Program type M
ZA
Conditions Immediate
A
NM211-00245
YA
TC57
(c
Workpiece
ht
ig
transfer unit
op
No. 2
C
TC57 No. 1
spindle spindle
Workpiece transfer
clearance (TC44)
Workpiece transfer position specified
in transfer display
Program type M
NM211-00236
Conditions Immediate
Set this parameter equal to or as close as possible to its standard value.
mm/min
Unit Excessive setting may cause a contact error.
0.1 in/min
(TC44, TC59)
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-315
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d.
in the transfer display
ve
Conditions Immediate NM211-00237
er
–1
Unit min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999
ts
Workpiece transferred from No. 1 spindle to No. 2 spindle
gh
ri
ll
Workpiece pressing distance in workpiece
No. 2
.A
transfer unit No. 1
Workpiece spindle
spindle
N
TC59
O
TI
TC59 Workpiece transfer
60
Program type M
A clearance (TC44)
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
Unit
o.
ZA
Se
unit jobsites
A
TC61 = 1:
IM
TC61 = 2:
ZA
TC61 = 4:
M
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 7
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-316
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Selection of tool change command output When a FLASH tool is used, specify the position for indexing the tool,
position for FLASH tool namely, the tool change command output position for indexing the tool of
the same TNo. at the same B-axis angle during programmed operation.
In all other cases, the tool change command output position specified by
SU10 becomes valid.
M5 Z-axis
[6] [1] [3] I21/I22 Z-axis Zc : Stock material edge projection length
Dmax : Stock material maximum outside
diameter
x : Tool turning clearance (X-axis) SU50
.
M5 X-axis
d
Machine zero point + B-axis spindle edge offset value
[4]
ve
BA62
+ Spindle tool length
er
z : Tool turning clearance (Z-axis) SU51
s
re
Fixed point
[5] [0] [2]
ts
I21/I22 X-axis
gh
[9/10]
ri
x
ll
.A
[7] [8]
User-specified
N
Dmax fixed point 1/2
O
TI
60
ZA
Note :
A
determined by SU51.
)2
(c
ht
SU51
ig
yr
op
Stock material
C
2. The turret type of turret conducts tool turning at the tool change
command output position. The ATC type of turret moves from the
Program type M tool change command output position to the ATC position.
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 10
2-317
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Selection of tool change command output When a FLASH tool is used, specify the position for indexing the tool,
position for FLASH tool namely, the tool change command output position for indexing the tool of
the same TNo. at the same B-axis angle during programmed operation.
In all other cases, the tool change position specified by SU10 becomes
valid.
INTEGREX e-H I21/I22 Z-axis Zc : Stock material edge projection length
[11] 3rd zero point Dmax : Stock material maximum outside
diameter
M5 Z-axis x : Tool turning clearance (X-axis) SU50
M6 [6] [1] [3] + B-axis spindle edge offset value
X-axis
.
BA62
d
+ Spindle tool length
ve
M5
X-axis [4] z : Tool turning clearance (Z-axis) SU51
er
Machine zero point
I21/I22
s
[5] [0] [2] X-axis
re
User-specified
[9/10]
ts
fixed point 1/2
2nd zero point
gh
x
[7] [8]
ri
Setting X-axis Z-axis
ll
0 Clearance position Clearance position
.A
Dmax
1 Machine zero point Clearance position
N
2 Clearance position Machine zero point
O
Zc z 3 Machine zero point Machine zero point
TI
4 2nd zero point 2nd zero point
60
machining
PO
TC62 X-axis
8
End point of previous
Machine zero point
al
ZA
M5 point 1 point 1
Z-axis [4]
Z-axis
A
SU51
Program type M
Conditions Immediate Stock material
Stock material edge protrusion
length
Unit — length
Setting range 0 to 11
2-318
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Set the amount of relief after executing the workpiece transfer unit.
Example : Transfer from HD2 to HD1
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
Gripping position Amount of relief
ts
gh
ri
ll
Amount of relief after transfer using the
.A
workpiece transfer unit
(Spindle mode 6 and 7)
N
TC64
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M
29
Unit 0.01 s
N
K
ri
outputted at the start of cutting off (#4, #5), and M-code of No. n+1 (Parts
IM
catcher control
ZA
TC65
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
This parameter is used as the basis for judging whether the index angle
ig
TC66
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1°
Setting range 0 to 3599
2-319
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Example :
1. Standard type cutting
Prior to cutting up along the wall in the end of final cycle, escape will
Return distance (radial value) in X-axis at be made by specified distance.
wall during rough cutting in bar cutting unit,
in corner machining unit or in mill-turning
unit of MAZATROL programs
TC67
TC67
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in TC68
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535 2. High speed rough cutting
Escape will be made by TC67 and TC68 specified distance during
ts
return after reaching the wall.
gh
ri
Return distance in Z-axis at wall during
ll
rough cutting in bar cutting unit, in corner
.A
machining unit or in mill-turning unit of
N
MAZATROL programs
TC68
O
TI
TC67
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
TC68
29
Conditions Immediate
R
Set number of revolutions during dwell for each cutting operation for
ri
ZA
machining #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, or #5 groove (T. GROOVE unit) with pecking
Se
The tool stops moving until the spindle makes revolutions set in this
Number of revolutions during dwell for parameter.
K
pecking of grooving
ZA
TC69
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
Unit Revolutions
(c
Number of cutting edges to be used if the tool file data for the
ig
FLASH tool
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Number of cutting edges
Setting range 0 to 99
2-320
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Specify the feed stopping rotation dwell time during the chip cutting cycle.
Feed is stopped while the spindle rotates for the specified time.
Note :
Feed stopping rotation dwell time during the
chip cutting cycle (valid only for roughing) If “0” is entered, the dwell time will be handled as “0”. However, the feed
rate will be reduced since the dwell function itself will be executed.
TC71
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit Revolutions
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
If the number of times of roughing has not been specified in the program,
gh
operation will occur in accordance with the setting of this parameter.
ri
ll
.A
Number of times of roughing in the
composite-type fixed cycle (G273, G73)
N
Number of times of
TC72
O
roughing
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit Times
N
K
ri
ZA
Pecking speed
Se
Return speed at pecking portion in groove When executing groove cutting with grooving pattern #0 (only for oblique
A
groove) the tool returns from the groove bottom also at the “G1” feed rate
M
Returns at G1
)2
Returns at G0
(c
ht
Program type M
ig
0.001 mm/rev In turning-drilling unit, TC73 setting will be used only for #2 and #2
op
Unit
0.0001 in/rev types.
C
2-321
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Tool
Pecking return distance in groove cutting
unit of MAZATROL programs
TC74
TC74
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate NM211-00248
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in * For EIA/ISO programs (fixed cycle) refer to SU104.
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
d
gh
d: Tool diameter
ri
: Groove width
Tool
ll
Overlap distance for machining wide groove
.A
in groove cutting unit
N
TC75
O
TI
60
A TC75
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
NM211-00249
O
K
ri
TC76 TC76
IM
machining unit
ZA
TC76
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
TC76 TC76
)2
TC77
ig
L L0
yr
op
2-322
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
TC78
(n/2-1)th cut
(n/2)th cut
.d
ve
Conditions Immediate NM211-00247
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in * For EIA/ISO programs (fixed cycle) refer to SU105.
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
Clamping will follow the setting of TC79 if the calculated value of the cut
gh
depth with the threading unit is smaller than the setting of TC79. This
parameter is valid only for the infeed operation of the fixed-area scheme.
ri
Minimum cut depth clamping value (radial
ll
* For EIA/ISO programs (fixed cycle) refer to SU106.
.A
value) in thread cutting unit of MAZATROL
programs
N
TC79
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
If, during the composite-type fixed cycle G276/G76 mode, a tool nose
ri
ZA
angle has not been specified in the program, the setting of this parameter
Se
mode
ZA
TC80 Angle
A
M
YA
Program type E The setting must be either 0, 29, 30, 55, 60 or 80.
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit °
)2
If the number of times of repetition has not been specified in the program,
operation will occur in accordance with the setting of this parameter.
ig
yr
op
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit Times
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-323
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
L2 L1 L
End
point
Start
ψ point
NM211-00272
.
L : Effective thread length
d
Chamfering data calculation coefficient in
ve
L1 : Same pitch incomplete thread length (follow-up delay)
thread cutting unit and thread cutting cycle L2 : Chamfering data
er
(G276/G292, G76/G92) ψ : Chamfering angle
s
TC82
re
TC82
L2 = L0 × 10
ts
gh
L0 : Thread lead
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit Lead/10
O
N
Setting range 0 to 40
al
ZA
TC83 = 0 or 1:
Number of cutting operations to be
Cutting based on the setting of TC78 occurs once.
K
<Supplementary description>
Parameter TC83 is valid only for #0, #0: it does not function for #1, #1
3
or #2, #2.
01
Program type M
If TC78 = 0, TC83 is invalid.
)2
Conditions Immediate
For thread refinishing, one cutting operation is performed as before.
(c
Unit Times
ht
TC84
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/rev / 0.0001 in/rev
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-324
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Specify the number of the magazine pocket holding the adapter for the
long boring bar.
Address Description
Specification of the pocket for the long TC85 Pocket No. 1 for long boring bar
boring bar TC86 Pocket No. 2 for long boring bar
TC85
TC87 Pocket No. 3 for long boring bar
to TC88 Pocket No. 4 for long boring bar
TC94 TC89 Pocket No. 5 for long boring bar
TC90 Pocket No. 6 for long boring bar
.
Program type M, E TC91 Pocket No. 7 for long boring bar
d
ve
Conditions Immediate TC92 Pocket No. 8 for long boring bar
er
TC93 Pocket No. 9 for long boring bar
Unit —
s
TC94 Pocket No. 10 for long boring bar
re
Setting range 0 to 960
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
TC95
O
TC96
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
TC97 = 0:
IM
TC97 = 1:
ZA
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
Specify the sequence of the returning operation set in the ATC and
ig
RETURN items in the end unit for machines with the lower turret.
yr
TC98 = 0:
op
2-325
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the ATC operation after machining when the ATC item in the end
unit is not set.
TC99 = 0:
The same operation as when the item is set to “0” is followed.
ATC operation after machining when not (The tool is not returned.)
specified in the END unit
TC99 = 1:
TC99 The same operation as when the item is set to “1” is followed.
(The tool is returned and axes move to the returning position.)
TC99 = 2:
The same pattern as when the item is set to “2” is followed.
Program type M
d.
(The axes move to the returning position and the tool is returned).
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit — The setting is regarded as “0” if out of range.
s
re
Setting range 0 to 2
ts
Select a droop sampling axis.
gh
ri
ll
Selection of droop sampling axis
.A
(For detecting imbalance)
N
TC101
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0 to 31
al
ZA
Se
TC102
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 32 to 39
(c
ht
Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 9999
2-326
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Set the clearance for rechucking the workpiece using the workpiece
transfer unit.
Movement to the clearance position occurs in the G0 mode.
Movement from the clearance position to the gripping position occurs in
the G1 mode using the feed rate specified in parameter TC57.
.d
ve
Clearance for rechucking using the Workpiece
er
workpiece transfer unit
s
TC104
re
Clearance + Direction
ts
TC104
gh
Spindle No. 2 specification
ri
ll
G1 G0
Gripping position
.A
N
O
TI
Workpiece
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
ZA
Se
A
IM
—
K
ZA
TC105
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions —
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
ht
0: Not to be enabled
op
2-327
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the distance beyond the workpiece where the end point in the
workpiece longitudinal direction can be placed when machining the inner
surface in bar machining, copy machining or thread cutting unit.
TC107
Overshoot for
inside machining
Program type M
d .
TC107
ve
Conditions Immediate
Workpiece length
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
Select the waiting position after the two-workpiece machining.
gh
TC108 = 0
ri
Tool-rotating position in accordance with the spindle and the basic
coordinate system selected for machining after the two-workpiece
ll
End position of the two-workpiece
.A
machining
machining
TC108 = 1
N
TC108 Tool-rotating position in accordance with the spindle and the basic
O
coordinate system selected for the two-workpiece machining
TI
60
TC108 = 2 A
R
40
TC108 = 3
Conditions Immediate
Retraction position specified by the two-workpiece machining unit (END)
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0 to 3
al
Sets the reference length for the display of bar materials on the BL
ri
ZA
SCHEDULE display
Se
A
IM
materials on the BL SCHEDULE display If a value outside the allowable setting range is set, the set value is
ZA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit mm/0.01 in
)2
1 to 9999 (mm)
Setting range
(c
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit mm/0.1 in
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-328
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit mm/0.1 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
The settings of these parameters will be used if the amount of release is
gh
not specified in the program.
ri
ll
Composite-type fixed cycle
.A
— amount of X-axial release (G273)
N
TC117
TC117
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
TC118
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
2-329
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the distance from the B-axis rotational center of the milling spindle
to the front end of the long boring bar.
Distance to the front end of the long boring (On the 3D MONITOR display, long boring bar image is shown at the
bar display position when the tool data is changed or the tool is changed to
other tool after changing the parameter value.)
d .
ve
Milling spindle Milling spindle
s er
re
B-axis rotational center
ts
gh
ri
ll
Long boring bar
.A
TC120 Long boring bar Shift stroke Y
N
Shift stroke X
to
O
TI
TC137 Address Description
60
TC120
A Long boring bar No. 1 - Shift stroke X
R
40
PO
ZA
TC127
IM
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in TC137 Long boring bar No. 6 - Shift stroke Z
(c
2-330
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
F1
F1 No acceleration
d .
ve
F2 F2 > F1
er
F1 F1 : Feed rate for rough
s
cutting cycle
re
F2 : Feed rate after
Program type M
acceleration
ts
Conditions Immediate
gh
Unit — NM211-00208
ri
(TC2, TC3)
ll
Setting range 0, 1
.A
TC141 (bit 1) = 0: Disuse
N
O
TI
F1
F1
60
A No deceleration
R
40
TC141
o.
O
N
F3 < F1
ri
ZA
F1 cutting cycle
A
Unit — NM211-00209
(TC5, TC6)
A
Setting range 0, 1
M
Example :
thread cutting unit
yr
TC141 Lc
op
(bit 2)
C
2-331
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
1st thread Acceleration distance is
Program type M
2nd thread same for any thread
er
Conditions Immediate number
s
3rd thread
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 0, 1
gh
An angle margin for nose shape compensation can be selected by setting
ri
data in bits 4 and 5.
ll
.A
Selecting an angle margin for nose shape
N
Setting Angle margin for nose
compensation
O
TC141 Bit 5 Bit 4 shape compensation
TI
(bit 4) 0 0 3.0
60
(bit 5)
A 0 1 2.0
R
40
PO
1 0 1.0
29
Conditions Immediate
N
Unit —
al
K
ri
Setting range 0, 1
ZA
Se
TC141 (bit 6) = 1
A
TC141 (bit 6) = 0
K
TC141
M
(bit 6)
YA
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
TC141 (bit 7) = 1
yr
TC141 (bit 7) = 0
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-332
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
TC142
(bit 0)
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
TC142 (bit 1) = 0
gh
The relationship between the starting position of machining with the next
unit and the ending position of machining with the previous unit is
ri
Selecting an inter-unit relief path when a examined and if interference is judged to be likely, the tool will escape to a
ll
succession of I.D. turning units using the clearance point.
.A
same tool exist and there is no movement TC142 (bit 1) = 1
N
TC142 to the rotating position of the tool The tool escapes to the clearance point each time the I.D. turning unit is
O
(bit 1) executed to completion.
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
TC142 (bit 2) = 0:
A
TC142 (bit 2) = 1:
Selection of the jaw data reference method Reference using the name of the jaw.
K
ZA
TC142
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
TC142 (bit 3) = 0:
Angle tool holder cannot be used.
ig
yr
TC142 (bit 3) = 1:
op
TC142 Use BA63 to set the angle of the angle tool holder.
(bit 3)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-333
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
TC142 (bit 5) = 0:
gh
An alarm will not be issued even if the ending position of workpiece
pressing is reached during the transfer of the workpiece.
ri
Selection whether an alarm is to be issued TC142 (bit 5) = 1:
ll
.A
if the ending position of workpiece pressing An alarm will be issued if the ending position of workpiece pressing is
is reached during transfer of the workpiece reached during the transfer of the workpiece.
N
TC142
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
TC142 (bit 6) = 0:
ri
ZA
unit of the MAZATROL program, the X-axis moves to the machine zero
IM
point.
X-axis retraction position during workpiece
transfer as specified in the workpiece TC142 (bit 6) = 1:
K
transfer unit of the MAZATROL program When the workpiece is transferred as specified in the workpiece transfer
ZA
TC142 unit of the MAZATROL program, the X-axis moves to the third zero point.
A
(bit 6)
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
TC142 (bit 7) = 0:
Upper turret moves to the X-axis zero point during machining with the
ig
lower turret.
yr
op
TC142 (bit 7) = 1:
Upper turret retraction during machining Upper turret retraction does not occur during machining with the lower
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-334
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Whether the end tool of the long boring bar can be changed by ATC
(1: Changeable, 0: Not changeable)
76543210 (1: Changeable, 0: Not changeable)
Whether the end tool of the long boring bar Long boring bar No. 1
can be changed
Long boring bar No. 2
TC143 Long boring bar No. 3
Long boring bar No. 4
Long boring bar No. 5
Program type M, E Long boring bar No. 6
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits
ts
76543210
gh
Automatic selection of the relief path for the
ri
continuous I.D. machining
ll
Workpiece transfer axis motion for opposed turret
.A
specification lathes
N
0: Z-axis return to zero point
O
1: Compliant with TC63/TC64
TI
C-axis clamping during workpiece transfer with
60
A C-axis positioning
R
40
0: Valid
PO
29
1: Invalid
R
—
C
unit
al
TC144 0: Valid
ri
ZA
1: Invalid
Se
single-process operation
0: Not executed
K
1: Executed
ZA
(CONTI. = 1).
M
0: Not executed
YA
1: Executed
Relief path G00/G01 selection for edging
3
0: G00
01
1: G01
Program type M
)2
Unit —
1: Inheriting the mounted tool
ig
2-335
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
d .
command mode
ve
0: Normal operation
er
1: Alarm stop
s
re
After C-axis transfer using the workpiece transfer
unit
ts
0: Milling mode
gh
1: Turning mode
ri
Selection of a calculation method for tail barrier
ll
end reference
.A
0: Spindle edge
N
1: Z-offset
O
Output of maximum spindle speed command
TI
specified in the common unit
60
position)
TC145
R
ZA
machining)
ZA
tip
)2
of the tip, this path will be ignored and the next path executed. In this
ig
1: Alarm stop
C
2-336
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Selection of the turning spindle rotation timing when the relay point for the
turning approach is specified
0 : Spindle rotation after movement to relay point
Selection of the turning spindle rotation 1 : Spindle rotation before movement to relay point
timing when the relay point for the turning
approach is specified
TC146
(bit 0)
d .
Conditions Immediate For mill-turning unit or turning-drilling unit in which a milling tool is used,
ve
Unit — the spindle rotates after movement to the relay point, even when TC146
er
bit 0 = 1.
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Used to select the mode of X-axis commands in manual program units.
ts
0: Radial value
gh
1: Diametral value
ri
ll
X-axis command in manual program unit
.A
TC146
N
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
Program type M
A
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
Used to select the operation when the infeed angle or relief angle is 0° or
ri
ZA
less.
Se
0: Tool path output assuming that the infeed angle or the relief angle is
A
IM
90°
Operation at the infeed angle or relief angle
of 0° or less 1: Alarm stop
K
TC146
ZA
(bit 2)
A
M
YA
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
C-axis command output for the second workpiece transfer unit onward at
ht
0: Do not output
yr
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-337
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Automatic setting of M8 as an M-code to be output at the beginning of a
unit which is selected for the single-process operation.
gh
0: No setting
ri
1: Setting
ll
M8 output before executing single-process
.A
operation
TC146
N
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
for both sides. (If the setting in question is omitted, the C-OFFSET
C-offset on HD1/HD2 in two-workpiece
setting on the SETUP INFORMATION display is used for both sides.)
machining unit of MAZATROL program
K
respective sides.
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
the workpiece coordinate system according to the tool offset setting in the
ig
TPC data.
yr
0: Modification
op
current position
TC146
(bit 7)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-338
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Program type M
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Z/C offset value to be used in the EIA/ISO subprogram after workpiece
gh
transfer in the MAZATROL program
ri
0: Z/C offset value set in the workpiece transfer unit
ll
Z/C offset value to be used in the EIA/ISO 1: Z/C offset value for the MAZATROL program set on the SET UP
.A
subprogram after workpiece transfer in the MANAG. display
MAZATROL program
N
TC147
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
TC147
A
(bit 3)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-339
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Include nose R. (MTPro compatible)
gh
1: Do not include nose R.
ri
ll
Handling of nose R in the retraction path
.A
during grooving #4, 5 (cutting off)
N
TC147
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Z-axial withdrawal after M-code unit execution when the tool nose is
ZA
Se
0: Invalid
K
1: Valid
ZA
Example :
A
The tool will be withdrawn after execution of the M-code unit when the
M
tool nose has been positioned in the area between the front clearance
YA
point and the workpiece zero point (the hatched section in the figure)
using the manual program unit, or when the program is restarted from
3
Z-axial withdrawal after M-code unit the M-code unit with the tool nose positioned in that area.
01
TC147 (TC37)
(c
(bit 7)
ht
ig
Workpiece edge
yr
protrusion
op
C
Rear clearance
(TC40)
2-340
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
.d
ve
er
Clearance area
s
re
ts
Selection of compensation cancel when
gh
working around the workpiece
ri
TC148
ll
(bit 4)
.A
N
O
TI
Wear compensation cancel
60
A
R
40
PO
R
o.
Wear compensation
al
cancel
Clearance area
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
Program type M
K
Conditions Immediate
ZA
Unit —
A
Setting range 0, 1
M
YA
Movement onto a clearance point when the tool tip after O.D. turning is
located within the clearance area around the workpiece
3
0: Do not move
01
1: Move
)2
area to a clearance point during O.D. * Operation with this parameter set to 1 (ON)
ht
turning
TC148
ig
O.D.
C
direction
Program type M
Conditions Immediate Move onto a
clearance point
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-341
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Movement onto a clearance point when the tool tip after face/rear turning
is located within the clearance area around the workpiece
0: Do not move
1: Move
Selection of movement from the clearance
area to a clearance point during face/rear
Move onto a
turning
TC148 clearance point
(bit 6) To the rear To the front
Clearance area
.
Move onto a
d
clearance point
ve
Program type M
er
Conditions Immediate
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 0, 1
gh
W-axis command from the lower turret when upper - head 1 and lower
ri
-head 2 is set in two-workpiece machining unit
ll
.A
0: Impossible
1: Possible (using address B)
N
W-axis command enabled/disabled during
O
two-workpiece machining * The W-axis command can be issued using G110 (cross command) and
TI
TC148 address B regardless of parameters except for two-workpiece machining
60
(bit 7) unit. A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M
R
o.
O
N
Conditions Immediate
C
al
Unit —
K
ri
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
Se
cutting cycle
M
TC149 * In the case of MAZATROL program: G32 block in thread cutting unit
YA
(bit 0)
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr
0: Invalid
op
1: Valid
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-342
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
Spindle rotation during turning when an 1: Rotation at a spindle speed specified at the TPC approach relay point
S-code is specified in TPC data (rotation by G97)
TC149 * The spindle rotates at a speed that is set when bit 4 of parameter TC149
is set to 0, regardless of the setting value, if simultaneous drill rotation is
(bit 4)
valid in turning-drilling unit.
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Alarm 613 DATA MISSING IN WPC UNIT occurs.
gh
1: Setting of Z is handled as 0.
ri
Machine operation on tool path check of a
ll
program for which workpiece scheme is
.A
selected and T. CENTER is specified for X
and Y, but Z is left blank in the basic
N
TC149 coordinates system unit (WPC).
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
0: No alarm
Se
(bit 7)
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Invalid
ig
1: Valid
yr
op
workpiece
TC150
(bit 0)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-343
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Pinch cut/Y-axis turning in MAZATROL * This parameter is valid only when the pinch cut/Y-axis turning option is
program selected.
TC150
(bit 1)
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
When a program that performs 2 workpiece machining is executed with
gh
only one spindle,
0: No alarm stop
ri
Alarm stop if a program that performs 2
ll
1: Stop with the output of alarm 789 DBL SPDL OPER UNIT ERROR
.A
workpiece machining with only one spindle
is executed
N
TC150
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
control
ZA
TC150
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
Set the depth of cut in the Z-axis direction when machining pattern #2 is
selected in the external diameter turning unit.
ig
yr
op
TC155 TC155
diameter in bar machining unit
TC155
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-344
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
TC159
.
TC156
d
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
TC156
ri
Program type M
ll
Conditions Immediate
.A
[Related parameters]
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
N
TC159
O
Setting range 0 to 65535
TI
Set any of rotation angles (0, 90, 180 and 270) in the direction from the
60
A
default direction.
R
40
PO
function (IBA):
O
N
Angular offset
C
TC157
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
K
Unit
ZA
Sets the override for the traverse feed rate in reciprocating grooving
YA
operation.
Setting “0” results in the same operation as when “100” is set.
3
01
operation
(c
TC158
ht
ig
yr
Program type M
op
Conditions Immediate
C
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 200
2-345
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
TC159
d .
TC159
ve
er
s
re
ts
gh
TC156
ri
Program type M
ll
.A
Conditions Immediate
[Related parameters]
N
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
O
TC156
TI
Setting range 0 to 65535
60
A
Sets the retraction distance from the wall at completion of groove bottom
R
40
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
+X
ZA
TC160 +Z
IM
TC161
K
ZA
Cutting path
A
TC160
M
Retraction path
YA
2-346
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
TC162
Wall clearance in uni-directional grooving
+X
TC162
+Z
d .
ve
er
Program type M
s
Cutting path
re
Conditions Immediate
ts
Positioning path
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
gh
Setting range 0 to 65535
ri
Set a multiplier factor to be used in the math formula which calculates the
ll
.A
amount of balance.
N
O
INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER
TI
function (IBA):
60
PO
29
R
o.
Program type M, E
N
Conditions Immediate
al
K
ri
ZA
Unit —
Se
Set the factor to be used in the math formula that calculates the amount of
balance.
K
ZA
function (IBA):
M
TC252
3
01
)2
Program type M, E
(c
Conditions Immediate
ht
Unit —
ig
2-347
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the dead zone for the drooping level for the math formula that
calculates the amount of balance.
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
0 to 2147483648
re
Setting range
ts
Set the dead zone for the rotary speeds for the math formula that
gh
calculates the direction of imbalance.
ri
INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER
ll
.A
function (IBA):
Imbalance rotary speed offset
N
TC254
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Set the slope of the math formula that calculates the direction of
ri
ZA
imbalance.
Se
A
IM
TC255
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
1: Considering C1/C2
yr
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-348
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title TURNING
d .
Program type M
ve
er
Conditions Immediate
1
s
Unit —
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-349
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Cutting start position
er
Spindle Spindle
s
No. 1
re
No. 2
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
When TC290 bit 1 = 1
N
Spindle No. 1 OD/ID: Chuck side, Front/back: Inner diameter side
O
Spindle No. 2 OD/ID: Chuck side, Front/back: Inner diameter side
TI
60
Spindle Spindle
PO
29
No. 1 No. 2
R
o.
reciprocating/uni-directional grooving
C
TC290
al
K
ri
ZA
(bit 1)
Se
A
IM
Spindle No. 1
A
Spindle No. 2
YA
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-350
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-3-8 User parameter SOLID (SD)
SD49
d .
ve
Program type M, E
er
Conditions Immediate
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 0, 1
gh
Select a table type for 3D setup display.
ri
0: Square table
ll
.A
1: Round table
2: Chuck
N
Table type
O
TI
SD50 * When this parameter is set to “2” on machines with the vertical Z-axis
60
A
(L110 bit 7 = 1) and the rotary head axis (BA48 ≠ 0), the table will be
R
40
Program type M, E other machines, the chuck shape will not be displayed even if this
parameter is set to “2”.
R
Conditions Immediate
o.
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 0 to 2
ri
ZA
Se
display.
IM
0: X-axis
1: Y-axis
K
2: Z-axis
A
SD51
M
Program type M, E
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
Sets the drawing mode for arcs in the tool path check and shape check.
ig
yr
SD53
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-351
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d.
ve
0 : Invalid *
Permissible error
er
1 : 1.2 mm
s
2 : 0.8 mm
re
3 : 0.5 mm
ts
4 : 0.4 mm
gh
QUICK MAZATROL product shape display
accuracy 5 : 0.35 mm
ri
SD58 6 : 0.3 mm
ll
.A
7 : 0.25 mm
N
8 : 0.2 mm
O
9 : 0.15 mm
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
K
ri
Conditions Immediate
machining)
Unit —
A
Setting range 0 to 9
YA
Fixed value
3
01
)2
—
(c
SD59
ht
to
ig
SD63
yr
op
Program type —
C
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-352
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOLID
Set the default value for the model’s movement distance per time that is to
be displayed in the movement distance assignment dialog box.
SD97
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Set the default value for the amount of model rotation per time that is to be
gh
displayed in the amount-of-rotation assignment dialog box.
ri
ll
.A
Amount of model rotation per time
N
SD98
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.0001°
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-353
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Vertical type
SD125 +Z
+Y
SD128
+X
SD126
.
SD127
d
ve
SD130
er
SD129
s
re
Horizontal type
ts
gh
ri
SD129 +Y
ll
+X
.A
SD126
+Z
N
SD130
SD125
O
Table size
TI
SD128
SD125: Minimum table dimension X
60
SD125
29
SD125 SD126
al
K
ri
ZA
SD131
Se
SD131
IM
+Y SD128
K
+X
ZA
A
M
SD127
YA
3
01
Horizontal type
)2
SD129 SD130
(c
SD131
ht
SD131
ig
SD126
yr
+X
op
+Z
C
Program type M, E
SD125
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
2-354
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOLID
1. SD51 = 0:
In the length in the Y-axis direction (SD127 + SD128) and that in the
Z-axis direction (SD129 + SD130), the value having a smaller absolute
value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the length in the
X-axis direction (SD125 + SD126) is taken as the height of the round
table. The center of the rectangle (SD127, SD128, SD129, SD130) is
taken as the center of the round table.
d .
ve
2. SD51 = 1:
In the length in the X-axis direction (SD125 + SD126) and that in the
er
Z-axis direction (SD129 + SD130), the value having a smaller absolute
s
re
value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the length in the
Y-axis direction (SD127 + SD128) is taken as the height of the round
ts
table. The center of the rectangle (SD125, SD126, SD129, SD130) is
gh
taken as the center of the round table.
ri
3. SD51 = 2:
ll
In the length in the X-axis direction (SD125 + SD126) and that in the
.A
Table size Y-axis direction (SD127 + SD128), the value having a smaller
N
SD125: Minimum table dimension X absolute value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the
O
SD126: Maximum table dimension X length in the Z-axis direction (SD129 + SD130) is taken as the height
TI
SD127: Minimum table dimension Y of the round table. The center of the rectangle (SD125, SD126,
SD125
60
SD128: Maximum table dimension Y SD127, SD128) is taken as the center of the round table.
A
to
R
40
SD125 SD126
O
N
+Y
al
SD128
ri
ZA
Se
+X
Length in the
A
Y-axis direction
IM
K
SD127
ZA
A
SD129 SD130
3
01
+X
)2
SD126
(c
+Z Length in the
ht
X-axis direction
ig
Program type M, E
yr
2-355
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Amount of chamfer
Amount of table chamfer
SD131
d .
ve
er
Program type M, E
s
Conditions Immediate
re
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
ts
gh
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
ri
0: Reflecting information on tools used to the shape
ll
1: Reflecting information (nominal diameter, etc.) specified in the program
.A
to the shape
N
Tool data setting using QUICK MAZATROL
O
TI
SD165
60
(bit 1)
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M
o.
O
N
Conditions Immediate
C
al
Unit —
K
ri
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
Se
Fixed value
IM
K
ZA
—
A
SD166
M
(bit 0)
YA
3
01
Program type —
)2
Conditions —
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range —
ig
0: To be a solid of revolution
yr
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-356
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOLID
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-357
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Program type M, E
er
Conditions Immediate
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 0, 1
gh
Select the operation to be performed when tool data (ACT-, NOSE-R,
ri
EDG-ANG, TIP-WID, WIDTH) is not input upon automatically determining
ll
cutting conditions.
.A
Selection of operation for automatic
N
determination of cutting conditions when
O
0: Displaying the alarm 414 AUTO CALCULATION IMPOSSIBLE
tool data is not input
TI
US1 1: Automatically determining cutting conditions by referring to NOM- in
60
(bit 1) A
the program and parameters US43, US44, US45 and US46
R
40
PO
29
Program type M
R
o.
Conditions Immediate
N
Unit —
al
K
ri
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
Se
US1
M
(bit 2)
YA
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
0: Invalid
yr
1: Valid
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-358
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title DISPLAY STRUCTURE
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set the number of users which the data guard function identifies.
gh
* The function is invalid when “0” or “1” is set.
ri
ll
Data guard function:
.A
Maximum number of users
N
US37
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0 to 8
al
K
ri
US39 (DRILL)
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
Enabled when “BOR BAR”, “B-B BAR” or “BCK FACE” is set for the tool
conditions
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 999
2-359
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
When determining “DEP-1” automatically using the automatic cutting
gh
condition determination function, adjust the depth of cut during I.D.
machining.
ri
Automatic determination of cutting
Enabled when “IN” or “IN INNER (BAK)” is set for the machining section in
ll
conditions
.A
the tool sequence for a “BAR”, “CPY” or “CORNER” unit.
Reference shank diameter
N
US42 (BAR, CPY, CORNER)
O
DEP-1 = R-MAX-DEPTH (CUTTING CONDITION display)
TI
WORKPIECE MATERIAL PERCENTAGE_R-DEPTH% (CUTTING
60
A
CONDITION display) TOOL MATERIAL PERCENTAGE_R-DEPTH%
R
40
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit mm/0.1 in
N
K
ri
as the tool nose radius if “NOSE-R” is not input for the specified tool.
IM
(BAR, CPY, CORNER, FACING) Note : US43 is enabled only when US1 bit 1 = 1.
US43
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
as the tool width if “WIDTH” is not input for the specified tool.
Automatic determination of cutting
op
Enabled when “IN” or “IN INNER (BAK)” is set for the machining section in
conditions
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit mm/0.1 in
Setting range 0 to 100
2-360
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title DISPLAY STRUCTURE
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.1°
s
re
Setting range 0 to 1000
ts
When determining “FR” automatically using the automatic cutting
gh
condition determination function, determine the condition by using US46
as the tool nose width if “TIP-WID” is not input for the specified tool.
ri
Automatic determination of cutting
Enabled when a “T.GROOVE” unit is selected.
ll
conditions
.A
Tool nose width when tool data is not input
N
(T.GROOVE) Note : US46 is enabled only when US1 bit 1 = 1.
US46
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-361
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
J30 J34 J38
d
136 137 130 Note :
ve
J2 J6 J10 J14 J18 J22 J26 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
(Fixed (Fixed (Fixed Not possible to
er
value) value) value) set G-codes
s
re
whose uses are
predefined.
ts
J31 J35 J39
gh
Calling type
1 1 2
J3 J7 J11 J15 J19 J23 J27 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
ri
(Fixed (Fixed (Fixed
1: G65 3: G66.1
value) value) value)
ll
.A
J4 J8 J12 J16 J20 J24 J28 J32 J36 J40 — — — — Invalid
N
O
TI
Setting Program
No.11 No.12 No.13 No.14 No.15 No.16 No.17 No.18 No.19 No.20 Unit Conditions Description
60
A range type
R
40
0 to Work number of
PO
J265 J269 J273 J277 J281 J285 J289 J293 J297 J301 — M, E Immediate the program to be
29
999999999 called
R
o.
The G-code
O
N
number to be used
C
Note :
ri
ZA
J266 J270 J274 J278 J282 J286 J290 J294 J298 J302 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Se
Not possible to
A
set G-codes
IM
Calling type
ZA
J267 J271 J275 J279 J283 J287 J291 J295 J299 J303 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
A
1: G65 3: G66.1
M
J268 J272 J276 J280 J284 J288 J292 J296 J300 J304 — — — — Invalid
YA
3
01
Setting Program
No.21 No.22 No.23 No.24 No.25 No.26 No.27 No.28 No.29 No.30 Unit Conditions Description
range type
)2
0 to Work number of
(c
J305 J309 J313 J317 J321 J325 J329 J333 J337 J341 — M, E Immediate the program to be
999999999 called
ht
The G-code
ig
number to be used
yr
Note :
C
J306 J310 J314 J318 J322 J326 J330 J334 J338 J342 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to
set G-codes
whose uses are
predefined.
Calling type
J307 J311 J315 J319 J323 J327 J331 J335 J339 J343 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
1: G65 3: G66.1
J308 J312 J316 J320 J324 J328 J332 J336 J340 J344 — — — — Invalid
2-362
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO
Setting Program
No.31 No.32 No.33 No.34 No.35 No.36 No.37 No.38 No.39 No.40 Unit Conditions Description
range type
0 to Work number of
J345 J349 J353 J357 J361 J365 J369 J373 J377 J381 — M, E Immediate the program to be
999999999 called
The G-code
number to be used
for program call
Note :
J346 J350 J354 J358 J362 J366 J370 J374 J378 J382 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to
set G-codes
whose uses are
d .
predefined.
ve
Calling type
er
J347 J351 J355 J359 J363 J367 J371 J375 J379 J383 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
s
1: G65 3: G66.1
re
J348 J352 J356 J360 J364 J368 J372 J376 J380 J384 — — — — Invalid
ts
gh
ri
Setting Program
No.41 No.42 No.43 No.44 No.45 No.46 No.47 No.48 No.49 No.50 Unit Conditions Description
range type
ll
.A
0 to Work number of
J385 J389 J393 J397 J401 J405 J409 J413 J417 J421 — M, E Immediate the program to be
N
999999999 called
O
The G-code
TI
number to be used
60
Note :
PO
29
J386 J390 J394 J398 J402 J406 J410 J414 J418 J422 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to
R
o.
set G-codes
O
N
predefined.
al
K
ri
Calling type
ZA
J387 J391 J395 J399 J403 J407 J411 J415 J419 J423 — 0 to 3
1: G65 3: G66.1
A
IM
J388 J392 J396 J400 J404 J408 J412 J416 J420 J424 — — — — Invalid
K
ZA
Setting Program
No.51 No.52 No.53 No.54 No.55 No.56 No.57 No.58 No.59 No.60 Unit Conditions Description
A
range type
M
0 to Work number of
YA
J433 J437 J441 J445 J449 J453 J457 J461 J465 J469 — M, E Immediate the program to be
999999999 called
3
The G-code
01
number to be used
)2
J434 J438 J442 J446 J450 J454 J458 J462 J466 J470 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to
ht
set G-codes
ig
predefined.
op
Calling type
C
J435 J439 J443 J447 J451 J455 J459 J463 J467 J471 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
1: G65 3: G66.1
J436 J440 J444 J448 J452 J456 J460 J464 J468 J472 — — — — Invalid
2-363
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
are predefined.
d
ve
J43 J47 J51 J55 J59 Calling type
er
0 0 0 0 0 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
1: G65 3: G66.1
s
(Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value)
re
J44 J48 J52 J56 J60 Parameter for system
ts
0 0 0 0 0 — — — — internal setting
Setting prohibited
gh
(Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value)
ri
ll
Setting Program
.A
No. 6 No. 7 No. 8 No. 9 No. 10 Unit Conditions Description
range type
N
J61
O
0 to Work number of the
100000002 J65 J69 J73 J77 — M, E Immediate
TI
999999999 program to be called
(Fixed value)
60
J62 Note :
154 J66 J70 J74 J78 — 0 to 9999 M, E Immediate
R
o.
(Fixed value)
N
are predefined.
al
K
ri
ZA
J64
0 J68 J72 J76 J80 — — — — Invalid
K
(Fixed value)
ZA
A
M
Setting Program
No.11 No.12 No.13 No.14 No.15 No.16 No.17 No.18 No.19 No.20 Unit Conditions Description
YA
range type
0 to Work number of the
3
J145 J149 J153 J157 J161 J165 J169 J173 J177 J181 — M, E Immediate
program to be called
01
999999999
The M-code number to
)2
Note :
ht
J146 J150 J154 J158 J162 J166 J170 J174 J178 J182 — 0 to 9999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to set
ig
are predefined.
op
Calling type
C
J147 J151 J155 J159 J163 J167 J171 J175 J179 J183 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
1: G65 3: G66.1
J148 J152 J156 J160 J164 J168 J172 J176 J180 J184 — — — — Invalid
2-364
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO
Setting Program
No.21 No.22 No.23 No.24 No.25 No.26 No.27 No.28 No.29 No.30 Unit range type
Conditions Description
.
Calling type
d
J475 J479 J483 J487 J491 J495 J499 J503 J507 J511 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
ve
1: G65 3: G66.1
er
J476 J480 J484 J488 J492 J496 J500 J504 J508 J512 — — — — Invalid
s
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-365
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
—
J89
to
J107
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
When updating the model with the SAFETY SHIELD function at power-on,
gh
if “model update completion check interval (300 ms) * the number of
retrials” counting from the start of update is exceeded, it will be regarded
ri
as a failure in model update and alarm 1106 SAFETY SHIELD FAILURE
ll
Maximum number of retrials to update the (3, , ) will be output.
.A
model with the SAFETY SHIELD function 0 or less : 50 times
N
J108 1 or above : The setting value (J108) is regarded as the number of
O
TI
retrials.
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit Times
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-366
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO
Set the chuck reference position 1 on the No. 2 spindle side or the NC
tailstock position with respect to the machine zero point of the upper turret.
Use BA79 to BA86 for machines with the No. 2 spindle set as System 2.
Setting the chuck reference position 1 on the No. 2 spindle side
Machine zero point
of the upper turret
J111 J109
d.
ve
er
Barrier setup chuck reference position 1 on
s
J110
re
the No. 2 spindle side
J109 Barrier setup NC tailstock position
ts
to
gh
J112
J112
ri
ll
.A
Setting the NC tailstock position
N
Machine zero point
of the upper turret
O
TI
60
A J111
R
40
PO
29
J110
R
J109
o.
O
N
Program type M, E
al
Conditions Immediate
ri
ZA
Se
Set the chuck reference position 2 on the No. 2 spindle side with respect
K
Use BA79 to BA86 for machines with the No. 2 spindle set as System 2.
A
to J115 J113
01
J116
)2
J114
(c
ht
Program type M, E
ig
Conditions Immediate
yr
J116
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
op
2-367
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Program type M, E
er
Conditions Immediate
s
Unit —
re
Setting range 1 to 999
ts
gh
Amount of offset for height axis rotational center offset (K124, K128) of the
rotary axis for the tool
ri
<If the first rotary axis rotates for tool control>
ll
.A
Set the amount of offset for the distance (K124) from the rotational center
of the tool control rotary axis (at the tool side) in the direction of the height
N
Amount of offset for height axis rotational
O
axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the opposite
center offset (K124, K128) of the rotary axis
TI
side).
60
K124 + J121
PO
29
O
N
Set the amount of offset for the distance (K128) from the spindle holder
C
al
end in the direction of the height axis to the rotational center of the tool
K
Program type E
control rotary axis (at the tool side).
ri
ZA
* Height axis rotational center offset of the rotary axis at the tool side =
A
Setting range — * This parameter can be altered by using system variable #6022.
K
2-368
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO
Set the delay time before actually turning the enable signal ON/OFF after
the execution of the M code for turning the SPRINT control enable signal
ON/OFF.
SPRINT control enable signal ON/OFF J125: Enable signal ON delay time
delay time [Option] J126: Enable signal OFF delay time
J125
J126
d .
ve
Program type —
er
Conditions Immediate
s
Unit ms
re
Setting range 99999999 to 99999999
ts
gh
Set the device number that outputs the SPRINT control start signal.
ri
ll
Note :
.A
1. A decimal number must be set with this parameter. Convert the
SPRINT control start signal assigned
N
assigned device number (hexadecimal) into a decimal and set the
device [Option]
O
decimal number.
TI
J127 Example :
60
A
When this is assigned to device Y650:
R
40
PO
Program type —
o.
O
N
Conditions Immediate
C
al
ZA
Set the device number that outputs the SPRINT control select signal.
IM
K
Note :
ZA
SPRINT control select signal assigned 1. A decimal number must be set with this parameter. Convert the
device [Option] assigned device number (hexadecimal) into a decimal and set the
A
M
decimal number.
J128
YA
Example :
When this is assigned to device Y650:
3
Program type —
2. If "0" is set, the signal is not output.
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Set the distance from the rotation center of the lower turret to the end face
of the chuck on the No. 1 turning spindle, with the Z-axis located at the
op
Z-axis stroke for the teaching of lower turret Chuck end face
tool Reference workpiece zero point
J130
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in J130
Setting range –99999999 to 99999999
2-369
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the ID number of the M-code for making the interference check
function valid/invalid.
.
Program type M, E J139: Tool model interference check invalid
d
ve
Conditions Immediate J140: Tool model interference check valid
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Select whether the M-code registered in parameter J131–J138 to make
gh
the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid during
automatic operation is to be output from the NC to the PLC ladder.
ri
0: Invalid (No output to the PLC ladder)
ll
.A
1: Valid (Output to the PLC ladder)
Selecting whether to output the M-code for
N
making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY 76543210
O
TI
SHIELD function valid/invalid during M-code registered in J131
60
automatic operation A
J141 M-code registered in J132
R
40
PO
C
al
Program type M, E
ri
ZA
Conditions Immediate
A
Selecting whether to output the M-code for 0: Invalid (No output to the PLC ladder)
YA
automatic operation
01
(bit 0)
(bit 1) M-code registered in J139
)2
(c
Conditions Immediate
ig
yr
Unit —
op
Setting range 0, 1
C
2-370
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO
.
Program type M, E
d
M code registered in J551
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Used in the manual programming unit and subprogram unit (EIA/ISO)
gh
1: Cancel
ri
Method to handle the tool offset data when
ll
the program is returned to a MAZATROL
.A
program with the tool offset function set
N
J143 valid in an EIA/ISO subprogram
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
Select the reference of the value to be input when teaching the tool nose
ri
ZA
Se
Selection of the lower turret tool teaching 1: Parameter J130: Z-axis stroke for teaching
K
J143
A
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions
01
Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0 : Do not wait
In reference point return operation (G28,
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-371
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Fixed value
—
J143
(bit 3)
Program type —
.
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
J143
N
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
ZA
Se
(G23/G22)
ZA
J143
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
—
C
J143
(bit 7)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-372
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO
Tool interference check type on the TOOL DATA, TOOL LAYOUT and
VISUAL TOOL MANAGEMENT displays
0: Magazine-type tool interference check
1: TOOL HIVE-type tool interference check
Tool interference check type
J144
(bit 0)
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Overwriting of tool life data (maximum allowable wear, life time, use time,
gh
life count, use count) when parameter L57 is set to 1 (tool data overwriting
ri
during automatic operation valid)
ll
0: Possible
.A
Tool life data overwrite during automatic
1: Impossible
operation
N
J144
O
TI
(bit 2)
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 0, 1
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
K
J145
to
A
M
J184
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 99999999
2-373
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
re
Setting range 99999999
ts
Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis offset for ID (both sides), X-axis
gh
offset for groove width)
ri
ll
Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis
.A
offset for ID (both sides), X-axis offset for
groove width)
N
J237
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
ZA
Se
groove width)
ZA
J238
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
Setting range
ht
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 99999999
2-374
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO
Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis offset for groove width, offset for
ID groove)
J240
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
re
Setting range 99999999
ts
For any two axes that run on the same slideway, the maximum distance
gh
that those axes can be separated from each other is set to prevent
damage to the way covers. If the two axes are going to be separated
ri
beyond the value set for this parameter, a software limit alarm is output to
ll
stop the axis movement. Using parameters J251 to J254, the maximum
.A
separating distances can be set for up to four axes.
N
O
TI
Set the machine coordinate of the check target axis, set at parameters
60
L117 to L120, existing at the permissible most separated position from the
A
check reference axis, set at parameters L113 to L116, which is located at
R
40
In the example shown below, if the W-axis and the Z2-axis are defined
N
as the check reference axis and the check target axis, respectively, set
al
ZA
J254: 4th set of axes separated position from the W-axis, which is located at the home
J254
Se
direction will be invalid. Note that the check is possible only for the
IM
combination of NC axes.
K
ZA
Machine coordinate
W=0
A
M
Z2-axis
YA
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
2-375
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d.
ve
Arithmetic operation after G code G1 – 70 ······· Stop with alarm displayed (808 MIS-SET G CODE)
er
G [70 – 1] ···· Handled as G69
J261
s
re
(bit 0)
[ When bit 0 of parameter J261 is set to 1 ]
ts
G70 – 1 ······· Stop with alarm displayed (807 ILLEGAL FORMAT)
gh
G68 + 1······· Stop with alarm displayed (807 ILLEGAL FORMAT)
ri
G1 – 70 ······· Stop with alarm displayed (807 ILLEGAL FORMAT)
ll
.A
G [70 – 1] ···· Handled as G69
N
O
TI
60
Unit —
R
o.
Setting range 0, 1
N
0: Hidden
ri
ZA
Se
1: Displayed
A
TPC
J261
K
ZA
(bit 3)
A
M
Program type M
YA
Conditions Immediate
3
Unit —
01
Setting range 0, 1
)2
(c
to
J424
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-376
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
For details, refer to the explanation for M-code macroprogram call.
gh
ri
ll
.A
M-code macroprogram call
J473
N
to
O
TI
J512
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
Setting prohibited
A
IM
K
—
J513
ZA
to
A
M
J530
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-377
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Amount of correction for height axis rotational center offset (K233, K237)
of the tool control rotary axis
<If the first rotary axis rotates for tool control>
Set the amount of offset for the distance (K233) from the rotational center
of the tool control rotary axis (at the tool side) in the direction of the height
axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the opposite
Amount of correction for height axis side).
rotational center offset (K233, K237) of the * Height axis rotational center offset of the rotary axis at the tool side =
tool control rotary axis (tool tip point control) K233 + J531
J531
d .
ve
<If the second rotary axis rotates for tool control>
er
Set the amount of offset for the distance (K237) from the spindle holder
s
end in the direction of the height axis to the rotational center of the tool
re
control rotary axis (at the tool side).
ts
* Height axis rotational center offset of the rotary axis at the tool side =
gh
Program type E K237 + J531
ri
Conditions After stop of movement * This parameter can be altered by using system variable #6022.
ll
Unit 0.0001 mm
.A
Setting range —
N
O
For setting SPRINT interface (option), fixed value
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
—
J533
R
o.
to
N
J540
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Program type —
A
Conditions —
IM
Unit —
K
Setting range —
ZA
M code setting for temporarily J550: Temporarily disable the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function
disabling/canceling disabled status of
3
in automatic operation
01
Program type E
yr
Conditions Immediate
op
Unit —
C
2-378
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-3-11 Machine parameter MEASURE (K)
Distance from the center of the C-axis (spindle) to the nose of the tool
Z
Tool
K1
d .
K1
ve
X
er
Spindle
s
center
re
K1
Program type E
ts
gh
Conditions Immediate
ri
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Y
ll
Setting range 0 to 99999999
.A
The minimum rotational angle of the C-axis at shaping block connections
N
Rotational angle of the C-axis at block connections:
O
The C-axis does not rotate if l l < K2.
TI
60
A
R
40
90°
Minimum rotational angle
PO
29
K2
R
K2
o.
180°
N
0° If –K2 K2,
C
–K2
ri
ZA
Program type E
Se
Conditions Immediate
IM
270°
Unit 0.001° –
K
2-379
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
X Y Z B C V
M1
M2
d .
・
ve
Identification number of the shaping control ・
er
axis
s
When there is an axis for which data is not set on the MACHINE
re
PARAMETER display (“FEED VEL.” (M), “TIME CONST.” (N), etc.),
K3
ts
where the axis data is set, as shown below, set the identification number
gh
of the shaping axis as follows:
ri
If the value set at parameter K105 bit 6 is:
ll
“0”, set “6”.
.A
Counting of the axis number starts with “1” and the axis for which the
data is not set is not included when counting the axis number.
N
O
“1”, set “7”.
TI
Counting of the axis number starts with “1” and the axis for which the
60
PO
Set the type of the axis which has been set on this parameter to the
R
Conditions Immediate
o.
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 3 to 13
K
ri
ZA
Unbalanced axis
ZA
K7
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 1, 2, 4
ht
Set the waiting time before the speed attainment signal is turned ON after
ig
thread cutting.
op
C
K8
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 65000
2-380
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Fixed value
K10
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Set this parameter to change the display language.
gh
Setting Language Setting Language
ri
0 English 12 Portuguese
ll
.A
1 Japanese 13 Danish
N
2 German 14 Czech
O
3 French 15 Turkish
TI
4 Italian 16 Polish
60
5
A Spanish 17 Romanian
R
40
6 Norwegian 18 Hungarian
29
8 Finnish 20 Slovak
N
Chinese Chinese
al
9 21
K
ZA
10 Dutch 22 Slovenian
Se
11 Korean 25 Bulgarian
IM
K
—
ht
ig
K12
yr
op
C
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-381
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
1. Workpiece measurement
Sensor path
fa
K13
Measurement skip feed rate (X-axis, Z-axis)
Workpiece
K13
Measurement stroke (K19)
fa: Measurement approach
Program type M
.
speed (K14)
d
NM211-00233
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit mm/min
s
2. Tool tip measurement
re
Setting range 0 to 20000
Tool path
ts
gh
ri
K13
ll
Measurement approach speed (X-axis,
.A
Z-axis) Sensor
N
K14
O
Measurement stroke (K20)
TI
60
A NM211-00234
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Unit mm/min
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
Sensor path
A
IM
[1]
Measurement skip speed (C-axis)
K
ZA
[3]
K15 [1], [3] : Rapid feed
A
speed (K16)
YA
[4] : K15
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
NM211-00235
)2
Unit °/min
(c
K16
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit °/min
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-382
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
.
3. Alarm will be caused in cases below.
d
ve
1 – 2
Compensation data > 100 K18
s er
1 – 2
re
100 K18 > Compensation data
ts
where 1 = Tolerance upper limit
gh
Program type M, E 2 = Tolerance lower limit (Specified in program)
ri
Conditions Immediate
ll
.A
Unit % With tool measurement
1. Tool compensation will be applied in the cases below.
N
Setting range 0 to 100
O
100 K18 Compensation data 100 K17
TI
60
A
100 K17 Compensation data 100 K18
R
40
PO
29
o.
C
al
(upper limit)
ZA
Compensation data > 100 K18
Se
K18
A
IM
radius/Z-axis direction)
A
(Specified in program)
M
YA
Program type M, E
Note :
Conditions Immediate
3
a
ig
a : Approach point
yr
Measurement region
c
Program type M
K19
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in d NM211-00259
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-383
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
K20
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate TOOL EYE TOOL EYE
reference reference
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in point #4 point #3
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
During approach operation to measurement start point, if touch sensor is
gh
actuated, the C-axis will rotate by angle determined by the measurement
object shape angle and setting value K21.
ri
Example : CW programmed as measurement direction
ll
Coefficient to determine rotation angle
.A
when retrying measurement C reference
face
N
ON : Measurement object shape
K21
O
angle
TI
: × K21/100
60
A
R
40
in this direction
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit % NM211-00261
N
K
ri
K22
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit Times
(c
measurement
K23
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Times
Setting range 0 to 99999
2-384
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
—
K24
to
K28
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Delays master/slave axis position matching during automatic error
gh
correction (parameter K103 bit 1 = 0).
ri
ll
Simultaneous control:
.A
Delay counter for automatic correction of
synchronizing errors
N
K29
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit 1.7 ms
N
K
ri
Specify the approach speed and pre-measuring speed for laser tool length
ZA
Se
measurement
IM
length measurement
to K33 Pre-measuring speed for laser tool
A
M
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Specify the pre-measuring spindle speed for laser tool length (diameter)
ig
measurement.
yr
op
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-385
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
K36
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
The upper-limit value of the feed rates available while the external
gh
deceleration signal is ON
ri
Feedrate
ll
.A
External deceleration speed
N
K37
O
TI
60
K37 A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
External
Conditions After stop of movement ON
deceleration
R
o.
signal
O
Unit mm/min
N
K
ri
macroprogram appointment
A
macroprogram appointment
ZA
K38
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate Note : This parameter is valid only when bit 2 of parameter K105 is 1.
)2
Unit —
(c
macroprogram appointment
yr
macroprogram appointment
K39
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate Note : This parameter is valid only when bit 3 of parameter K105 is 1.
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 999999999
2-386
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
K40
d .
1. This parameter is valid only when bit 4 of parameter K105 is 1.
ve
Conditions Immediate
2. See the description of parameter K56 for details of the addresses
er
Unit —
available with the second auxiliary function.
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999999
ts
The feed rate during axis movement by G31 (skip function)
gh
If the same block as that of G31 contains an F command, then that feed
rate becomes valid.
ri
ll
.A
G31 skipping speed
N
K41
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit mm/min
N
K
ri
The feed rate during axis movement by G31.1 (multi-step skip function)
ZA
Se
If the same block as that of G31.1 contains an F command, then that feed
A
K42
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Unit mm/min
(c
The feed rate during axis movement by G31.2 (multi-step skip function)
ig
If the same block as that of G31.2 contains an F command, then that feed
yr
K43
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 120000
2-387
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
The feed rate during axis movement by G31.3 (multi-step skip function)
If the same block as that of G31.3 contains an F command, then that feed
rate becomes valid.
K44
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit mm/min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 120000
ts
The feed rate during axis movement by G31.4 (skip function)
gh
If the same block as that of G31.4 contains an F command, then that feed
ri
rate becomes valid.
ll
.A
G31.4 skipping speed
N
K45
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit mm/min
N
K
ri
A
IM
(Amount of drooping)
ZA
K46
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.0001 mm
(c
Specify the M-code that is output at the start and end of measurement in
ig
measurement
* If the set value is out of the range, this parameter is invalid. (Setting
K47
range: 100 to 998)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 100 to 998
2-388
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
K48
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 2
ts
Set the first number of the M-codes to be used for the M-code standby
gh
function.
ri
Example :
ll
To use M950 to M995 as the standby M-codes set “950” in K49 and “46”
.A
First number of the standby M-codes
in K50.
N
K49
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
N
K
ri
Set the total number of M-codes to be used for the M-code standby
ZA
Se
function.
A
IM
Example :
To use M950 to M995 as the standby M-codes set “950” in K49 and “46”
Total number of the standby M-codes
K
in K50.
ZA
K50
A
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
and is to be retried.
yr
K51
If workpiece measurement results
in an error and is to be retried
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement M-code output
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 1000
2-389
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
K52
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Set the type of vocal output language.
gh
Setting Language Setting Language
ri
0 English 11 Korean
ll
.A
1 Japanese 12 Portuguese
2 German 13 Danish
N
O
3 French 14 Czech
TI
4 Italian 15 Turkish
60
6 Norwegian 17 Rumanian
K53
PO
29
7 Swedish 18 Hungarian
R
8 Finnish 19 Russian
o.
O
N
Chinese (traditional
C
9 20 Slovakian
character)
al
ZA
Se
Note :
A
Program type M, E
IM
Output will be in English (0) if the selected value is for a language not
Conditions Immediate supported.
K
Unit —
ZA
Setting range 0 to 21
A
M
K54
ht
ig
yr
Program type M, E
op
Conditions Immediate
C
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 100
2-390
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
A vocal warning will be output if the value of the spindle load meter
exceeds the percentage value set in K55.
K55
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 0 to 200
ts
Select the address name of the second auxiliary function from among the
gh
following three types:
ri
Address name Setting (HEX)
ll
Name of second auxiliary function
.A
Invalid 0
A 41
N
K56
O
B 42
TI
C 43
60
Program type E A
R
40
Note :
Conditions At power on
PO
29
Do not use the same address for the axis name and the second auxiliary
Unit —
function.
R
o.
Hexadecimal two-digit
N
Setting range
C
0, 41, 42, 43
al
ZA
select the method of calling the macroprogram whose work number has
Se
2 G66 P
M
3 G66.1 P
YA
Program type M, E
Note : Valid only when bit 2 of K105 is 1.
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0 to 3
(c
select the method of calling the macroporgram whose work number has
ig
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 3
2-391
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
Note : Valid only when bit 4 of K105 is 1.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 3
ts
Fixed value (4)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
K60
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
A
IM
—
K
ZA
K61
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
K62
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-392
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
K63
Program type —
.
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Fixed value (2)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
K64
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
A
IM
—
K
ZA
K65
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
K66
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-393
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
K67
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Coordinate system with reference to which the offset amounts are to be
gh
used in tool length offset for the selected machining surface.
(For machines of five-surface machining by angular tools)
ri
0: Machine coordinate system
ll
Coordinate system in which the amount of
.A
tool offset becomes valid (for five-face 1: Workpiece coordinate system
machining by angular tools)
N
K68
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
coordinate interpolation C-axis rapid feed or cutting feed rate is clamped to M3.
ZA
(bit 1) The X-axis speed specified by M1/M3 is used for the C-axis.
M
C-axis rapid feed rate is clamped to M1 and the cutting feed rate is
Program type M, E
clamped to M3.
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
—
C
K68
(bit 3)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-394
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
—
K68
(bit 4)
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
0 : Invalid
ts
gh
1 : Valid
ri
ll
Override/dryrun speed valid/invalid when
.A
the G31 command is issued
K68
N
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
0: Invalid
ri
ZA
Se
1: Valid
A
IM
(bit 7)
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
K69
(bit 0)
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-395
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type E
d .
Conditions After stop of movement
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-3 is used as
ts
the skip signal:
gh
0: Not used as the skip signal
ri
1: Used as the skip signal
ll
G31.1 skip condition SKIP-3
.A
K69
N
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
Program type E
A
R
40
PO
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
ZA
K69
ZA
(bit 3)
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
K69
(bit 4)
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-396
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-6 is used as
ts
the skip signal:
gh
0: Not used as the skip signal
ri
1: Used as the skip signal
ll
G31.1 skip condition SKIP-6
.A
K69
N
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
Program type E
A
R
40
PO
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
ZA
K69
ZA
(bit 7)
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
K70
(bit 0)
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-397
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
Program type E
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-3 is used as
gh
the skip signal:
ri
0: Not used as the skip signal
ll
1: Used as the skip signal
.A
G31.2 skip condition SKIP-3
N
K70
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
K70
ZA
(bit 3)
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
K70
(bit 4)
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-398
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-6 is used as
gh
the skip signal:
ri
0: Not used as the skip signal
ll
1: Used as the skip signal
.A
G31.2 skip condition SKIP-6
K70
N
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
K70
ZA
(bit 7)
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
K71
(bit 0)
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-399
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
Program type E
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-3 is used as
gh
the skip signal:
ri
0: Not used as the skip signal
ll
1: Used as the skip signal
.A
G31.3 skip condition SKIP-3
N
K71
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
K71
ZA
(bit 3)
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
K71
(bit 4)
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-400
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
.
Program type E
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-6 is used as
gh
the skip signal:
ri
0: Not used as the skip signal
ll
1: Used as the skip signal
.A
G31.3 skip condition SKIP-6
N
K71
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
K71
A
(bit 7)
M
YA
Program type E
3
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
SKIP-2
op
SKIP-10
G31.4 skip conditions
C
SKIP-3
K72 SKIP-11
HR353
SKIP-5
SKIP-13
Program type E SKIP-6
SKIP-14
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Select the skip signal for the G31.4 command.
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-401
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
SKIP-2
G4 skip conditions SKIP-10 QX721
K73 SKIP-3
d.
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits
ts
Set the desired time from an emergency stop to the start of cutting off the
gh
contactor of the main power to the driving section during the execution of a
safety supervisory function when all-axis zero-speed confirmation is
ri
impossible.
ll
Emergency stop contactor cutoff time
.A
A contactor cutoff signal will be immediately output if all-axis zero-speed
(Safety supervisory function) confirmation is executable earlier than the set time.
N
K74
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit s
N
Setting range 0 to 60
al
K
ri
executed.
IM
K75
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
executed.
op
K76
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range &0 to &7F
2-402
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Enter the device number of the remote I/O device to be activated to input a
door open/closed status signal. The device of the entered serial device
number will be reserved according to the particular setting of K78 (the
parameter for setting the number of door switches).
Door switch input device
(Safety supervisory function)
Note : Door switch input will be invalid if “&0” is entered.
K77
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range &0 to &7F
ts
Set the number of doors for which the door open/closed status signal is to
gh
be output.
ri
ll
Number of door switches
.A
(Safety supervisory function)
N
K78
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
N
Setting range 0 to 16
al
K
ri
Set the filtering time for the speed that is to be monitored in a servo-off
ZA
Se
Supervisory speed filtering time during Note : Input of “0” means 200 ms.
servo-off
K
ZA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit 1.777 ms
(c
A vocal warning will be output when the value of the load meter for servo
ig
(Vocal output)
K80
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 200
2-403
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Fixed value
K81
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit ms
s
re
Setting range 0 to 32767
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
K82
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
ZA
Se
should not exceed the distance between software limit and mechanical
IM
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
Unit 0.00005 mm
(c
Maximum allowable amount of set with K84), compensation will be executed by dividing the interpolation
motion into multiple sections.
C
2-404
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
If the setting of K85 is from 1 to 300 ms, this setting will be used as the
linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the G32 threading block.
If the setting is outside the valid range, however, the normal linear
acceleration/deceleration time constant for G01 will be used.
Special linear acceleration/deceleration
time constant for threading
K85
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit ms
s
re
Setting range 0 to 32767
ts
Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
K87
N
to
O
TI
K89
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
The overriding value for return from the hole bottom during a synchronous
ZA
Se
tapping cycle
A
IM
K90
A
M
YA
Programmed × K90
feed rate 100
Program type E
3
01
valid.
yr
op
C
K91
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 127
2-405
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
K92
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 127
ts
Fixed value (2)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
K93
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
operation that has been stopped by tapping [ATC STOP], set this
A
operation has been stopped by [ATC 1: [ATC STOP] is not to be made invalid
ZA
K94 STOP]
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
1: Do not move.
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-406
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
Command code to be displayed in the MDI window when [W SUB] is
ts
selected in the MDI mode
gh
0: G110B2
ri
1: G110Z[B]2
ll
W-axis command code selection for MDI
.A
mode
K94
N
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
* This parameter is valid only when the program is created in the WPC
IM
executed
(bit 4)
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
0: Displayed
ht
ig
1: Not displayed
yr
block has expired Alarm 135 BLOCK START INTERLOCK is not displayed on the ALARM
K94 or ALARM HISTORY display.
(bit 5)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-407
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
.
execution
d
ve
0: Not performed
—
1: Performed
s er
K95 Coordinate system update during handle pulse
re
interrupt
ts
0: Not performed
gh
1: Performed
ri
Fixed value (0)
ll
Acceleration/deceleration time constant for handle
.A
pulse feed
N
0: Time constant for cutting feed
O
1: No time constant
TI
Software limits for G30 execution
60
Program type M, E
A 0: Invalid
R
40
1: Valid
PO
Conditions At power on
29
In-position check
R
Unit — 0: Invalid
o.
1: Valid
N
76543210
ri
ZA
0: Check
IM
1: Non-check
K
0: Smoothing
1: Distribution finish (equivalent to DEN)
A
M
1: Invalid
)2
G1 command mode
ht
0: Valid
ig
1: Invalid
yr
Unit —
Fixed G0 inclination
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-408
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Specify the name of the axis to be made parallel with respect to the
direction of the spindle when the angle of the B-axis is 0 degrees.
Program type M, E
d .
Note : If 0 is entered, the axis will be regarded as the Z-axis (&5A).
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit Hexadecimal, two digits
s
re
Setting range &41 to &5A
ts
Specify the name of the axis to be made orthogonal with respect to the
gh
direction of the spindle when the angle of the B-axis is 0 degrees.
ri
ll
B-axis misalignment correction
.A
Name of orthogonal axis
N
K98
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate Note : If 0 is entered, the axis will be regarded as the X-axis (&58).
R
o.
K
ri
A
IM
Dynamic offset
K
K99
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Specify the name of the axis to be made parallel with respect to the
ig
Dynamic offset
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit Hexadecimal, two digits
Setting range &41 to &5A
2-409
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the name of the axis to be made orthogonal with respect to the
rotational plane of the rotational axis to undergo dynamic offset.
Dynamic offset
Name of orthogonal axis
K101
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit Hexadecimal, two digits
s
re
Setting range &41 to &5A
ts
Fixed value (0)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
K102
N
(bit 0)
O
to
TI
(bit 2)
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
How to use the data of compensation for the sensing tool’s eccentricity
ZA
Se
ment.
IM
0: M Pro scheme
For workpiece measurement: No use of eccentricity settings; Use of
K
Compensation method for the sensing For coordinate measurement: Use of eccentricity setting for the direc-
M
tool’s eccentricity and stylus radius in tion of measuring feed; Use of stylus radius setting for transverse
YA
Full use of the eccentricity and stylus radius settings for both work-
01
(bit 3)
piece measurement and coordinate measurement.
)2
direction directions
op
Conditions Immediate
Coordinate 0 Valid Invalid Invalid Valid
Unit — measurement 1 Valid Valid Valid Valid
Setting range 0, 1
2-410
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Z-axis direction for setting the TPC relay points for a measurement unit.
0: Direction opposite to the program coordinate system
X
Z-axis direction for setting the TPC relay
points for a measurement unit
K102 Z
(bit 4)
1: Direction of the program coordinate system
X
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit — Z
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Barrier information for EIA/ISO programs is to be set
gh
0: in the relevant parameters,
ri
1: on the SET UP MANAGE. display.
ll
Barrier information setting for EIA/ISO
.A
programs
N
K102
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Whether or not, on the TOOL DATA display, the direction of rotation can
ZA
Se
0: No
Setting the direction of rotation for milling 1: Yes (Normal/Reverse)
K
tools
K102
ZA
(bit 6)
A
M
YA
Program type M
Conditions At power on
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
—
C
K102
(bit 7)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-411
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
Handling of the sign assigned to hobbing address D
(Note 1)
0: If plus (+), the workpiece spindle and the milling
spindle rotate in opposite directions.
If minus (–), both spindles rotate in the same
direction.
1: If plus (+), the workpiece spindle and the milling
spindle rotate in the same direction.
If minus (–), both spindles rotate in opposite
.
directions (MT Pro compatible).
d
ve
Synchronous control error auto-correction (Note 2)
er
0: Valid 1: Invalid
—
s
re
Fixed value
K103
ts
DDB micron unit
gh
0: Interpolation 1: Microns
ri
Fixed value
ll
Output of S-code and T-code at restart
.A
0: Invalid 1: Valid
N
* Set 0 for machining center specifications.
O
Whether FIXED PT can be selected at RETURN of
TI
60
1: Impossible to select
PO
29
R
o.
Unit — 2. Even with K103 bit 1 = 0, unless M17 bit 4 is set to 0 (linear axis) for
ri
ZA
2-412
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
76543210
Output of a laser measurement B-axis 0-degree
command after ATC
0: Output invalid
1: Output valid
Direction of the laser axis of the laser measuring
instrument
0: Depends on the setting of parameter L16.
L16 = 1: Parallel to the Y-axis,
L16 = 2: Parallel to the X-axis
d .
1: Depends on the setting of bit 2 in parameter
ve
K104.
er
Direction of the laser axis of the laser measuring
s
re
instrument
0: Parallel to the Y-axis
ts
1: Parallel to the X-axis
gh
Note :
ri
— This parameter is valid when K104 bit 1 = 1.
ll
.A
Voice Adviser (Vocal output function)
K104
N
0: Invalid
O
1: Valid
TI
60
A Type of voice
0: Male’s voice
R
40
PO
1: Female’s voice
29
0: Invalid
N
1: Valid
al
ZA
0: Alarm stop
IM
1: Operation is executed.
Feed rate for an approach to the starting point in
K
ZA
Conditions Immediate
approach at G0, or if the modal command is
Unit — other than G0, approach at G1
3
01
—
yr
op
K105
C
(bit 1)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-413
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Program type M, E
. d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Invalid
gh
1: Valid
ri
ll
.A
T-code macro call invalid/valid
N
K105
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Invalid
ZA
Se
1: Valid
A
IM
invalid/valid
ZA
K105
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
—
K105
(bit 5)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-414
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
d .
ve
X Y Z B C V
Program type E
er
M1
s
Conditions Immediate M2
re
— ・
Unit
ts
・
Setting range 0, 1
gh
ri
Fixed value (0)
ll
.A
N
O
—
TI
K105
60
(bit 7)
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type —
o.
O
N
Conditions —
C
al
Unit —
ri
ZA
Setting range —
Se
76543210
IM
interrupt
ZA
being executed.
ht
ig
Fixed value
op
C
2-415
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
—
K107
(bit 0)
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Polar coordinate interpolation in the condition that the rotational axis
gh
shape correction is valid
0: Corner judgment halfway through a block
ri
Corner judgment halfway through a block
ll
1: No corner judgment halfway through a block
.A
during polar coordinate interpolation where
rotary axis shape correction is valid
K107
N
* When this parameter is set to 1, the machine will undergo hard
O
(bit 4) acceleration when the moving axis changes partway through a block,
TI
which may cause machine vibrations.
60
A
* When this parameter is set to 0, optimum acceleration control works
R
40
Program type M, E during the operation of a block. In this condition, if the feed rate is high, it
PO
29
Conditions At power on may slow down at corners and the machining cycle time may be longer.
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
0: In radius values
ri
ZA
Se
1: In diameter values
A
K107
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-416
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
—
K107
(bit 7)
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Specify the maximum permissible error range for the master and slave
gh
axes for synchronous control (Tandem driving system).
ri
If the specified range is overstepped, alarm 141 EXCESS
SIMULTANEOUS ERROR will be displayed.
ll
Permissible error range for synchronous
.A
Note : Error checking will not occur if 0 is set.
control
N
K108
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
0.0001 mm
O
Unit
N
K
ri
Set the judgment angle near a singular point. The setting, if 0, will be
ZA
Se
handled as 1°.
A
IM
K110
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Unit °
(c
K111
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 1000
2-417
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
Rotary axis for
d
the tool
ve
Machine type 2nd rotary axis
for the tool
er
Tool
Workpiece
s
K113 Tool
re
Workpiece Table
ts
gh
Table Rotary axis
ri
for the table
ll
3 = Table tilt type
.A
N
Table
O
Tool
TI
1st rotary axis
60
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
Unit —
R
o.
Set the axis number of the horizontal axis in the rectangular coordinate
al
system.
ri
ZA
A setting of 0 is invalid.
Se
A
IM
K114
ZA
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0 to 16
(c
Set the axis number of the vertical axis in the rectangular coordinate
ht
system.
A setting of 0 is invalid.
ig
yr
K115
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16
2-418
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Set the axis number of the height axis in the rectangular coordinate
system.
A setting of 0 is invalid.
K116
Program type E
.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 16
ts
1 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the horizontal axis.
gh
2 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the vertical axis.
ri
3 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the height axis.
ll
12: 2nd rotary axis ...... Rotates about horizontal axis,
.A
1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about vertical axis.
N
13: 2nd rotary axis .... Rotates about horizontal axis,
Rotational direction of the rotary axis
O
1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about height axis.
TI
21: 2nd rotary axis ...... Rotates about vertical axis,
60
K117 A
1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about horizontal axis.
R
40
PO
Program type E
al
Conditions Immediate
ZA
Unit —
A
IM
Setting range —
Set the axis number of the first rotary axis.
K
A setting of 0 is invalid.
ZA
A
M
K121
3
01
)2
(c
Program type E
ht
Conditions Immediate
ig
Unit —
yr
Setting range 0 to 16
op
C
2-419
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
<If the first rotary axis rotates for tool control>
gh
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
ri
the tool side) in the direction of the vertical axis to the rotational center of
the tool control rotary axis (at the opposite side).
ll
Vertical axis rotational center offset of the
.A
first rotary axis <If the first rotary axis rotates for table control>
N
K123 Set the distance from the spindle tip point in the direction of the horizontal
O
axis to the rotational center of the table control rotary axis (at the opposite
TI
side) when all axes are in the machine home position.
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.0001 mm
O
N
ZA
Se
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
A
the tool side) in the direction of the height axis to the rotational center of
IM
Note :
ZA
Height axis rotational center offset of the axis rotational center offset is equal to K124 + J121 (amount of height
M
first rotary axis axis rotational center offset of the rotary axis on the tool side).
YA
K124
<If the first rotary axis rotates for table control>
3
01
Set the distance from the spindle tip point in the direction of the height axis
)2
to the rotational center of the table control rotary axis (at the opposite side)
when all axes are in the machine home position.
(c
ht
Note :
ig
Program type E When K113 = 2 (machine type: mix type), K124 has the same meaning
yr
as BA62 (amount of offset for the B-axis - spindle). In the case of inch
Conditions Immediate
op
specifications, multiply the BA62 value by 2.54, round off to the nearest
whole number, and enter this value to K124.
C
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±99999999
2-420
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
K125
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 16
ts
<If the second rotary axis rotates for tool control>
gh
Set the distance from the spindle holder end in the direction of the
ri
horizontal axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the
tool side).
ll
Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the
.A
second rotary axis <If the second rotary axis rotates for table control>
N
K126 Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis in
O
the direction of the horizontal axis to the rotational center of the table
TI
control rotary axis (at the workpiece side) when all axes are in the machine
60
A
home position.
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.0001 mm
O
N
ZA
Se
Set the distance from the spindle holder end in the direction of the vertical
A
axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the tool side).
IM
Vertical axis rotational center offset of the <If the second rotary axis rotates for table control>
K
second rotary axis Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis in
ZA
K127 the direction of the vertical axis to the rotational center of the table control
A
rotary axis (at the workpiece side) when all axes are in the machine home
M
position.
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit 0.0001 mm
)2
Set the distance from the spindle holder end in the direction of the height
yr
axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the tool side).
op
Height axis rotational center offset of the <If the second rotary axis rotates for table control>
C
second rotary axis Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis in
K128 the direction of the height axis to the rotational center of the table control
rotary axis (at the workpiece side) when all axes are in the machine home
position.
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±99999999
2-421
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
When the first rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: center position
deviation in the vertical axis direction
When the first rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: center position
deviation in the horizontal axis direction
Position deviation 1 of the first rotary axis When the first rotary axis rotates about height axis: center position
deviation in the horizontal axis direction
K129
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm
s
re
Setting range ±30000
ts
When the first rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: center position
gh
deviation in the height axis direction
ri
When the first rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: center position
deviation in the height axis direction
ll
.A
Position deviation 2 of the first rotary axis When the first rotary axis rotates about height axis: center position
deviation in the vertical axis direction
N
K130
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit
O
0.0001 mm
N
K
ri
When the second rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: center position
ZA
Se
When the second rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: center position
IM
axis When the second rotary axis rotates about height axis: center position
ZA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.0001 mm
(c
When the second rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: center position
ig
When the second rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: center position
op
When the second rotary axis rotates about height axis: center position
axis
deviation in the vertical axis direction
K132
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±30000
2-422
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Set the X-axis deviation of the spindle center position. Normally set 0
because the zero point is determined with respect to the spindle center
position. This parameter is invalid with the 3-axis machine, table tilt type
machine, and 4-axis machine of table-side rotation type.
X-axis position deviation at the spindle
center position
K133
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm
s
re
Setting range ±30000
ts
Set the Y-axis deviation of the spindle center position. Normally set 0
gh
because the coordinate origin is determined with respect to the spindle
center position. This parameter is invalid with the 3-axis machine, table tilt
ri
type machine, and 4-axis machine of table-side rotation type.
ll
Y-axis position deviation at the spindle
.A
center position
N
K134
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit
O
0.0001 mm
N
K
ri
When the first rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: angle deviation
ZA
Se
When the first rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: angle deviation about
IM
horizontal axis
Angle deviation 1 of the first rotary axis
K
centerline When the first rotary axis rotates about height axis: angle deviation about
ZA
vertical axis
K135
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.0001
(c
When the first rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: angle deviation
ig
When the first rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: angle deviation about
op
height axis
Angle deviation 2 of the first rotary axis
C
When the first rotary axis rotates about height axis: angle deviation about
centerline
horizontal axis
K136
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001
Setting range ±10000
2-423
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
When the second rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: angle deviation
about vertical axis
When the second rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: angle deviation
about horizontal axis
Angle deviation 1 of the second rotary axis
When the second rotary axis rotates about height axis: angle deviation
centerline
about vertical axis
K137
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001
s
re
Setting range ±10000
ts
When the second rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: angle deviation
gh
about height axis
ri
When the second rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: angle deviation
about height axis
ll
Angle deviation 2 of the second rotary axis
.A
centerline When the second rotary axis rotates about height axis: angle deviation
about horizontal axis
N
K138
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit
O
0.0001
N
K
ri
Set the X-axis angle deviation of the spindle centerline. This parameter is
ZA
Se
invalid with the 3-axis machine, table tilt type machine, and 4-axis machine
A
centerline
ZA
K139
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.0001
(c
Set the Y-axis angle deviation of the spindle centerline. This parameter is
ig
invalid with the 3-axis machine, table tilt type machine, and 4-axis machine
yr
centerline
K140
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001
Setting range ±10000
2-424
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Set the machine type for the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis
sets for 5-axis machining.
1: Tool tilt type
2: Mix type
3: Table tilt type
Example :
d.
ve
Tool control
er
Machine type (2nd set of axes) rotary axis
Second tool
s
re
control rotary axis Tool
K225 Workpiece
ts
Tool
gh
Workpiece
Table
ri
Table
ll
Table control
.A
rotary axis
N
3 = Table tilt type
O
TI
Table
60
Program type E
R
o.
Conditions Immediate
O
N
Unit —
al
ZA
Se
Set the axis number of the horizontal axis in the rectangular coordinate
A
system for the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
IM
K226
M
YA
3
Program type E
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 16
ht
ig
Set the axis number of the vertical axis in the rectangular coordinate
yr
system for the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
op
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16
2-425
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the axis number of the height axis in the rectangular coordinate
system for the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
machining. Setting 0 disables the function.
Axis number of the height axis in the
rectangular coordinate system
(2nd set of axes)
K228
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 16
ts
1 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the horizontal
gh
axis.
ri
2 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the vertical axis.
ll
3 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the height axis.
.A
12 : The second rotary axis rotates around the horizontal axis and the first
N
rotary axis around the vertical axis.
Rotational direction of the rotary axis
O
13 : The second rotary axis rotates around the horizontal axis and the first
TI
(2nd set of axes)
rotary axis around the height axis.
60
K229 A
21 : The second rotary axis rotates around the vertical axis and the first
R
40
23 : The second rotary axis rotates around the vertical axis and the first
R
o.
31 : The second rotary axis rotates around the height axis and the first
al
Program type E
ri
ZA
32 : The second rotary axis rotates around the height axis and the first
Se
Unit —
IM
(For the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
Setting range — machining)
K
Set the axis number of the first rotary axis for the 2nd set of axes when
ZA
selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis machining. Setting 0 disables the
A
function.
M
YA
K230
)2
(c
Program type E
ht
ig
Conditions Immediate
yr
Unit —
op
Setting range 0 to 16
C
2-426
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
<If the first rotary axis is the tool control rotary axis>
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
the tool side) in the direction of the horizontal axis to the rotational center
of the tool control rotary axis (at the root side).
Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the
first rotary axis (2nd set of axes) <If the first rotary axis is the table control rotary axis>
K231 Set the distance from the spindle nose point to the rotational center of the
table control rotary axis (at the root side) in the horizontal axis direction,
with all axes at the machine zero points.
(For the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
Program type E
.
machining)
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
<If the first rotary axis is the tool control rotary axis>
gh
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
ri
the tool side) to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the
root side) in the vertical axis direction.
ll
Vertical axis rotational center offset of the
.A
first rotary axis (2nd set of axes) <If the first rotary axis is the table control rotary axis>
N
K232 Set the distance from the spindle nose point to the rotational center of the
O
table control rotary axis (at the root side) in the vertical axis direction, with
TI
all axes at the machine zero points.
60
A
(For the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
R
40
Program type E
PO
machining)
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.0001 mm
O
N
K
ri
<If the first rotary axis is the tool control rotary axis>
ZA
Se
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
A
the tool side) to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the
IM
Note :
ZA
In the case of machines with the capability of Maza-Check, the height axis
A
Height axis rotational center offset of the rotational center offset of the rotary axis on the tool side).
YA
K233 <If the first rotary axis is the table control rotary axis>
3
01
Set the distance from the spindle nose point to the rotational center of the
)2
table control rotary axis (at the root side) in the height axis direction, with
all axes at the machine zero points.
(c
ht
Note :
ig
When K225 = 2 (machine type: mix type), K233 has the same meaning as
yr
BA62 (the offset for the B-axis - spindle). In the case of inch
Program type E
specifications, multiply the BA62 value by 2.54, round off to the nearest
op
Conditions Immediate whole number, and enter this value for K233.
C
Unit 0.0001 mm (For the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
Setting range ±99999999 machining)
2-427
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the axis number of the second rotary axis for the 2nd set of axes when
selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis machining. Setting 0 disables the
function.
K234
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 16
ts
<If the second rotary axis rotates for tool control>
gh
Set the distance from the spindle holder end to the rotational center of the
ri
tool control rotary axis (at the tool side) in the horizontal axis direction.
ll
Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the <If the second rotary axis is the table control rotary axis>
.A
second rotary axis (2nd set of axes) Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis
N
K235 (at the root side) to the rotational center of the table control rotary axis (at
O
the workpiece side) in the horizontal axis direction, with all axes at the
TI
machine zero points.
60
A
(For the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
R
40
Program type E
PO
machining)
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.0001 mm
O
N
K
ri
Set the distance from the spindle holder end to the rotational center of the
A
tool control rotary axis (at the tool side) in the vertical axis direction.
IM
Vertical axis rotational center offset of the <If the second rotary axis is the table control rotary axis>
K
second rotary axis (2nd set of axes) Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis
ZA
K236 (at the root side) to the rotational center of the table control rotary axis (at
A
the workpiece side) in the vertical axis direction, with all axes at the
M
(For the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
Program type E machining)
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.0001 mm
(c
Set the distance from the spindle holder end to the rotational center of the
yr
tool control rotary axis (at the tool side) in the height axis direction.
op
Height axis rotational center offset of the <If the second rotary axis is the table control rotary axis>
C
second rotary axis (2nd set of axes) Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis
K237 (at the root side) to the rotational center of the table control rotary axis (at
the workpiece side) in the height axis direction, with all axes at the
machine zero points.
(For the 2nd set of axes when selecting multiple axis sets for 5-axis
Program type E machining)
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±99999999
2-428
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Fixed value
K238
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
K239
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
A
IM
orbit machining
ZA
K242
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Set the M code number of the forward rotation command for orbit
ig
machining.
yr
op
K243
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 999
2-429
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the M code number of the reverse rotation command for orbit
machining.
K244
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
Set the M code number of the rotation stop command for orbit machining.
gh
ri
ll
.A
M code number of the rotation stop
command for orbit machining
N
O
K245
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type E
29
Unit —
N
C
al
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-430
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
d .
the start point
ve
Start
er
point
s
Permissible error at involute interpolation
re
end point
ts
K246
gh
ri
ll
Base circle
.A
X
0
N
O
TI
If the error L becomes larger than the value set for this parameter, the
60
A
alarm 817 INCORRECT ARC DATA occurs at the start point of the
R
40
involute interpolation.
PO
29
R
o.
Note :
O
N
Program type E When 0 is set, the permissible error at the end point becomes 0,
al
meaning that the alarm 817 INCORRECT ARC DATA occurs unless the
K
Conditions Immediate
ri
ZA
curve that passes the start point completely coincides with the curve that
Se
Setting range 0 to 99999999 When a value outside the setting range is set, 0 is assumed.
IM
to maintain the acceleration within the value set for this parameter.
A
Note :
M
curvature radius.
01
)2
Program type E
(c
ht
Conditions Immediate
ig
2
Unit 0.1 mm/sec
yr
2-431
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit mm/min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Sets the lower limit for the involute interpolation override. When this
gh
parameter is set, the override is adjusted according to the curvature radius
ri
so that the feedrate at the cutting position becomes the specified feedrate,
with respect to the feedrate at the tool center path.
ll
.A
Involute interpolation override lower limit Note :
N
When this parameter is set to 0 or a value outside the setting range, the
O
K249 involute interpolation override function is disabled and the override is
TI
always set to 100% during tool radius offset.
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
C
al
ZA
Sets the time to wait before the zero-speed signal of the hobbing axis
Se
controlled hobbing)
K250
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit ms
(c
During operation other than rapid feed (G00), the tool is said to be in a
ig
singular posture when the vector normal to machining face and the tool
yr
posture vector are parallel. When the orientations of the two vectors are
op
posture.
cutting point command mode (for other than
rapid feed)
* When 0 is set, 500 (0.0000500°) is assumed.
K251
* For rapid feed (G00), parameter K254 is used.
Program type E
In the cutting point
Conditions
command mode [Related parameters]
Unit 0.0000001° K254
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-432
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Fixed value
K252
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Set the angle of the mill spindle when the tip of the tool in the mill spindle is
gh
oriented in the +X-axis direction in orbit machining.
ri
ll
Angle that sets the mill spindle tool tip in the
.A
+X-axis direction in orbit machining
N
K253
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.001°
N
K
ri
During rapid feed (G00), the tool is said to be in a singular posture when
ZA
Se
the vector normal to machining face and the tool posture vector are
A
parallel. When the orientations of the two vectors are within the threshold
IM
Threshold value for singular posture in the value, the tool is considered to be in a singular posture.
cutting point command mode (for rapid
K
feed)
ZA
Program type E
3
—
K257
(bit 0)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-433
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: 50 items
1: 400 items
* After changing the setting of K257 bit1, initialize jaw shapes with the
Jaw shape data: registration count
data initialization operation.
K257
(bit 1)
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
K257
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
machining
ZA
K257
A
(bit 3)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Not displayed
op
machining
K257
(bit 4)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-434
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
—
K257
(bit 6)
Program type —
. d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
Setting range —
re
Fixed value (1)
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
K257
N
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
ZA
Se
0: Invalid
A
1: Valid
IM
function
ZA
K258
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions At power on
01
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Invalid
ig
1: Valid
yr
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-435
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Used to add tool axis direction coordinate Ty in the HANDLE INTERUPT
gh
window.
0: Invalid
ri
ll
1: Valid
.A
HANDLE INTERUPT window Ty display
K258
N
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
window.
Se
0: Invalid
IM
1: Valid
HANDLE INTERUPT window Tz display
K
ZA
K258
A
(bit 4)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
0: Disabled (using the Z-axis as the feed axis in the workpiece axis
direction)
ig
yr
function
K259
(bit 0)
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-436
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE
Fixed value
—
K280
(bit 0)
Program type —
.
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
K280
N
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
Fixed value
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
—
K
ZA
K280
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions —
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
ht
Fixed value
ig
yr
op
—
C
K280
(bit 6)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-437
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d.
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-438
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-3-12 Machine parameter TABLE (L)
The eccentricity of the stylus of the touch sensor with respect to the center
of the spindle
Touch sensor
L1
+Z
.
Stylus
d
ve
+X Spindle centerline
er
Program type M
s
Conditions At power on
re
Stylus L1
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in centerline
ts
gh
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
ri
ll
.A
N
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor L2
O
(Y-component) +Y
TI
60
L2 A
R
40
+X
PO
29
MPL093
R
o.
Conditions At power on
al
ZA
2. With 5-axis machines, L84 and L85 are used for these settings.
Se
The true radius value of the stylus ball of the touch sensor
IM
Touch sensor
K
ZA
L3
YA
+Z
Stylus ball
3
01
Program type M +X
)2
Conditions At power on
(c
L4 × 2
C
L4
+X
L3 × 2 MPL094
Program type M
Note :
Conditions At power on
These data are automatically set when calibration measurement is
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
performed using the MMS unit.
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
2-439
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
The distance from the spindle taper gage line to the table surface, No. 1
turning spindle chuck edge, or the reference block on the pallet existing
when the Z-axis is in the machine zero-point position
Spindle L5
Machine
zero point
Machine Spindle
zero point
L5
d .
Pallet
ve
Z-axis stroke for tip position memory Reference block
er
(TEACH function)
Table
s
MPL095
re
L5
ts
Machine
gh
zero point
ri
L5
ll
.A
N
O
Spindle Machine
Spindle
TI
edge zero point
edge
60
A L5
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
Chuck edge
29
K
ri
If (registered tool length data) – (tool length data that has been measured
IM
during the detecting operation) L6, then the tool is judged broken.
Tool-breakage judgment distance for TBR
K
function
ZA
L6
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
2-440
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
d .
process or when the machining for the last process is being
ve
executed.
er
Note :
s
re
Program type M
1. When “2” is set for this parameter, the operation is equivalent to that
ts
Conditions Immediate for the setting of “0” upon executing a tool measurement unit.
gh
Unit — 2. When “3” is set for this parameter, the operation is equivalent to that
ri
Setting range 0 to 3 for the setting of “1” upon executing a tool measurement unit.
ll
.A
The maximum skipping movement distance for the measurement with the
MMS unit
N
An alarm message will appear if the touch sensor has not come into
O
contact with the workpiece within this distance.
TI
60
PO
L8
29
R
o.
O
N
Program type M, E
al
K
ri
Conditions Immediate
ZA
Se
0: Standard machine
1: Machine of random ATC specifications
A
M
L9
3
01
)2
(c
Program type M, E
ht
Conditions At power on
ig
Unit —
yr
Setting range 0, 1
op
C
2-441
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
L10
L10
MPL511
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 1 mm/0.1 in
s
Setting range 0 to 999
re
Set the touch sensor's interference direction.
ts
gh
0: Non-interference (normal diameter)
ri
1: To jut out in the direction of a pocket of higher number (Positive
direction of magazine)
ll
Touch sensor’s interference direction
.A
2: To jut out in the direction of a pocket of lower number (Negative
direction of magazine)
N
L11
O
TI
60
Program type M, E
A
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0 to 2
C
al
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
L12
A
Y
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
Set the allowable angle for calculation of parallelism and right angle to be
op
measured manually.
C
L13
Program type M
Conditions Immediate Note :
Unit 0.0001° When error angle is smaller than the setting angle, the parallelism and
right angle are calculated.
Setting range 0 to ±900000
2-442
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
ts
Set macro program number for straightness measurement.
gh
Before shipment, the macro program is numbered “9999” at the factory.
ri
ll
Macro program number for straightness
.A
measurement
N
L15
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
K
ri
ZA
Setting prohibited
A
IM
K
—
ZA
L16
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
L17
Program type M, E
Conditions Next block
Unit 0.1° (Only for INTEGREX j)
Setting range 0 to 3600
2-443
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Tailstock absent.
1: Tailstock present.
Presence/absence of tailstock
L18
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set the number of electric steady rests.
gh
0: No electric steady rest
ri
1: One electric steady rest
ll
2: Two electric steady rests
.A
Number of electric steady rests
N
L19
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0 to 2
al
K
ri
ZA
Select the output type for the angle command of the indexing unit and the
Se
L21
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-444
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
Use L22 and L23 to set the dimensions of the sensor for tool nose
measurement.
L24 and L25 are provided to set in machine coordinates the reference
point of the sensor (see the diagram below).
Example :
[INTE IV, INTE e-HII, lathes]
1. For No. 1 turning spindle
Machine zero point
d.
ve
er
L24
s
Sensor’s
re
reference point
ts
L25
gh
Data of the tool nose measurement sensor
ri
L22
L22 : Sensor width along the X-axis
ll
.A
L23 : Sensor width along the Z-axis Sensor for tool nose
L24 : X-coordinate of the sensor’s measurement
L22
N
reference point L23
O
to L25 : Z-coordinate of the sensor’s Set the imaginary upper left corner of the sensor as its reference point
TI
L25 reference point for No. 2 spindle.
60
[INTE e-VII]
A
R
40
PO
2.
29
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
L25
IM
Sensor’s
reference point
K
L24
ZA
A
L23
M
YA
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in As shown above, the X- and Z-axes must be replaced with each other
(c
L26
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range ±99999999
2-445
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
During manual TOOL EYE measurement, even if the sensor turns on for a
time shorter than that which has been specified in this parameter, that will
not be regarded as sensor-on.
L27
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 7.1 ms
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
In the machine configuration that will cause the arm of the TOOL EYE to
gh
interfere with the tool when the arm is extended or retracted with the tool
present at the measuring approach point during automatic tool
ri
measurement with the TOOL EYE, set the distance through which the tool
ll
is to be returned in the Z-axis direction before extending or retracting the
.A
arm for the measurement.
N
In the MAZATROL program, before the arm is extended or retracted, the
O
tool is returned through the L28/L78-set distance from the measuring
TI
60
approach point.
A
R
In the EIA/ISO program, when G136 command execution is completed,
40
PO
the tool will be returned through the L28/L78-set distance from the
29
approach point. (In the EIA/ISO program, the tool will be retreated to a
R
o.
relay point, only in retraction mode, and the arm will be extended by
O
N
point for TOOL EYE measurement (For QTN machine specifications, parameter L28 becomes valid for the #2
K
ri
L28
Se
X
IM
K
Z
ZA
In case of #2, #4
approaching (QTN) TOOL EYE #1, #2 APK1
A
approach point
L28 APK1
K20
3
01
APK3
K20 TOOL EYE #3, #4
(c
Program type M, E
approach point
ht
2-446
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
Machine efficiency
L29
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 0 to 100
ts
Select for each machine model the appropriate case introduction
gh
messages on MACHINING NAVIGATION-PREDICTION display.
ri
Specific data is preset for each machine model. Do not disturb the
ll
presettings.
Selection of machining navigation case
.A
introduction messages
N
L30
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
K
ri
ZA
L31 #3103
K
L33 #3105
to
A
L34 #3106
M
L34
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
For the command to rotate the index table, specify the minimum index
ig
L37
Program type M
Conditions At power on Note :
This parameter is ineffective for the system with an NC rotary table.
Unit °
Setting range 0 to 180
2-447
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
For the command to rotate the index table, select the turning direction and
the M-code number to be output.
0 or 1: B-code (0: Turning in the direction of CW,
1: Turning in the direction of CW/CCW/shortcut)
M/B-code for index of index table 2 to 9999: M-code (Numeric value is the M-code number to be
output)
L38
Note :
1. This parameter is ineffective for the system with an NC rotary table.
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions At power on 2. Turning direction of the index table can be selected in the indexing
unit only when this parameter is set to 1.
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999
ts
Specify the execution condition of the indexing unit.
gh
Execution of the indexing unit just before starting of machining of each
tool sequence or at the end of each process:
ri
ll
0: Won’t be made when the index angle is the same as the preceding
Selection of execution/non execution of
.A
indexing unit execution.
indexing unit
N
1: Will be made unconditionally.
L39
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Select availability to specify the index table angle in the end unit.
Se
L40
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
For execution of the indexing unit, specify the commanding order for
ig
Program type M
Note :
Conditions At power on
In case of setting to 2, only the X-axis coordinates can be set at turning
Unit — position of the indexing unit.
Setting range 0 to 2
2-448
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
Select setting of the initial value (modal) of the index table angle for cyclic
operation.
0: Actual table angle of the machine
1: Table angle indexed at present taken as 0°
Initial value of index table angle
L42
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select showing or not showing of the index table angle on the POSITION
gh
display.
ri
0: Not to show
ll
1: To show
.A
Indication of index table angle
N
L43
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Set to 1 for the machine with the index table, or set to 0 for that of the
O
Unit —
N
NC rotary table.
C
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
When the tool nose angle is specified: The amount of correction that is
nose position correction of a drilling tool
ZA
not auto-set.
M
When the tool nose angle is specified: The amount of correction that is
01
Unit — When the tool nose angle is not specified: The amount of correction
that assumes a nose angle of 118° is auto-set.
(c
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
Set the minimum unit of index table angle command for the indexing units,
ig
ANGLE in the end units and B-codes in the manual program unit.
yr
0: 1°
op
L45
Note :
Index table angle display on the POSITION display is valid only when
L43 = 1 (index table angle display on).
Program type — 0: 1° index table
Conditions — 1 to 7: Nth axis under auxiliary equipment axis specs. (N = 1 to 7)
8: Positioning table
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 8
2-449
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
L46
.
Program type M
d
Note :
ve
Conditions At power on
When this parameter is set to 0 or 1, use of the pallet changing unit is
er
Unit — prohibited.
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
Select preparation of next pallet or not to do so according to the pallet
gh
change mechanism.
ri
0: Not to prepare next pallet
ll
1: To prepare next pallet
To prepare or not to prepare next pallet
.A
change
N
L47
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Conditions At power on When this parameter is set to 1, it is possible to set the number of the
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
K
L48
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 9
ht
with the next ATC operation in execution of the pallet changing unit and
yr
L49
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-450
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
L50
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
(For five surface machining)
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Tool command system in MDI operation (Tool on the spindle and next
gh
time tool)
ri
0: Command of pocket number
ll
1: Command of group number
.A
Tool command system in MDI operation
N
L51
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
variable)
A
0: Impossible
IM
1: Possible
Writing of machining management data with
K
macro variable
ZA
L52
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
MANAGEMENT display.
yr
1: To show WNo.
Showing of program number in PALLET
C
MANAGEMENT display
L53
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-451
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Invalid
1: FMS pallet ID operation mode
2: Pallet management operation mode
L54
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 2
ts
0: FR-SF
gh
1: FR-SE
ri
ll
.A
Spindle load meter display type
N
L55
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
2: Method by M32 tool edge memorizing function (for X-, Y-, Z-axes)
IM
L56
A
Mothod by M2
M
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
0: Impossible
op
1: Possible
Rewriting of tool data during automatic
C
operation
L57
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-452
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
Select a head angle indication system for the five surface machining
system.
0: Indication corresponding to 90° index (0°, 90°, 180°, 270°)
1: Indication corresponding to 1° (5°) index
Head index angle indication system
L58
.
Program type E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit — (For five surface machining)
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
This parameter limits input items on the HEAD OFFSET display.
gh
0: Data just on item SPDL. CMD can be input.
ri
1: All data can be input.
ll
.A
Input selection for HEAD OFFSET display
N
L59
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
K
Head quantity
ZA
L60
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Setting range 0 to 10
ht
change (APC)
yr
L61
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
(For five surface machining)
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2
2-453
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
When FIXED is selected at the item RELAY in the face definition unit, the
head arrives at the face for next machining through the point(s) specified
by the parameters (to be set in the machine coordinates system).
For AGX or five-surface machining models, the relay points (X1, Y1) and
(X2, Y2) can be specified in the program (in the face definition sequence).
Head relay point X1
For the five surface machining, the head goes through the four corners of
a face where the two specified points are positioned in its diagonal line.
L62
Z
.
Program type M
d
(X1, Y1)
ve
Conditions Immediate Y
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in X
s
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
ts
gh
(X2, Y2)
ri
MPL515
ll
(For five-surface machining)
.A
Head relay point Y1
(For AGX series)
N
L63
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
L64
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
L65
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
2-454
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
L66
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate (For five-surface machining)
er
Unit — (For AGX series)
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set the length from the end surface of the spindle to the center of head
gh
rotation for respective machines. (100 mm in usual)
ri
Y
ll
= 180°
Length between the end surface of the
.A
spindle and the center of head rotation
N
L67 = 0°
O
TI
60
A L67
Z
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
MPL516
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
= 180°
Y
IM
= 0°
K
L68
A
M
L68
YA
X
Program type M, E
3
MPL517
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
L69
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For AGX series)
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
2-455
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the axes that simultaneously move from a machining face to the
next machining face or in case of tool replacement.
0: Two (three) axes simultaneously move to the safety position.
1: Y-axis (or X- and Y-axes) moves to the safety position after Z-axis
Axis movement from machining face on
moved.
escapement
The X-axis moves when a relay point (RELAY) or a fixed point (FIXED) is
L70 selected for the item RELAY in the face definition unit.
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit — (For AGX series)
s
re
Setting range 1, 0
ts
For execution of the program for oblique face machining, specify to
gh
execute or not machining on the coordinate that is turned from the basic
coordinate (set in WPC unit or in OFFSET unit) at an angle of the
ri
correction value for the B-axis.
ll
Shift of basic coordinate for oblique face
.A
0: Machining on the coordinate that is turned from the basic
machining coordinate at an angle of the correction value for the B-axis
N
L71
O
1: Machining on the basic coordinate specified in the program
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 1, 0
al
K
ri
ZA
Set the time constant to be used in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode.
Se
Program type E
3
01
Unit ms
(c
Setting range 0 to 57
ht
A setting of 0 is invalid.
yr
op
acceleration/deceleration filter 2
L73
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 56
2-456
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
L74
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement
er
Unit mm/min
s
re
Setting range 1 to 999999
ts
Set the time constant to obtain acceleration/deceleration of the cutting
gh
feed rate for pre-interpolational linear control.
ri
ll
Time constant for pre-interpolational linear
.A
control during cutting feed rate
acceleration/deceleration
N
L75
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit ms
N
K
ri
ZA
Set the maximum cutting speed in the G61.1 mode at percentage to the
Se
L76
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit %
(c
interpolation
L77
MPL518
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit °
Setting range 0 to 30
2-457
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
In the machine configuration that will cause the arm of the TOOL EYE to
interfere with the tool when the arm is extended or retracted with the tool
present at the measuring approach point during automatic tool
measurement with the TOOL EYE, set the distance through which the tool
is to be returned in the X-axis direction before extending or retracting the
arm for the measurement.
In the MAZATROL program, before the arm is extended or retracted, the
tool is returned through the L28/L78-set distance from the measuring
approach point.
In the EIA/ISO program, when G136 command execution is completed,
.
the tool will be returned through the L28/L78-set distance from the
d
ve
approach point. (In the EIA/ISO program, the tool will be retreated to a
Amount of X-axial retreat from the approach
er
relay point, only in retraction mode, and the arm will be extended by
point for TOOL EYE measurement execution of M284 in the next block onward.)
s
re
X
L78
ts
gh
Z
ri
In case of #2, #4
ll
approaching (QTN) TOOL EYE #1, #2 APK1
.A
approach point AP1
TOOL EYE #1, #2
N
AP1 L78
approach point
O
L28 APK1
TI
K20
60
approach point
o.
Conditions Immediate
O
AP3 APK3
N
ZA
Se
synchronized-tapping gain
A
L79
M
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
)2
Conditions At power on
(c
Unit 0.001 mm
ht
Set the deceleration rate at the linear to arc or arc to linear blocks of
yr
shape correction.
op
C
L80
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit mm/min / in/min
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-458
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
L81
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Set the thickness of the tilting table.
gh
This parameter is used for the software travel limit function provided to
ri
avoid collision between the spindle head and the tilting table (in its angular
ll
position from –90° to –120°).
.A
Table thickness
N
L82
O
TI
60
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.0001 mm
N
K
ri
This parameter is used for the software travel limit function provided to
A
avoid collision between the spindle head and the tilting table.
IM
K
L83
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.0001 mm
L83 (For machines equipped with a tilting table)
(c
2-459
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
2Mx
ex
.
Program type M Stylus
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement Spindle center
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
MPL519
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999 ex: Alignment deviation correction value on X-axis
ts
ey: Alignment deviation correction value on Y-axis
gh
Mx: Stylus radius in the X-axis direction (The setting of L3)
My: Stylus radius in the Y-axis direction (The setting of L4)
ri
ll
Correction value of alignment deviation Y
.A
Note :
(Upper face)
N
The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L85
O
(on the upper face) with the MMS unit.
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
K
ri
ZA
2Mx
Se
A
IM
(0-degree face)
ZA
2My
L86 ey
A
M
YA
ex
Program type M Stylus
3
01
Note :
(0-degree face)
The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L87 (0-degree face) with the MMS unit.
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For five-surface machining)
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
2-460
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
2Mx
ex
.
Program type M Stylus
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement Spindle center
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
MPL519
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999 ex: Alignment deviation correction value on X-axis
ts
ey: Alignment deviation correction value on Y-axis
gh
Mx: Stylus radius in the X-axis direction (The setting of L3)
My: Stylus radius in the Y-axis direction (The setting of L4)
ri
Correction value of alignment deviation Y
(90-degree face)
ll
.A
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor Note :
N
(Y-component for B-axis at 90-degree The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L89
O
position) (90-degree face) with the MMS unit.
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
K
ri
ZA
2Mx
Se
(180-degree face)
K
ex
Program type M Stylus
3
01
(180-degree face)
C
Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement (For INTEGREX series)
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For five-surface machining)
2-461
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
2Mx
ex
.
Program type M Stylus
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement Spindle center
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
MPL519
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999 ex: Alignment deviation correction value on X-axis
ts
ey: Alignment deviation correction value on Y-axis
gh
Mx: Stylus radius in the X-axis direction (The setting of L3)
My: Stylus radius in the Y-axis direction (The setting of L4)
ri
ll
Correction value of alignment deviation Y
.A
Note :
(270-degree face)
N
The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L93
O
(270-degree face) with the MMS unit.
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
K
ri
measuring table.
IM
0: Invalid
X/Y travel distance during EIA-programmed
K
1: Valid
tool measurement
ZA
L94
A
Note :
M
specifications.
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
data setting.
yr
0: Invalid
op
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-462
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
The amount of shifting for TNo. during offset number auto-setting for
EIA-programmed tool measurement data setting.
[Offset No.] = [TNo. setting] + [L96 setting]
Amount of shifting during offset number
auto-setting for EIA-programmed tool
Note : Valid only when L95 = 1.
measurement
L96
.
Program type E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 4000
ts
1 - 999: M-code of the specified number
gh
1000: None
ri
Other than above: M149
ll
M-code to be output when selecting menu
.A
function for the MDI tool designation
N
L97
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
K
ri
Specify the muximum tool length for the MDI laser tool length
ZA
Se
measurement.
A
IM
measurement
ZA
L98
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Specify the cycle time at which the operational status management data
ig
Note :
op
Cycle time for saving the operational status 1. If the setting is 0, the data will be saved each minute.
C
management data 2. If the setting is –1, the data will be saved only when the date
changes or when NC power is turned off.
L99
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit min
Setting range –1 to 1439
2-463
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
[INTE e-HII]
Approach point for tool
diameter measurement
L103: X
L100: X
Machine
d .
zero point
ve
L102: Z
s er
re
L100 Laser sensor position X
ts
gh
L101 Laser sensor position Y L101: Y
L102 Laser sensor position Z
ri
ll
L103 Approach point X for laser tool
.A
diameter measurement
L100
N
L104 Approach point Y for laser tool
to
O
diameter measurement L98
TI
L105 L105: Z
L105 Approach point Z for laser tool length
60
measurement A
Approach point for tool
R
40
length measurement
PO
29
[INTE e-VII]
o.
O
N
Machine
C
zero point
K
L100: X
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
L104: Y
L105: Z L102: Z
ZA
L98
A
M
L101: Y
YA
Program type M, E
3
0: Measuring table
1: Laser tool measuring equipment
op
L106
(bit 0)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-464
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Measuring table (see L22 to L26)
gh
1: TOOL EYE (see BA95 to BA102)
ri
ll
.A
Selection of measuring equipment
N
L106
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
L106
A
(bit 3)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
function.
yr
0: Disabled
op
1: Enabled
C
—
L106
(bit 4)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-465
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Select whether the user-defined angle setting for the B-axis in the
coordinate measurement unit and workpiece measurement unit is to be
made valid or invalid.
B-axis user-defined angle setting in the 0: Invalid
coordinate measurement unit and 1: Valid
workpiece measurement unit
L106
(bit 5)
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set the non-compensation area for the tool measurement and execution
gh
timing of tool and workpiece measurement operation.
ri
0: MT Pro scheme
ll
Non-compensation area setting
.A
Non-compensation area for the tool measurement based on the
N
measuring tolerance (K17 and K18) invalid (handled as if K17 = 0
O
and K18 = 100)
TI
Execution timing of tool and workpiece measurement operation
60
A
The measurement unit is executed whenever the parts count
R
40
L106
C
ZA
Se
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
equipment.
op
Selection of laser measuring menu display 1: No display of the laser measuring menu
L106
(bit 7)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-466
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
In AGX machines, the tool locus (on the TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK
display) on the following coordinate is drawn by the EIA/ISO program.
0: Loft on the standard coordinates system
1: Loft on the machine coordinates system
Tool path drawing
L107 Note :
(bit 0) When 1 (drawing on the machine coordinate) is selected, the loft does
not correspond to the form made on the MAZATROL coordinates
system. However, 1 makes a loft corresponding to the tool movement of
the machine.
.
Program type E
d
ve
Conditions Immediate (For AGX series)
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set whether the tailstock function is to be made valid or invalid.
gh
0: Tailstock function invalid
ri
1: Tailstock function valid
ll
.A
Tailstock function valid/invalid
N
L107
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Conventional type
IM
1: Motor-driven type
Tailstock type
K
ZA
L107
A
(bit 2)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Display off
yr
1: Display on
op
pounds (lbs)
L107
(bit 3)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-467
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
LBB No. setting for the grooving I.D. tool, threading I.D. tool, or touch
sensor
0: Invalid
1: Valid
—
L107
(bit 4)
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Moves the X-axis to the third zero point and the Y/Z-axes to the
gh
respective zero points.
ri
1: Moves the X-axis to the third zero point and the Y/Z-axes to the
respective second zero points.
ll
XYZ-axis operation for the first T-command
.A
after cycle start
N
L107
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
L107
A
(bit 6)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
(For AGX series)
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-468
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
—
L108
(bit 0)
to
(bit 4)
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Set whether the C-axis coordinate obtained by C-axis coordinate rotation
gh
in the indexing unit is to be incorporated into the path and shape drawings
on the TOOL PATH CHECK, TRACE, and SHAPE CHECK displays of
ri
Incorporating the C-axis coordinate into the VRX machine.
ll
the TOOL PATH CHECK, TRACE, and
.A
0: Incorporation valid.
SHAPE CHECK displays of the VRX 1: Incorporation invalid (M640M-5X compatible).
N
L108 machine
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
A
IM
K
—
ZA
L108
A
(bit 6)
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
Set whether, during tool path check of the MAZATROL program on the
ig
tool nose of the milling tool is to be displayed with the tool diameter
similarly to the M640M Pro or with a tool nose mark similarly to the
op
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-469
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the relationship between axial directions of the two axes, on the
machine coordinate system, for which software limit relative position is
checked.
0: Same direction
1: Reverse directions
Example :
When checking the software limit relative position between the Z2- and
W-axis, the positive (+) direction of the W-axis on the machine
coordinate system may be the same or reverse direction of the positive
(+) direction of the Z2-axis depending on the machine model.
.d
Axial direction for checking the software
ve
limit relative position Set “0” if the positive (+) direction of the Z2- and W-axis is the same on
er
the machine coordinate system as shown in Fig. 1. Conversely, if the
Bit 0: Axial direction (1st set of axes)
direction is reverse as shown in Fig. 2, then set “1”.
s
L109 Bit 1: Axial direction (2nd set of axes)
re
(bit 0) Bit 2: Axial direction (3rd set of axes) Fig. 1
ts
to Bit 3: Axial direction (4th set of axes)
gh
W-axis
(bit 3)
ri
+
ll
.A
Z2-axis +
N
O
TI
Fig. 2
60
A
R
40
W-axis
PO
29
+
R
Program type M, E
o.
O
N
Z2-axis
al
Unit —
K
ri
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
Se
(bit 4)
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions Immediate
(c
Unit —
ht
Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr
When [TEACH] is tapped while the lower turret is selected in the basic
coordinate system unit,
op
Teaching when the lower turret is selected 1: Enables teaching only along the Z- and C-axis.
in the basic coordinate system unit (WPC) (With other axes, Alarm 1450 SELECT LOWER TURRET is caused.)
L109
(bit 5)
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-470
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
Fixed value
—
L109
(bit 6)
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
Fixed value
N
L109
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
76543210
ZA
Se
A
IM
0: Z/C-axis
A
1: W/U-axis
M
YA
0: Disabled
01
1: Enabled
L110
)2
0: X-axis
ig
1: Vertical
Program type M, E Z-axis direction
Conditions At power on 0: Horizontal
1: Vertical
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-471
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Output
1: Do not output
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Fixed value (1)
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
L111
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
0: Executed
IM
1: Not executed
Whether interference check is executed or
K
L111
A
(bit 7)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-472
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
76543210
d .
Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 2 is
ve
L112
present or absent
er
0 : Without carriage-connection steadyrest 2
s
re
1 : With carriage-connection steadyrest 2
ts
Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 3 is
gh
present or absent
0 : Without carriage-connection steadyrest 3
ri
1 : With carriage-connection steadyrest 3
ll
.A
Program type M, E Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 4 is
present or absent
N
Conditions At power on
0 : Without carriage-connection steadyrest 4
O
Unit —
TI
1 : With carriage-connection steadyrest 4
60
Set the axis to be taken as the check reference in software limit check in
PO
29
L113
K
ZA
L116
IM
Program type M, E
K
ZA
Conditions Immediate
A
Unit —
M
Setting range 0 to 16
YA
Set the check target axis corresponding to the axis set as the check
3
Software limit relative position check – relative position. Specify the axis number by that of NC.
Check target axis
)2
L120
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16
2-473
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
For arbitrary two axes that move on the same slideway, the limit of
distance those axes can approach with each other is set to prevent
interference. If they are going to move closer beyond the distance set at
this parameter, software limit alarm is output and they stop moving. Using
parameters L121 to L124, the limit distance in the approaching direction
can be set for up to four axes.
Set the machine coordinate of the check target axis, set at parameters
L117 to L120, existing at the permissible closest position from the check
reference axis, set at parameters L113 to L116, which is located at the
home position.
d.
ve
Example:
er
In the example shown below, if the W-axis and the Z2-axis are defined
as the check reference axis and the check target axis, respectively,
s
re
move the Z2-axis close to the W-axis, which is located at the home
position, up to the position just before they interfere with each other, and
ts
set the machine coordinate of the Z2-axis located at that position. If zero
gh
Software limit relative position check –
Limit distance in the approaching direction is entered, the checking function in the approaching direction will be
ri
invalid. Note that the check is possible only for the combination of NC
L121 1st set of axes
ll
axes.
.A
L121 L122 2nd set of axes
L123 3rd set of axes
to
N
L124 4th set of axes Machine coordinate W = –100.
O
L124
TI
60
A W
Z2
R
40
PO
29
X2
R
o.
O
N
W-axis machine
ri
zero point
Se
Machine coordinate W = 0
IM
K
ZA
Z2-axis
A
M
Program type M, E
YA
Specify the time constant for smoothing the tool attitude during tool tip
(c
point control.
ht
This time constant is valid only when all the following conditions are
ig
satisfied:
yr
Rotational axis prefiltering time constant High-speed smooth interpolation is valid (G05P02, G61.1, F3 bit 0 =
op
1)
C
2-474
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
d .
Positioning direction of the head rotation will be handled as 1.
ve
-axis for oblique plane indexing
er
<Example of operation with 0 assigned to L126 and 45° as a plane angle>
L126
s
Head rotation -axis = –114.4698°
re
Table rotation B-axis = 65.5302°
ts
gh
– –
ri
ll
.A
N
+B
O
+B
TI
60
Program type M, E A
R
40
Conditions Immediate +B –
PO
29
Unit —
R
Setting range 0 to 2
O
N
ZA
L130 G0 L S
Auto- G1 L S
A
matic
M
Unit ms
01
Speed Speed
(c
ht
Time Time
ig
L132
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 200
2-475
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
reference position in the X-axis direction. Specify a minus value when
ve
the actual center of B-axis rotation is located at the plus side in the X-axis
er
direction with respect to the reference position.
s
Program type —
re
Setting range: –10000 to 10000
Conditions After stop of axis movement
ts
Setting a value exceeding the upper (lower) limit has the same effect as
gh
Unit 0.0001 mm setting the upper (lower) limit.
ri
Setting range See explanation to the right.
ll
<For tool tilt type (Example: VERSATECH)>
.A
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
N
the tool side) to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the
O
<For tool tilt type> root side) in the vertical axis direction.
TI
Tool control rotary axis offset
Setting range: –30000 to 30000
60
specifications)>
L134 A-axis rotation center displacement (Y-axis
R
direction) VARIAXIS)>
N
Sets the displacement of the actual center of A-axis rotation from the
al
ZA
the actual center of A-axis rotation is located at the plus side in the Y-axis
Se
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
YA
the tool side) to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the
<For tool tilt type> root side) in the height axis direction.
3
(Z-axis direction))
Sets the displacement of the actual center of A-(B-)axis rotation from the
ig
the actual center of A-(B-)axis rotation is located at the plus side in the
op
2-476
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
d .
Program type —
ve
er
Conditions After stop of axis movement
s
Unit 0.0001 mm
re
Setting range –30000 to 30000
ts
gh
<For tool tilt type only (Example : VERSATECH)>
Set the distance along the vertical axis from the spindle edge to the
ri
rotational center of the tool-side rotational axis (tool side).
ll
<For tool tilt type>
.A
Tool rotational axis offset
N
vertical axis offset amount for the 2nd
O
rotational axis
L137
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type —
R
O
N
Unit 0.0001 mm
al
ZA
Se
Set the distance along the height axis from the spindle edge to the
IM
L138
M
YA
3
Program type —
01
Unit 0.0001 mm
(c
chamfering tool
(For fully automatic tool measurement with
measuring table)
L139
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
Setting range 0 to 999
2-477
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: 50 ms
1: 50 ms
2: 100 ms
Waiting time for the completion signal of 3: 150 ms
M35 (tool breakage detection) from PLC
L140
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 50 ms
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
gh
ri
Software limit relative position check (for
ll
.A
auxiliary equipment axis) – Task delay
period
N
L141
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit 0.1 ms
O
N
ZA
A
IM
acceleration/deceleration control
ZA
L145
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
L74
Setting range 1 to 999999
(c
Set the time constant for pre-interpolational linear control during cutting
ht
function is valid.
yr
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit ms [Related parameters]
L75
Setting range 1 to 5000
2-478
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit ms [Related parameters]
L129
s
re
Setting range 1 to 200
ts
Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1 time constant (2nd stage)
gh
used when the Smooth corner control function is valid.
ri
Smooth corner control function:
ll
.A
Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1
time constant (2nd stage)
N
L148
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
[Related parameters]
o.
Unit ms
O
L130
N
Sets the rapid feed rate to be used before interpolation when a feed
ri
ZA
command involving a rotary axis is specified during tool tip point control
Se
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
[Related parameters]
Unit mm/min
L150
)2
Sets the rapid feed time constant to be used before interpolation when a
ht
feed command involving a rotary axis is specified during tool tip point
ig
Smooth corner control function: control with the smooth corner control function enabled.
yr
interpolation for rapid feed command When “0” is set, the setting of L146 is assumed.
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
[Related parameters]
Unit ms
L149
Setting range 1 to 5000
2-479
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
L151
d .
ve
L151
L82
ser
re
Program type M, E
ts
Conditions Immediate
gh
[Related parameters]
Unit 0.0001 mm L82
ri
Setting range 0 to 99999999 (Function dedicated to machines equipped with the tilt table)
ll
.A
Display of the [PALLET No.SET] menu item
N
0: Displayed
O
1: Not displayed
TI
60
display Note :
L171
PO
29
O
N
C
al
Program type M, E
K
ri
ZA
Conditions Immediate
Se
Unit —
IM
Setting range 0, 1
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-480
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE
L270
.
Program type E
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit mm/min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
gh
ri
ll
Time constant for clamping the acceleration
.A
in orbit machining
N
L271
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit ms
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-481
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
The feed rate for moving each axis under the G00 command during
automatic operation
The feed rate for moving each axis in either the manual rapid feed mode
or the zero-point return mode
Rapid feed rate
M1
d .
ve
er
Program type M, E
Note :
s
Conditions After stop of movement
re
Initial zero-point return is performed at the feed rate set in parameter
Unit mm/min (°/min)
ts
M2.
gh
Setting range 0 to 600000
ri
The feed rate for moving each axis during initial zero-point return
ll
(reference-point return) at power on
.A
Feed rate
N
O
Feed rate for initial zero-point return
TI
M2
60
A
M2
R
40
PO
N8
29
R
o.
Program type M, E
O
N
Watchdog
C
ZA
MPL520
Se
Even if a feed rate higher than this parameter setting is specified, the
K
latter governs.
ZA
M3
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
2-482
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
M4
Machine M4
zero point
Program type M, E
d .
MPL521
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit 0.0001 mm
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
The machine coordinating values of the point to which each axis is to
gh
move back under the G30 command (second zero-point return).
ri
ll
.A
Second zero-point coordinating value Second zero point
M5
N
M5
O
TI
60
A
Machine M5
R
40
Unit 0.0001 mm
O
N
ZA
Se
M6
A
M
YA
Machine M6
Program type M, E zero point
3
MPL521
01
Unit 0.0001 mm
(c
Machine M7
Program type M, E zero point
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±99999999
2-483
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
M8
M8 (Y-axis)
+X
Moving zone
Program type M, E M9 (Y-axis)
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
M9 (X-axis) M8 (X-axis)
ts
MPL522
gh
ri
Note : This parameter is invalid when M8 = M9.
ll
Maximum software limit specified by
.A
manufacturer (– direction)
N
M9
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Select a unit of command from the following table and set it.
ri
ZA
Se
* micron system
A
IM
Program type E
3
Conditions At power on
01
)2
Unit —
(c
Address name X Y Z A B C
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range &0 to &7F
2-484
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
M12
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range &0 to &7F
ts
Specify the address name of the axes to be used for display, by the
gh
appropriate hexadecimal number of the ASCII code.
ri
For reverse display, set up the most significant bit.
ll
Example :
.A
Axis name (for display)
1. Reverse display of “C”
N
M13 C : &0043 Reverse display of “C”: &00C3
O
TI
2. Reverse display of “X1”
60
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
K
ri
When the watchdog-less home position is set, it will be shifted through the
ZA
Se
distance
A
IM
M14
ZA
position
M
New M14
)2
Ex-M14
(c
Program type M, E
ht
Conditions Immediate
ig
point point
Setting range ±99999999
op
C
2-485
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Specify the name of the address to be used for axis name changing
(G110), by the appropriate hexadecimal number of the ASCII code.
M15
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range &0 to &7F
ts
The distance from the grid point to the actual zero point that exists during
gh
zero-point return (reference point return) in the initial operation after
power-on.
ri
ll
M16
.A
Zero-point shift amount/grid shift amount
N
O
M16
TI
60
A Watchdog
R
40
(Reference point)
29
Note :
N
Conditions Immediate
C
M20 is 1.
ri
ZA
76543210
IM
0: Millimeter
ZA
1: Inch
A
0: (+) direction
YA
1: (–) direction
Error correction schema with servo on
3
Type of axis
M17 0: Linear
(c
1: Rotational
ht
0: CW
op
1: CCW
If axis is removed:
C
0: Alarm
1: No alarm
Program type M, E Note :
Usually, specify the rotational direction for the motor when viewed from
Conditions At power on
the front (the opposite side of the encoder). For “Spindle-Cs control”,
Unit — however, specify the rotational direction for the motor when viewed
Setting range Binary, eight digits from the rear.
2-486
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
Spindle C-axis
M18
(bit 0)
Program type M, E
.d
Conditions At power on
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
0: Fixed point for zero-point return using dog
ts
gh
1: Position existing when power was turned on
ri
ll
.A
Machine zero-point position
M18
N
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
0: Invalid
A
1: Valid
IM
K
M18
A
(bit 3)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Invalid
ig
1: Valid
yr
op
C
Dog-less axis
M18
(bit 4)
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-487
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Radius
1: Diameter
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Invalid
gh
1: Valid
ri
ll
.A
Automatic/manual simultaneous
absolute-value updating
N
M18
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
0: Invalid
Se
1: Valid
A
IM
M18 bit 7
0 1
K
SV17 bit 7
M18 1 Dog type Absolute detection position
A
(bit 7)
M
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
1 : Do not transmit
Transmission of rapid feed rate value to
SV69/SV70
M19
(bit 0)
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-488
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
0 : NC
1 : Servo
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Parameter for system internal setting
gh
Setting prohibited
ri
ll
.A
—
N
M19
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
0: No check
ZA
Se
M19
A
(bit 5)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0 : G01
ig
1 : G00
yr
op
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-489
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Forward
1: Reverse
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Normal
gh
1: KOMET tool axis
ri
ll
.A
KOMET tool axis selection
N
M20
O
(bit 1)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: With the ISS being selected, the stop is delayed by about 140 ms than
ZA
Se
otherwise.
A
Example :
IM
Type of stopping the motion of feed and The stop position for combining the tailstock or steady rest will be
rapid traverse for the INTELLIGENT shifted accordingly.
K
ZA
SAFETY SHIELD (ISS) 1: Independently of whether the ISS is selected or canceled, the axis
M20
movement will come to a stop in one and the same position.
A
(bit 2)
M
Example :
YA
Conditions At power on
readjustment of the combining position.)
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
axis.
yr
0: Display the value considering the reference workpiece zero point (S23)
op
and WPC-Z.
Current position display of NC steady rest
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-490
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
0: Include
1: Do not include
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Normal
gh
1: Multi-axis integrated type amplifier
ri
ll
Multi-axis integrated type amplifier
.A
specification
N
M20
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
M20
A
(bit 6)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Normal
ig
1: GL-axis
yr
op
C
GL-axis specification
M20
(bit 7)
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-491
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Linear acceleration/
deceleration
First-order lag Rapid-feed
acceleration/
Second-order lag deceleration type
—
Exponential acceleration/
linear deceleration
M21
Linear acceleration/
d .
deceleration
ve
First-order lag Cutting-feed
er
acceleration/
s
Second-order lag deceleration type
re
Program type M, E Exponential acceleration/
ts
linear deceleration
Conditions At power on
gh
Unit — Time constants for each type of acceleration/deceleration control must be
ri
set using parameters N1 through N6.
ll
Setting range Binary, eight digits
.A
76543210
N
Deceleration time constant for rapid-feed
O
exponential acceleration/linear deceleration
TI
0: Parameter N3
60
—
A 1: Parameter N3 × 2
R
40
PO
29
Program type M, E
ri
ZA
Conditions At power on
Se
Unit —
IM
0: NC control axes
ZA
axes
M23
3
01
(bit 0)
)2
(c
Program type M, E
ht
Conditions At power on
ig
yr
Unit —
op
Setting range 0, 1
C
2-492
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
Set the axis for which the MP scale offset method is adopted.
0: Normal
1: MP scale offset method
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set an access inhibition area in the inclined-axis control software limit
gh
area consisting of the X-axis and the Yt-axis.
ri
Parameters M25 and M26 are valid only for the X-axis and the
Yt-axis.
ll
.A
If the X-axial and Yt-axial upper limits (M25) and lower limits (M26)
are all zeros, the illegal axis area check function is invalid.
N
O
Use the parameter BA126 to select Type A or B (BA126 bit 1).
TI
Illegal axis area upper limits (Type A) When the selection of whether to make this interference checking
60
A
function valid or invalid is to be made according to the B-axis angle,
R
40
(Type A) The interference checking function will be valid when the following
conditions are satisfied:
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
Se
Program type M, E
IM
M8 (Yt)
Setting range ±99999999
A
Yt-axial (A)
lower limit
M
Lower
3
interference area
01
Yt-axial
(B) upper limit
)2
M25 (Yt)
Yt-axial
(c
lower
ht
soft-limit
Illegal axis area lower limits (Type A) M9 (Yt)
ig
M26 X-axial
yr
2-493
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
The interference checking function will be valid when the following
ve
(Type B)
conditions are satisfied:
er
1. M26 (B-axis) B-axis angle M25 (B-axis)
s
re
2. M25 (B-axis) = M26 (B-axis) = 0
ts
gh
<Type B (BA126 bit 1 = 1)>
ri
Program type M, E X-axial upper
ll
Yt-axial upper Upper
soft-limit
.A
Conditions After stop of movement limit M25 (Yt) interference area
M8 (X)
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°
N
O
Setting range ±99999999 (A)
TI
X-axial (X,Yt) = (0,0)
60
A
lower limit
R
40
(B)
o.
O
N
X-axial
C
Yt-axial lower
lower
al
soft-limit M9 (Yt)
soft-limit
ri
ZA
M9 (X)
Se
Yt-axial upper
IM
Set the value that determines the maximum allowable value (Amax) of the
yr
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 5000
2-494
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
.
M30 (RA) + M30 (SA) M1 (SA)
d
RA: reference axis
ve
Program type M, E M31 (RA) + M31 (SA) M1 (SA) SA: superposition axis
er
Conditions After stop of axis movement Note :
s
re
Unit mm/min Whether the axes move in the same direction or in different directions is
Setting range 0 to 600000 judged from the command and polarity (parameter N21, bit 6).
ts
gh
Set the rapid feed clamping speed for superposition control when both the
ri
reference axis and superposition axis move at a rapid feed rate and in the
same direction (see the Note).
ll
.A
(Set value for the reference axis and superposition axis to be used during
Rapid feed clamping speed 2 for superposition control.)
N
superposition control Set M29 to M31 so that the following conditions are satisfied:
O
TI
M30 M29 (RA) + M31 (SA) M1 (SA)
60
Conditions After stop of axis movement Whether the axes move in the same direction or in different directions is
N
Unit mm/min judged from the command and polarity (parameter N21, bit 6).
al
ZA
Se
(Set value for the reference axis and superposition axis to be used during
IM
superposition control.)
K
Program type M, E
)2
Unit mm/min
ht
If the operating speed of the axis exceeds the set value in safety
op
supervisory mode 2, this will cause a safety supervisory alarm and result
C
in an emergency stop.
Safety speed
(Safety supervisory mode 2)
M32
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit mm/min / °/min
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-495
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
M33
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement
er
Unit mm/min / °/min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Set the safety clamping speed to be used in safety supervisory mode 2.
gh
In safety supervisory mode 2 and while a safety clamping request is in
effect, operation decelerates to the set speed. (Assign a value smaller
ri
than that of parameter M32 to parameter M34.)
ll
Safety clamping speed
.A
(Safety supervisory mode 2)
N
M34
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
ZA
Se
M35
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Set to which door group the axis belongs in safety supervisory mode.
ig
yr
op
M36
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-496
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
A speed clamping signal is output after the axis has decelerated to the
clamping speed. This parameter specifies to what additional percentage
of the safety clamping speed the axis is to be decelerated as the output
timing of the speed clamping signal.
Safety clamping speed reduction judgment
coefficient If 0 is set, the speed clamping signal will be output when the axis
(Safety supervisory mode) decelerates to a 10% additional speed (i.e., 110% of the safety clamping
speed).
M37
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Set the machine interference detection distances for the INTELLIGENT
gh
SAFETY SHIELD.
ri
Set data so that the primary check distance is longer than the secondary
check distance.
ll
.A
N
Interference check distances for
O
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD during
TI
manual operation
60
interference check
PO
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
distance (M39)
A
Program type M, E
IM
Conditions At power on
Note :
K
For the machine specifications with a ram spindle, specify the maximum
M
operating range for the ram spindle selection. When ram spindle is
YA
M08/M09.
M40: Upper limit
)2
M41
ht
ig
yr
Program type M, E
op
2-497
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Set which door signal is input for the axis with door signal input on the
gh
drive side (servo) in safety supervisory mode.
ri
1: Door 1 signal
ll
Selection of a door for signal input on the 2: Door 2 signal
.A
drive side (servo) in safety supervisory
4: Door 3 signal
mode
N
8: Door 4 signal
M45
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
K
ri
Fixed value
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
—
ZA
M61
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 255
2-498
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.
Set the limit for the rapid traverse rate in orbit machining.
When “0” is set for M67 or the value set for M67 is larger than M1, the
rapid traverse rate is clamped at the value set for M1.
M67
Program type E
.d
Conditions After stop of movement
ve
er
Unit mm/min (°/min)
s
Setting range 0 to 99999999
re
Set the limit for the cutting feedrate in orbit machining.
ts
gh
When “0” is set for M68, the cutting feedrate is clamped at the value set
for M3.
ri
When the value set for M68 is larger than M1, the cutting feedrate is
ll
Cutting feedrate limit in orbit machining
.A
clamped at the value set for M1.
N
M68
O
TI
60
Program type E
A
R
40
PO
O
N
Fixed value
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
—
K
ZA
M70
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
Conditions —
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
0: Invalid
ht
1: Valid
ig
yr
op
constant selection
M72
(bit 0)
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-499
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
N1
d .
ve
Time
er
Program type M, E
N1 N1
s
Conditions Immediate
re
MPL523
Unit ms Note :
ts
gh
Setting range 4 to 1800 This parameter is valid only when bit 0 of M21 is 1.
ri
Set the time constant to obtain linear acceleration/deceleration of the
ll
cutting feed rate.
.A
Speed
N
Cutting-feed time constant
O
M3
(linear acceleration/deceleration)
TI
60
N2 A
R
40
PO
29
Time
R
o.
Program type M, E
O
N2 N2
N
Conditions Immediate
MPL523
al
Unit ms Note :
ri
ZA
Se
Setting range 4 to 1800 This parameter is valid only when bit 4 of M21 is 1.
A
linear deceleration)
ZA
(First-order lag)
M
N3 Time
YA
Time
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
N3 N3 N3 N3 × 2
Conditions Immediate MPL524
(c
Unit ms Note :
ht
2-500
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.
Set the time constant for the filter that further smoothens the speed signal
waveform during rapid feed (G0) operation with shape correction off and
during rapid feed operation in manual operation mode.
The filter will be invalid if 0 is set.
Time constant for post-interpolation rapid
feed acceleration/deceleration filter
N4
Program type M, E
d .
Conditions After stop of movement
ve
er
Unit ms
s
Setting range 0 to 455
re
First-order lag time constant for cutting-feed acceleration/ deceleration
ts
gh
(First-order lag) (Exponential acceleration/
Speed Speed linear deceleration)
ri
ll
Cutting-feed time constant M3 M3
.A
(First-order lag)
N
N5 Time Time
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E N5 N5 N5 N5 × 2
PO
29
Note :
o.
Unit ms
O
N
During external deceleration, the position loop is disconnected for the time
ri
ZA
interval set using this parameter and, as a result, the speed becomes
Se
zero.
A
IM
OT time
K
ZA
N7
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit ms
)2
The feed rate at which each axis is moved back to the zero-point
(reference point) after the zero-point watchdog LS (limit switch) has turned
ig
Feedrate
op
return
M2
N8
N8
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement Watchdog Zero point
Unit mm/min (°/min) (Reference point)
MPL525
Setting range 1 to 60000
2-501
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
The spacing at which the grid point is ignored during zero-point return
(reference point return in the initial operation after power-on) after the
zero-point watchdog LS (limit switch) is turned off. With this parameter,
dispersion in position deviations of the zero point can be avoided.
Amount of grid ignorance during initial
zero-point return
N9
Watchdog
Program type M, E Zero point
d.
(Reference point)
ve
Conditions Immediate N9 MPL526
er
Unit 0.001 mm (0.001°)
The amount of grid ignorance must not exceed 1 grid spacing.
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
Set the grid interval of the detector.
gh
Usually, set the same value as the ball screw pitch. However, set the grid
ri
interval of the detector if the grid interval differs from the pitch.
ll
.A
Grid interval
N
N10
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit mm (0.001°)
N
K
ri
A
IM
—
K
ZA
N12
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
N13
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-502
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.
N15
Program type —
. d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Machine dependent specific value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
N16
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
1: 1 ch
A
2: 2 ch
IM
N17
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
0: SW0
yr
1: SW1
op
2: SW2
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 6
2-503
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
N19
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 3
ts
76543210
gh
ri
Linear-type rotational axis (Note)
ll
0: Rotary type
.A
1: Linear type
N
Rotational axis shortcut
O
0: Invalid
TI
1: Valid
60
A
R
40
K
ri
0: No re-acquisition
IM
1: Re-acquisition
K
Conditions At power on When M18 bit 0 = 1 (type of C-axis: built-in type), if N21 bit 0 is set to 1
A
(linear type rotational axis), SA46 bit 2 must be set to 0 (C-axis position
Unit —
M
1: No positioning
)2
(bit 0)
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-504
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select whether or not to perform the command of an axis whose name is
gh
specified with a comma, “ ’,U ”, “ ’,V ” or “ ’,W ”.
(The “ ’,V ” axis command is not dependent on the set value.)
ri
ll
0: Do not perform
.A
Axis for which the axis name is specified
1: Perform
with a comma
N
N22
O
TI
(bit 2)
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type E
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Fixed value
Se
A
IM
K
—
ZA
N22
A
(bit 3)
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
Fixed value
ig
yr
op
C
—
N22
(bit 4)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-505
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the maximum allowable value, Amax, for the acceleration occurring
between blocks.
M27 100 – N26 2
Amax = × 60 × 1000 × 100 (mm/ms )
N25
Time constant for deceleration rate
calculation Note :
If M27 = 0, M27 is regarded as equal to M1 (rapid feed rate).
N25
If N25 = 0, N25 is regarded as equal to N1 (rapid feed time constant)
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement
er
Unit ms
s
re
Setting range 0 to 5000
ts
gh
ri
ll
Accuracy coefficient for deceleration rate
.A
calculation
N
N26
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
ZA
Se
superposition control.
A
IM
N27
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit ms
(c
superposition control.
yr
op
N28
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit ms
Setting range 4 to 1800
2-506
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.
N29
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit ms
s
re
Setting range 0 to 455
ts
Set the cutting feed time constant for a time constant changeover M-code
gh
Cutting feed time constant for time constant command.
ri
changeover M-code command
ll
N30: for M881 command Feed rate
.A
N31: for M882 command
N30 N32: for M883 command
N
N33: for M884 command
O
to
N34: for M885 command
TI
N35
60
PO
29
Program type M, E
R
O
N
Unit ms
C
ZA
Se
If the actual ball screw pitch is a decimal fraction (special gear ratio) with
A
rotations of the ball screw per rotation of the rotary axis (360 degrees/
actual ball screw pitch).
Multi-turn counter increment with absolute
K
gear ratio
A
N36
M
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Set the rotational speed of the rotary axis so that the number of rotations
yr
of the ball screw per rotation of the rotary axis (360 degrees/actual ball
screw pitch) will not be a decimal fraction.
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range –32768 to 32767
2-507
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Fixed value
N38
Program type —
. d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, maximum value
gh
The optimum time constant is calculated from the estimated inertia ratio by
ri
setting the maximum and minimum values for the rapid feed time constant
ll
and inertia ratio.
.A
Real time tuning II Rapid feed time
constant, maximum value Rapid feed time constant
N
O
N57
TI
N57
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
N60
R
Conditions Immediate
o.
O
N
Unit ms
C
Inertia ratio
N58 N61
al
ZA
The optimum time constant is calculated from the estimated inertia ratio by
IM
setting the maximum and minimum values for the rapid feed time constant
and inertia ratio.
K
N58
M
N57
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
The optimum time constant is calculated from the estimated inertia ratio by
op
setting the maximum and minimum values for the rapid feed time constant
C
N60
N57
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate N60
Unit ms Inertia ratio
Setting range 0 to 10000 N58 N61
2-508
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.
The optimum time constant is calculated from the estimated inertia ratio by
setting the maximum and minimum values for the rapid feed time constant
and inertia ratio.
Real time tuning II Maximum inertia ratio
Rapid feed time constant
N61
N57
. d
Program type M, E
ve
Conditions Immediate N60
er
Unit %
s
Inertia ratio
re
Setting range 0 to 65535 N58 N61
ts
The current time constant is used if the difference between the optimum
gh
time constant and current time constant is equivalent to or smaller than the
ri
value set for N63, and the optimum time constant is used if the difference
ll
is greater than the value set for N63.
.A
Real time tuning II Rapid feed time
constant, range of change
N
O
N63
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions Immediate
o.
O
N
Unit ms
C
al
ZA
Set the cutting feed time constant for variable acceleration control.
Se
N66
M
YA
[Related parameters]
3
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit ms
(c
0 : Invalid
op
1 : Valid
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-509
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Fixed value
—
N67
(bit 1)
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-510
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-3-15 Machine parameter ANOTHER (S)
Set for each axis the feed forward gain for acceleration/deceleration
before interpolation for the MAZAK Precision Rapid Boring Tornado
Option.
S3
d .
ve
er
Program type M, E
s
Conditions Immediate
re
Unit 0.1%
ts
gh
Setting range 0 to 1000
ri
Set for each axis the feed forward gain for acceleration/deceleration
ll
before interpolation.
.A
N
O
Feed forward gain
TI
60
S4 A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
Program type M, E
O
N
Conditions Immediate
al
Unit %
ri
ZA
Se
Set the position of the rotational center of the table in the machine
IM
coordinates system.
K
–X
ZA
A
S5
M
YA
–Y
01
S5 Note :
)2
1. Z-axis data are not required for a machine with a tilting table.
(c
Program type M, E
(For INTEGREX series)
C
2-511
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
When movement is beyond the length set by this parameter during the
power off, it activates the alarm mode.
If 0 is set, no alarm occurs.
S6
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in/
Unit
s
0.0001°
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
This parameter specifies the range of rotating machining for the table
gh
rotating machining (X-B machining).
ri
Set the upper limit (on Z-axis) of the machining range in the machine
ll
coordinates system.
.A
Upper limit (on Z-axis) of machining range The machine recognizes that it is prohibited to move beyond this limit in
for table rotating machining the negative direction.
N
O
S7
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions At power on
o.
(For HV machining)
N
ZA
S8
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
and Z).
yr
S10 –Y
S10 (Z)
Program type M, E
S10 (Y)
Conditions Immediate –Z
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range 0 to ±99999999 (For machines equipped with a tilting table)
2-512
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER
Specify the corner position of the tilting table in (Y- and Z-axial) distances
from its axis of rotation.
This parameter is used for the software travel limit function.
Corner position of the tilting table Note : X-axial data are not required.
S11
S11 (Z)
Program type M, E
d .
S11 (Y)
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm
(For machines equipped with a tilting table)
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Specify the axis of rotation of the tilting table in machine coordinates (Y
gh
and Z). Use this parameter to execute the automatic program origin
calculation function (option).
ri
Measure and enter data for respective machines.
ll
Axis of rotation of the tilting table
.A
Note : X-axial data are not required.
(Used for the automatic program origin
N
calculation function)
O
S12 –Y
TI
60
A S12 (Z)
R
40
PO
Program type M, E
29
S12 (Y)
–Z
R
Conditions Immediate
o.
O
N
ZA
Set the in-position width for G00. The in-position check for G00 is
Se
For utilizing the in-position width of G00, set the in-position width of the
IM
Note :
S13
A
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit 0.001 mm
(c
Set the inposition width for G01. The in-position check for G01 is effective
ig
when one of G09 (exact stop check), G61 (exact stop check mode) and
yr
the error detection is selected with the parameter K95 bit 7 set to 1.
op
For utilizing the in-position width for G01, set the in-position width of the
C
S14 Note :
1. This parameter is valid only when bit 3 of M19 is 0.
2. Setting a value outside 0 to 32767 assumes S14 = 50.
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit 0.001 mm
Setting range 0 to 32767
2-513
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Fixed value
S15
Program type —
. d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Set automatically after estimation of the characteristics.
gh
ri
ll
.A
Unbalanced axis torque offset
N
S16
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
A
IM
S17
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit %
(c
S18
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 200
2-514
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER
Specify the tool change completion position of the long boring bar end tool
by the corresponding machine coordinates.
S19
Machine S19
zero point
Program type M, E
.
Conditions Immediate MPL521
d
ve
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Unit
er
0.0001°
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
Set the completion position of automatic pallet change operation.
gh
ri
ll
.A
APC completion position
N
S20
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
ZA
Se
A
IM
operation
ZA
S21
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Specify the critical cutting feed rate to be used during tool tip point control.
ig
point control
S22
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit mm/min (°/min)
Setting range 1 to 200000
2-515
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the position of a reference workpiece zero point for each axis in the
machine coordinate system.
Set the position of a reference workpiece zero point relating to the turret
also in the machine coordinate system.
For machining centers, this parameter is invalid.
* Tool set value is determined based on this parameter.
Reference workpiece zero point X
S23 M
Z
d.
S23 (Z)
ve
er
S23 (X)
s
re
Program type M, E
ts
gh
Conditions After stop of movement
ri
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in Reference workpiece zero point
ll
Setting range ±99999999
.A
Sets the ATC complete position for long milling tools.
N
O
TI
60
A
R
Long milling tool ATC complete position
40
PO
29
S24
R
o.
O
N
C
al
Program type M, E
ri
ZA
Se
Set the central position of the tilt table upper surface on the VIRTUAL
ZA
tilt table
MACHINING display in terms of machine coordinates for each axis.
(for machines with a tilt table)
(For other machining centers)
3
+X +Y
ht
Conditions Immediate
yr
2-516
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER
Set the position of the tilt table rotational center on the VIRTUAL
MACHINING display in terms of machine coordinates for each axis.
+Z +Z
. d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
(Special function for machines with a tilt table)
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
For the machine specifications with a ram spindle, specify the offsets
gh
between the main spindle and the ram spindle for each axis.
ri
+Z +Z
ll
.A
+Y +X
N
O
TI
Ram spindle offset amount S27X
60
S27Y
A
R
40
S27
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
S27Z S27Z
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Main spindle
A
(Milling spindle)
Conditions Immediate
K
Unit 0.0001 mm
ZA
Setting range ±99999999 (Special function for machines with a ram spindle)
A
For graphics on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display, set with machine co-
M
+Z
01
S28
ht
S28 (X)
op
Program type M
C
Note :
Conditions At power on
This parameter is only used when multiple material pieces can be
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
arranged on the display in question (F35 bit 0 = 1). Use parameter S25
Setting range ±99999999 to set the center of the additional table’s upper surface.
2-517
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Machine
zero point
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
S29 (Z) Axis of rotation
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
(Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
Set the distance from the axis of rotation of the work hand to the reference
gh
position of the vice for the work hand during workpiece transfer.
ri
S30 (Z)
Distance from the axis of rotation of the Reference position
ll
of the vice
.A
work hand to the reference position of the
vice
N
S30
O
TI
Work hand S30 (X)
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
Axis of rotation
R
o.
Setting range ±99999999 (Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)
al
ZA
Se
Example :
A
G30.1X10.Z10.;
IM
Specification of the machine coordinates of Entry of the above command returns the tool in rapid feed mode
K
the floating reference point through the intermediate point (X10, Z10) to the floating reference point
ZA
Program type E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
The general setting for rapid traverse speed in parameter M1 will be used
also for the mode of tool tip point control if it is lower than the setting in
ig
parameter S32.
yr
op
Note :
tip point control
Set zero (0) in S32 if it is desirable to use the general setting in
S32 parameter M1 for the rapid traverse in question.
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit mm/min (°/min)
Setting range 0 to 200000
2-518
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER
Set the machine coordinate of the table edge on the negative side of the
X-axis.
Reference position X for the TEACH Machine zero point
Reference position S33 (X)
function, to be used for setting the LENGTH
B item of an angular tool
(For machines of five-surface machining by
S33 angular tools)
Program type M, E
d.
Table
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Set the amount of offset to add to the data for rotary head misalignment
gh
offset for each axis.
ri
ll
Amount of offset for rotary head * This parameter is valid on the machines with the capability of
.A
misalignment Maza-Check.
N
S34
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Set the position of the rotational center of the second table in the machine
ri
ZA
coordinate system when table selection is valid. (That of the first table to
Se
S35(Y) S5(Y)
A
S5(X)
M
YA
S35(X)
3
Z
01
Y
)2
S5(Z)
C
Z
Y
X
Conditions At power on Among the rotary axes (parameter M17 bit 4 = 1) excluding the rotary
head, the first axis is regarded as the first rotary table and the second
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in axis the second rotary table.
Setting range 0 to ±99999999
2-519
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the central position of the second additional table in the machine
coordinate system on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display when the table
selection function is valid. (Set the first additional table at parameter S25.)
For the table having the horizontal axis of rotation
S36(Y) S25(Y)
S25(X)
.
S36(X)
d
ve
er
Z
Position of the center of the second Y
s
re
additional table on the VIRTUAL X
MACHINING display
ts
S36
gh
For the table having the vertical axis of rotation
ri
ll
Machine zero point
.A
N
S36(Y) S36(Z) S25(Y)
O
S25(Z)
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Z
Y
R
o.
X
N
Program type M, E
al
Note :
ri
ZA
Conditions Immediate
Se
Among the rotary axes (parameter M17 bit 4 = 1) excluding the rotary
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
A
head, the first axis is regarded as the first rotary table and the second
IM
0: 1000 ms
M
YA
1 to 7: 8 ms
Time-out period for releasing the 8 to 3000: The time-out period is set according to the setting.
3
S38 Note :
(c
Program type M, E emergency stop status is output to register R71. When the ready
C
Conditions At power on lamp turning on process has failed due to a communication error,
“0” is output to the register R71.
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 3000
2-520
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER
Set the turning spindle number of the table control mechanism that
features switching of servo C-axis and turning spindle.
0: Specification not supported or the spindle C-axis specification
Turning spindle number of the table control 1 to 8: Spindle number
mechanism that features switching of servo
C-axis and turning spindle
S39
Program type M, E
d.
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0 to 8
re
Set the offset amount from the turning spindle 0°position to the servo
ts
C-axis machine zero point for the table control mechanism that features
gh
switching of servo C-axis and turning spindle.
ri
Offset amount from the turning spindle
ll
.A
0°position to the servo C-axis machine zero
point
N
S40
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit 0.0001°
O
N
ZA
Se
Set the axis of which setting check or rotation command is not output in
A
1: Non-target axis
(bit 0)
A
M
Note :
YA
Program type M This is invalid for rotational axes of the sixth or higher.
When parameter BA48 = 0 and L21 = 0, this is invalid for rotational
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Setting range 0, 1
(c
0 : Displayed
yr
1 : Hidden
op
counter
S45
(bit 1)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-521
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Sets the disable axis for the rapid feed overlapping function.
0: Rapid feed overlapping function enabled axis
1: Rapid feed overlapping function disabled axis
Rapid feed overlapping function disabled
axis * When bit 2 of S45 is set to “1”, the settings of S49 and S50 will be
S45 ignored.
(bit 2)
S49 : Rapid feed overlapping function: G0 in-position width
Program type M, E S50 : Rapid feed overlapping function: G1 in-position width
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Set the G0 in-position width to be used when the rapid feed overlapping
gh
function is valid.
ri
If a value outside the setting range is set, operation is carried out with the
upper limit value (10000000) or lower limit value (0).
ll
Rapid feed overlapping function:
.A
G0 in-position width
N
O
S49
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
0.0001 mm / 0.00001 in
O
Unit
N
0.0001°
al
ZA
Se
Set the G1 in-position width to be used when the rapid feed overlapping
A
function is valid.
IM
If a value outside the setting range is set, operation is carried out with the
upper limit value (10000000) or lower limit value (0).
K
G1 in-position width
A
M
S50
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
0.0001 mm / 0.00001 in
(c
Unit
0.0001°
ht
2-522
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER
Sets the distance from the center of rotation to the edge of the
small-diameter table for VARIAXIS.
Even if a value is set for the axis parallel to the rotary axis of the tilt table,
the value is not used for the software limit check.
S51
d .
ve
s er
S51 (Y)
re
ts
S11 (Y)
gh
Program type M, E
ri
Conditions Immediate [Related parameters]
ll
.A
Unit 0.0001 mm S11
(Function dedicated to machines equipped with the tilt table)
N
Setting range 0 to 99999999
O
Sets the in-position width for rapid feed overlapping at joints between
TI
consecutively specified G00 in the tool tip point control or cutting point
60
A
command mode.
R
40
PO
Rapid feed overlap function G0 in-position If a value outside the setting range is set, operation is carried out with the
29
width (for tool tip point control and cutting upper limit value (10000000) or lower limit value (0).
R
o.
point command) When 0 is set, the value set for S49 (Rapid feed overlapping function: G0
O
N
S52
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Program type M, E
IM
Conditions Immediate
K
0.0001 mm / 0.00001 in
Unit
ZA
S49
Setting range 0 to 10000000
M
Sets the in-position width for rapid feed overlapping at joints between
YA
consecutively specified G00 and G01 or G01 and G00 in the tool tip point
control or cutting point command mode.
3
01
Rapid feed overlap function G1 in-position If a value outside the setting range is set, operation is carried out with the
)2
width (for tool tip point control and cutting upper limit value (10000000) or lower limit value (0).
point command)
(c
When 0 is set, the value set for S50 (Rapid feed overlapping function: G1
in-position width) is used.
ht
S53
ig
yr
op
Program type M, E
C
Conditions Immediate
0.0001 mm / 0.00001 in [Related parameters]
Unit
0.0001° S50
Setting range 0 to 10000000
2-523
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Fixed value
S70
Program type —
d.
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
Setting range —
re
Used to select whether the alarms 1022 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM
ts
ALARM3 and 72 SERVO WARNING are to be displayed or not.
gh
0 : Displayed
ri
1 : Not displayed
ll
Smart safety monitoring alarm
.A
(for servo axis)
S71
N
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-524
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-3-16 Machine parameter SPINDLE (SA)
.
SA4 Invalid Invalid Invalid H
d
ve
Maximum spindle speed in each speed
range (range 1 to 8) Example :
SA1
er
Output voltage
s
to
re
SA8
ts
gh
MAX
ri
H
ll
L
.A
N
O
Program type M, E min
–1
TI
(Spindle speed)
60
Unit min
–1 SA1 SA10
PO
29
Address
ri
1 2 3 4
ZA
Se
SA10 Invalid H M ML
to SA11 Invalid Invalid H MH
K
Program type M, E
YA
Conditions At power on
–1
Unit min
3
01
Address
Maximum spindle speed during tapping 1 2 3 4
yr
SA17 L L L
to
C
SA18 Invalid H M ML
SA24 SA19 Invalid Invalid H MH
SA20 Invalid Invalid Invalid H
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 999999
2-525
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
–1
Unit min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999
ts
Scaling factor (for high-speed coil) with respect to the reference output of
gh
the load meter
ri
Output
(kW) Output diagram at
ll
Load meter reference output scaling factor short-time rating
.A
(high-speed coil) P0
N
Output diagram at
SA29
O
continuous rating
P1
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
N0 N1
29
Speed
Conditions Immediate SA29 = P1/P0 × 100 –1
(min )
R
o.
SA30 = N1
O
Unit %
N
K
ri
Base rotational speed (for high-speed coil) for the output changed by the
ZA
Se
parameter SA29 with respect to the reference output of the load meter
A
Output
IM
Output diagram at
SA30 continuous rating
A
P1
M
YA
Program type M, E
N0 N1
3
Speed
01
–1
Unit min
(c
Scaling factor (for low-speed coil) with respect to the reference output of
ig
Output
op
(low-speed coil) P0
Output diagram at
SA31 continuous rating
P1
Program type M, E
N0 N1 Speed
Conditions Immediate SA31 = P1/P0 × 100 –1
(min )
Unit % SA32 = N1
2-526
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Base rotational speed (for low-speed coil) for the output changed by the
parameter SA31 with respect to the reference output of the load meter
Output
Output diagram at
(kW)
Load meter reference output base short-time rating
P0
rotational speed (low-speed coil)
Output diagram at
SA32 continuous rating
P1
Program type M, E
.
N0
d
N1 Speed
ve
Conditions Immediate SA31 = P1/P0 × 100 –1
(min )
SA32 = N1
er
–1
Unit min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999
ts
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the synchronous
gh
tapping cycle
SA33: Range 1
ri
ll
SA34: Range 2
Acceleration/deceleration time constant for
.A
the synchronous tapping (range 1 to 8) SA35: Range 3
SA33
N
SA36: Range 4
to
O
TI
SA40
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit ms
N
ZA
Se
A
IM
SA41
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
–1
Unit min
(c
SA42
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 999999
2-527
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
SA43
Program type M, E
d .
Conditions At power on
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0 to 2
re
Specify the rotary switch number of the spindle amplifier.
ts
gh
0: SW0
ri
1: SW1
ll
2: SW2
Spindle amplifier rotary switch number
.A
3: SW3
N
SA44 4: SW4
O
5: SW5
TI
60
6: SW6 A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0 to 6
C
al
0: As specified by bit 1
ri
ZA
Spindle speed range changing method, in * For the setting of SA45 bit 0 = 1, set the rated torque, viscous &
IM
relation to switching the torque factors for coulomic friction coefficients of the spindle motor in the relevant
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection parameters as tabulated below:
K
SA45 type
ZA
Setting range 0, 1
(c
SA45 type 2
(bit 1)
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-528
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Program type M, E
d .
Conditions After stop of movement
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
Homing direction for synchronous tapping
.A
SA45
N
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
Program type M, E
A
R
40
PO
29
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
ZA
Se
A
IM
SA45
ZA
(bit 4)
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
0: Invalid
ht
1: Valid
ig
yr
op
SA45
(bit 5)
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-529
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Program type M, E
d .
Conditions After stop of movement
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
ts
76543210
gh
Direction of orientation
ri
00: Shorter route
ll
01: Forward rotation
.A
10: Reverse rotation
N
C-axis position control changeover type
O
00: After return to zero point
TI
01: After deceleration stop
60
type
PO
29
O
N
0: Forward rotation
K
ri
ZA
1: Reverse rotation
Se
0: Reverse rotation
M
1: Forward rotation
YA
Program type M, E
3
Unit —
)2
76543210
ig
yr
op
SA47
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-530
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
SA48
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 2
ts
Set the speed attainment detection width. If a value other than 1-99 (%) is
gh
set, the value will be regarded as 15 (%).
ri
ll
.A
Speed attainment detection width
N
SA49
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit %
N
Setting range 0 to 99
al
K
ri
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 8
ht
0, 5 to 8: Without gear
op
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 8
2-531
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
SA52
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 2
ts
Set the 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for the L coils of the spindle motor.
gh
Note :
ri
Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for 1. Only the 1/2h rated torque, not the 1/4h rated torque, may be known
ll
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection for the particular motor. If that is the case, set the 1/2h rated torque.
.A
type If coil selection is not possible for the spindle, enter the same value
in both SA53 and SA54. An alarm will result if 0 is entered even in
N
— L coils
SA53 either one of the two parameters.
O
TI
2. If bit 1 in SA45 is set to 1, set the 1/4h rated torque applied when
60
A
the spindle motor gear position is 1.
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
Set the 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for the H coils of the spindle motor.
ZA
Se
Note :
A
IM
Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for 1. Only the 1/2h rated torque, not the 1/4h rated torque, may be known
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection for the particular motor. If that is the case, set the 1/2h rated torque.
K
type If coil selection is not possible for the spindle, enter the same value
ZA
— H coils in both SA53 and SA54. An alarm will result if 0 is entered even in
SA54 either one of the two parameters.
A
M
2. If bit 1 in SA45 is set to 1, set the 1/4h rated torque applied when
the spindle motor gear position is 2.
YA
Program type M
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Set the 1/4h rated torque applied when the spindle motor gear position is
ig
3.
yr
Note :
op
type for the particular motor. If that is the case, set the 1/2h rated torque.
— Spindle gear position 3 2. This parameter is valid only when the setting of bit 1 in SA45 is 1.
SA55
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 N·m
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-532
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Set the 1/4h rated torque applied when the spindle motor gear position is
4.
Note :
Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection 1. Only the 1/2h rated torque, not the 1/4h rated torque, may be known
type for the particular motor. If that is the case, set the 1/2h rated torque.
— Spindle gear position 4 2. This parameter is valid only when the setting of bit 1 in SA45 is 1.
SA56
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.1 N·m
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-533
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Example :
Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for If “fms” is 90000 for an “S” value of 5000 and 140000 for S10000:
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection
type — Range 1 fms
SA57 140000 Gradient = b/a
b
90000
a
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit — 5000 10000 S
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
Since “cms” = (140000 – 90000) / (10000 – 5000) = 10, set “10” in the
gh
above example.
ri
Note :
Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for
ll
Set the spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” when SA45 bit 0 = 1.
.A
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection (Enter, moreover, 1000 times the respective calculation results in this
type — Range 2
N
case.)
SA58
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
type — Range 3
ZA
SA59
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
Unit —
(c
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range ±99999999
2-534
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Set the value where the width of the flat section in the current feedback
data matches estimated data.
Example :
Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms”
for auto-pecking of the cutting load If “fms” is 90000 for an “S” value of 5000 and 140000 for S10000, set “c”
detection type — Range 1 in L105.
SA61 fms
140000 Gradient = 10
b
Program type M
.
90000
d
a
ve
Conditions Immediate c
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range ±99999999 5000 10000 S
ts
gh
ri
Calculate “c” form the linear equation “y = (b/a) x + c”. Since “c” = 90000
Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” – (10 × 5000) = 40000, set “40000” in the above example.
ll
.A
for auto-pecking of the cutting load Note :
detection type — Range 2
N
Set the spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” when SA45 bit 0 = 1.
SA62
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
SA63
A
M
YA
Program type M
3
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
Unit —
(c
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range ±99999999
2-535
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the filter for the data which has been sampled at 3.5-ms intervals.
If the entered value is “0”, the data actually used will be 4 × 3.5 (ms).
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 3.5 ms
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
If the rotational speed of the milling spindle during polygonal machining
gh
exceeds the setting of this parameter, that rotational speed will be
clamped at this setting.
ri
Also, if the rotational speed of the milling spindle during hobbing exceeds
ll
Maximum permissible speed of milling
.A
the setting of this parameter, that rotational speed will be clamped at this
spindle for polygonal/hobbing machining setting.
N
SA66 Note : This parameter is valid only for the milling spindle.
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
–1
O
Unit min
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
P3 P4 P5
MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT
P1 P2
MACHINING
K
SA67
ZA
NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION P6
to Monitoring Functions
A
M
SA73 POSITION P0
YA
Speed
–1
Program type M, E (min )
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
–1
Unit min Cross axis: speed Vertical axis: output
Point
(c
–1
Setting range 0 to 999999 (Unit: min ) (Unit: 1/100 kW)
ht
P0 SA67 SA74
ig
2-536
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Set the spindle limit speed at which the time constant for the spindle
position control is to be changed
Spindle limit speed selection for spindle
position control time constants [Spindle speed]
SA81: Limit speed 1
SA81 SA82: Limit speed 2
to SA83: Limit speed 3 Max. spindle
speed
SA83
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on SA83
er
–1
Unit min
s
SA82
re
Setting range 0 to 999999
SA81
ts
gh
ri
0 [Time]
Spindle position control time constants
ll
SA84
SA84: Time constant 1
.A
SA84 SA85: Time constant 2
SA85
N
SA86: Time constant 3
to
O
TI
SA86 SA86
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit ms
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
Revolutions
A
IM
SA87: Revolutions 1
ZA
SA88
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Note :
ig
changeover revolutions.
Spindle speed operating time constant
op
SA10 to 16
SA89 SA90: Time constant 2
SA88 × (SA10 to 16/SA9)
SA91: Time constant 3
to SA87 × (SA10 to 16/SA9)
SA91
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-537
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
SA92
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
–1
Unit min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999
ts
Set the amount of shifting from the Z-phase when the axis is to be
gh
returned to its zero point for synchronous tapping.
ri
Shifting is conducted in the Z-phase detection direction (specified in bit 4
of SA46).
ll
Amount of synchronous tapping zero point
.A
shifting
N
SA93
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit °
N
K
ri
Set the homing speed effective when “After return to zero point” (SA46 bit
ZA
Se
SA94
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
–1
Unit min
(c
mode
SA95
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 999999
2-538
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Set the amount of shifting from the zero point of orientation control.
SA96
Program type M, E
.
Conditions Immediate
d
ve
Unit 0.00005°
er
Setting range ±7200000
s
re
The synchronous tapping time constant for high-speed synchronous
ts
tapping is reduced with respect to the synchronous tapping time constant
gh
set in parameter SA33 to SA40. The value set in SA97 becomes the
reduction ratio.
ri
Reduction ratio of the synchronous tapping
time constant for high-speed synchronous Without the high-speed synchronous tapping option or for the axis
ll
.A
tapping combination that does not allow high-speed synchronous tapping, normal
SA97 synchronous tapping is applied, in which case the data setting of SA33 to
N
SA40 is used as it is.
O
TI
High-speed synchronous tapping time constant
60
Program type M, E
A = SA33 × (100 – SA97)/100
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
Unit %
R
o.
cutting
ri
ZA
Se
* Set the value that is adjusted to the machine specification when the
IM
SA98
ZA
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit ms
)2
SA99
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 30000
2-539
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
–1
Unit min Cross axis: speed Vertical axis: output
s
Point
re
–1
Setting range 0 to 999999 (Unit: min ) (Unit: 1/100 kW)
P0 SA100 SA107
ts
Output in the following spindle output
gh
P1 SA101 SA108
diagrams at continuous rating: P2 SA102 SA109
ri
MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT P3 SA103 SA110
ll
.A
MACHINING P4 SA104 SA111
SA107 NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION P5 SA105 SA112
N
to
O
Monitoring Functions P6 SA106 SA113
TI
SA113 POSITION
60
Note : A
R
40
Program type M, E 1. Set values for spindle output diagrams at continuous rating.
PO
29
Conditions Immediate 2. This parameter is valid for models that allow you to switch between
R
Unit 0.01 kW
O
N
ZA
Se
If the operating speed of the spindle exceeds the set value in safety
A
supervisory mode 2, this will cause a safety supervisory alarm and bring
IM
safety supervision
ZA
SA114
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit min
(c
If the operating speed of the spindle exceeds the set value in safety
yr
supervisory mode 3, this will cause a safety supervisory alarm and bring
op
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 999999
2-540
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
–1
Unit min
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999
ts
Set the spindle safety clamping speed to be monitored in safety
gh
supervisory mode 3.
ri
In safety supervisory mode 3 and while a safety clamping request is in
effect, the spindle is decelerated to the set speed.
ll
Spindle safety clamping mode 3 for safety
.A
Assign a value smaller than the speed value to be monitored in mode 3
supervision
(i.e., specified in SA115).
N
SA117
O
Assign a value greater than the speed value to be monitored in mode 2
TI
(i.e., specified in SA116).
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
–1
O
Unit min
N
K
ri
Select the door group to which the spindle belongs in safety supervisory
ZA
Se
mode.
A
[Examples of setting]
whose speed is to be monitored
ZA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
request is input, a clamping signal will be output after the spindle has
yr
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 100
2-541
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
SA120
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit Teeth
s
re
Setting range –99999999 to 99999999
ts
Amount of branching point correction for Set the amount of correction at the branching point where one PLG gear
gh
spindle index gear tooth tooth is split into eight equal segments.
ri
SA121: Branching point [1]
SA122: Branching point [2]
ll
.A
SA123: Branching point [3]
SA121 SA124: Branching point [4]
N
SA125: Branching point [5]
to
O
SA126: Branching point [6]
TI
SA128 SA127: Branching point [7]
60
PO
Program type M, E
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.0001°
N
K
ri
ZA
Set the notch filter frequency for the cutting-load detection pecking cycle.
Se
A
IM
SA131
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit 0.1 Hz
(c
Set the notch filter depth to be used in the cutting-load detection pecking
ig
cycle.
yr
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 7
2-542
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Set the detection torque to be used when the breakage detection distance
(l) is specified for the cutting-load detection pecking cycle.
SA133
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.01 Nm
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
Set the maximum spindle orientation speed.
gh
Note :
ri
1. Some other functions (such as safety speed clamping control based
ll
on a PLC ladder) may cause the spindle orientation speed to be
.A
Maximum spindle orientation speed clamped at a speed lower than the setting of this parameter.
N
2. Immediately after power-on, the Z-phase is detected, so the spindle
SA134
O
is oriented at the maximum speed specified in parameter SA92, not
TI
SA134.
60
A
3. Clamping based on this parameter will be invalid if the setting is 0.
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
–1
O
Unit min
N
K
ri
controlled according to the override variable time constant (SA98) and the
A
Spindle
Override change Speed change width
K
SA135
M
YA
Time
3
Program type M, E
thread cutting (SA98)
)2
Conditions Immediate
–1 * Set the value that is adjusted to the machine specification when the
(c
Unit min
override variable thread cutting option is provided. When this parameter
ht
Set which door signal is input for the axis with door signal input on the
yr
1: Door 1 signal
C
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 255
2-543
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
SA139
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Sets the turret indexing gear ratio at the motor side.
gh
ri
ll
.A
Turret indexing gear ratio at the motor side
N
SA140
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
N
K
ri
SA142
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
2-544
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Program type M, E
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Set whether or not a spindle gear shift command and a turning spindle
ts
speed command are output simultaneously.
gh
0: Not output simultaneously
ri
1: Output simultaneously
ll
Simultaneous output of a gear shift M code
.A
and a turning spindle speed command
SA143
N
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
R
M
40
Program type
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
ZA
SA143
ZA
(bit 3)
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
Fixed value
ht
ig
yr
op
—
C
SA143
(bit 4)
Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —
2-545
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Fixed value
—
SA143
(bit 5)
.
Program type —
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
SA143
O
TI
(bit 6)
60
A
R
40
PO
Program type —
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
ZA
0: Invalid
Se
1: Valid
A
IM
SA144
A
(bit 0)
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: H winding coil
ig
1: L winding coil
yr
op
Spindle winding coil selection while * This parameter is valid when bit 0 of parameter SA144 is set to 1.
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-546
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
0: Include
1: Do not include
Program type M, E
.d
Conditions Immediate
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
0: Spindle cycle counter increase
ts
gh
1: Spindle cycle counter decrease
ri
ll
Encoder polarity for the spindle rotation for
.A
normal thread cutting
SA144
N
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
ZA
Se
A
IM
SA144
ZA
(bit 5)
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
SA144
(bit 6)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-547
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range 0, 1
re
Sets the M code number for enabling the spindle speed fluctuation
ts
synchronous mode for the spindle speed fluctuation function.
gh
ri
Spindle speed fluctuation function
ll
.A
M code number for enabling the spindle
speed fluctuation synchronous mode
N
SA231
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Sets the M code number for disabling the spindle speed fluctuation
ri
ZA
A
IM
SA232
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
Conditions At power on
01
Unit —
)2
Sets the M code number for enabling the spindle speed fluctuation for the
ht
fluctuation
SA233
Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 999
2-548
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE
Sets the M code number for disabling the spindle speed fluctuation for the
spindle speed fluctuation function.
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 999
ts
Fixed value
gh
ri
ll
.A
—
N
SA242
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
ZA
Se
0: Normal
A
1: Reverse
IM
(bit 0)
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
Used to select whether the alarms 1022 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM
ht
0: Displayed
yr
1: Not displayed
op
SA243
(bit 1)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-549
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
BA1 BA1
d .
ve
Program type M, E
er
NM211-00312
Conditions Immediate
s
re
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
ts
Setting range 0 to 99999999
gh
Setting of chuck width of the No. 1 turning spindle
ri
ll
.A
BA2
N
Chuck width (for chuck barrier)
O
— No. 1 turning spindle
TI
BA2
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M, E
R
o.
Conditions Immediate
N
NM211-00313
ri
ZA
BA3 BA3
YA
3
01
Program type M, E
)2
Conditions Immediate
NM211-00314
(c
Specify the workpiece outside diameter to be used for the EIA program.
yr
op
C
BA4 BA4
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in BA17
2-550
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
BA5 BA5
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate Note :
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in For single turning-spindle specifications, this parameter is invalid.
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Setting of chuck width of the No. 2 turning spindle
gh
ri
ll
Chuck width (for chuck barrier)
.A
— No. 2 turning spindle
N
BA6
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
NM211-00313
29
BA6
Conditions Immediate
R
Note :
o.
K
ri
A
IM
BA7 BA7
A
M
YA
Conditions Immediate
Note :
)2
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in For single turning-spindle specifications, this parameter is invalid.
(c
BA8
NM211-00315
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-551
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
BA9
BA9
Program type M, E
d .
NM211-00316
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Setting of tail spindle outside diameter
gh
ri
ll
Tail spindle outside diameter
.A
(for tail barrier) BA10
N
BA10
O
TI
60
A NM211-00317
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
BA11
IM
BA11
A
M
YA
NM211-00318
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
BA12
NM211-00319
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-552
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
BA13
BA13
NM211-00320
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Setting of tail head taper angle
gh
ri
ll
Tail head taper angle
.A
BA14
(for tail barrier)
N
BA14
O
TI
60
A NM211-00321
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit 0.001°
N
K
ri
A
IM
BA15
(for tail barrier)
ZA
BA15
A
NM211-00322
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
2-553
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the dimensional data for forming tail barriers using an EIA/ISO
program.
<During tail operation>
BA17 BA16
.d
EIA tail barrier <During tail reversing>
ve
BA16 Tail dimensions
s er
to
re
BA18 Machine
ts
zero point BA18
gh
ri
ll
.A
BA16: Tail extruding length
N
BA17: Workpiece length (Note 2)
O
BA18: Distance from the machine zero point to the leading edge
TI
position during tail reversing
60
PO
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in 2. BA17 is valid for MAZATROL programs as well, when ONLY MILL
R
o.
C
al
Specify the distance from the machine zero point of the Z-axis to the edge
K
ri
BA19
Distance from the Z-axis machine zero
IM
BA19
A
Spindle
M
edge
YA
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate Note :
3
01
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in Enter the distance with minus sign for the machine zero point in the
minus direction with respect to the spindle edge.
)2
Specify the distance from the machine zero point of the Z-axis to the edge
ht
BA20
Distance from the Z-axis machine zero
op
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in Enter the distance with minus sign for the machine zero point in the
minus direction with respect to the spindle edge.
Setting range ±99999999
2-554
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Specify the jaw number that has been registered on the CHUCK JAW
DATA display to be referred to in the EIA program when forming a jaw
barrier for the No. 1 turning spindle.
BA21
Program type E
d.
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 1 to 44
ts
Specify the jaw number that has been registered on the CHUCK JAW
gh
DATA display to be referred to in the EIA program when forming a jaw
barrier for the No. 2 turning spindle.
ri
ll
Jaw number for EIA program barrier
.A
— No. 2 turning spindle
N
BA22
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 1 to 44
al
K
ri
BA24
A
IM
Turret dimensions
K
ZA
BA23
A
BA24 BA23
M
Conditions Immediate
)2
Specify the turret reference position from the machine zero point for the
ig
Turret
op
reference BA26
position
C
2-555
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Setting of tool holder mounting position. When plus data is used, the tool
holder is mounted horizontally, and minus data downward.
Tool holder mounting position Example : Type 1
BA27 - Type 1 Turret reference positon
BA27 BA30 - Type 2
BA33 - Type 3 BA27 (> 0)
BA30
BA36 - Type 4
BA33
BA36
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
BA27 (< 0) NM211-00327’
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
Same for types 2, 3, 4
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
Setting tool holder width in X-axis direction
gh
Example : Type 1
ri
Tool holder width in X-axis direction Turret reference position
ll
BA28 - Type 1
.A
BA28 BA31 - Type 2
BA34 - Type 3
N
BA31
BA37 - Type 4
O
BA34
TI
BA28
60
NM211-00328’
o.
K
ri
Example : Type 1
A
BA29 - Type 1
BA29
K
BA32 - Type 2
ZA
BA35
M
BA38
YA
Program type M
3
BA29 BA29
01
2-556
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Set the holder shape data for forming tool barriers using an EIA/ISO
program.
<Holder-under type>
Input BA39 with a minus sign.
BA40
d.
BA39
ve
er
BA41
EIA tool barrier
s
re
BA39 Holder dimensions
ts
to <Holder-side type (0° type)> <Holder-side type (180° type)>
gh
BA41 Input BA39 with a plus sign. Input BA39 with a plus sign.
ri
Input BA41 with a plus sign. Input BA41 with a minus sign.
ll
.A
BA39 BA39
N
O
BA40 BA40
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
BA41
R
BA41
o.
O
N
Program type E
C
Conditions Immediate BA40: EIA tool barrier, X-axial width of the holder
K
ri
Barrier type
YA
BA42
3
01
)2
Program type M, E
(c
Conditions Immediate
ht
Unit —
ig
yr
2-557
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the first tool number assigned to the first set of tools.
BA43
Program type M, E
. d
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 1 to 4000
ts
Set the number of tools assigned as the first set of tools.
gh
ri
ll
.A
Number of tools (in the 1st set of tools)
N
BA44
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
N
K
ri
Set the first tool number assigned to the second set of tools.
ZA
Se
A
IM
BA45
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
BA46
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 1 to 960
2-558
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 4
ts
Set the axis name of the head axis to be rotated.
gh
Set “&42” if the head axis to be rotated is the B-axis.
ri
ll
.A
Axis name of the head to be rotated
N
BA48
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
N
K
ri
control functions.
A
(Inclined-axis control)
ZA
BA49
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions At power on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 16
ht
control functions.
yr
(Inclined-axis control)
BA50
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16
2-559
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At power on BA51
BA52
er
Unit —
s
Yt
re
Setting range ±99999999 BA53
ts
gh
Set the value of BA51/BA52 assuming that 10000000 is assigned to
ri
BA53.
ll
Vector of real X
.A
(Inclined-axis control)
N
BA52
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
o.
Unit —
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
Vector of real Y
K
(Inclined-axis control)
ZA
BA53
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions At power on
01
)2
Unit —
(c
Set the axis number of the work spindle to be used for hobbing.
ig
BA54
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16
2-560
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range –1 to 3
ts
Set the turning spindle to be used in the D2 command mode of polygonal
gh
machining.
ri
0: Turning spindle No. 1
1: Turning spindle No. 2
ll
Turning spindle number for polygonal
.A
2: Turning spindle No. 3
machining (D2) 3: Turning spindle No. 4
N
BA56 –1: Invalid
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range –1 to 3
al
K
ri
machining.
A
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range –1 to 3
ht
machining.
yr
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range –1 to 3
2-561
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
If 0 is set in BA59, 3 will be regarded as having been set, and M03 will
d
ve
Conditions Immediate be output.
er
Unit — If 0 is set in BA60, 4 will be regarded as having been set, and M04 will
s
be output.
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
gh
ri
ll
Spindle reverse rotation M-code for tapping
.A
cycle
N
BA60
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type —
PO
29
Conditions —
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
Enter the distance from the rotational center of the B-axis to the tool
ZA
Se
center.
A
BA61
BA61
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
Note :
3
01
Conditions Immediate Enter the distance with a minus sign for B-axis rotational center above
)2
Enter the distance from the rotational center of the B-axis to the spindle
ig
edge.
yr
distance
BA62
2-562
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
BA63
.
Program type M
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit ° HLD.TYP: 45 HLD.TYP: 45
s
(BA63 = 45) (180 – BA63 = 135)
re
Setting range 0 to 90
ts
gh
Upper turret
ri
BA65
machine zero point
ll
.A
B-axis tool reference position X
N
BA64
O
BA64
TI
60
A Upper turret
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
BA65
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Set the deceleration area and measuring area in the G37 command.
ig
BA66: Set the distance between the starting point of movement at the
yr
measuring rate, and the measuring point. This value will be used
op
G37 measuring area BA67: Set the moving distance in measuring feed mode. This value will
be used when argument D is omitted from the G37 command.
BA66
BA67
Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Unit
±99999999
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-563
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the deceleration area and measuring area in the G36 command.
BA68: Set the distance between the starting point of movement at the
measuring rate, and the measuring point. This value will be used
when argument R is omitted from the G36 command.
G36 deceleration area
BA69: Set the moving distance in measuring feed mode. This value will
G36 measuring area
BA68 be used when argument D is omitted from the G36 command.
BA69
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Workpiece zero point:
gh
Workpiece edge center
ri
Tool position reference point:
Reference point on the turret
ll
.A
Turret clearance:
Distance between the reference points on both turrets (radius value)
N
O
Workpiece offset:
TI
Workpiece zero point – Reference point of reference turret tool
60
<Schematic diagram>
o.
O
N
Tool position
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Work offset
Se
Turret clearance
IM
(BA70)
K
Program type M, E
Workpiece zero point
ZA
Conditions Immediate
A
1: System 2
01
2: System 3
)2
3: System 4
(c
BA71
yr
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 3
2-564
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
BA72
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit %
s
re
Setting range 0 to 100
ts
0: Chuck, sub-chuck and tailstock invalid
gh
1: Chuck valid
ri
2: Sub-chuck valid
ll
Barrier valid/invalid 1 3: Tailstock valid
.A
(chuck, sub-chuck, tailstock)
N
BA73
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0 to 3
al
K
ri
BA74
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-565
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the reference position when it is viewed from the machine zero point.
BA77
BA75 (#1) BA64
(#1) (#1)
Upper turret BA78
Barrier setup turret reference position BA92 (#1)
BA75 (#1)
X1
.
to
d
ve
Z1
BA78 BA76 (#1)
er
B-axis tool reference position
s
Lower turret/Steady rest
re
BA78
ts
BA92 Z2 (#2)
(#2)
gh
X2 BA76
ri
Program type M, E BA75 BA77 (#2)
(#2) (#2)
ll
Conditions Immediate
.A
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in BA19 (#2)
Lower turret/Steady rest
N
machine zero point
O
Setting range ±99999999
TI
Set the reference position 1 of the chucks with respect to the machine
60
A
zero point of the upper turret.
R
40
Use J109 to J112 for machines with the No. 2 spindle set as System 1.
PO
29
BA79
N
BA82
ZA
Se
BA82
A
(#2)
Program type M, E
IM
BA82 (#1)
Conditions Immediate
K
BA80 (#1)
(#2)
Setting range ±99999999
A
M
Set the chuck reference position 2 to be used to set barrier around jaws
YA
BA86
BA86 BA86 (#1)
ig
(#2)
yr
op
Program type M, E
C
Conditions Immediate
BA84 (#1) BA84
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in (#2)
Setting range ±99999999
2-566
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
d .
ve
to
er
BA90 BA87 BA89
s
(#1) (#1)
re
ts
BA88
gh
(#1)
ri
ll
BA90
.A
Program type M, E (#1)
N
Conditions Immediate
O
R10366 (lower-order)
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
TI
R10367 (higher-order)
60
BA91
N
plate
ri
ZA
BA91
Se
point plate
K
Program type M, E
ZA
Conditions Immediate
BA91
A
Set the central position X when viewed from the machine zero point.
3
01
Z1
yr
op
C
Program type M, E
BA92 Z2
Conditions Immediate
(HD2)
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in X2 Lower turret (HD2)
machine zero point
Setting range —
2-567
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
When using the C-axes of the HD1/HD2 in the lower turret system, set the
offset angle with respect to the upper turret, for the lower turret system.
<HD1> <HD2>
BA93: Upper/lower turret tool angle
difference (HD1)
BA94: Upper/lower turret tool angle
BA93 difference (HD2)
BA93
BA93 BA94
BA94
BA94 XX XX
YY CC CC YY
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001°
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
Use BA95 and BA96 to set the dimensions of the sensor for tool nose
gh
measurement.
BA97 and BA99 are provided to set in machine coordinates the reference
ri
point of the sensor (see the diagram below).
ll
.A
Example :
1. For horizontal type
N
O
Machine zero point
TI
60
A
R
40
BA97
O
reference point
N
Sensor’s
C
BA95
K
reference point
BA99
ri
ZA
BA96
Se
BA99
ht
ig
Sensor’s
reference point
yr
BA97
op
C
BA99
Program type M
Sensor for tool nose
Conditions Immediate
measurement
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
BA95
Setting range ±99999999
2-568
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
s
re
Setting range ±99999999
ts
Set adjustment “FdT” for holding the thrust of the servo axis.
gh
Set a value less than BA108 × BA106/100.
ri
If any other value is set, the thrust may be unstable.
ll
.A
Adjustment “FdT” for servo axis thrust hold
N
BA105
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
K
ri
Set the dead zone for the drooping level of the servo axis thrust.
ZA
Se
Dead zone
K
ZA
BA106
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit %
(c
Set the monitoring time for changes in the drooping level of the servo axis
ig
thrust.
yr
op
C
Filter
BA107
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit 1/3.5 ms
Setting range 0 to 99999999
2-569
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the drooping level for holding the servo axis thrust.
This drooping level is held during the application of the servo axis thrust.
BA108
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement
er
Unit 0.00005 mm
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Specify the axis offset amount applied during automatic calculation of the
gh
tool setting value for the backface tool, which is difficult to measure using
the TOOL EYE. This automatic calculation is done based on the tool
ri
setting value for the target tool measured in the opposite position.
ll
Offset amount (X) during automatic tool
.A
setting value calculation
N
BA109
O
Reference workpiece
TI
zero point
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
K
ri
ZA
Se
Offset amount (Z) during automatic tool TOOL SET X = Tool setting value X for target tool + Parameter for offset
K
amount Z
YA
Program type M, E
3
Conditions Immediate
01
)2
Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration Set the pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for a time
ig
time constant for time constant changeover constant changeover M-code command.
yr
BA111: For M881 command acceleration/deceleration time constant will not be changed, even when a
time constant changeover M-code command is assigned. The
C
Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 999999
2-570
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Set the outside diameter and width for the turret which is to be indicated
on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display.
BA118
Outside diameter of the turret for Virtual
Machining
BA117 BA117
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
Width of the turret for Virtual Machining
N
BA118
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
K
ri
0: Head 1
ZA
Se
1: Head 2
A
2: Head 1/2
IM
TOOL EYE
ZA
BA119
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
Set the X-axis position of mounting the HOLDER part of an assembly tool
ig
model.
yr
Machine
op
zero point
Mounting position X for an assembly tool
C
model
BA120
BA120
2-571
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Set the Z-axis position of mounting the HOLDER part of an assembly tool
model.
BA121
Machine
Mounting position Z for an assembly tool zero point
model
BA121
.
mounting position
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999
ts
Specify the turret reference position from the machine zero point for the
gh
turret-type tool post (for VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display).
ri
Turret BA123
For VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D
ll
reference
.A
MONITOR display position
Turret reference position
N
BA122
O
BA123 BA122
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
K
ri
A
IM
K
—
ZA
BA124
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-572
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Set the types of tailstock, tool holder and chuck for which the EIA barriers
are to be activated.
76543210
d .
Tool holder present/absent
ve
0: Absent
er
1: Present
s
re
Barrier tool nose position
ts
0: Tool length correction
gh
1: Current tool nose
ri
EIA barrier activation Setting of BA11 is handled as tailstock extruding
ll
length
.A
BA125
Execution of spindle revolution M-code specified in
N
same block as synchronous tapping
O
0: Invalid
TI
1: Valid
60
A
R
40
0: Valid
29
1: Invalid
R
o.
0: Valid
al
1: Invalid
ri
ZA
Note :
Se
1. “Tailstock usage invalid” does not mean canceling the tail barriers; it
IM
If bit 1 is set to 0, the tailstock function itself will become invalid. For
ZA
4. Bit 6 of this parameter is valid only when the setup data has been
YA
Unit —
entered.
Setting range Binary, eight digits
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-573
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
76543210
System to be made valid without system selection
for queuing
Y-axis interference type
0: Type A 1: Type B
Y-axis moving range display
0: Invalid 1: Valid
Tool command scheme (Note)
0: M06 required. 1: M06 not required.
.
FLASH tool valid/invalid
d
ve
0: Invalid 1: Valid
—
er
Milling spindle orientation command (M219)
s
0: Output 1: No output
BA126
re
System without turret
ts
gh
Shape of the tailstock center for Virtual Machining
ri
0: Single stage 1: Twin stage
ll
Note :
.A
T-command operation is defined as follows by the setting of bit 3:
N
If the setting of bit 3 is 0
O
TTM6: Replaces the current tool with and indexes as the
TI
60
next tool.
A
TM6: Replaces the current tool with .
R
40
Unit — T: Replaces the current tool with and set as the tool
O
N
offset number.
C
76543210
ri
ZA
Se
TTM6M202
0: No simultaneous output
3
— 1: Simultaneous output
01
0: Output 1: No output
yr
2-574
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Method of automatic determination of the virtual nose point for tool
gh
measuring unit (TOOL EYE)
ri
0: Determined according to the machining section, direction of rotation
and orientation (left/right hand) in the tool data
ll
.A
* If measurement is carried out at a B-axis angle other than that used for
actual machining, the measurement result will not be correct because
N
the virtual nose point that is automatically determined for measurement
O
TI
according to the machining section, direction of rotation and orientation
60
(left/right hand) of the tool will not agree with the virtual nose point of the
A
actual tool.
R
40
PO
29
Machining
O
section: O.D.
C
measurement measurement
Left hand
pattern #1 pattern #3
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
BA128
ZA
measurement pattern does not agree with the virtual nose point that is
)2
Machining
yr
Tool nose
points agree
Program type M
Conditions Immediate Tool nose point Tool nose points agree
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-575
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for the AFC function in the first set
of tool data (BA43, BA44)
0: Valid
Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for 1: Invalid
the AFC function in the first set of tool data
(BA43, BA44)
BA128
(bit 2)
Program type M
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for the AFC function in the
gh
second set of tool data (BA45, BA46)
ri
0: Valid
Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for
ll
1: Invalid
the AFC function in the second set of tool
.A
data (BA45, BA46)
BA128
N
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
Program type M
A
R
40
PO
Conditions Immediate
29
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-576
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
0: Approach from the approach relay point (APK2) for TOOL EYE #2, #4
1: Approach from the approach relay point (APK1) for TOOL EYE #2, #4
<When bit 4 of parameter BA128 is set to 0>
* The areas enclosed with dotted lines show approaches to TOOL EYE
#2/#4.
APK2 <Upper turret SP1> <Upper turret SP2>
APK1 APK1
AP2 AP2
d .
L28 L28 L28 L28
ve
TOOL TOOL
EYE EYE AP4
s er
AP4
re
AP3
<Lower turret SP1> <Lower turret SP2>
ts
gh
AP4 AP3 AP3 AP4
ri
TOOL TOOL
ll
EYE EYE
L28 L28
.A
L28 L28
AP2 AP1 AP1 AP2
N
L78 L78 L78
L78
O
TI
APK2 APK1 APK2
APK1
60
A
R
40
AP1: TOOL EYE #1 approach point, APK1: TOOL EYE #1/#3 approach relay point
PO
29
AP2: TOOL EYE #2 approach point, APK2: TOOL EYE #2/#4 approach relay point
o.
K
ri
(bit 4)
ZA
* The areas enclosed with dotted lines show approaches to TOOL EYE
Se
#1/#2/#3/#4.
A
IM
TOOL
EYE EYE
M
YA
AP3 AP3
AP3 AP3
01
TOOL
)2
TOOL
EYE
EYE
L28
(c
L28
ht
L78 L78
ig
AP1 AP1
yr
APK1 APK1
op
C
Related parameters
L28: Amount of Z-axial retreat from the approach point for TOOL EYE
measurement
Program type M L78: Amount of X-axial retreat from the approach point for TOOL EYE
measurement
Conditions Immediate
SU118 to SU121: Tool change position during TOOL EYE measurement
Unit —
SU158 (bit 0): Tool change position during TOOL EYE measurement
Setting range 0, 1
2-577
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
0: Invalid
gh
1: Valid
ri
ll
.A
Turret lathe with an ATC unit
N
BA128
O
(bit 6)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
0: Invalid
A
1: Valid
IM
Note : Setting of bit 7 is valid only for machines without lower turret.
ZA
turret
BA128
A
(bit 7)
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions At pwer on
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Not output
ig
1: Output
yr
op
Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-578
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
Fixed value
—
BA129
(bit 1)
Program type —
d .
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
Select the inclination to be used for fixed G0 inclination control (option) in
gh
the G68/G68.5 mode when parameter M1 (rapid feed rate) and parameter
N1 (rapid-feed time constant) are used.
ri
0: Uses the minimum inclination among the actual axes after G68/G68.5
ll
Fixed G0 inclination control in the
.A
conversion.
G68/G68.5 mode
1: Uses the minimum inclination among the virtual axes before
N
BA129
G68/G68.5 conversion. (*)
O
(bit 2)
TI
60
A
* If the move command specifies one axis, the inclination of the specified
R
40
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Select whether or not to measure the milling tool length with the tool
ZA
Se
measuring unit.
A
0: When a milling tool is selected, its length is not be measured and the
IM
Selection of whether or not to measure the alarm 714 ILLEGAL SEQUENCE DATA is raised.
milling tool length with the tool measuring
K
unit
BA129 When BA129 bit 3 is 0, no measurement is performed on models in which
parameters are set as described below.
A
(bit 3)
M
Unit — For INTEGREX i with a workpiece hand, even if BA129 bit 3 is 0, the
(c
selected
yr
0: Not displayed
op
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-579
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Planetary tapping in the MAZATROL rear XY mode
gh
0: Helical machining in the CCW direction (right-hand thread cutting)
ri
1: Helical machining in the CW direction (left-hand thread cutting)
ll
Planetary tapping in the MAZATROL rear
.A
XY mode
N
BA129
O
(bit 7)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
Fixed value
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
—
ZA
BA130
A
(bit 1)
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
0: Not set
op
1: Set
C
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-580
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Switches the approach pattern for TOOL EYE measurement in
gh
MAZATROL program.
ri
0: xtends the TOOL EYE after approach selected by the SU11 setting.
ll
1: Executes zero-point return first, and then executes approach after
.A
Switching of the approach pattern in TOOL extending the TOOL EYE.
EYE measurement (MAZATROL program)
N
1. The turret always moves to the machine zero point.
BA131
O
2. Extends the TOOL EYE.
TI
(bit 5)
60
PO
* After the measurement with the TOOL EYE, the following operation
29
ZA
Se
Sets the axis number of the axis to be used as the hobbing axis in hobbing
A
BA241
M
YA
3
Program type E
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 31
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-581
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Sets the initial fluctuation cycle for the spindle speed fluctuation function.
Note :
If 0 is set, 0.1 s is assumed.
Spindle speed fluctuation function If 50 or greater is set, 50 is assumed.
Fluctuation cycle Initial value
MS26
d .
ve
er
Program type E
s
Conditions At power on
re
Unit 0.1 s
ts
gh
Setting range 0 to 50
ri
Sets the initial fluctuation amplitude with respect to the specified speed for
ll
the spindle speed fluctuation function.
.A
Note :
N
Spindle speed fluctuation function If 0 is set, 1% is assumed.
O
Fluctuation amplitude Initial value If 50 or greater is set, 50 is assumed.
TI
60
A
R
MS27
40
PO
29
R
o.
Program type E
O
N
Conditions At power on
al
Unit %
ri
ZA
Se
Setting range 0 to 50
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-582
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MACHINE STRUCTURE
Sets the initial fluctuation mode for the spindle speed fluctuation function.
0: MODE 1: Increasing/decreasing the spindle speed with respect to the
specified speed
–1
Spindle speed (min )
Spindle speed
Fluctuation during fluctuation
amplitude
Specified speed
d .
ve
er
Spindle speed fluctuation function
Spindle speed fluctuation mode
s
Fluctuation cycle
re
Initial value
Time
MS125
ts
gh
(bit 0)
ri
1: MODE 2: Increasing/decreasing the spindle speed by taking the
ll
specified speed as the upper limit
.A
–1
Spindle speed (min )
N
O
TI
60
A Fluctuation
amplitude
R
40
Specified speed
PO
29
Spindle speed
during fluctuation
R
o.
Program type E
O
N
Conditions At power on
al
Fluctuation cycle
K
Unit —
ri
ZA
Time
Se
Setting range 0, 1
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-583
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Meaning Description
Set values
BAUDRATE
110 4800
300 9600
1200 19200
d .
2400
ve
Program type M, E
er
Conditions At I/O startup
s
Unit —
re
Setting range 110 to 19200
ts
gh
Type of processing to be executed if the machining program of an existing
work number is to be loaded
ri
ll
.A
SAME WNo. Set values Description
N
Issues an alarm if the work number
O
ALARM
already exists.
TI
60
A LOAD
Overrides the program if the work
R
40
Unit —
O
N
Setting range —
al
ZA
Se
A
IM
Program type M, E
3
Unit —
)2
Setting range —
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-584
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title CMT
Invalid
—
CMT1
to
CMT32
Program type —
.
d
ve
Conditions —
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-585
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Meaning Description
Set values
BAUDRATE
110 4800
300 9600
1200 19200
d .
2400
ve
Program type M, E
er
Conditions At I/O startup
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 110 to 19200
gh
Number of data bits (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)
ri
ll
Set values
.A
DATA BITS
N
7
O
TI
8
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M, E
R
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 7, 8
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
Set values
K
PARITY
ZA
NONE
A
ODD
M
EVEN
YA
3
Program type M, E
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
Set values
C
STOP BITS
1
1.5
2
Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range —
2-586
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE
Meaning Description
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range —
ts
The waiting time for replies from the connected device during inputting or
gh
outputting.
ri
An alarm occurs if this time elapses following the final reply.
ll
.A
WAIT TIME
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit 0.1 s
N
K
ri
ZA
FORMAT
EIA Paper tape punching in EIA code
ZA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range —
2-587
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Meaning Description
Set
values Data I/O Tape operation
RS232C RS232C
PORT COM1
conversion connector conversion connector
RS232C RS232C
COM2
conversion connector conversion connector
RS232C RS232C
COM3
conversion connector conversion connector
d .
ve
RS232C RS232C
Program type M, E COM4
conversion connector
er
conversion connector
Conditions At I/O startup
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range —
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-588
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE
d.
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 5
ts
Effective only when TAP1 is set to 4 or 5.
gh
ri
ll
.A
Terminator code 1
N
TAP2
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
N
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
K
Terminator code 2
ZA
TAP3
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
0: No placement of CR
op
1: Placement of CR
C
TAP4
Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-589
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
DC code parity
0 No assignment
1 Assignment
TAP5
Note :
This parameter is valid only when HAND SHAKE is set to DC
Program type M, E CONTROL.
. d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Select whether or not DC2 and DC4 codes are to be output to the feed
gh
sections which will be generated at the beginning and end of paper tape
punching.
ri
Example : :
ll
.A
Feed EOR (Significant EOR Feed
N
information)
O
Feed section DC code output
TI
DC2 DC4
60
TAP6
A
R
40
Program type M, E
ri
Select whether or not DSR flow control is valid for serial communication
during tape operation.
A
0: Valid
M
1: Invalid
YA
Note :
01
TAP7
This parameter setting is enabled when the cycle start button is pressed
)2
Program type M, E
ig
Conditions Immediate
yr
Unit —
op
C
Setting range 0, 1
2-590
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE
“[” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
EIA
“[” code
TAP9
d.
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit — (0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(0 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(1 × 22)+(0 × 21)+(0 × 20) = 76
s
MPL068
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character
gh
code “]” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.
Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.
ri
ll
“]” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
.A
EIA
N
“]” code
TAP10
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Unit —
N
MPL069
C
K
ri
ZA
“#” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
K
EIA
ZA
“#” code
TAP11
A
M
YA
Unit —
MPL070
(c
2-591
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
“=” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
EIA
“=” code
TAP13
d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
(0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(1 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(0 × 22)+(1 × 21)+(1 × 20)= 91
er
Unit —
MPL072
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character
gh
code “:” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.
Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.
ri
ll
Example : : Hole to be punched
“:” code for paper tape reader/puncher for
.A
EIA
N
“ : “ code
TAP14
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Unit —
N
MPL073
C
K
ri
ZA
EIA
ZA
“(“ code
TAP15
A
M
YA
Unit —
MPL074
(c
“)” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
EIA
TAP16 “)” code
Program type M, E
Set value
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit — (0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(0 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(0 × 22)+(1 × 21)+(0 × 20)=74
Setting range 0 to 255 MPL075
2-592
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE
76543210
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits
ts
0: Tape loading impossible
gh
1: Tape loading possible
ri
ll
Data transfer of a paper tape program
.A
which has been punched by M2
TAP26
N
O
(bit 0)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
ZA
Se
TAP26
ZA
(bit 1)
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
0: Valid
ht
1: Invalid
ig
yr
op
TAP26
(bit 2)
Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-593
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: 8 digits
1: 4 digits
Program type E
. d
Conditions At I/O startup
ve
Unit —
s er
Setting range 0, 1
re
0: Output of ASCII data in hexadecimal notation
ts
gh
1: Output in characters
ri
Input/output of material data during
ll
.A
punching/reading
TAP26
N
O
(bit 4)
TI
60
Program type E
A
R
40
PO
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
0: Do not add
K
ri
ZA
1: Add
Se
A
IM
TAP26
ZA
(bit 5)
A
M
YA
Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-594
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE
76543210
To specify whether or not M99 is to be set as the
program end code in reading of paper tape
0: Set as program end
1: Not set as program end
To specify whether or not M02 is to be set as the
program end code in reading of paper tape
0: Set as program end
1: Not set as program end
.
To specify whether or not M30 is to be set as the
d
ve
Bit parameter related to program end code program end code in reading of paper tape
0: Set as program end
er
(M) for paper tape reader
1: Not set as program end
s
re
TAP27 To recognize the code “O” (or “:”) as the program
ts
end in reading of multiple programs (on one paper
gh
tape)
0: Yes
ri
1: No
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
O
N
ZA
Example :
IM
(Significant
Feed EOR information) EOR Feed
TAP29
A
M
YA
MPL078
Conditions At I/O startup
01
)2
Unit Character
(c
TAP30
TAP30 characters
MPL079
Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit Character
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-595
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
TAP31
Program TAP31 characters Program
d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit Character
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-596
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-3-21 Data I/O parameter DNC parameter (DNC)
Meaning Description
Set values
BAUDRATE
110 4800
300 9600
1200 19200
d .
2400
ve
Program type M, E
er
Conditions At I/O startup
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 110 to 19200
gh
Number of data bits (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)
ri
ll
Set values
.A
DATA BITS
N
7
O
TI
8
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Program type E
R
O
N
Unit —
C
al
Setting range 7, 8
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
Set values
K
PARITY
ZA
NONE
A
ODD
M
EVEN
YA
3
Program type E
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
Set values
C
STOP BITS 1
1.5
2
Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range —
2-597
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Meaning Description
The waiting time for replies from the connected device during inputting or
outputting.
An alarm occurs if this time elapses following the final reply.
WAIT TIME
Program type E
d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit 0.1 s
s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535
ts
Type of processing to be executed if the machining program of an existing
gh
work number is to be loaded
ri
ll
Set values Description
.A
SAME WNo. Issues an alarm if the received work
ALARM
N
number already exists.
O
Overrides the program if the received
TI
LOAD
work number already exists.
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
N
Setting range —
al
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
RS232C
PORT COM1
ZA
conversion connector
RS232C
A
COM2
M
conversion connector
YA
RS232C
COM3
conversion connector
3
RS232C
01
Unit —
ht
Setting range —
ig
yr
op
C
2-598
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC
d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 5
ts
Effective only when DNC1 is set to 4 or 5.
gh
ri
ll
.A
Terminator code 1
N
DNC2
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Unit —
N
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
K
Terminator code 2
ZA
DNC3
A
M
YA
Program type E
3
01
Unit —
(c
DC code parity
0 No assignment
DNC5 1 Assignment
Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-599
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
This parameter is used to set the number of times that the code or TEXT
is to be repeatedly transmitted to a host system in case that the @ code is
not sent from the host system within the waiting time which has been set
at WAIT TIME.
Number of NC transmission retries during
HOST NC
DNC file transfer
Retransmitted if @
is not received.
DNC9
@
An alarm occurs if the
TEXT transmission operation is
Program type M, E
.
repeated up to the number of
d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup @ times set with this parameter.
er
Unit Number of times EOT MPL081
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
This parameter is used to set the number of times that the @ code is to be
gh
repeatedly transmitted to a host system in the case that the EOT-code or
TEXT from the host system is not received within the waiting time which
ri
has been set at WAIT TIME.
ll
Number of NC reception retries during DNC
.A
HOST NC
file transfer
N
Initialized if EOT or
O
TEXT is not received.
DNC10
TI
@
60
@
o.
EOT
Setting range 0 to 255
al
K
ri
ZA
Number of NC transmission/reception This parameter has almost the same meaning as that of parameters
DNC9 and DNC10, except that command messages are interchanged in
K
transfer the case of DNC11 and files are interchanged in the case of DNC9 and
DNC10.
A
DNC11
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
HOST NC
op
@ waiting time during DNC
C
DNC12
transmission
@
DNC12 TEXT
DNC12
@
Program type M, E
EOT
Conditions At I/O startup MPL083
Unit 0.1 s
( DNC9)
Setting range 0 to 255
2-600
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC
.
Program type M, E
d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup @
TEXT MPL084
er
Unit 0.1 s
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255 ( DNC10)
ts
The NC waiting time from transmission of @ to reception of EOT from the
gh
host system.
ri
HOST NC
ll
.A
EOT waiting time during DNC
transmission @
N
O
DNC14 TEXT
TI
60
A @
R
40
DNC14
PO
Program type M, E
29
EOT
Conditions At I/O startup MPL085
R
o.
Unit 0.1 s
N
( DNC10)
Setting range 0 to 255
al
K
ri
ZA
The NC stop time from reception of ! from the host system to transmission
Se
of .
A
IM
HOST NC
K
!
DNC15
A
DNC15
M
MPL086
YA
Program type M, E Code is transmitted to the host system if the time that has been set with
3
Unit 0.1 s
(c
The time from the moment the NC receives the digital-out command to the
ig
DNC16
Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit 0.1 s
Setting range 0 to 255
2-601
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
@ @
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
DNC17
er
Unit 0.01 s EOT EOT
s
MPL087
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
The NC waiting time from transmission of command message EOT to
gh
reception of command reply message from the host system.
ri
HOST NC
*
ll
.A
DNC command reply message waiting time @
N
Command messages
TEX
O
DNC18 @
TI
60
A EOT
DNC18
R
40
Program type M, E *
PO
Command
29
messages
O
Unit 0.1 s
N
TEXT
C
MPL088
Setting range 0 to 255
al
K
ri
ZA
the host system the tool data, parameters etc. that are specific to the
A
DNC19
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
The NC stop time from reception of EOT from the host system to
ig
HOST NC
op
*
C
TEXT
DNC20
@
2-602
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC
TEXT
DNC21
@
Program type M, E EOT
d .
DNC21
ve
Conditions At I/O startup *
er
Unit 0.01 s
@
s
MPL090
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
76543210
gh
Select the type of processing to be executed if
the tool quantity data within the NC memory
ri
mismatches that which has been transferred
ll
from the DNC memory.
.A
—
0 : Issues an alarm if the tool quantity data
N
mismatches.
DNC25
O
1 : Executes loading forcibly, even if the tool
TI
quantity data mismatches.
60
0 : Valid
Conditions At I/O startup
R
1 : Invalid
o.
Unit —
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
displayed.
A
— NC becomes impossible.
1: The program protect function is released.
3
DNC26
01
program reception.
op
Conditions At I/O startup When both bit 5 and bit 6 are set to 1 (enable), this functions for three
digit G-format and G10 format codes input/output.
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits
2-603
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
gh
ri
ll
Number of retry times with detection of a
.A
physical error
N
DNC29
O
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
K
ri
ZA
0: M32 scheme
A
IM
1: M Plus scheme
2: M640M scheme
K
DNC30
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 3
ht
Set the time interval from the time the response from the COM port driver
ig
has disappeared, to the time the initialization of the COM port driver is
yr
started.
op
C
DNC31
Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit 0.1 s
Setting range 0 to 65535
2-604
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
2-3-22 Data I/O parameter OTHER (IOP/DPR/IDD)
Handling of TPC data when loading Bit 1 Bit 0 Handling of TPC data
IOP2 programs created with the MATRIX series
0 0 Not loaded
(bit 0) 0 1 Parameters loaded
(bit 1) 1 0 Not loaded
d.
1 1 Parameters and relay points loaded
ve
Program type M
er
Conditions At I/O startup
s
re
Unit —
ts
Setting range 0, 1
gh
Mazak data library function
ri
0: Invalid
ll
.A
1: Valid
N
Mazak data library function
O
IOP4
TI
60
(bit 0) A
R
40
PO
29
Program type M, E
R
o.
Conditions At power on
O
N
Unit —
al
Setting range 0, 1
ri
ZA
Se
0: To output
A
1: Not to output
IM
K
(bit 1)
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
0: Valid
ig
yr
1: Invalid
op
C
Parameter load error prevention function When the function is enabled, a warning window is displayed if loading is
started with a parameter selected on the DATA I/O display.
IOP4
(bit 2)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-605
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
Program type M, E
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
Unit —
s er
Setting range 0, 1
re
Tool count in tool data is checked when loading tool data in binary format.
ts
0: Invalid
gh
1: Valid
ri
Tool data count check during tool data * When tool data does not match the tool count checked during loading,
ll
loading
.A
alarm 505 CANNOT LOAD (MISMATCH) occurs.
IOP5
N
(bit 1)
O
TI
60
Program type M, E A
R
40
Conditions Immediate
PO
29
Unit —
R
o.
Setting range 0, 1
N
Selects how the sign for the start point Z of point machining (XC, XY
al
ZA
Selection of the sign for the start point Z of 0: Does not invert the sign from the set value.
IM
(bit 2)
A
M
Program type M, E
YA
Unit —
01
Setting range 0, 1
)2
input/output.
ig
IOP5
C
(bit 6)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-606
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER
Overwriting associated with loading of the tool model of the same name
0: Next tool model loaded without overwriting
1: Overwriting
Overwriting associated with loading of the
tool model of the same name
IOP5
(bit 7)
Program type M, E
d .
Conditions Immediate
ve
Unit —
s er
Setting range 0, 1
re
Appending the text string specified in the setting text file to the end of the
ts
program name at program conversion using the B-axis tilt table
gh
compatible program conversion function or EIA conversion (INTEGREX
ri
IV INTEGREX i)
ll
0: Do not append
.A
1: Append
N
O
Program name change upon program
TI
* If the resulting program name exceeds 32 characters, the program
conversion
60
name before the conversion will be truncated at its end and then the
A
IOP6 specified text string is appended at the end to bring the length of the
R
40
(bit 1)
PO
* The setting text file for the B-axis tilt table compatible program
R
o.
C:\ymw\M8Y\data\MC_sdg\EiaCnvVA2B\eia_cnvva2b_program_name
C
.txt
al
K
ri
* The setting text file for the EIA conversion function (INTEGREX IV
ZA
Se
C:\ymw\M8Y\data\MC_sdg\EiaCnvF2I\eia_cnvf2i_program_name.txt
IM
Conditions Immediate
* This parameter is enabled only for the B-axis tilt table specification
Unit — machines and the INTEGREX i Series horizontal multi-tasking
K
ZA
0: Do not add
(bit 2)
ht
ig
Program type E
yr
Conditions Immediate
op
C
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-607
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Commenting out the blocks that contain variable numbers and operators
gh
upon EIA conversion (INTEGREX IV INTEGREX i)
ri
0: Commenting out the blocks and adding M9999 at the following block
ll
Commenting out blocks containing variable 1: Not commenting out
.A
numbers and operators upon EIA
conversion
N
IOP6 * This parameter is enabled only for the INTEGREX i Series horizontal
O
(bit 4) multi-tasking machines.
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type E
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
(INTEGREX IV INTEGREX i)
A
following block
Commenting out T-command blocks upon
K
IOP6
A
(bit 5) * This parameter is enabled only for the INTEGREX i Series horizontal
M
multi-tasking machines.
YA
Program type E
3
01
Conditions Immediate
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
Specify the serial port number of the NC unit that is to be used for
ig
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-608
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER
Fixed value
—
IOP7
(bit 2)
(bit 3)
Program type —
d .
Conditions —
ve
er
Unit —
s
Setting range —
re
ts
Bit 5 Bit 4 ID amplifier type
gh
0 0 EUCHNER
ri
0 1 BALLUFF
ll
(Magazine-side display unit) ID amplifier
.A
type 1 0 Invalid
IOP7
N
1 1 No ID amplifier
(bit 4)
O
(bit 5)
TI
60
A
Program type
R
M, E
40
PO
29
Conditions At power on
R
Unit —
o.
O
N
Setting range 0, 1
C
al
K
ri
ZA
IOP7
ZA
1 1 Invalid
(bit 6)
A
(bit 7)
M
YA
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
3
01
Unit —
)2
Setting range 0, 1
(c
0: Do not clear
ht
1: Clear
ig
yr
op
IOP8
(bit 0)
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-609
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
0: Do not clear
1: Clear
Program type M, E
.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1
ts
Display of [TILT.TBL A->B CONVERT] menu item on the DATA I/O
gh
display
ri
0: Hidden
ll
1: Displayed
B-axis tilt table compatible program
.A
conversion menu
N
IOP8 * Enabled only with B-axis tilt table specification machines.
O
(bit 3)
TI
60
A
R
40
Program type M
PO
29
Conditions Immediate
R
o.
Unit —
N
Setting range 0, 1
al
K
ri
ZA
A
IM
K
—
ZA
IOP9
A
M
YA
Program type —
3
01
Conditions —
)2
Unit —
(c
Setting range —
ht
Set the connection port number for the Mazak data library function.
ig
yr
op
C
IOP13
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-610
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER
0: Invalid
1: Enabled (LAN-RS232C converter required)
11: Enabled (LAN-RS232C converter not required)
MAZA-CARE function
(for the Japanese market only) * When the term of MAZA-CARE contract has expired, the function
cannot be used even if the parameter is made valid.
IOP14
Program type M, E
d.
ve
Conditions At power on
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0, 1, 11
ts
Baud rate for RS-232C interface
gh
Baud rate
Set values Baud rate Set values Baud rate
ri
110 4800
ll
0 110 4 4800
.A
300 9600
1 300 5 9600
1200 19200
N
2 1200 6 19200
DPR1
O
2400
TI
3 2400
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
N
Setting range 0 to 6
al
K
ri
ZA
1 0 1
K
1.5 1 1.5
ZA
2 2 2
DPR2
A
M
YA
Program type M, E
3
01
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0 to 2
ht
Set values
op
C
Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1
2-611
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
er
Unit —
s
re
Setting range 0 to 255
ts
This parameter is used to select the method of handshaking to control the
gh
state of data transfer between the NC system and connected device.
ri
Set values Method Description
ll
.A
Method of handshaking 0 None No control
N
1 DC control Complies with control code DC1 through DC4
DPR9
O
TI
2 RTS/CTS Complies with device connection RTS/CTS.
60
A
R
40
Program type M, E
PO
29
Unit —
N
Setting range 0 to 2
al
K
ri
ZA
K
DPR10
1 Assignment
A
M
Note :
YA
Unit —
(c
Setting range 0, 1
ht
ig
yr
op
C
2-612
Serial No. 294060
PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER
Select whether or not DC2 and DC4 codes are to be output to the feed
sections.
Example :
(Significant
Feed EOR EOR Feed
information)
.
DPR11
d
ve
Set values Description
er
0 Neither DC2 nor DC4 is output.
s
re
1 Only DC2 is output.
ts
2 Only DC4 is output.
gh
3 Both DC2 and DC4 are output.
ri
Program type M, E
ll
Conditions At I/O startup Note :
.A
Unit — This parameter is valid only when the handshaking method is set to DC
N
control (DPR9 is set to 1).
O
Setting range 0 to 3
TI
The waiting time for replies from the connected device during inputting or
60
outputting.
A
R
40
R
o.
Waiting time
O
N
DPR12
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
K
ZA
Unit 0.1 s
Setting range 0 to 65535
A
M
Output format
1 EIA Output in EIA code
(c
DPR13
ht
ig
yr
Program type M, E
op
C
2-613
Serial No. 294060
2 PARAMETER
.
DPR14
d
1 – Not used
ve
2 COM3 RS232C conversion connector
s er
3 COM4 RS232C conversion connector
re
ts
When DPR14 = 4, data is output to the hard disk regardless of the DPR16
gh
setting.
ri
Program type M, E
ll
Set values Output destination
.A
Conditions At I/O startup
4 Hard disk (C:\ymw\M8Y\data\MC_sdg\Print\)
Unit —
N
O
Setting range 0 to 4
TI
60
PO
29
Example :
R
(Significant
al
DPR15
K
ZA
Se
This parameter denotes the number of lines fed when the output
IM
Unit Character
A
2-614 E
Serial No. 294060
Original Instructions
PARAMETER LIST
ALARM LIST
M-CODE LIST
.d
ve
INTEGREX i-100 series
er
INTEGREX i-200 series
s
re
INTEGREX i-300 series
ts
INTEGREX i-400 series
gh
HA12HA0034E (2/2)
ri
Manual No.:
ll
.A
NC: MAZATROL SmoothX
N
O
TI
Serial No.:
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
Before using this machine and equipment, fully understand the contents of this
al
K
ri
manual to ensure proper operation. Should any questions arise, please ask the
ZA
Se
IMPORTANT NOTICE
A
1. Be sure to observe the safety precautions described in this manual and the contents of the
M
safety plates on the machine and equipment. Failure may cause serious personal injury or
YA
material damage. Please replace any missing safety plates as soon as possible.
3
3. For the purpose of explaining the operation of the machine and equipment, some illustrations
)2
may not include safety features such as covers, doors, etc. Before operation, make sure all
(c
4. This manual was considered complete and accurate at the time of publication, however, due to
yr
our desire to constantly improve the quality and specification of all our products, it is subject
op
to change or modification. If you have any questions, please contact the nearest Technical
C
06.2018
R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Preface
Safety precautions relating to the CNC unit (in the remainder of this manual, referred to simply as
the NC unit) that is provided in this machine are explained below. Not only the persons who
create programs, but also those who operate the machine must thoroughly understand the
contents of this manual to ensure safe operation of the machine.
Read all these safety precautions, even if your NC model does not have the corresponding
functions or optional units and a part of the precautions do not apply.
.
Rule
d
ve
er
1. This section contains the precautions to be observed as to the working methods and states
s
usually expected. Of course, however, unexpected operations and/or unexpected working
re
states may take place at the user site.
ts
During daily operation of the machine, therefore, the user must pay extra careful attention to
gh
its own working safety as well as to observe the precautions described below.
ri
ll
2. Although this manual contains as great an amount of information as it can, since it is not
.A
rare for the user to perform the operations that overstep the manufacturer-assumed ones,
N
not all of “what the user cannot perform” or “what the user must not perform” can be fully
O
TI
covered in this manual with all such operations taken into consideration beforehand.
60
“inexecutable” functions.
PO
29
3. The meanings of our safety precautions to DANGER, WARNING, and CAUTION are as
R
o.
follows:
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
DANGER
K
ZA
life or body.
M
WARNING
YA
3
01
machine damage.
CAUTION
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
HGENPA0102E S-1
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Basics
After turning power on, keep hands away from the keys, buttons, or switches of the
operating panel until an initial display has been made.
WARNING Before proceeding to the next operations, fully check that correct data has been entered
and/or set. If the operator performs operations without being aware of data errors,
unexpected operation of the machine will result.
Before machining workpieces, perform operational tests and make sure that the machine
operates correctly. No workpieces must be machined without confirmation of normal
operation. Closely check the accuracy of programs by executing override, single-block,
and other functions or by operating the machine at no load. Also, fully utilize tool path
d.
check, Virtual Machining, and other functions, if provided.
ve
er
Make sure that the appropriate feed rate and rotational speed are designated for the
s
re
particular machining requirements. Always understand that since the maximum usable
ts
feed rate and rotational speed are determined by the specifications of the tool to be used,
gh
those of the workpiece to be machined, and various other factors, actual capabilities differ
ri
from the machine specifications listed in this manual. If an inappropriate feed rate or
ll
rotational speed is designated, the workpiece or the tool may abruptly move out from the
.A
machine.
N
O
Before executing correction functions, fully check that the direction and amount of
TI
60
correction are correct. Unexpected operation of the machine will result if a correction
A
R
40
Parameters are set to the optimum standard machining conditions prior to shipping of the
R
o.
machine from the factory. In principle, these settings should not be modified. If it becomes
O
N
absolutely necessary to modify the settings, perform modifications only after thoroughly
al
ZA
Se
any program. Unexpected operation of the machine will result if the settings are modified
A
• Cutting conditions that are the result of the MAZATROL Automatic Cutting Conditions
3
Determination Function
01
WARNING
)2
• Cutting conditions for tools that are suggested to be used by the Machining Navigation
ht
Function
ig
yr
Confirm that every necessary precaution in regards to safe machine setup has been taken
op
Confirm that the machine door is securely closed before starting machining.
Failure to confirm safe machine setup may result in serious injury or death.
S-2
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Programming
Fully check that the settings of the coordinate systems are correct. Even if the designated
program data is correct, errors in the system settings may cause the machine to operate
in unexpected places and the workpiece to abruptly move out from the machine in the
WARNING
event of contact with the tool.
During surface velocity hold control, as the current workpiece coordinates of the surface
velocity hold control axes approach zeroes, the spindle speed increases significantly. For
the lathe, the workpiece may even come off if the chucking force decreases. Safety speed
limits must therefore be observed when designating spindle speeds.
Even after inch/metric system selection, the units of the programs, tool information, or
d .
parameters that have been registered until that time are not converted. Fully check these
ve
data units before operating the machine. If the machine is operated without checks being
ser
performed, even existing correct programs may cause the machine to operate differently
re
from the way it did before.
ts
gh
If a program is executed that includes the absolute data commands and relative data
ri
commands taken in the reverse of their original meaning, totally unexpected operation of
ll
the machine will result. Recheck the command scheme before executing programs.
.A
N
If an incorrect plane selection command is issued for a machine action such as arc
O
interpolation or fixed-cycle machining, the tool may collide with the workpiece or part of
TI
60
the machine since the motions of the control axes assumed and those of actual ones will
A
R
40
functions.)
R
o.
The mirror image, if made valid, changes subsequent machine actions significantly. Use
N
the mirror image function only after thoroughly understanding the above. (This precaution
al
K
ri
issued with a correction function remaining made valid, correction may become invalid
K
temporarily. If this is not thoroughly understood, the machine may appear as if it would
ZA
operate against the expectations of the operator. Execute the above commands only after
A
making the corresponding correction function invalid. (This precaution applies only to NC
M
The barrier function performs interference checks based on designated tool data. Enter
3
01
the tool information that matches the tools to be actually used. Otherwise, the barrier
)2
The system of G-code and M-code commands differs, especially for turning, between the
ht
machine operation. Thoroughly understand the system of G-code and M-code commands
op
C
S-3
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
For the machines of INTEGREX i/e-Series, programmed coordinates can be rotated using
an index unit of the MAZATROL program and a G68 command (coordinate rotate com-
mand) of the EIA/ISO program. However, for example, when the B-axis is rotated through
WARNING
180 degrees around the Y-axis to implement machining with the turning spindle No. 2, the
plus side of the X-axis in the programmed coordinate system faces downward and if the
program is created ignoring this fact, the resulting movement of the tool to unexpected
positions may incite collisions.
To create the program with the plus side of the X-axis oriented in an upward direction, use
the mirror function of the WPC shift unit or the mirror imaging function of G-code
command (G50.1, G51.1).
After modifying the tool data specified in the program, be sure to perform the tool path
d.
check function, the Virtual Machining function, and other functions, and confirm that the
ve
er
program operates properly. The modification of tool data may cause even a field-proven
s
machining program to change in operational status.
re
If the user operates the machine without being aware of any changes in program status,
ts
interference with the workpiece could arise from unexpected operation.
gh
For example, if the cutting edge of the tool during the start of automatic operation is
ri
present inside the clearance-including blank (unmachined workpiece) specified in the
ll
.A
common unit of the MAZATROL program, care is required since the tool will directly move
N
from that position to the approach point because of no obstructions being judged to be
O
present on this path.
TI
For this reason, before starting automatic operation, make sure that the cutting edge of
60
A
R
the tool during the start of automatic operation is present outside the clearance-including
40
PO
R
o.
O
N
for each axis, movements to the ending point will not usually become linear. Before using
K
ri
ZA
these functions, therefore, make sure that no obstructions are present on the path.
Se
CAUTION
A
Before starting the machining operation, be sure to confirm all contents of the program
IM
obtained by conversion. Imperfections in the program could lead to machine damage and
K
operator injury.
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
S-4
Serial No. 294060
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Operations
Single-block, feed hold, and override functions can be made invalid using system
variables #3003 and #3004. Execution of this means the important modification that
makes the corresponding operations invalid. Before using these variables, therefore, give
WARNING
thorough notification to related persons. Also, the operator must check the settings of the
system variables before starting the above operations.
If manual intervention during automatic operation, machine locking, the mirror image
function, or other functions are executed, the workpiece coordinate systems will usually be
shifted. When making machine restart after manual intervention, machine locking, the
mirror image function, or other functions, consider the resulting amounts of shift and take
d.
the appropriate measures. If operation is restarted without any appropriate measures
ve
being taken, collision with the tool or workpiece may occur.
ser
Use the dry run function to check the machine for normal operation at no load. Since the
re
feed rate at this time becomes a dry run rate different from the program-designated feed
ts
gh
rate, the axes may move at a feed rate higher than the programmed value.
ri
After operation has been stopped temporarily and insertion, deletion, updating, or other
ll
commands executed for the active program, unexpected operation of the machine may
.A
result if that program is restarted. No such commands should, in principle, be issued for
N
the active program.
O
TI
60
A
During manual operation, fully check the directions and speeds of axial movement.
R
40
PO
29
For a machine that requires manual homing, perform manual homing operations after
R
turning power on. Since the software-controlled stroke limits will remain ineffective until
o.
CAUTION
O
N
manual homing is completed, the machine will not stop even if it oversteps the limit area.
C
al
ZA
Se
Do not designate an incorrect pulse multiplier when performing manual pulse handle feed
A
operations. If the multiplier is set to 1000 times and the handle operated inadvertently,
IM
S-5
Serial No. 294060
The procedure for data storage is detailed in the Operating Manual, Part 3
(OPERATING NC UNIT AND PREPARATION FOR AUTOMATIC
OPERATION), Chapter 10, (DISPLAYS RELATED TO DATA STORAGE).
d.
Always use an initialized USB memory or SD card. The USB connector and
ve
er
the SD card slot are located on the right side of the machine operating panel.
s
re
ts
gh
ri
USB memory SD card
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
On machines with a random ATC feature, each actual ATC operation changes the tool
data (in pocket numbers). Be sure not to run the machine after loading the externally
stored data of the TOOL DATA display without having confirmed the data’s
CAUTION correspondence to the current tooling on the magazine. Otherwise the machine cannot be
be guaranteed to operate normally.
S-6
Serial No. 294060
Limited Warranty
The warranty of the manufacturer does not cover any trouble arising if the NC unit is used for its
non-intended purpose. Take notice of this when operating the unit.
Examples of the trouble arising if the NC unit is used for its non-intended purpose are listed
below.
1. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any commercially available software
products (including user-created ones)
2. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any Windows operating systems
d.
ve
3. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any commercially available computer
er
equipment
s
re
ts
Operating Environment
gh
ri
1. Ambient temperature
ll
.A
During machine operation: 0° to 50°C (32° to 122°F)
N
O
2. Relative humidity
TI
60
A
During machine operation: 10 to 75% (without bedewing)
R
40
PO
deteriorate quickly.
o.
O
N
C
al
Network Setting
ri
ZA
Se
Note 1: Do not change the settings of the following two network adapters. Any changes will
K
S-7
Serial No. 294060
Note 2: Use “Ethernet_PC” to connect the NC to an intra-factory network and other systems.
Do not use, however, the following network addresses: “192.168.100.xxx” and
“192.168.202.xxx”
d .
“How to Change Network Settings”
ve
Magazine display unit for Operating Manual of the Visual Tool ID/Data Management
er
Tool ID (touch panel) “CONNECTING TO THE LOCAL AREA NETWORK”
s
re
ts
Note 3: If you configure network settings for the NC unit, using Internet Information Services
gh
(IIS) on Windows, do not use the following port numbers.
ri
ll
21
.A
683
N
43816
O
55555
TI
60
55556 A
R
40
57400
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
S-8 E
Serial No. 294060
CONTENTS
d .
2-1-2 Precautions ............................................................................................................. 2-2
ve
s er
2-2 Parameter List .................................................................................................... 2-3
re
ts
gh
2-2-1 User parameter ....................................................................................................... 2-3
ri
ll
2-2-2 Machine parameter ............................................................................................... 2-42
.A
N
2-2-3 Data I/O parameter ............................................................................................... 2-79
O
TI
60
A
2-3 Detailed Description ......................................................................................... 2-84
R
40
PO
29
O
N
C
al
ZA
Se
C-1
Serial No. 294060
d .
ve
2-3-20 Data I/O parameter TAPE parameter (TAP) .................................................... 2-586
s er
re
2-3-21 Data I/O parameter DNC parameter (DNC) ..................................................... 2-597
ts
gh
2-3-22 Data I/O parameter OTHER (IOP/DPR/IDD).................................................... 2-605
ri
ll
.A
3 ALARM ................................................................................................. 3-1
N
O
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Se
3-2-2 No. 1 - No. 99, No. 1000 - No. 1099 (System/Drive error) ...................................... 3-4
M
YA
3-2-3 No. 100 - No. 199, No. 1100 - No. 1199 (CNC machine control error) ................. 3-18
3
01
3-2-4 No. 200 - No. 399, No. 1200 - No. 1399 (PLC machine control error) .................. 3-39
)2
(c
ht
3-2-5 No. 400 - No. 499, No. 1400 - No. 1499 (CNC screen operation error)................ 3-77
ig
yr
3-2-6 No. 500 - No. 599, No. 1500 - No. 1599 (I/O error) ............................................ 3-102
op
C
3-2-7 No. 600 - No. 699, No. 1600 - No. 1699 (MAZATROL program error) ............... 3-117
3-2-8 No. 700 - No. 799, No. 1700 - No. 1799 (MAZATROL program error) ............... 3-133
3-2-9 No. 800 - No. 899, No. 1800 - No. 1899 (EIA/ISO program error) ...................... 3-146
3-2-10 No. 900 - No. 999, No. 1900 - No. 1999 (EIA/ISO program error) ...................... 3-164
C-2
Serial No. 294060
3-2-11 No. 2000 - No. 2099 (3D setup error) ................................................................. 3-180
3-2-13 No. 2200 - No. 2299 (CAM data output error) .................................................... 3-190
4-1 Miscellaneous Functions (M Codes) Upper Turret Commands (TR1 Side) ........ 4-1
d .
ve
er
4-2 Miscellaneous Functions (M Codes) Lower Turret Commands (TR2 Side) ...... 4-15
s
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
C-3
C
op
yr
ig
ht
(c
)2
01
3
YA
M
A Se
ZA
K ri
al
IM
N
A o.
ZA 29
K
C-4 E
40
C
O 60
Serial No. 294060
R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
3 ALARM
If machine failures occur or if erroneous operations are carried out, appropriate alarm numbers
and messages will be displayed in the alarm display section of the screen. If alarm display
appears, refer to the alarm list to locate and eliminate the cause of the alarm. More than one
alarm may be raised at once, depending on the particular status of alarm occurring. In the event
of alarm display, therefore, it is highly recommended that the operator should call the
DIAGNOSIS (USER) - ALARM display on the screen and make sure of the type of alarm.
3-1 Outline
1. Scope of this chapter
d .
This chapter describes all the alarms displayed on the screen of NC unit. Always refer to
ve
this chapter for eliminating an alarm.
ser
re
2. Precautions on this chapter
This chapter also lists alarms related to machine model-dependent functions and optional
ts
gh
functions. These alarms may therefore include ones not displayed for your machine. Check
ri
the type of machine purchased by you and its specifications before you read this chapter.
ll
.A
Note 1: The contents of this list are subjected to change without notice, for NC unit or machine
N
improvement.
O
Note 2: Any questions about the contents of this list should be communicated to Mazak
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
K
ri
ZA
An alarm will be displayed on the DIAGNOSIS (USER) - ALARM display in the following format:
Se
Work number
M
Alarm message
YA
Alarm number
3
01
Operating Manual.
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-1
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
3-1-2 Precautions
1. If program-related alarm display appears, that portion of the program in which the alarm has
occurred will be displayed within the parentheses next to the alarm message. The meaning
of each code in parentheses on the alarm list is listed in the table below.
Code Meaning
WNo. Work number (MAZATROL or EIA/ISO)
UNo. Unit number (MAZATROL)
SNo. Tool sequence number (MAZATROL)
NNo. Sequence number (EIA/ISO)
BNo. Block number (EIA/ISO)
blank No display, or intra-system alarm processing code
.d
ve
2. The stopped status, clearing procedure, and display color for some types of alarm depend
er
on whether the alarm-encountered program is on the foreground (program selected on the
s
re
POSITION display) or on the background (program selected on the PROGRAM display).
ts
The above mentioned three types of information for the latter case are indicated with
gh
parentheses in the alarm list.
ri
ll
3. The table for an alarm which does not exist remains blank.
.A
4. An alarm may not be displayed for certain machine models or versions of NC-software.
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-2
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
3-2 Detailed Description
Cause [6]
Action [7]
.d
ve
er
[1] Alarm number
s
[2] Alarm message
re
[3] Type of error
ts
gh
Code Type Description
ri
A Operation A wrong key has been pressed. Or the machine has been operated incorrectly.
ll
.A
B Registered data The program or tool data includes an error(s).
N
There are data to be checked, such as on inspection items.
O
C Servo Malfunctioning of the servo control mechanism
TI
60
C
al
ZA
Se
Code Status
A
IM
H Emergency stop
I Reset stop
K
ZA
J Single-block stop
K Feed stop (hold)
A
M
L Operation continued
YA
Code Procedure
)2
3-3
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
3-2-2 No. 1 - No. 99, No. 1000 - No. 1099 (System/Drive error)
Cause ——
Action ——
.
d
Turn power off and then back on. If this does not clear the alarm status, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or
ve
Action Technology Center.
s er
3 EMERGENCY STOP ( , , ) A H M Red
re
The emergency stop button on the operating panel has been pressed.
ts
Cause
gh
ri
Release the pressed state of the emergency stop button and reset the NC unit to its initial state.
ll
Action
.A
N
4 CORRECTABLE ECC ERROR ( , , ) E H M Red
O
Data error on the memory.
TI
Cause
60
A
R
40
Action
29
R
o.
The contents of the system software and/or custom software have been destroyed.
al
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
Action
IM
K
Cause ——
A
M
Action
3
01
Action
yr
op
3-4
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
10 DETECTOR MALFUNCTION (Alarm No., Axis, ) E H M Red
The absolute position detection system has detected its detector error(s).
Cause
.d
ve
12 SERVO BATTERY WARNING (Alarm No., Axis, ) E L M Blue
er
The battery for retaining absolute position data is running low with a voltage drop, or has exhausted.
s
Cause
re
* Depending on the machine, the message ABSOLUTE POSITION WARNING may be displayed in red.
ts
The battery must be re-charged or replaced. For the battery information, refer to the Maintenance Manual.
gh
Action
ri
13 PRE-PROCESSOR MALFUNCTION ( , , ) E H M Red
ll
.A
The software is not correctly working.
Cause
N
O
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
( , , )
PO
29
Cause
o.
O
N
C
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
Amplifier power is not yet turned on. Or no signals are transferred yet.
Cause
3
01
Check for an incorrectly connected cable, an incorrectly attached connector, an inadequate input supply voltage to the
)2
23 —— ( , , )
ig
yr
Cause ——
op
C
Action ——
24 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
3-5
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
ve
( , , )
s er
Cause
re
ts
gh
Action
ri
30 POWER SUPPLY MALFUNCTION ( , , ) C/D H M Red
ll
.A
A power supply alarm has occurred.
Cause
N
O
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
Cause
o.
Note :
ri
ZA
Action
Se
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
A
function.
IM
The parameters that have been transferred from the NC unit to the servo amplifier during NC power-on are not correct.
ZA
Cause
A
M
Note :
Action
ig
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
yr
function.
op
3-6
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
35 OVERLOAD ( , , ) C H N Red
An extraordinary overload has been detected.
Cause
Check if any collision has occurred on the machine and perform the corresponding recovery, or check and reduce the
Action cutting conditions.
If measures other than the above should be taken, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
( , , )
Cause
Action
d .
ve
41 SPINDLE MALFUNCTION 1 ( , , ) C H M Red
er
The spindle (power-off level) is abnormal.
s
re
Cause
The inertia on the spindle is excessive.
ts
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
gh
Note :
ri
Action
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
ll
.A
function.
N
42 SPINDLE PARAMETER MALFUNCTION ( , , ) C H M Red
O
The parameters that have been transferred from the NC unit to the spindle amplifier during NC power-on are not correct.
TI
Cause
60
A
R
40
Action
29
R
o.
Cause
K
ZA
Se
Note :
IM
Action
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
K
function.
ZA
Cause
The inertia on the spindle is excessive.
YA
Note :
Action
)2
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
function.
(c
( , , )
ht
ig
Cause
yr
op
C
Action
3-7
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
It is required that the machining data is rechecked for possible loss or that the battery is recharged or replaced. For battery
Action recharging or replacement, refer to the relevant description given in the Maintenance Manual.
d .
ve
3. On-alarm temperature value
er
Reduce the temperature by turning off the NC power or by mounting a cooling unit.
Action
s
re
54 DIO5V MALFUNCTION ( , , ) E H O Blue
ts
gh
Cause ——
ri
ll
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
.A
Action
N
O
55 REMOTE I/O ERROR (Note 1, Note 2, ) E H O Blue
TI
60
Cause —— A
R
40
PO
29
Note :
o.
O
N
1. & 00 00 01 00 2. & 00 01
C
al
ZA
Station 1
Station 2
A
…
M
Station 8
YA
The ROMs mounted in the system ROM card are currently being checked for abnormalities.
Cause
(c
ht
Action
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center if the alarm is not cleared.
yr
op
57 NO PLC ( , , ) F H N Red
C
3-8
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
59 PLC STOPPED ( , , ) F H P Red
The PLC has ceased running.
Cause
d.
ve
61 REMOTE I/O INITIALIZE ERROR (No., System, ) E H N Red
er
An error occurred during remote I/O initialization processing.
s
re
No. Cause
ts
0 × 01 RIO2.0 control register does not “stop” although RIO2.0 stop was requested.
gh
0 × 02 Cyclic transfer counter is not operating.
ri
0 × 04 In RIO2.0 communication, connection status cannot be obtained.
ll
.A
0 × 08 RIO1.0 communication was conducted using a station number (9 or larger) which is
outside the RIO1.0 communication range.
N
Cause
0 × 10 A unit for RIO1.0 communication is connected to the No. 3 system.
O
TI
0 × 20 Units of more than 17 stations were connected to the No. 3 system.
60
0 × 40
A
A safety RIO unit and a unit for RIO1.0 communication are connected to the same
R
40
system.
PO
29
0 × 100 Time-out in obtaining the RIO1.0 communication enabled station information while
O
N
K
ri
ZA
Action
A
IM
(No., Register
62 RI/O ARBITRARY ALLOTMENT ERROR E H N Red
number, )
K
ZA
1 A value outside the allowable range is set for a system number or a station number.
YA
3 A value outside the allowable range is set for a device setting value.
01
3-9
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Cause 3 A value outside the allowable range is set for a device setting value.
4 An illegal value is set for a device setting value.
5 The same device is set for multiple stations.
6 Parameter check is executed for arbitrary allocation parameters although the setting is
.
for fixed allocation.
d
ve
er
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
Action
s
re
(Threshold value,
ts
64 HIGH SPEED DIO SETTING OVER E H N Red
Number of excesses, )
gh
The number of set high-speed inputs/outputs exceeds the upper limit.
ri
Cause
ll
.A
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
N
Action
O
TI
65 OVER VOLTAGE DETECT ( , , ) E L M Blue
60
Cause
PO
29
After completing the machining, turn off the NC power and then back on.
R
o.
Action
O
N
ZA
Se
Cause ——
A
IM
A servo with a system not applicable to high-speed synchronous tapping is connected in spite of the high-speed
M
Action
01
)2
A servo with a system not applicable to high-speed synchronous tapping is connected in spite of the high-speed
Cause
ht
Action
op
C
69 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
3-10
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
70 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
Cause
d .
ve
72 SERVO WARNING ( , , ) E H O Blue
er
The servomotor is loaded abnormally.
s
Cause
re
The inertia has become excessive.
ts
Turn off the NC and the machine, remove the cause of the abnormal load, and then turn on the machine and the NC.
gh
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center if the alarm is not cleared.
ri
Note :
ll
Action 1. If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia
.A
estimation function.
N
2. If this alarm occurs when resetting the emergency stop state, press and hold the RESET key for 0.5 seconds or
O
longer.
TI
60
( , , A )
R
40
PO
Cause
29
R
o.
Action
N
C
al
ZA
Se
Cause ——
IM
Action
ZA
Cause
3
Note :
Action
)2
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
(c
function.
ht
( , , )
ig
yr
Cause
op
C
Action
3-11
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
1000 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
.
1 Safety watchdog error
d
ve
2 Crosscheck error
er
3 Function (*1) Safety system internal processing error
s
re
4 Safety parameter saving memory error 1
ts
5 Safety parameter saving memory error 2
gh
6 Safety initial processing time-out
ri
7 Axis name NC-DRV safety initial communication error
ll
.A
8 Unit information Safety I/O initial processing time-out
N
*1
O
TI
Cause Function Function name
60
K
ri
1002 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR2 (No., Axis name, ) E H M Red
)2
No. Cause
ig
1 Encoder error
yr
3-12
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
d.
ve
8 Unit information Reception crosscheck error
er
9 Unit information Host station communication error 1
s
re
10 Unit information Host station communication error 2
11 Unit information Host station communication error 3
ts
gh
12 Unit information Drive safety reception crosscheck error
ri
13 Factor (*1) User safety sequence 1 illegal
ll
14 Factor (*1) User safety sequence 2 illegal
.A
15 Unit information Output signal crosscheck error
N
O
*1
TI
60
Factor A Cause
R
40
0 × 1200 CRC error occurred. The user safety sequence can be faulty.
PO
29
Cause
C
1. A RET instruction could not haven been executed at the branch destination of a CALL
ri
ZA
instruction.
Se
2. A RET instruction could haven been executed although a CALL instruction was not executed.
IM
An abnormality was detected with the data in the sequence program to be executed.
ZA
The total number of steps of the ladder to be executed could be larger than the size of PLC
3
With a BCD or DBCD instruction, BCD conversion could be attempted for a BIN value outside the
(c
With a BIN or DBIN instruction, BIN conversion could be attempted for a BCD value outside the
yr
3-13
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
. d
7 Emergency stop Illegal emergency stop device specification
ve
device number
er
9 - Illegal setting of safety I/O device allocation parameter
s
re
ts
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
Action
gh
ri
ll
1005 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR5 (No., Axis name, ) E H M Red
.A
A safety monitoring function error was detected.
N
No. Cause
O
TI
1 SLS speed error
60
K
ri
Action If the alarm is still not cleared, please contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
ZA
A
No. Cause
3
Cause
The emergency stop signal is off when the safety external emergency stop function is
)2
valid.
(c
ht
Action
yr
op
Abnormal operation of the safety circuit inside the drive unit has been detected.
Cause
3-14
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
( , , )
Cause
Action
1020 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM1 (No., Axis name, ) E H O Blue
A safety monitoring function error was detected.
No. Cause
.
1 SSM hysteresis width setting error
d
ve
SSM hysteresis width is larger than SSM speed.
er
2 Safety absolute position not established
s
Cause
re
1. The safety absolute position has not been established even once after making valid
SLP/SCA.
ts
gh
2. In the encoder diagnosis performed while SLP/SCA power is off, there is a positional
offset between the position saved when the power was turned off and the position
ri
restored when the power was turned on.
ll
.A
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
N
Action
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-15
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.
In motor brake test pattern 1, axis movement amount exceeded the
d
ve
permissible value.
er
6 Axis name SBT warning 5
s
In motor brake test pattern 2, axis movement amount exceeded the
re
permissible value.
ts
7 Axis name SBT warning 6
gh
In motor brake test pattern 3, axis movement amount exceeded the
ri
permissible value.
ll
.A
Cause *1
N
Factor Description
O
TI
0001 System during automatic operation existing
60
PO
K
ri
0007
Se
000C
M
1022 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM3 (No., Axis name, ) E H O Blue
ht
ig
No. Cause
op
The safe stop 1 request signal or the safe torque stop request signal of the PLC input
signal is off.
3-16
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
.
1024 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM5 (No., , ) E H O Blue
d
ve
A safety monitoring function error was detected.
er
Cause
s
re
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
ts
Action
gh
ri
( , , )
ll
.A
Cause
N
O
TI
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-17
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
3-2-3 No. 100 - No. 199, No. 1100 - No. 1199 (CNC machine control error)
Cause ——
Action ——
. d
ve
Modify the program so that the tool tip may move within the area specified in the software limit parameters.
Action
s er
( , , )
re
ts
Cause
gh
ri
Action
ll
.A
113 OVER TRAVEL (Axis, , ) A K P Red
N
O
The tool tip has reached stroke limit in the direction of the axis corresponding to the displayed axis name.
TI
Cause
60
A
R
40
Move the tool tip away from the end in manual operation mode.
Action
PO
29
R
o.
( , , )
O
N
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Action
A
IM
The spindle speed acceleration was clamped while the spindle speed fluctuation function was enabled.
ZA
Cause
A
M
An attempt was made to use the spindle speed fluctuation function although the relevant option was not featured.
)2
Cause
(c
The spindle speed fluctuation function cannot be used since the relevant option is not featured.
ht
Action
ig
yr
op
C
3-18
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
123 SP ROT. FLUCT. SETTING ERROR (Alarm No., , ) B K P Red
d .
The spindle whose spindle speed fluctuation is enabled does not match the spindle encoder
ve
&0000 0010
number or the spindle specified for the constant surface speed control.
s er
re
Review the setting.
Action
ts
gh
124 SP ROT. FLUCT. ILLEGAL COMMAND (Alarm No., , ) B K P Red
ri
ll
Alarm No. Cause
.A
A spindle speed fluctuation mode enabling M code was specified while override variable thread
N
cutting was enabled.
&0000 0001
O
An override variable thread cutting enabling M code was specified while the spindle speed
TI
fluctuation was enabled.
60
A
A spindle speed fluctuation enabling M code was specified in the G61.1 mode.
R
40
&0000 0002
PO
A spindle speed fluctuation enabling M code was specified in the polygon machining mode.
R
o.
&0000 0004 A polygon machining mode command was specified while spindle speed fluctuation was
N
enabled.
al
A spindle speed fluctuation enabling M code was specified in the hobbing mode.
ri
ZA
&0000 0008
Se
A hobbing mode command was specified while spindle speed fluctuation was enabled.
A
A spindle speed fluctuation enabling M code was specified during synchronized tapping.
IM
&0000 0020
A synchronized tapping command was specified while spindle speed fluctuation was enabled.
K
Cause The master spindle in synchronous operation was specified as the spindle for spindle speed
ZA
fluctuation.
&0000 0040
A
A spindle for which spindle speed fluctuation was enabled was specified as the master spindle
M
The slave spindle in synchronous operation was specified as the spindle for spindle speed
fluctuation.
3
&0000 0080
01
A spindle for which spindle speed fluctuation was enabled was specified as the slave spindle
)2
The master axis in the simplified synchronous mode was specified as the servo axis for spindle
speed fluctuation.
ht
&0000 0100
ig
A servo axis for which spindle speed fluctuation was enabled was specified as the master axis
yr
The slave axis in the simplified synchronous mode was specified as the servo axis for spindle
speed fluctuation.
C
&0000 0200
A servo axis for which spindle speed fluctuation was enabled was specified as the slave axis in
the simplified synchronous mode.
3-19
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Either extend the length of the proximity-point watchdog or reduce the reference-point returning speed. After that, carry out
Action the zero-point returning operation once again.
First actuate the handle for manual pulse feed to move the axis back in the opposite direction to the zero-point, and then
Action carry out the zero-point returning operation once again.
d .
ve
127 ILLEGAL DIR. FOR ORIGIN RETURN ( , , ) A K P Red
er
The axis-movement direction selected with the axis selector switch is not correct for the reference-point return in manual
s
Cause
re
operation mode.
ts
Select the correct direction (+, –) using the axis selector switch.
gh
Action
ri
128 OUTSIDE INTERLOCK AXIS ( , , ) A K P Red
ll
.A
An axis is interlocked because the interlock function has become active (input signal has turned off).
Cause
N
O
Clear the active state of the interlock function.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
The very direction in which the manual skip function has become effective is specified in the axis-movement command. Or
Cause
R
O
N
Action
K
ri
ZA
Se
Change the cutting-feed override value to one greater than 0. If this alarm message is displayed when the cutting-feed
)2
Action override value is not 0, check the signal line for a short-circuit.
(c
An attempt has been made to execute an axis movement in the cutting feed mode or dry-run in the automatic
yr
Cause operation mode, with the manual feedrate remaining set to 0 on the machine operating panel.
op
After a restart search, the cycle start button was pressed with the manual feedrate set to 0.
C
Change the manual feedrate to a value greater than 0. If this alarm message is displayed when the manual feedrate is not
Action 0, check the signal line for a short-circuit.
1. Conditions for spindle rotation start are not satisfied. Check the program and tool data.
Action 2. The spindle amplifier and the encoder must be checked for normal operation. Contact the nearest Mazak Technical
Center or Technology Center.
3-20
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
134 SPINDLE ROTATION EXCEEDED ( , , ) D K N Red
The spindle-speed limit has been exceeded.
Cause
Reduce the spindle speed. The spindle amplifier must be checked for normal operation.
Action
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
d .
ve
136 CUTTING BLOCK START INTERLOCK ( , , ) B K P Blue
er
The interlock signal to lock the start of the cutting program block has been input.
s
Cause
re
ts
The sequence program needs checking for normal functioning.
gh
Action
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
ri
137 DYNAMIC COMPENSATION EXCEEDED ( , , ) A K P Red
ll
.A
Dynamic compensation amount exceeded 3 mm (0.12 in).
Cause
N
O
Make sure that the workpiece coordinate zero point is centrally positioned in the workpiece, and set the difference
TI
Action between the center of the workpiece and the rotary center of the table to 3 mm (0.12 in) or less.
60
A
R
40
Cause
o.
2. A 3D coordinate conversion command (G68/G69) was specified while G0 was temporarily canceled in tool tip point
O
N
Action
ZA
An abnormality has occurred in the NC unit during the pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration process.
K
Cause
ZA
Hardware trouble is likely. Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
A
Action
M
YA
Action
ht
The synchronization error between the master axis and the slave axis during synchronous control has overstepped a
Cause
op
3-21
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.
d
0 × 102 NC ready signal is not ON.
ve
0 × 103 Reset state not yet cleared.
er
0 × 104 Feed hold is in operation.
s
re
0 × 105 Hardware overtravel not yet cleared.
ts
0 × 106 Software overtravel not yet cleared.
gh
0 × 107 No operation mode selected.
ri
0 × 108 Two or more operation modes selected.
ll
.A
Cause 0 × 109 During change in operation modes.
N
0 × 110 During editing on the EIA MONITOR display.
O
0 × 111 During search on the tape data.
TI
60
0 × 117 An alarm related to polygonal machining or hob milling not yet cleared.
al
ZA
0 × 120 After establishing absolute positions through zero return operation, the
Se
Action
ZA
Cause
Trouble has occurred in the absolute position detector.
3
Action
)2
Automatic operation has been started in a mode other than automatic operation.
Cause
ig
yr
Action
C
147 SHAPING AXIS TURNING ANGLE OVER (WNo., NNo., BNo.) A K P Blue
1. The rotational angle limit at the shaping block connections has been exceeded.
Cause
2. The radius of the arc is less than the rotational radius of the C-axis.
1. Review the program.
Action
2. Review the setting of parameter K1 (rotational radius of the C-axis).
3-22
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
148 CHUCK BARRIER (Note 1, Note 2, ) A (B) K (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. The tool entered in the chuck barrier.
Note :
1. Interfering component 1
Display
1 No. 1 spindle chuck
2 No. 2 spindle chuck
4 Tailstock
8 Turret
2. Interfering component 2
Cause Display Type A Type B Type C
.
d
0 Tool tip Turret Tool, holder, turret
ve
1 Turret Holder —
er
2 — Tool —
s
re
Machine type A, B and C above are available according to the settings of the following parameters:
ts
Type BA73 BA129 bit 1
gh
A Other than 0 0
ri
B — 1
ll
C 0 0
.A
2. Interference is occurring between the tool and chuck in the solid mode.
N
Review and correct the machining program. If the program is correct, review the tool data and the barrier parameters.
O
Action
TI
60
PO
Note :
R
o.
Cause
O
For details of the cause, refer to Note 2 “Interfering component 2” in the explanation of alarm 148 CHUCK
N
BARRIER.
al
2. Interference is occurring between the tool and tailstock in the solid mode.
ri
ZA
Review and correct the machining program. If the program is correct, review the tool data and the barrier parameters.
Se
Action
A
IM
1. Interference is occurring between the workpiece of the No. 1 turning spindle side and the workpiece of the No. 2
ZA
2. Interference is occurring between the tool and workpiece in the solid mode.
M
Review and correct the machining program. If the program is correct, review the tool data and the barrier parameters.
YA
Action
3
Executing the tandem driving function has been attempted despite a tandem driving option not being present.
Cause
(c
ht
The tandem driving function can be used only for a special machine. If this alarm occurs in a special machine that allows
Action
ig
the use of the tandem driving function, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
yr
1. The settings of the address name parameters (M11) on each axis are illegal.
C
Cause
2. An attempt has been made to simultaneously control axes other than the master axis that has been set in a parameter.
1. Correct the address names of the master axis and slave axis to the uppercase alphabet and the lowercase alphabet,
Action respectively, and set the address name parameters (M11) of each axis properly.
2. Subject the specified master axis to simultaneous control.
153 TRANSFER/PUSH UNFINISHED ( , , ) A K O Red
1. The axis reached its pressing completion position before a skipping signal was generated.
Cause
2. The drooping amount during pressing operation cannot overstep the setting in parameter K46.
1. Check whether the pressing completion position in the program is correct.
Action
2. Modify the K46 setting as appropriate.
3-23
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.
d
Action
ve
er
156 ILLEGAL MEASURING SENSOR SIGNAL ( , , ) A, B H O Red
s
re
The measuring sensor has turned on at a position in a non-measuring area.
Cause
ts
gh
If the sensor has come to contact with an object, confirm the program. In other cases, confirm the mounting status of the
Action
ri
sensor.
ll
.A
157 MEASURED RESULT MALFUNCTION ( , , ) A, B H O Red
Measurement results are not normal.
N
Cause
O
TI
60
Action Check if the sensor tool length registered on the TOOL DATA display is correct.
PO
29
O
N
It was attempted to manually control an axis currently under the control for cross machining.
C
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
The axes under the cross machining control cannot be controlled manually.
Se
Action
A
IM
&0000 0001 The specified axis does not exist in the counterpart system.
YA
&0000 0004
01
question.
)2
&0000 0010 A command for cross machining control is given from the counterpart system.
(c
In the mode of inclined-axis control a cross-control command is given for the fundamental axis
(X-axis) without positioning of the inclined axis (Y-axis) in its zero point.
ht
Cause
&0000 0040
ig
In the mode of inclined-axis control a cross-control command is given for the inclined axis
yr
(Y-axis).
op
A cross control command or cross control cancel command was specified for the NC axis in the
spindle speed fluctuation synchronous mode.
C
&0000 0080
A cross control command or cross control cancel command was specified for an NC axis for
which spindle speed fluctuation is enabled.
At the execution of a cross-machining command, the axis movement completion wait time
&0000 0400
exceeded the time set at parameter SU54.
3-24
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
160 ILLEGAL NUMBER OF CROSS AXIS ( , , ) E I P Red
The number of axes in the remote system has become zero as a result of crossing command execution.
Cause
Check the parameters related to the type of acceleration & deceleration and to the motion speed during superposition
Action control.
. d
ve
162 ILLEGAL SUPERPOSITION PARAMETER (WNo., UNo., SNo.) E I P Red
er
Incorrect parameter settings do not allow the superposition control to be started.
s
Cause
re
ts
Check the parameters related to the type of acceleration & deceleration and to the motion speed during superposition
gh
Action control.
ri
163 BARRIER WORK (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A K O Red
ll
.A
There is a danger that one workpiece will interfere with the other.
Cause There is a danger that the partition plate will interfere with the workpiece or the lower turret.
N
O
Review the barrier parameters, or for automatic operation, correct the program properly.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
With the machine under the control for safety speed, a command for the following was given:
R
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
The command signal for the control for safety speed was turned on in the following modes of machining:
Cause Threading, Synchronous tapping, Cross machining, Superposition control.
K
ZA
An M810 command was given from one HD side to operate the lower turret that was currently used on the other HD side.
Cause
3
01
Give the M810 command after the use of the lower turret on the other side.
)2
Action
(c
ht
An attempt was made in the mode of tool tip point control to perform such an improper operation as follows:
yr
1. Manual interruption
op
Cause
2. Interruption using the manual pulse handle
C
3. MDI interruption
Do not attempt to perform any of the above operations 1 to 3 in the mode of tool tip point control.
Action
3-25
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d.
ve
Manual interruption cannot be performed in the mode of high-speed smoothing control.
er
Action
s
re
170 W AXIS THRUST FORCE ALARM ( , , ) E J O Red
ts
W-axis thrust has not been obtained.
gh
Cause
ri
ll
Review and correct the program.
.A
Action
N
171 ILLEGAL W AXIS COMMAND ( , , ) E J O Red
O
TI
W-axis operation was programmed during the application of the W-axis thrust.
60
Cause A
R
40
PO
Action
R
o.
C
al
The head (B) axis is used without the B-axis control option.
K
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
Action
IM
K
Action
3
01
The No. 2 spindle/C-axis is used without the No. 2 spindle high-precision indexing option.
Cause
(c
ht
Vibration detection is used without the rotary table vibration detection option.
C
Cause
3-26
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
177 ONE-TOUCH TUNING IMPOSSIBLE (System No., , ) B I P Red
The inertia estimation has been attempted by G297 during movement of the axis whose inertia was to be estimated.
The G298 parameter setup command has been set during movement of the parameter setup reference axis or of some
axis assigned to the parameter data development system.
Cause
The G298 parameter setup command has been set during cutting feed time constant changeover or control axis
superposition.
The G298 parameter setup command has been set during axis rotation.
Review and correct the program.
Action
.
The estimated inertia has exceeded the maximum inertia specified in the TSVC parameter or the TSPC parameter.
d
Cause
ve
er
Correct the settings of the TSVC parameter or the TSPC parameter.
s
Action
re
ts
179 CANNOT AUTO MEASURE INERTIA (System No., , ) B I P Red
gh
Resonance has not been reduced during inertia estimation.
ri
Cause The minimum inertial is not specified in TSVC or TSPC.
ll
.A
The inertia estimation itself has failed.
N
Correct the settings of the TSVC parameter or the TSPC parameter.
Action
O
TI
60
Cause
29
R
o.
Action
C
al
K
ri
Although operation has been started in MDI mode, data has been found to be missing.
A
Cause
IM
Action
ZA
A
The axis removal request signal has been turned on when the axis removal-in-progress signal was on (after turning off the
YA
axis removal request signal, the operator has turned the axis removal request signal back on without waiting for the axis
Cause removal-in-progress signal to turn off).
3
01
After the axis removal request signal was turned on for the absolute position control axis, the axis removal request signal
)2
has been turned off during display of alarm 71 ILLEGAL SERVO PARAMETER.
(c
Turn on the axis removal request signal when the axis removal-in-progress signal is off.
Action
ht
Cause
C
MDI interruption is not possible. Return to original mode and resume operation.
Action
3-27
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
1. Manual interruption
ve
Cause
2. Interruption using the manual pulse handle
er
3. MDI interruption
s
re
Do not attempt to perform any of the above operations 1 to 3 in the mode of inclined-surface machining.
Action
ts
gh
186 W-THERMAL COMP. OVER LIMIT ( , , ) B L S Blue
ri
The amount of compensation for workpiece thermal expansion exceeded the effective range of +0.5 to –0.5 mm.
ll
Cause
.A
N
The operation is continued with the amount of error compensation reduced to the limit (+0.5 to –0.5 mm).
O
Change the reference point for workpiece thermal expansion compensation to a point on the workpiece, or execute the
TI
Action
60
workpiece thermal expansion compensation enable/disable command when the tool tip is in close proximity to the
A
workpiece.
R
40
PO
The workpiece thermal expansion compensation command is issued to a tool for which tool data is not entered.
o.
Cause
O
N
C
al
Enter the tool data (tool length). If the tool length is not specified, compensation will be made on the assumption that the
ri
ZA
Action tool tip is at the spindle nose (or at the center of rotation of the B-axis if the machine has a spindle head rotating
Se
mechanism).
A
IM
Set the reference point for workpiece thermal expansion compensation before issuing the workpiece thermal expansion
A
Action
M
compensation command.
YA
The directions of rotation of the turning tool selected in the manual program unit and the spindle do not match.
01
Cause
)2
Check the direction of rotation set for the tool selected in the manual program unit and select a correct tool.
(c
Action
Alternatively, set TC144 bit3 to “0” to enable automatic output of the spindle rotation command.
ht
ig
190 —— ( , , )
yr
op
Cause ——
C
Action ——
After checking the entire data of the program being executed, tool data, tool file, parameters, etc., save the data using the
Action data I/O operation and then Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
3-28
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
192 EXECUTION IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) E I P (S) Red (Blue)
1. A measurement operation was attempted although there is no FRM unit.
2. Coordinate measurement was executed from the FRM unit set as the center of table rotation.
3. Measurement of a tool other than a milling tool was attempted with laser measurement.
4. Offsetting of a tool other than a turning tool was attempted using measurement of O.D., I.D, single-side O.D., or
single-side I.D. in a workpiece measurement unit.
5. Offsetting other than tool radius offset was attempted for a milling tool using measurement of groove width, protrusion
Cause width, I.D. protrusion width, or I.D. groove width in a workpiece measurement unit.
6. The barrier teaching function was activated while running a program stored outside the memory operation range or
while there was an active barrier alarm during MDI operation.
.
7. An axis command for the driven axis was specified with the axis set in the synchronized operation mode.
d
ve
8. The override variable thread cutting function was activated while position data is memorized using the rethreading
er
function.
s
re
9. A winding that does not support the override variable thread cutting function is selected.
1. Set the FRM unit.
ts
gh
2. Review the setting of the FRM unit.
ri
3. Measure only milling tools with laser measurement.
ll
4. Select a turning tool.
.A
Action 5. Offset only the tool radius for a milling tool.
N
O
6. Do not use the barrier teaching function for programs other than the ones stored in the memory operation range.
TI
7. Specify the command after canceling the synchronization of the axes.
60
A
8. Clear the memorized position data before using the override variable thread cutting function.
R
40
PO
O
N
Tool data that correspond to the pocket numbers being displayed in the “TNo.” item of the POSITION display are
C
Cause unregistered.
al
K
ri
ZA
Action
A
IM
An internal error(s) has occurred when surface speed or feedrate changing by VFC function was under way.
ZA
Cause
A
After checking the entire data of the program being executed, tool data, tool file, parameters, etc., save the data using the
M
Action data I/O operation (floppy disk) and then contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
YA
During the second or subsequent rounds of manual measurement, an attempt has been made to perform skipping in a
Cause
)2
Action
ig
During the second or subsequent rounds of manual measurement, an attempt has been made to measure an illegal point.
Cause
C
3-29
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
. d
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-30
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Clearing
Type of Stopped
No. Message procedur Display
error status
e
1101 INTERFERE ( , , ) A K S Blue
Interference occurs between <Interfering section 1> and <Interfering section 2>.
Cause
Tap the alarm clear button. When the alarm clear button is tapped, the interference check for the secondary check
Action distance is carried out.
When the RESET key is pressed, the process returns to the interference check for the primary check distance.
1102 INTERFERE ( , , ) A I P Red
Interference occurs between <Interfering section 1> and <Interfering section 2>.
Cause
d.
Press the RESET key to clear the alarm. When the RESET key is pressed, the process returns to the interference check
ve
Action for the primary check distance.
er
Alternatively, disable the machine interference check to clear the alarm.
s
re
1103 INTERFERE CHECK DATA OVERLOAD ( , , ) B L S Blue
ts
The 3D interference check process cannot be performed within a proper time.
gh
Cause
ri
Set a simple workpiece model or a fixture model or a tool model.
ll
Action
.A
N
1104 RAPID FEED OVERRIDE SET AT 0 ( , , ) A K P Blue
O
The rapid feed override value set up on the operating panel is “0”.
TI
Cause
60
A
R
40
Action
R
o.
Machine operation has been stopped because of a delay in interference check process.
al
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
The machine will be restarted when the interference check process catches up with the operation.
A
Action
IM
If this alarm recurs, set up a simplified material model, fixture model or tool model.
K
If the processing load of the PC is too high, it may not be possible to update the model properly.
A press of the RESET key returns operation to a normal state, thus allowing interference checks to be performed properly.
A
M
5. Preparation of the safety shield has not completed normally because an alarm occurred during preparation of the
(c
safety shield.
ht
* For causes 1 to 4, the alarm No. given as the argument is not effective.
ig
Review and correct the parameter and model data. Then press the RESET key.
yr
If this does not clear the alarm status, turn power off and then back on.
op
Action If the alarm is not caused by software or hardware fault, pressing the RESET key to update the model may clear the alarm.
C
If the alarm cannot be cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
* For cause 5, take the necessary action according to the corrective action for the alarm number.
3-31
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Clearing
Type of Stopped
No. Message procedur Display
error status
e
1107 INCOMPLETE TOOL DATA ( , , ) B L N Red
1. Manual tool measurement results cannot be calculated because of tool data items remaining blank.
Cause 2. The “tool length” or “tool diameter (nominal diameter)” of the tool was not set in the tool data when executing an MDI
program. (MAZATROL tool length and tool diameter are enabled and bit 7 of parameter F84 is set to “1”.)
1. Confirm the settings of the machining section, rotational direction, and nose R in the tool data items, and enter the
correct data.
2. Review the tool data and set any missing data.
Action Related parameters (F84 bit 7, F92 bit 7, F93 bit 3)
When MAZATROL tool diameter is enabled (F92 bit 7 = 1), enter the “tool diameter (nominal diameter)”.
When MAZATROL tool length is enabled (F93 bit 3 = 1), enter the “tool length”.
. d
If bit 7 of F84 is set to “0”, missing data will be ignored and the MDI program will be executed.
ve
1108 CANNOT CHANGE OPERATION MODE ( , , ) A L Q Blue
s er
The automatic operation key was pressed during tape operation.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Changeover to memory operation mode during tape operation is prohibited. Reselect tape operation mode before
Action restarting operation.
ri
ll
1109 TOOL LENGTH OVER ( , , ) B L N Red
.A
The tool length input range has been overstepped as a result of tool measurement.
N
Cause
O
TI
Use a tool of any tool length value falling within the range defined in parameters SU110–SU113.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
1110 —— ( , , )
R
o.
Cause
O
——
N
C
al
K
ri
Action ——
ZA
Se
1111 —— ( , , )
IM
Cause ——
K
ZA
A
Action ——
M
YA
Cause
01
)2
1113 —— ( , , )
ig
yr
Cause ——
op
C
Action ——
1114 SIMULTANEOUS AXIS EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K (L) P (S) Red
Commands that involve movement of axes exceeding the maximum number of simultaneously controllable axes have
Cause been specified.
3-32
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Clearing
Type of Stopped
No. Message procedur Display
error status
e
1115 AXIS NUMBER ERROR ( No, , ) A K (L) O Blue
The Tx-/Ty-/Tz-axis was selected in the manual mode while in the conditions described below. Or, the Tx-/Ty-/Tz-axis was
selected during manual handle pulse interruption.
No. Cause
The axis number specified for K114 (or K226) as the horizontal axis of the orthogonal
0 × 00000001
coordinate system does not exist in the control path. Or, the axis is not a linear axis.
The axis number specified for K115 (or K227) as the vertical axis of the orthogonal coordinate
0 × 00000002
system does not exist in the control path. Or, the axis is not a linear axis.
The axis number specified for K116 (or K228) as the height axis of the orthogonal coordinate
0 × 00000004
system does not exist in the control path. Or, the axis is not a linear axis.
Cause
.
The axis number specified for K121 (or K230) as the first rotary axis does not exist in the
d
0 × 00000008
ve
control path. Or, the axis is not a rotary axis.
er
The axis number specified for K125 (or K234) as the second rotary axis does not exist in the
0 × 00000010
s
control path. Or, the axis is not a rotary axis.
re
The first digit (direction of the first rotary axis) of the value specified for K117 (or K229) as the
ts
0 × 00000020
direction of rotation of the rotary axis is incorrect.
gh
The second digit (direction of the second rotary axis) of the value specified for K117 (or K229)
ri
0 × 00000040
as the direction of rotation of the rotary axis is incorrect.
ll
0 × 00000080 The machine type set for K113 (or K225) is incorrect.
.A
N
Set a correct value for parameters K113 to K117, K121, K125 (or parametersK225 to K230, K234).
O
Action
TI
60
( ,
A
, )
R
40
PO
29
Cause
R
o.
O
N
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
Machine interference has been detected with the NC axis active in automatic operation mode.
IM
Cause
K
Press the RESET key. Modify the program to prevent machine interference from recurring.
ZA
Action
A
M
The operations that make interference checking impossible were performed during automatic operation when the
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function was valid.
3
1: After an EIA modal search under the invalid status of the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD in automatic operation mode,
)2
Cause the Automatic Operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function was made valid in an attempt to start automatic
(c
operation.
ht
2: Following completion of the EIA modal search, manual operation mode was selected and after the axis was moved to a
ig
position different from that before the search, memory mode was reselected and a restart operation was attempted.
yr
3: An attempt was made to start the MDI operation at the same time for both the upper and the lower turret.
op
Confirm the cause of the alarm. Also, avoid performing the corresponding operations when the Automatic Operation
C
Interference checking during automatic operation is prohibited in the hard disk, Ethernet, IC card, or tape operation mode.
Action Restart operation after making the automatic operation interference checking function invalid with the Automatic Operation
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD menu.
3-33
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Clearing
Type of Stopped
No. Message procedur Display
error status
e
1125 SAFETY SHIELD CALCULATING ( , , ) A L Q Blue
1. Calculation for interference checking during automatic operation is in progress.
2. An NC alarm or PLC alarm occurs at the pre-read block. Or an M code is not completed at the pre-read block.
Cause
When the cause is No. 1 above, nothing will be displayed in parentheses.
When the cause is No. 2 above, contributing factors 1, 2 and 3 will be displayed in the parentheses.
1. When the Automatic Operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function is valid, the start of automatic operation
displays this alarm message, but the alarm will be automatically cleared when the calculation is completed.
If this alarm occurs except during the start of automatic operation, change the model to a simple one.
Action
If the single block or feed hold signal is input while an alarm is active, the next operation is not executed even when the
alarm is cleared and the machine remains stopped until the cycle start button is pressed again.
.
2. Report the arguments (contributing factors 1, 2 and 3) to the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
d
ve
1126 —— ( , , )
s er
Cause
re
——
ts
gh
Action ——
ri
ll
1127 INVALID SAFETY SHIELD ( , , ) B L S Blue
.A
The INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD for automatic operation has been canceled.
N
1. With the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being valid for automatic operation, a command which is not compatible with
O
interference check was executed.
TI
Cause
60
2. With the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being valid for automatic operation, an attempt was made to start a program
A
stored in the storage areas for Hard Disk operation, Ethernet operation, and IC Card operation, or a program prepared
R
40
Tap the alarm clear button to clear the alarm. Be all the more cautious of allowing interference because the INTELLIGENT
R
Action
o.
K
ri
ZA
With the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being valid for automatic operation, the feed-overriding value has been
Se
Cause changed.
A
IM
Tap the alarm clear button to clear the alarm. In addition, take care about interference because the actual operation may
Action differ from the result of the interference check due to the change in the feed rate override.
K
ZA
An attempt was made to change the part count value manually during automatic operation with the SAFETY SHIELD
M
Set the part count value before starting the operation, or perform automatic operation with the SAFETY SHIELD function
3
The amount of space error compensation has exceeded the upper limit.
Cause
ht
ig
Action
op
C
3-34
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Clearing
Type of Stopped
No. Message procedur Display
error status
e
1132 ILLEGAL CHOPPING CONDITION (Cause, , ) A I P Red
1. The chopping axis is in the servo-off or removed status.
2. The chopping axis is the rotating axis, basic axis or tilting axis under tilt control, or tandem axis.
3. The top dead point and the bottom dead point are the same.
4. The chopping axis has not been returned to its zero point.
5. An attempt was made to start chopping when the chopping axis is selected for the axis to control manually.
Cause
6. The chopping feed rate is zero.
7. An attempt was made to change the chopping axis during chopping.
8. An attempt was made in the replay mode of the fixed offset method to use an offset number of which record has not
been written.
d .
9. An M-code command for axis movement is issued during chopping.
ve
Press the RESET key. Take action below against respective causes described above.
ser
1. Ensure that the chopping axis is not in the servo-off or removed status.
re
2. Select an axis other than the rotating axis, basic axis or tilting axis under tilt control, or tandem axis for the chopping
ts
axis.
gh
3. Review the position of the top dead point or bottom dead point.
ri
Action 4. Return the chopping axis to its zero point.
ll
5. Select another axis for an axis to control manually and start chopping.
.A
6. Review the chopping feed rate setting.
N
O
7. Do not change the chopping axis during chopping.
TI
8. Use an offset number of which recording is finished in the replay mode of the fixed offset method.
60
A
9. Do not issue any M-code command for axis movement during chopping.
R
40
PO
Manual interrupt or zero-point return mode for the chopping axis is selected during chopping.
R
o.
Cause
O
N
C
al
Do not attempt to select manual interrupt for the chopping axis during chopping. Do not select the zero-point return mode.
K
Action
ri
ZA
Action
M
YA
1135 —— ( , , )
3
Cause ——
01
)2
Action ——
(c
ht
The work spindle speed exceeded the clamp speed during hobbing.
Cause
op
C
Check and correct the spindle speed or the Z-axis feedrate so that the work spindle speed does not exceed the clamp
Action speed, and then restart the operation.
Tap the alarm clear button. In addition, take care about interference because the actual operation may differ from the
Action result of the interference check due to the difference between the actual tool and the tool model used for interference
check.
3-35
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Clearing
Type of Stopped
No. Message procedur Display
error status
e
1138 INVALID SAFETY SHIELD(MATERIAL) ( , , ) A L S Blue
A material interference check cannot be carried out while the modal restarting process of the EIA/ISO program is in
Cause progress.
Check that there is no interference with the material along the path from the current position to the restarting start position.
Action Retract the tool to a safe position before executing modal restart of the EIA/ISO program.
.
Interpolation other than G7.1 (cylindrical interpolation) or G12.1 (polar coordinate interpolation) active
d
ve
With the B-axis
er
Interpolation active
s
re
Add the material model cutting invalid M-code in the program before starting the operation.
ts
It is also possible to select whether the operation should be continued or stopped by an alarm by using the following
gh
parameter settings.
ri
0 1
Action
ll
F156 bit0 Continue operation with material cutting According to the setting of F156 bit1
.A
enabled only at the end position.
N
F156 bit1 Continue operation with material cutting Stop with an alarm
O
disabled.
TI
60
A
R
1140 —— ( , , )
40
PO
29
Cause ——
R
o.
O
N
Action ——
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
1. When the cutting point control mode was valid, automatic operation was restarted after manual interruption from a
IM
position that differs from the position where manual interruption was called.
K
2. When the cutting point command function is valid, automatic operation was restarted after manual interruption from a
ZA
Cause rotary axis position that differs from the rotary axis position where manual interruption was called.
3. When the cutting point command function is valid, automatic operation handle interruption or MDI interruption was
A
M
performed.
YA
4. When the cutting point command function is valid, the mode was changed to the zero-point return mode.
1. After manual interruption, in the state the cutting point command function is valid, restart automatic operation only after
3
returning the axes to the position where they were located before manual interruption.
01
2. After manual interruption, in the state the cutting point command function is valid, restart automatic operation only after
)2
returning the rotary axis to the position where it was located before manual interruption.
(c
Action
3. Do not attempt automatic operation handle interruption or MDI interruption when the cutting point command function is
ht
valid.
ig
4. When the cutting point command function is valid, changing the mode to the zero-point return mode is not allowed.
yr
( , , )
C
Cause
Action
3-36
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Clearing
Type of Stopped
No. Message procedur Display
error status
e
1145 ILLEGAL OPER CUTTING PT CTRL (WNo., NNo. , BNo. ) A K (L) O (S) Red
User macro interruption occurred in the block in which the tool path passes a singular point.
Cause
( , , )
Cause
.
Action
d
ve
er
1152 CANNOT USE ORBIT MACHINING (Cause, , ) A K (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
s
re
1. G149 was specified without specifying a rotation stop M code during orbit machining.
ts
2. G148 (orbit machining mode ON) was specified while the mill spindle was rotating.
gh
3. G148 was specified for a machine that does not feature a mill spindle.
ri
Cause 4. A cross machining command was specified while in the orbit machining mode.
ll
5. Simplified synchronization control was attempted while in the orbit machining mode.
.A
6. Superimposition axis control was attempted while in the orbit machining mode.
N
7. Orbit machining was attempted during inclined-axis control.
O
TI
1. Specify a rotation stop M code before specifying G149.
60
3. The machine does not support orbit machining. Review the program.
PO
29
Action 4. No cross machining command can be specified in the orbit machining mode. Review the program.
R
o.
5. Simplified synchronization control is not possible in the orbit machining mode. Review the program.
O
N
6. Superimposition axis control is not possible in the orbit machining mode. Review the program.
al
7. Orbit machining is not possible during inclined-axis control. Review the program.
ri
ZA
Se
1. Manual interruption using the MDI mode is not possible during orbit machining. Reselect the previous operation
mode.
A
Action
M
2. The manual operation mode cannot be selected during orbit machining. Reselect the previous operation mode.
YA
The feedrate/speed of any of the X-/Y-/Z-axis and mill spindle was clamped at the value set for parameter M1, M67 or
01
Cause M68.
)2
(c
Review the spindle speed commands (S command) or feedrate commands (F commands) specified in the program or the
ht
If display of this alarm is not necessary, set bit 4 of parameter K257 to “0”.
yr
1. The position of the fundamental axis or parallel axis was outside the movement range upon specifying G124.
C
Cause
2. The fundamental axis or parallel axis has moved beyond the specified movement range in the G124 mode.
1. Move the fundamental axis and parallel axis inside their movement ranges before specifying G124.
Action
2. Correct the program so that the axis concerned move within the movement range.
1156 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
3-37
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Clearing
Type of Stopped
No. Message procedur Display
error status
e
1157 ILLEGAL OPERATION IN ENGRAVING ( , , ) A K Q Blue
Any of the following operations was attempted while executing the engraving function.
1. Manual interruption
Cause
2. Manual pulse handle interruption
3. MDI interruption
Do not perform operations 1 to 3 above while executing the engraving function.
Action
.
Cause
d
ve
* The measurement axes vary depending on the machine model.
er
Move the tool away from the TOOL EYE sensor (Sensor ON Sensor OFF)
s
re
Action Pressing the RESET key with the sensor turned OFF clears the alarm.
After confirming that the alarm has been cleared, restart the measurement.
ts
gh
1159 ILLEGAL WRITING TOOL-OFFSET ( , , ) A K O Red
ri
During manual tool measurement (with TOOL EYE), the sensor was turned ON without specifying the destination for
Cause
ll
writing the tool offset for tool offset measurement.
.A
Move the TOOL EYE sensor away from the tool and turn the sensor OFF.
N
Action
O
Pressing the RESET key with the sensor turned OFF clears the alarm.
TI
After confirming that the alarm has been cleared, set the destination for writing the tool offset and restart the measurement.
60
PO
When an M code for canceling the disabled status of the automatic operation safety shield is specified, operation stops
29
Cause until synchronization for restarting the interference check is completed. Operation restarts when the synchronization has
R
o.
completed.
O
N
Wait until the synchronization for the interference check has completed.
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
( , , )
A
IM
Cause
K
ZA
Action
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-38
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
3-2-4 No. 200 - No. 399, No. 1200 - No. 1399 (PLC machine control error)
The alarm message in the DIAGNOSIS display varies between the machine provided with
tailstock or spindle 2 and the machine provided with lower turret as shown below.
CAUTION
d.
ve
ser
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
TR1 or TR2 is displayed on the display. The alarm message related to the secondary
ht
turning spindle or lower turret (or its milling spindle) is displayed with TR2.
ig
yr
3-39
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.
d
2) Check the chiller unit in accordance with its operating manual.
ve
Action
3) If the breaker QF201 is tripped, turn it back on.
er
Address: X1302
s
re
202 AIR PRESSURE DOWN ( , , ) F H O Red
ts
The air pressure has dropped and the pressure switch was triggered.
gh
Cause
ri
ll
Check the air supply port and piping for abnormalities.
.A
Action
Address: X1506
N
O
203 MILL SPINDLE OIL PRESS. DOWN ( , , ) F K O Red
TI
The oil pressure in the milling spindle oil/air lubrication pump system has decreased.
60
Cause A
R
40
PO
29
Address: X150A
o.
O
N
K
ri
The liquid level in the tank for milling spindle oil/air lubrication system has decreased.
ZA
Cause
Se
A
IM
Refill the milling spindle oil/air lubrication tank with lubricating oil.
Action
Address: X150B
K
ZA
The air pressure in the milling spindle oil/air lubrication system has decreased.
M
Cause
YA
Action
01
Address: X170C
)2
The cooling oil pressure switch (SP115) of the spindle cooling unit was triggered.
ht
Cause
ig
yr
Action
Address: X1314
C
Check the lubricating system for the B-axis and magazine gripper.
Action
Address: X150C
3-40
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
208 GEAR LUBE LEVEL LOW ( , , ) F J Q Yellow
The oil level in the lubricating oil tank of the B-axis or magazine gripper is very low.
Cause
Add lubricating oil to the lubricating oil tank of the B-axis and magazine gripper.
Action
Address: X150D
( , , )
Cause
.
Action
d
ve
er
212 MAGAZINE DRIVER MALFUNCTION ( , , ) C J N Red
s
re
The alarm for the magazine rotating servo driver was raised.
Cause
ts
gh
1) Press the RESET key.
ri
Action 2) Turn off the circuit breaker and then back on. Then rotate the magazine manually to check for interference between
ll
tools.
.A
213 TOOL No.OK?(SPDL,NEXT, )----> (Spindle tool No., Standby tool No., ) - - P Yellow
N
O
This alarm message is displayed when automatic ATC recovery is finished.
Cause
TI
60
A
Check that the spindle tool and standby tool numbers are consistent with those displayed.
R
40
Action
PO
Then press and hold the reset key (more than one second) to reset the alarm.
29
O
N
When a group number is specified in the EIA program, tool data of the specified group number is not found.
Cause
al
When a group number is specified in the EIA program, tool data of the specified group number is set as an invalid tool.
ri
ZA
Se
215 —— ( , , )
K
ZA
Cause ——
A
M
Action ——
YA
3
Cause
(c
Action
ig
Address: X1307
yr
One of the following circuit breakers has tripped (clogging of filter or nozzle):
C
3-41
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Check the filters etc. and turn on the relevant circuit breaker.
Action
Address: X1305
Turn off the circuit breaker and watch for a while what is going on with the transformer.
.
Action
d
Address: X1301
ve
er
220 —— ( , , )
s
re
Cause ——
ts
gh
Action ——
ri
ll
221 —— ( , , )
.A
N
Cause ——
O
TI
60
Action —— A
R
40
PO
29
The load on the spindle cannot be reduced, even though the feed override was reduced using the AFC function.
O
Cause
N
C
al
Check if the tool has worn out and applies an extra load. Reduce the cutting load.
ri
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
( , , )
K
Cause
ZA
A
Action
M
YA
Two or more M-codes that cannot be handled simultaneously were issued at the same time.
01
Cause
)2
Cause
C
3-42
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
230 ILLEGAL MMS UNIT ( , , ) F K N Red
Something is wrong with the workpiece measuring amplifier.
Cause
Turn off the circuit breaker and watch for a while what is going on with the amplifier.
Action
( , , )
Cause
Action
d .
ve
235 MAGAZINE MANUAL INTERRUPT ( , , ) A L S White
s er
The manual interruption key on the magazine operating panel is activated.
re
Cause
ts
gh
After completing manual intervention, deactivate the manual interruption key.
Action
ri
ll
236 —— ( , , )
.A
N
Cause ——
O
TI
60
Action —— A
R
40
PO
29
Cause
N
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
Address: X4
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Operation is stopped immediately before starting the ATC operation. Tap [ATC STOP] to deselect it, and then press the
M
( , , )
3
01
Cause
)2
(c
Action
ht
ig
The orientation of the milling spindle was not completed within 30 seconds after the issue of a milling spindle orient
Cause command.
C
Cause
Action
3-43
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.
d
Address: X1708, X1709
ve
( , , )
ser
re
Cause
ts
gh
Action
ri
ll
258 ATC COVER OPEN SENS. MALF. ( , , ) F K O Yellow
.A
The ATC cover open status sensor has not turned on within a predetermined time after the issue of an ATC cover open
N
Cause command.
O
TI
60
Check for chips or other foreign substances that obstruct cover open/close operation.
A
Action
R
40
Address: X1317
PO
29
The ATC cover close status sensor has not turned on within a predetermined time after the issue of an ATC cover close
O
N
Cause command.
C
al
Check for chips or other foreign substances that obstruct cover open/close operation.
ri
ZA
Action
Se
Address: X1318
A
IM
( , , )
K
Cause
ZA
A
M
Action
YA
The clamp sensor of the shifter pocket is malfunctioning or the pocket itself is not fully clamped in the shifter.
Cause
)2
(c
Address: X1620
ig
yr
The unclamp sensor of the shifter pocket is malfunctioning or the pocket itself is not fully unclamped from the shifter.
Cause
C
3-44
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
d.
Address: X162B
ve
er
269 MAGAZINE2 POCKET UCL SENS. MALF. ( , , ) F K O Red
s
On Magazine 2: The unclamp sensor of the magazine pocket is malfunctioning or the pocket itself is not fully unclamped
re
Cause from the magazine.
ts
gh
Check the magazine.
Action
ri
Address: X1628
ll
.A
( , , )
N
Cause
O
TI
60
Action
A
R
40
PO
29
Milling or turning spindle orientation or C-axis connection was attempted with the front door open.
N
Cause
C
al
K
ri
Action
Se
A
IM
279 —— ( , , )
K
Cause ——
ZA
A
Action
M
——
YA
When the tool on the milling spindle was unclamped, a milling spindle orient command was entered.
Cause
)2
(c
Clamp the tool on the milling spindle before orientating the milling spindle.
Action
ht
ig
281 —— ( , , )
yr
op
Cause ——
C
Action ——
Set the ATC arm to its reference position in a manual operation mode.
Action
3-45
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
ve
285 NOT UNCLAMPED (NOT MANUAL MODE) ( , , ) A L O Yellow
s er
When manual operation mode was not selected, a tool unclamp command was entered.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Select manual operation mode when unclamping the tool.
Action
ri
ll
286 NOT AUTO MODE (UNCLAMPED TOOL) ( , , ) A L O Yellow
.A
When the tool was not clamped, automatic operation mode was selected.
N
Cause
O
TI
Clamp the tool when selecting automatic operation mode.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
( , , )
R
o.
Cause
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
Action
YA
292 —— ( , , )
3
01
Cause ——
)2
(c
Action ——
ht
ig
Shifter movement command was given when the magazine rotation is in progress.
Cause
C
Give the shifter movement command after the magazine has stopped.
Action
3-46
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
295 NO TOOL SELECT (SHIFTER POS ERR) ( , , ) B K O Yellow
Magazine rotation command was given when the tool shifter was not positioned at the ATC position.
Cause
296 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
ve
297 NO TOOL CHANGE (Z POS ERR) ( , , ) A L O Yellow
s er
A command for rotating the ATC arm was given when the Z-axis position was not appropriate to ATC.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Perform a Z-axis movement as required for ATC.
Action
ri
ll
298 TOOL UNCLAMP OK? ( , , ) A L S Yellow
.A
The tool unclamp button has been pressed once.
N
Cause
O
TI
Pressing and holding the tool unclamp button for one second while the message is displayed unclamps the tool.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
When the angle of the B-axis was not 0°, a tool unclamp command was entered in a manual operation mode.
O
Cause
N
C
al
When unclamping a milling tool, set the angle of the B-axis at 0°.
ri
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Action 3) Check all circuit breakers in the control cabinet to see if they have tripped. If a tripped circuit breaker is found, turn it
3
back on.
01
Address: X1303
)2
A command for changing the thrust of the tailstock was given with the tailstock remaining in a pressing position. (For auto-
ht
3-47
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
ve
( , , )
s er
re
Cause
ts
gh
Action
ri
ll
309 SPINDLE ORIENT TIME OVER ( , , ) D K N Red
.A
The orientation of the turning spindle was not completed within a predetermined time after the issue of a turning spindle
N
Cause orient command.
O
TI
1) Press the RESET key.
60
Action
A
2) Turn off the circuit breaker and then back on, and operate the spindle manually or with MDI to see if it can be oriented
R
40
PO
correctly.
29
O
N
Mis-chucking has been detected under the specifications of the machine provided with chuck open/close confirmation
C
Cause sensors.
al
K
ri
ZA
2) If the diameter of the workpiece currently inserted in the chuck is different from that of the previous workpiece, or if the
IM
Action stroke of the chuck jaw has been changed, check also if the chuck opening/closing sensor works normally when a
workpiece is set in the chuck. If necessary, adjust the position of the sensor.
K
The chuck did not close within the time set with the alarm timer.
Cause
YA
3
Action 2) If the diameter of the workpiece currently inserted in the chuck is different from that of the previous workpiece, or if the
)2
stroke of the chuck jaw has been changed, change the setting of the alarm timer, i. e. , time set with the PLC parameter
TIM47.
(c
ht
Something is wrong with the foot switch for opening/closing the spindle chuck.
yr
Cause
op
C
3-48
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
314 CHUCK SENSOR MALFUNCTION ( , , ) F K O Red
Both the open end sensor and the closed end sensor were turned on simultaneously.
Cause
d .
ve
1) Adjust the chuck pressure and the pressure monitoring switch pressure.
er
Action 2) Check the hydraulic system of the chuck.
s
re
Address: X1502, X1503 (Turning spindle 1) X1406, X1407 (Turning spindle 2)
ts
316 CHUCK INT-EXT SELECT INHIBIT ( , , ) A L P Yellow
gh
When the milling spindle and the turning spindle were still rotating, the chucking mode between internal and external
ri
Cause chucking was switched.
ll
.A
Switch the internal/external chucking selector mode after both the milling spindle and the turning spindle have stopped
Action
N
rotating.
O
TI
317 C AXIS CONNECTION TIME OVER ( , , ) D K N Red
60
A
The connection of the C-axis was not completed within a predetermined time after the issue of a C-axis connect command.
R
40
Cause
PO
29
Action
O
N
2) Turn off the circuit breaker and then back on, and check if the C-axis is connected correctly.
C
al
318 —— ( , , )
ri
ZA
Se
Cause ——
A
IM
K
Action ——
ZA
The clamp and unclamp confirmation of the B-axis clamping mechanism do not work normally.
YA
Cause
3
Action
Address: X170D
)2
When special ATC pattern “B-axis rotation at the specified position in the index unit” is used, the data for rotation position Z
Cause
ig
Set coordinate data for rotation position Z at which B-axis rotation is possible.
op
Action
C
3-49
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
The engagement sensor of the lower-turret gear shift is malfunctioning or the gear shift is not fully engaged.
Cause
The disengagement sensor of the lower-turret gear shift is malfunctioning or the gear shift is not fully disengaged.
Check the lower-turret gear shift.
Action
Address: X1423, X1424
.
Check if the operation of the TOOL EYE is hindered by chips etc.
d
Action
ve
Address: X1504, X1505
er
324 PARTS CATCHER CYCLE TIME OVER. ( , , ) F K O Red
s
re
The confirmation sensor concerned has not turned on within 20 seconds after the issue of a parts catcher operation
ts
Cause command (M248/M249).
gh
Check the confirmation sensor for parts catcher extension/retraction.
ri
Action
ll
Address: X1507, X1508
.A
325 PARTS CATCHER POS. SENSOR MALF. ( , , ) F K O Red
N
O
The parts catcher has not been extended or retracted completely if the confirmation sensor concerned functions properly.
Cause
TI
60
A
Check the confirmation sensor for parts catcher extension/retraction.
R
40
Action
PO
O
N
A tailstock positioning command for pressing (M841 or M842) was completed at a position overstepping a permissible
Cause
al
pressing range.
K
ri
ZA
Se
Reverse the tailstock and confirm the target position on the SETUP INFORMATION display.
Action
A
IM
During machining with the tailstock, the amount of W-axis adjustment has exceeded its permissible range.
Cause
A
M
Make sure that the cutting depth, thrust, and other machining conditions are appropriate.
YA
Action
3
328 —— ( , , )
01
)2
Cause ——
(c
ht
Action ——
ig
yr
3-50
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
331 C AXIS CLAMP MALFUNCTION ( , , ) F H P Red
The C-axis position has changed more than the setting value of parameter RL51 while the C-axis is clamped.
Cause
332 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d.
ve
333 —— ( , , )
s er
Cause ——
re
ts
gh
Action ——
ri
334 TAIL THRUST-CONTROL ( , , ) A L - White
ll
.A
This message is displayed after the tail thrust control mode is turned ON (M504 or tail spindle advance with the tail spindle
N
Cause switch) until the pressing motion is finished.
O
Rapid feed or handle feed is not available while this alarm is occurring.
TI
60
Wait until the pressing motion is finished or cancel the tail thrust control mode (M503 or tail spindle retract with the tail
A
Action spindle switch).
R
40
PO
29
335 —— ( , , )
R
o.
O
N
Cause ——
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Action ——
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Check the indication on the “tool in the spindle” against the actual state.
Action
M
YA
Action
2) Wait for the ATC mechanism to finish operation.
ig
yr
338 —— ( , , )
op
C
Cause ——
Action ——
339 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
3-51
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.
Action
d
2) Turn off the circuit breaker and then back on. Then rotate the magazine manually to check for interference between
ve
tools.
er
342 CARRIER CONTROLLER MALF. ( , , ) E J N Red
s
re
The alarm for the tool carrier rotating servo driver was raised.
Cause
ts
gh
1) Press the RESET key.
ri
Action
ll
2) Turn off the circuit breaker and then back on. Then rotate the magazine manually to check for interference between
.A
tools.
N
343 —— ( , , )
O
TI
Cause ——
60
A
R
40
PO
29
Action ——
R
o.
344 —— ( , , )
N
C
al
Cause ——
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
Action ——
K
Automatic operation was started with the front door left open.
A
Cause
M
YA
Cause
ht
ig
Automatic operation has been started with the ATC cover open.
Cause
3-52
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
348 START ERROR (MG COVER OPEN) ( , , ) A L S Yellow
Automatic operation was started with the magazine door left open.
Cause
d .
ve
350 START ERROR (TOOL EYE EXT.) ( , , ) A L S Yellow
s er
Automatic operation was started with the TOOL EYE unit left out.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Return (retract) the TOOL EYE to its home position.
Action
ri
ll
351 START ERROR (SPINDLE MISS CHUCK) ( , , ) A L S Yellow
.A
Automatic operation was started when the spindle chuck was not fully closed.
N
Cause
O
TI
1) Check if the chuck holds the workpiece properly.
60
Action
A
2) Check if the chuck opening/closing sensor works normally when a workpiece is set in the chuck. If necessary, adjust the
R
40
PO
O
N
Automatic operation was started when the tailstock (optional) was pressing the workpiece or the tailstock was neither in its
C
K
ri
ZA
Action
A
IM
Starting automatic operation has been attempted although the parts catcher was not fully retracted.
ZA
Cause
A
M
Automatic operation was started when the ATC arm was not in its reference position (0°).
)2
Cause
(c
ht
Starting automatic operation has been attempted with a RESET signal input from an external controller.
Cause
3-53
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Cause ——
Action ——
.
Action
d
ve
er
358 LINE FILTER WARNING ( , , ) F L P Yellow
s
re
The high-pressure coolant unit or the separate line filter was overloaded.
Cause
ts
gh
Check the filter for clogging.
Action
ri
ll
.A
359 ATC ARM INHIBIT ( , , ) A L P Yellow
N
An ATC arm manual positioning command was entered under one of the following conditions:
O
1) The milling spindle was not clamped.
TI
Cause 2) A door was open and the machine setup switch was set to “O” (OFF).
60
A
3) A tool was not clamped (when a reference position/swinging over position was specified.)
R
40
A tool was not unclamped (when a tool change position was specified.)
PO
29
Action
o.
O
N
C
al
ZA
The orient angle was changed by manual interruption, and the cycle start button was pressed without returning the orient
Se
When the machine setup switch was set to “l” (ON), automatic operation was started.
Cause
YA
3
Action
Address: X1
)2
Automatic operation was attempted with the top door or side door open.
Cause
ig
yr
Action
C
3-54
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
364 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
ve
366 MILL CLAMP INVALID (NOT ORIENT) ( , , ) A L O Yellow
s er
When the milling spindle was not oriented, a milling tool clamp command was entered.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Orient the milling spindle correctly.
Action
ri
ll
.A
367 ORIENT/C AXIS INHIBIT (SYNCHRO.) ( , , ) A K O Yellow
N
An orient command was given for turning spindle 1 or 2 with the spindles being set in the synchronized operation mode.
Cause
O
TI
60
PO
29
When the tool is being unclamped, a milling spindle unclamp command was entered.
N
Cause
C
al
K
ri
Action
Se
A
IM
It was attempted to select the synchronized operation mode for the turning spindles with headstock 1 or 2 (HD1 or HD2)
Cause
ZA
Action
YA
370 —— ( , , )
3
01
Cause ——
)2
(c
Action ——
ht
ig
yr
When the front door was opened and the machine setup switch was set to “O” (OFF), a start command was entered.
Cause
C
Close the front door or set the machine setup switch to “l” (ON).
Action
3-55
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d.
ve
375 COOLANT LEVEL LOW WARNING ( , , ) F L Q Yellow
s er
The coolant level in the coolant unit of a machine of the high-pressure coolant specifications has decreased.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Check the coolant level in the coolant unit.
Action
ri
ll
376 WORK NO. SEARCH ERROR ( , , ) B K O Yellow
.A
For a machine witha warm-up function (optional), a work number search was made for an unregistered program.
N
Cause
O
TI
Register the warm-up program number (1 to 99999999) with a machine parameter.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
For a machine with a warm-up function (optional), a negative number was assigned to the warm-up program.
O
Cause
N
C
al
Register correctly the warm-up program number (1 to 99999999) with a machine parameter.
ri
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
378 —— ( , , )
K
Cause ——
ZA
A
M
Action ——
YA
Warm-up was stopped because a front door was opened or the machine setup switch was set to “l” (ON).
Cause
)2
(c
Action ——
ht
ig
( , , )
yr
op
Cause
C
Action
3-56
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
384 CONVEYOR OVERLOAD ( , , ) F L O Yellow
The chip conveyor is clogged with chips.
Cause
1) Check the quantity of grease and add grease if there is not enough grease left.
.
Action
d
2) Check the grease lubricating system.
ve
Address: X170B
er
386 —— ( , , )
s
re
ts
Cause ——
gh
ri
Action ——
ll
.A
387 C AXIS SYNCHRO CONTROL ALARM ( , , ) E L P Red
N
The C-axis synchronous command was issued but the synchronous mode was not set.
O
Cause
TI
60
A
Contact the nearest MazakTechnical Center or Technology Center.
R
40
Action
PO
29
O
N
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
Action
Address: X1509
3
390 —— ( , , )
01
)2
Cause ——
(c
ht
Action ——
ig
yr
No key operation has been made for a preset period while automatic operation is not in progress.
Cause
3-57
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.
before a failure continues to be output.)
d
ve
1) Press the RESET key.
er
Action 2) Turn off the circuit breaker and then back on.
s
re
Address: R0, R1, R2, R3
ts
393 —— ( , , )
gh
ri
Cause ——
ll
.A
Action ——
N
O
394 —— ( , , )
TI
60
A
R
Cause
40
——
PO
29
Action ——
o.
O
N
C
al
ZA
Although 120 seconds have passed since the issuance of the ATC command, the operation complete signal does not turn
Se
Cause on.
A
IM
3) Execute the ATC reset function of the machine menu. For recovery of normal status, see the Operating Manual.
M
A switch on the operating panel is faulty. Or a switch is held down by some external force.
yr
Cause
op
C
3-58
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
399 MAIN POWER OFF FAULT ( , , ) F H N Red
Power was not shut off in spite of an emergency stop, or power was shut off although an emergency stop was not made.
Cause
d .
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-59
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
1203 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d.
ve
1204 TURRET INDEX TIME OVER ( , , ) F K O Red
s er
The index finish signal was not turned ON within 20 seconds after the issue of a turret index command.
re
Cause
ts
gh
The turret index motor detector or controller is faulty.
Action
ri
ll
1205 TURRET CLAMP SENS.MALFUNCTION ( , , ) F K O Red
.A
The clamp confirmation sensor is not turned ON although the turret is clamped.
N
Cause
O
The clamp confirmation sensor is not turned OFF although the turret is unclamped.
TI
Check the clamp confirmation sensor of the lower turret.
60
Action
Address: X1422
A
R
40
PO
29
1206 —— ( , , )
R
o.
Cause
N
——
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Action ——
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Check the tool and the seating surface on the milling spindle for sticking chips.
M
Action
Address: X1703
YA
This alarm occurs at the same time with alarm 1207 TOOL FITTING ALARM. This alarm is retained until the tool is
Cause
unclamped once.
(c
This alarm will be reset when the tool is unclamped. Check if chips are stuck on the tool or tool seating surface on the
ig
1209 —— ( , , )
C
Cause ——
Action ——
3-60
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1210 SPINDLE INHIBIT (CHUCK OPEN) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
A turning spindle rotation command was given even though the chuck was not closed.
Cause
d .
ve
1212 SPINDLE INHIBIT (CHUCK INT/EXT) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
ser
When a selection between internal and external chucking was not made for the turning spindle chuck, a turning spindle
re
Cause rotate command was entered.
ts
gh
Select a chucking mode between internal and external chucking.
Action
ri
ll
1213 SPINDLE INHIBIT (CHUCK PRES. LOW) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
.A
When a pressure drop (alarm No. 315) in the chuck was detected, a turning spindle rotate command was entered.
N
Cause
O
TI
See the Alarm No. 315 CHUCK PRESSURE LOW section.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
When the front door was open, a turning spindle rotate command was entered.
O
Cause
N
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
Address: X2
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Action
Address: X1504, X1505
YA
A turning spindle rotate command was given with the lower turret unclamped.
Cause
)2
(c
A turning spindle rotate command was given with the tailstock in a state other than the following:
C
3-61
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Cause ——
Action ——
.d
ve
1220 SPINDLE INHIBIT (MILLING MODE) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
ser
In milling mode (C-axis connected), a turning spindle start command was given.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Disconnect the C-axis.
Action
ri
ll
.A
1221 SPINDLE INHIBIT (EXT. INTERLOCK) ( , , ) G K O Yellow
N
A turning spindle start command was given with an interlock signal input from an external controller.
Cause
O
TI
60
PO
29
A turning spindle start command was given with the B-axis being unclamped.
N
Cause
C
al
K
ri
Action
Se
Address: X170D
A
IM
A turning spindle start command was given with the milling spindle in tool unclamping state.
Cause
ZA
A
Action
YA
A turning spindle start command was given with the milling spindle being unclamped.
Cause
)2
(c
A turning spindle start command was given for the slave headstock in the synchronized operation mode of turning spindles.
Cause
C
Give a turning spindle start command for the headstock being selected as the master in the synchronized operation mode.
Action
( , , )
Cause
Action
3-62
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1230 MILL SP. INHIBIT (CHUCK OPEN) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
When the spindle chuck was not closed, a milling spindle rotate command was entered.
Cause
d .
ve
1232 MILL SP. INHIBIT (CHUCK INT/EXT) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
ser
When a selection between internal and external chucking was not made for the spindle chuck, a milling spindle rotate
re
Cause command was entered.
ts
gh
Select a chucking mode between internal and external chucking.
Action
ri
ll
.A
1233 MILL SP. INHIBIT (CHUCK PRES. LOW) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
N
When a pressure drop (alarm No. 315) in the chuck was detected, a milling spindle rotate command was entered.
Cause
O
TI
60
PO
29
When the front door was open, a milling spindle rotate command was entered.
N
Cause
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Action
Address: X2
A
IM
A milling spindle rotate command was given with the lower turret unclamped.
ZA
Cause
A
Action
YA
A milling spindle rotate command was given with the tailstock in a state other than the following:
)2
- Retracted to a certain extent (as specified for M843) from the pressing position.
ig
Return the tailstock to its home position, or position it correctly to apply thrust on the workpiece.
yr
Action
op
C
1237 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
3-63
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
1239 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
.
d
ve
1240 MILL SP. INHIBIT (HD SELECT ER) ( , , ) B K O Yellow
ser
In automatic mode of operation a milling spindle start command was given before headstock selection (with M901 or M902
re
Cause for HD1 or HD2).
ts
gh
Select the desired headstock beforehand.
Action
ri
ll
1241 MILL SP. INHIBIT (TOOL UNCLAMP) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
.A
A milling spindle start command was given with the milling spindle in tool unclamping state.
N
Cause
O
TI
Clamp a tool in the milling spindle.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
A milling spindle start command was given with the milling spindle being clamped.
O
Cause
N
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Action
YA
When the TOOL EYE arm was not at its backward end, a milling spindle rotate command was entered.
Cause
)2
(c
( , , )
yr
op
Cause
C
Action
3-64
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1250 AXIS MOVE INH. (DOOR OPEN) ( , , ) B K P Yellow
The axis movement command was issued with the front door open during automatic operation.
Cause
d .
ve
1252 —— ( , , )
s er
re
Cause ——
ts
gh
Action ——
ri
ll
1253 AXIS MOVE INH. (ATC ARM) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
.A
When the ATC arm was not in its reference position, an attempt was made to perform a Z-axis movement into the ATC
N
Cause area.
O
TI
Set the ATC arm to its reference position.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
1254 —— ( , , )
R
o.
Cause
N
——
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Action ——
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Do not give any command of axis movement in an XY-plane the Z-axis position of which is within the ATC area.
M
Action
YA
An attempt was made to perform an independent W-axis movement with the turning spindles being set in the synchronized
Cause operation mode.
)2
(c
3-65
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Set the machine setup switch to “I” (ON) or close the front door.
Action
.
d
ve
1261 TURRET ROT.INHIBIT(TR SELECT) ( , , ) A L O White
ser
Manual turret rotation has been attempted while the upper turret is selected.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Select the lower turret.
Action
ri
ll
1262 TOOL EYE EXT.INH.(AXIS POS.NG) ( , , ) A, B L O Yellow
.A
A lower-turret TOOL EYE extend command was given while the W-axis is not located at the zero point.
N
Cause
O
TI
Move the W-axis to the zero point.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
When the turning spindle or the milling spindle was rotating, a TOOL EYE extend command was given.
O
Cause
N
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Action
YA
A TOOL EYE extend/retract command has been given with the machine setup switch remaining set to “O” (OFF) and the
Cause front door remaining open.
)2
(c
Change the setting of the machine setup switch to “I” (ON). Or close the front door.
Action
ht
ig
The TOOL EYE extend command was issued when the GL was in the machine.
Cause
C
3-66
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1268 B AXIS ROT. INHIBIT (AXIS POS. NG) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
When the X-axis was not in its zero point, a B-axis rotate command was entered.
Cause
.
d
ve
1270 B AXIS ROT.INHIBIT (ATC ARM) ( , , ) A L S Yellow
ser
The B-axis rotate switch was pressed with the ATC arm not in the reference position.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Move the ATC arm to the reference position.
Action
ri
ll
1271 B AXIS ROT. INH. (TOOL UNCLAMP) ( , , ) A, B K O Yellow
.A
A command for B-axis movement was given with the milling spindle in tool unclamping state.
N
Cause
O
TI
Clamp a tool in the milling spindle.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
A B-axis rotation command of the milling spindle was given manually with the lower turret selected.
O
Cause
N
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
1273 —— ( , , )
K
Cause ——
ZA
A
M
Action ——
YA
When the spindle was rotating, a tailstock movement command was entered.
Cause
)2
(c
When the milling spindle was rotating, a tailstock movement command was entered.
Cause
C
3-67
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
ve
1279 —— ( , , )
ser
Cause ——
re
ts
gh
Action ——
ri
1280 START ERROR (W AXIS POS. MALF.) ( , , ) A K O Yellow
ll
.A
Starting automatic operation has been attempted without W-axis positioning at the zero point.
Cause
N
O
TI
Perform return to the zero point for the W-axis beforehand.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
1281 —— ( , , )
29
R
o.
Cause ——
O
N
C
al
Action ——
ri
ZA
Se
Starting automatic operation has been attempted before completion of internal processing for updating the 3D models to be
Cause
K
Action
M
YA
1283 —— ( , , )
3
01
Cause ——
)2
(c
Action ——
ht
ig
1284 —— ( , , )
yr
op
Cause ——
C
Action ——
3-68
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1286 COND.MISSING (MILL UNCLAMP) ( , , ) A, B K P Yellow
The M132 (milling spindle-through air) command was issued with the milling spindle unclamped.
Cause
Set the machine setup switch to “I” (ON), and place the GL in the feed hold state, and then open the front door.
Action
d .
ve
1288 BAR-FEEDER CONTROLLER MALF. ( , , ) G J O Red
er
An alarm signal is input from the bar feeder while the bar feeder is enabled.
s
Cause
re
ts
Check the bar feeder.
gh
Action
ri
( , , )
ll
.A
Cause
N
O
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
PO
The hand open command was issued with the milling spindle unclamped.
R
o.
Cause
O
Or the milling spindle clamp command was issued with the hand open.
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
The pressure switch is not turned ON when the time set for parameter TIM55 has elapsed after the hand open/close
Cause command was issued.
K
ZA
Check the primary air, and if there is no problem, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
M
YA
Cause the B-axis was not at the zero point at the first ATC operation during automatic operation.
01
)2
The milling spindle tool mis-clamping sensor has not turned on within a predetermined time after the issue of a milling
Cause spindle tool clamp command.
op
C
3-69
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
(When the hand is closed, a workpiece may be held in the hand and therefore the ATC operation is prohibited.)
ve
Open the hand.
er
Action
s
re
1298 —— ( , , )
ts
gh
Cause ——
ri
ll
.A
Action ——
N
1299 AUTO DOOR CONTROLLER MALFUNCTIO ( , , ) C K N Red
O
TI
Auto door drive servo driver alarm has occurred.
60
Cause A
R
40
PO
Action
2) Turn off the circuit breaker and then back on.
R
o.
O
N
When the data change check function is valid, the tool data with changes has been called.
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
This alarm will be reset by pressing the cycle start button. (Be sure to check that there is no problem in tool data
IM
Action beforehand.)
K
When the data change check function is valid, the tool offset data with changes has been called.
A
Cause
M
YA
This alarm will be reset by pressing the cycle start button. (Be sure to check that there is no problem in tool offset data
Action beforehand.)
3
01
This alarm occurs after alarm 1300 PLEASE CHECK THE TOOL DATA or 1301 PLEASE CHECK THE TOOL OFFSET
(c
Cause has been reset. While this alarm is occurring, the override value is clamped to the value set for parameter F145.
ht
Action
yr
op
1303 —— ( , , )
C
Cause ——
Action ——
1304 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
3-70
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1305 TOOL LIFE OVER ( , , ) F J O Red
The tool has been used for a period of time longer than its serviceable life.
Cause
Replace the blade of the tool for which the alarm was raised.
Action
d .
ve
1307 TPS POINT LIMIT EXCEED ( , , ) B L S Yellow
ser
The maximum number of TPS storage times has been exceeded.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Review the number of TPS storage times.
Action
ri
ll
1308 —— ( , , )
.A
N
Cause ——
O
TI
60
Action —— A
R
40
PO
1309 —— ( , , )
29
R
o.
Cause ——
N
C
al
Action
ri
——
ZA
Se
A GL retraction position move command was given to the milling spindle with the B-axis at an angle other than 0-deg.
Cause
K
ZA
Action
M
YA
A top door/side door open/close command was issued with the front door open.
01
Cause
)2
Action
ht
ig
A side door open/close command was given with the milling spindle in the GL wait position or with the Z-axis not in the
op
Move the milling spindle to the GL wait position or move the Z-axis to the zero point.
Action
3-71
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
( , , )
Cause
Action
.d
ve
1318 TOP DOOR SENSOR MALFUNCTION ( , , ) F K O Red
ser
The top door opened position sensor is malfunctioning or the top door is not fully opened.
re
Cause
The top door closed position sensor is malfunctioning or the top door is not fully closed.
ts
gh
Check the top door opened/closed position sensor.
Action
Address: X1480, X1481
ri
ll
1319 SIDE DOOR SENSOR MALFUNCTION ( , , ) F K O Red
.A
The side door opened position sensor is malfunctioning or the side door is not fully opened.
N
Cause
The side door closed position sensor is malfunctioning or the side door is not fully closed.
O
TI
Check the side door opened/closed position sensor.
60
Action A
Address: X1482, X1483
R
40
PO
( , , )
29
R
o.
Cause
N
C
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
Action
M
Address: X140C
YA
1326 —— ( , , )
3
01
Cause ——
)2
(c
Action ——
ht
ig
1327 —— ( , , )
yr
op
Cause ——
C
Action ——
3-72
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1329 RECOVERY MODE IMPOSSIBLE. ( , , ) A L P, S Yellow
[ATC RECOVERY MODE] was tapped while ATC recovery mode selection was not possible.
Cause
Tap [ATC RECOVERY MODE] while ATC recovery mode selection is possible.
Action
( , , )
Cause
Action
.
d
ve
er
1334 PROGRAM DATA ILLEGAL ( , , ) B H P Red
s
A rapid feed command was issued during preparation for pressing (after execution of M508).
re
Cause
ts
gh
Correct the program.
Action
ri
ll
( , , )
.A
N
Cause
O
TI
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
A parts catcher extend/retract command was issued while the W-axis was not at the zero point.
O
N
A parts catcher extend/retract command was issued while the X2-axis was not at the zero point.
C
Cause
al
A parts catcher extend/retract command was issued while the Z2-axis was in the negative side with respect to the +70 mm
ri
ZA
Action
IM
K
A parts catcher extend/retract command was issued while the front door was not closed.
Cause
A
M
Issue a parts catcher extend/retract command with the front door closed.
YA
Action
3
01
A parts catcher extend/retract command was issued while tool No. 1 was not indexed on the lower turret.
Cause
(c
ht
Issue the parts catcher extend/retract command with tool No. 1 indexed on the lower turret.
Action
ig
yr
op
1344 —— ( , , )
C
Cause ——
Action ——
3-73
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Cause
Action
Do not touch the edge sensor while the auto door is being closed.
.
Action
d
Address: X5
ve
er
1351 AUTO DOOR TIME OVER ( , , ) F K P Yellow
s
re
The auto door did not reach the open or close end position when the time set for parameter TIM65 has elapsed after the
Cause auto door open/close command was given.
ts
gh
Check if the auto door motion is hindered due to chips.
Action
ri
ll
.A
1352 —— ( , , )
N
O
Cause ——
TI
60
A
R
40
Action ——
PO
29
O
N
The auto door open/close speed reached an abnormal speed after the auto door open/close command was given.
C
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
Action
A
IM
The door unlock state was not confirmed within 0.5 seconds after the door unlock command was given for auto door open
ZA
Cause command.
A
M
Action
3
An auto door open command was issued while the milling spindle or turning spindle is rotating.
Cause
(c
ht
( , , )
C
Cause
Action
3-74
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1360 NO SFT/CRR MOVE (ATC ARM POS.) ( , , ) A L O Yellow
When the ATC arm was not in its reference position, a command for moving the tool shifter or carrier was given.
Cause
.
clamping state.
d
ve
Index the desired magazine position with a pocket beforehand.
er
Action Check the pocket detection sensor when actually a pocket is present in the magazine position currently indexed.
s
re
Address: X1625, X1629
ts
1362 NO POCKET ULD (PCT IN MAG.) ( , , ) A K O Yellow
gh
An attempt was made to return a pocket to the magazine by the shifter when there was another pocket in the indexed
ri
Cause position of the magazine.
ll
.A
Index the desired magazine position without a pocket beforehand.
N
Action Check the pocket detection sensor when actually no pocket is present in the magazine position currently indexed.
O
Address: X1625, X1629
TI
60
In the flow of automatic operation the state of detecting a pocket in the indexed magazine position was not appropriately
PO
Cause
29
Check the pocket detection sensor when actually no pocket is present in the magazine position currently indexed.
N
Action
C
K
ri
ZA
In the flow of automatic operation the state of detecting a pocket in the indexed magazine position was not appropriately
Cause
IM
Check the pocket detection sensor when actually a pocket is present in the magazine position currently indexed.
Action
ZA
In manual mode of operation an attempt was made to move the tool shifter to the magazine side with the indexed magazine
Cause position being in pocket clamping state.
3
01
In manual mode of operation an attempt was made to move the tool shifter to the magazine side before completion of
ig
Do not move the tool shifter till completion of magazine indexing operation.
Action
C
Set either the magazine position or the tool shifter to pocket unclamping state.
Action
3-75
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
ve
1370 NO TOOL CHANGE (SFT NO PCT) ( , , ) A L O Yellow
s er
A command for rotating the ATC arm was given without the tool shifter being in pocket clamping state.
re
Cause
ts
gh
Establish a pocket clamping state for the tool shifter.
Action
ri
ll
( , , )
.A
N
Cause
O
TI
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
Cause
N
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
Address: X140D
A
IM
1390 —— ( , , )
K
Cause ——
ZA
A
Action
M
——
YA
1391 —— ( , , )
3
01
Cause ——
)2
(c
Action ——
ht
ig
yr
The temperature or vibration threshold level of the milling spindle has been exceeded for 10 seconds in succession.
Cause
C
( , , )
Cause
Action
3-76
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
3-2-5 No. 400 - No. 499, No. 1400 - No. 1499 (CNC screen operation error)
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
Tap the cancel key and then input correct data.
ve
Action
s er
re
402 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT ( , , ) A L S Blue
1. The work number of a display inhibiting program was specified.
ts
Cause
gh
2. The numeric value that has been input is out of the allowable range.
ri
1. The operation concerned cannot be performed for the program of display inhibition (Program management function).
Action
ll
2. Tap the cancel key and then input correct data.
.A
403 PROGRAM TOO LARGE ( , , ) A L S Blue
N
O
The limit of 2000 lines per program has been exceeded.
TI
Cause
60
A
R
40
R
o.
1. Additional creation of a machining program is no longer possible since the memory has already been filled up to its
al
ZA
2. Additional preparation of process control data is no longer possible since 100 sets of such data have already been
Se
Cause
stored.
A
IM
3. Additional preparation of program layout data is no longer possible since 4000 sets of such data have already been
stored.
K
Make an available storage area by either erasing an unnecessary machining program from the memory or saving a
ZA
Action machining program onto an external storage, and then create a new machining program.
A
M
An attempt has been made to select a program whose work number has not been registered.
Cause
An attempt was made to select the work number marked with [!] in the project display.
3
01
Action
(c
1. Inhibiting operation (editing, erasing, renumber of work number and entry of names) has been performed for the
ig
edit-inhibiting program.
yr
3. An attempt has been made to carry out “TOOL NAME ORDER” operation on the TOOL DATA display while a tool
C
3-77
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.d
ve
409 ILLEGAL INSERTION ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
Program data insertion is not possible.
Cause
s
re
It is not possible to insert data before the common unit.
ts
Action
gh
ri
410 ILLEGAL DELETION ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
Program deletion is not possible.
.A
Cause
An attempt has been made to erase the common unit during editing of the MAZATROL program.
N
O
It is not possible to delete the common unit.
Action
TI
Edit the program only after moving the cursor to the position where the data exists.
60
A
R
411 POWER OFF DURING PROGRAM EDIT ( , , ) A L S Blue
40
PO
29
A portion of the program may have been destroyed because power has been turned off during program editing.
Cause
R
o.
O
N
Check the corresponding program for incorrect data, and correct the program data if an error(s) exists in it.
C
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
Cause
K
Correct the program so that the total number of repeats of subprogram nesting becomes nine or less.
ZA
Action
A
The program registration has exceeded its maximum value available (Standard: 256 programs).
Cause
3
01
Reduce the total number of registered programs by deleting unnecessary programs or moving them to the backup area or
Action by saving unnecessary programs in an external storage unit and then deleting them.
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-78
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
414 AUTO CALCULATION IMPOSSIBLE (No., , ) A L S Blue
Automatic determination of the data failed due to an error.
No. Cause
- Automatic determination error
1 Automatic calculation of C-SP, FR or DEP-1 failed because the data (related to tool data) used for
calculation are not set.
2 Automatic calculation of C-SP, FR or DEP-1 failed because the data (related to programs) used for
calculation are not set.
3 (1) Automatic calculation of C-SP, FR or DEP-1 failed because a tool for which cutting conditions cannot
be calculated automatically (special tap, special cutter, chip removal, touch sensor, ball end mill,
special threading, special turning) is selected.
d .
Cause (2) Automatic calculation of “C-SP”, “FR” or “DEP-1” failed because a unit for which cutting conditions
ve
cannot be calculated automatically (mill-turning unit, turning-drilling unit with a drilling tool (mill
er
spindle)) is selected.
s
re
4 Automatic calculation of C-SP or FR failed during automatic calculation of C-SP, FR and DEP-1 because
the data (related to parameters) used for calculation are not set.
ts
5 Automatic calculation of C-SP, FR or DEP-1 failed because the data (related to the tool file) used for
gh
calculation are not set.
ri
6 Automatic calculation of C-SP or FR failed during automatic calculation of C-SP, FR and DEP-1 because
ll
the data (related to CUTTING CONDITION display) used for calculation are not set.
.A
99 The result of calculation exceeded the setting range permitted in the program during automatic calculation
N
of C-SP, FR and DEP-1.
O
TI
60
Action
Review the setting data. A
R
40
PO
29
Cause
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Cause 2. An attempt has been made to edit an EIA program whose size is 32 MB or larger on the PROGRAM display or EIA
)2
MONITOR display.
(c
1. Modify the data only after canceling the parameter setting for prohibition of editing.
ht
Action 2. EIA programs with a size of 32 MB or larger cannot be edited on the NC unit. Therefore, they need to be edited
ig
During EIA/ISO conversion, an attempt has been made to perform erasure, work number change or editing of the
C
Cause conversion source program. Or an attempt has been made to select the TOOL PATH CHECK display.
During EIA/ISO conversion, erasure, work number change or editing of the conversion source program cannot be done.
Action The TOOL PATH CHECK display cannot be selected.
3-79
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
.
2. Machining-program number (changed)
d
Cause
ve
3. Machining priority number
er
4. Tool model name
s
re
5. Tool data suffix
Check and correct the data settings.
ts
gh
Action In case 4, this alarm indicates that the tool model name the operator has attempted registering is already present under the
same tool type (such as: drill, end mill, turning tool, or grooving tool) in other systems. Specify another tool model name.
ri
ll
421 DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue
.A
An attempt has been made to designate the data that does not exist.
Cause
N
O
TI
Check whether the designated data exists.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
An attempt has been made to edit or input the machining program, tool data, etc. during I/O operation.
R
o.
Cause
O
N
C
al
Wait until the I/O operation is completed, and then repeat the editing or input operation from the beginning.
K
Action
ri
ZA
Se
During tool layout, the number of tools used in the designated program has exceeded the maximum available number.
Cause
K
ZA
Check and correct the corresponding machining program so that the maximum available number of tools is not exceeded.
Action
A
M
YA
Cause tools.
01
)2
Assign the pocket number(s) and then finish the tool layout operation.
Action
(c
ht
1. Saving or loading has been attempted without designating any data (such as work numbers, etc.) on the DATA I/O
op
Cause
display.
C
3-80
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
427 MEMORY PROTECT (AUTO MODE) ( , , ) A L S Blue
An attempt has been made to input unallowable data in the automatic operation mode.
Cause
Change the mode over to the manual operation mode, and then input the data.
Action
Input allowable data only after placing the NC unit in its reset state or after changing the current mode over to another
Action mode.
d .
ve
429 CANNOT PERFORM MEASUREMENT ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
The following conditions were not satisfied:
s
re
Coordinate measurement
ts
1. Automatic operation must not be in progress.
gh
Cause 2. The spindle must have a tool mounted on it.
ri
3. The tool data of the tool mounted on the spindle must have already been input.
ll
Tool-length measurement
.A
1. Automatic operation must not be in progress.
N
Set the specified conditions and then make the measurement.
O
Action
TI
60
During creation of a machining program, an attempt has been made to input a tool name not available for the particular
PO
29
Action
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Cause
IM
Action
ZA
A
Cause
3
Action
)2
(c
The number of the machining program that has been designated for program reading from an external unit already exists
Cause
ig
Action
C
3-81
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
ve
437 NO NOM- DATA IN PROGRAM ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
It has been found during tool layout that there is a tool without a nominal diameter in the designated program.
s
Cause
re
ts
Check if nominal diameters have been assigned to all tools registered in the designated program.
gh
Action
ri
438 END UNIT NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
The end unit is not included in the machining program.
Cause
N
O
Create the end unit at the end of the program.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
A MAZATROL program has been designated for copying purposes during EIA/ISO program editing.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
No MAZATROL programs can be designated for copying purposes during EIA/ISO program editing.
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
1. The machining program that has been designated on the TOOL LAYOUT, PROCESS CONTROL or SET UP
RECORD display is an EIA/ISO program.
K
Cause 2. An EIA/ISO program has been designated for copying purposes during MAZATROL program editing.
ZA
3. An EIA/ISO program has been designated as the source program of EIA/ISO conversion.
A
4. An EIA/ISO program has been designated when writing coordinate values on the MEASURE display.
M
YA
No EIA/ISO programs can be designated for operation on the TOOL LAYOUT, PROCESS CONTROL, SET UP RECORD
Action or MEASURE display or during EIA/ISO conversion or MAZATROL program editing.
3
01
The head number that has been designated during MDI-MMS setting does not exist in the head data.
Cause
(c
ht
Action
yr
op
This message may also be displayed when the NC unit is busy processing data.
Action
Tap the alarm clear button and then carry out the operation once again.
3-82
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
444 EDITING PROHIBITED AREA ( , , ) A L S Blue
During automatic operation based on the EIA MONITOR display, an attempt has been made to move the cursor to the
Cause program section whose editing was prohibited.
d .
ve
446 RESTART TIMES EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
The block to be searched for at the time of restart of the EIA/ISO program does exist, but the designated number of times of
s
Cause reappearance of the block is too large.
re
ts
Check the number of times of reappearance of the block.
Action
gh
ri
447 PROGRAM ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
A program error(s) has occurred during EIA/ISO restart search.
Cause
N
O
The program being searched for includes an error(s). Perform a tool-path check upon the program contents.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
Cause
o.
O
N
Designate the restart position and tap the [EIA/ISO SEARCH] button to search the intended restart position.
al
Action
K
ri
ZA
Se
An attempt has been made to carry out another search operation when EIA/ISO restart searching had already been
Cause finished.
K
An attempt has been made to change the work number when EIA/ISO restart searching had already been finished.
ZA
Press the RESET key and then carry out the restart operation once again.
Action
A
The materials name that has been designated on the CUTTING CONDITION - W.-MAT/T.-MAT. display already exists.
yr
Cause
op
C
Check the contents of the program unit for which shape copying is to be made.
Action
3-83
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
It is not possible to copy shape data of the pallet-changing unit, index unit, or other units that do not have a shape
Action sequence.
d .
operation.
ve
Example :
er
Action 1. No shape data can be copied on the tool sequence line.
s
re
2. Review the program.
ts
455 SAME PROGRAM No. DESIGNATED ( , , ) A L S Blue
gh
The machining program currently being edited has been appointed for the particular program copying operation.
ri
Cause
ll
.A
Copying within the same program is not possible. Check the designated program number.
Action
N
O
TI
456 NO TOOL IN SPINDLE ( , , ) A L S Blue
60
PO
29
After mounting a tool on the spindle, carry out the particular operation once again.
R
Action
o.
O
N
K
ri
ZA
During creation of manual program mode unit, data setting has been attempted without addressing.
Se
Cause
A
IM
During creation of the manual program mode unit, designate an address before setting data.
Action
K
ZA
An attempt has been made to register a tool most likely to interfere with an adjacent pocket.
M
Example :
YA
Cause 1. An attempt has been made to register tool data or tool change data on the TOOL DATA display.
3
2. An attempt has been made to set such a tool on the TOOL LAYOUT display that is likely to interfere with an adjacent
01
pocket.
)2
Select a pocket that does not cause interference with an adjacent one.
Action
(c
ht
Cause 2. An attempt has been made to display an EIA program whose size is 32 MB or larger on the PROGRAM display, EIA
MONITOR display, or POSITION display.
C
1. Display the program only after canceling the parameter setting for prohibition of display.
Action 2. EIA programs with a size of 32 MB or larger cannot be displayed. Therefore, their contents need to be checked
outside the NC unit.
460 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
3-84
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
461 PRIORITY No. OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue
The same priority number is assigned to different tools.
Cause
Within one process, the same priority number must not be assigned to different tools.
Action Change the priority number.
The machining order within one unit has been reversed by the incorrect priority numbering.
Action Change the priority numbers.
d .
ve
463 PRIORITY No. OVERFLOW ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
A priority number exceeding 99 has occurred because an attempt has been made to move a priority number(s) on the
s
Cause PROGRAM LAYOUT display.
re
ts
Set priority numbers in the correct order, and then move the desired priority number(s).
gh
Action
ri
464 ILLEGAL ADDRESS INPUT ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
An address not covered by the specifications has been designated during input of subprogram unit addresses on the
Cause PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display.
N
O
Check and correct the address.
TI
Action
60
Although an attempt has been made to draw a workpiece shape using the selected EIA/ISO program, shape data is not
R
O
N
Action If the program is that which has been obtained by EIA/ISO conversion output, change the setting of the bit 0 of parameter
ri
ZA
F89 to 1 and then carry out the converting operation once again.
Se
Although an attempt has been made to draw a workpiece shape using the selected EIA/ISO program, the corresponding
Cause
K
Action
M
YA
467 —— ( , , )
3
Cause ——
01
)2
(c
Action ——
ht
The target time of the items which had been set on the MAINTENANCE CHECK display has been exceeded.
Cause
op
C
Carry out periodic checks, and then after completion of the checks, reset the current time of the check items of the
Action MAINTENANCE CHECK display to zero (0).
3-85
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
ve
472 CALCULATION ERROR ( , , ) B L S Blue
er
1. The calculation expressions displayed in the desk calculator window includes expressions that result in a calculation
s
failure.
re
Cause
2. Calculating tool lengths A and B has been attempted in spite of tool nose position storage not being completed.
ts
gh
1. Review the calculation expressions, and correct nonexecutable sections, such as those which may include division by
Action 0 or result in a negative number in SQRT.
ri
2. Store the position of the tool nose.
ll
.A
473 FINAL POINT DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) B L S Blue
N
Although the end-point data of the preceding line was not yet set in the BAR or CPY unit, [NEXT] was tapped.
O
Cause
TI
60
A
Tap [NEXT] after setting the end-point data of the preceding line.
R
40
Action
PO
29
O
N
1. During tape operation mode, an attempt has been made to select the EIA MONITOR display.
C
Cause
al
2. An attempt has been made to change the operation mode to tape operation mode when the EIA MONITOR display is
K
ri
selected.
ZA
Se
1. During tape operation mode, programs cannot be displayed on the EIA MONITOR display.
A
Action
IM
2. Select a display other than the EIA MONITOR display before changing the operation mode to tape operation mode.
An attempt has been made to use an EIA/ISO-option related function in spite of the absence of an EIA/ISO option.
Cause
A
M
An EIA/ISO-option related function cannot be used since the system has no EIA/ISO option.
YA
Action
3
An attempt has been made to use an optional function in spite of the absence of that option.
)2
Cause
(c
This function cannot be used since the system does not have the option for the function.
ht
Action
ig
yr
The maximum memory capacity for drawing tool paths has been consumed in the 3D mode of the TOOL PATH CHECK or
Cause
C
TRACE display.
Action ——
Copy the coordinates data only after the measurement has been completed.
Action
3-86
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
479 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
ve
Select necessary items.
er
Action
s
re
481 DIRECTORY NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue
ts
An I/O operation was attempted on a non-existing directory.
gh
Cause
ri
ll
Check whether the specified directory is present.
.A
Action
N
482 —— ( , , )
O
TI
60
Cause —— A
R
40
PO
29
Action ——
R
o.
O
N
483 —— ( , , )
C
al
Cause ——
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
Action ——
K
[LENG-OFS TEACH] has been tapped in spite of the fact that a tool not having its “Length Offset Data” item displayed on
Cause
A
the TOOL DATA display (for example, a turning tool) was mounted in the spindle.
M
YA
Executing the tool nose position storage function (TEACH) has been attempted when the head index angle displayed in
Cause
(c
TOOL DATA display mode was neither 0°, 90°, nor 180°.
ht
Execute the tool nose position storage function (TEACH) when the head index angle is either 0° 90° or 180°.
ig
Action
yr
op
The use of the jaw shape that has been specified for the program results in interference between adjacent jaws as a result
Cause of the SOLID mode PATH CHECK.
3-87
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Perform tool data updating operations after completing the magazine setup operations.
Action
Deselect [MAGAZINE SETUP] relating to visual tool data management.
d .
ve
490 REGISTRATION NUMBER EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
The data registration has exceeded its maximum value available.
s
Cause An attempt was made on the TOOL FILE display to register the ninth data item of workpiece material.
re
ts
Delete unnecessary items to register the desired one.
gh
Action
ri
491 ITEM NOT SETUP ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
Data registration is not yet complete.
Cause
N
O
Check if all the data items are set as required.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
Cause
o.
O
N
Action
K
ri
ZA
Se
Assigning dimensions to jaw data for which a shape has not been specified has been attempted.
IM
Cause
K
Action
A
M
Execution of tool selection has been attempted under the selected status of a non-magazine type turret.
Cause
3
01
Action
(c
Registered tool model data contains imperfections (a tool model cannot be drawn with the entered data).
Cause
yr
op
Note :
During Parametric model entry ······················The alarm-causing section is displayed.
Action During rotating/extruding tool model entry ·······Causes are displayed.
11: The entered shape has overlapping elements.
12: The entered shape is clockwise (CW).
13: The line connecting the starting and ending points overlaps
some other element.
3-88
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
496 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
ve
1. Tool tip position storage (tool length measurement) is possible only with the head in its horizontal machining position.
Action
er
2. MDI-MMS or manual measurement is possible only with the head in its horizontal or vertical machining position.
s
re
498 NO HEAD DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue
Offset data for the selected head is not registered on the HEAD OFFSET display.
ts
Cause
gh
ri
Check if the selected head data is registered on the HEAD OFFSET display.
Action
ll
.A
499 ILLEGAL HEAD TYPE ( , , ) A L S Blue
N
An attempt has been made to perform tool tip position storage on the TOOL DATA or TOOL OFFSET display during use of
O
Cause
TI
the horizontal type of head.
60
A
To perform tool tip position storage for tool length measurement, mount a vertical head or a cover.
R
40
Action
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-89
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the particular operation causing
Action the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
The file in question might be currently being accessed by another application. Wait for a while to repeat the same
Action operation. If the alarm is not cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the
.
information of the particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
d
ve
1402 FILE READ ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
Trouble has occurred in reading a file on the hard disk.
s
Cause
re
ts
The file in question might be currently being accessed by another application. Wait for a while to repeat the same
gh
Action operation. If the alarm is not cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the
ri
information of the particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
ll
1403 FILE WRITE ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
.A
Trouble has occurred in writing a file on the hard disk.
N
Cause
O
TI
The file in question might be currently being accessed by another application. Wait for a while to repeat the same
60
Action A
operation. If the alarm is not cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the
R
40
information of the particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
PO
29
It was attempted to edit jaw shape data of the machining program currently selected.
O
Cause
N
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
Action Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the particular operation causing
M
Cause
)2
Exit all the unnecessary applications to make the best of the NC ones.
(c
Action If the alarm is caused again, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the
ht
particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
ig
Creating a file and folder on the hard disk was not successful.
Cause
C
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the particular operation causing
Action the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the particular operation causing
Action the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
3-90
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1409 MILLING ONLY SELECTED ( , , ) A L S Blue
The designated function is not available for a program of initial-point scheme (ONLY MILL).
Cause
.
d
ve
1411 MILL & TRN (Z-OFS) SELECTED ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
The designated function is not available for a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with Z-offset setting.
Cause
s
re
Use the function for a program of another scheme.
ts
Action
gh
ri
1412 INCORRECT G-CODE ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
The designated function is not available for the G-code system selected by the F30 parameter.
.A
Cause
N
O
Correct the program, or change the F30 setting.
Action
TI
60
PO
The designated function is not available for the current operation mode or on the current display.
29
Cause
R
o.
O
N
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
Cause
K
The file in question might be currently being accessed by another application. Wait for a while to repeat the same
ZA
Action operation. If the alarm is not cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the
information of the particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
A
M
Check the settings of tool length or tool set data and, if required, measure the tool in question again.
)2
Action
(c
Cause
yr
op
Check and correct the parameter setting with reference to the codes displayed in parentheses.
Action
3-91
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
1419 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
ve
1420 FILE SIZE LIMIT EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
The size of the file is too large for new data to be written in it.
Cause
s
re
Delete the file, or rename the file.
ts
Action
gh
ri
1421 DATA ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
Cause ——
N
O
Action ——
TI
60
PO
Creating the data for turret-by-turret display of program layout was not successful.
29
Cause
R
o.
O
N
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
Since the program has not yet undergone tool path check, the TOOL DATA display (tool layout mode) cannot perform
IM
Cause calculations for indicating the spare tools to be additionally provided for the machining operation with the program.
K
Action
A
In the program-listing mode, [BARRIER INFORM.] has been tapped without any barrier data being registered.
Cause
3
01
Make a copy of the program in question on the PROGRAM FILE display, and prepare the setup data for the program
op
Action copied.
C
Tap the menu selector button to select a process with program layout data, or select the display mode for all processes.
Action Alternatively, select a process with program layout data on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display or PROCESS
CONTROL display and then call up the PROGRAM LAYOUT display from there.
3-92
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1427 3D INTERFRNCE CHECK MODEL ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
3D remodeling of the workpiece, fixture, or tool has failed.
Cause
d .
ve
1429 CANNOT PERFORM AUTO SET ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
Tool setup auto-setting for a tool not capable of using the tool setup auto-setting function (e.g., a magazine tool or a tool
Cause
s
facing the No. 1 turning spindle) has been attempted on the TOOL DATA display.
re
Apply the tool setup auto-setting function only to a turret tool facing the No. 2 turning spindle.
ts
Action
gh
ri
1430 NOT ACTIVE PROGRAM ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
1. This alarm indicates that the machine-operating program and the program selected on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL)
.A
display differ during execution of the workpiece transfer storage function on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display.
N
Cause 2. When the directory selection function was enabled (parameter US1 bit 4 = 1) or the project function was enabled
O
(parameter US1 bit 5 = 1), a work number that had the same name as the work number to be executed in automatic
TI
operation from the WORK No. SELECT window but was in a different operation area was selected for WORK No. in
60
A
the COMPARISON STOP window or for SUB PROG. No. in the RESTART (EIA/ISO) window.
R
40
PO
1. Match the machine-operating program and the program selected on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display.
29
Action
2. Select the work number to be executed in automatic operation.
R
o.
The tool for which the reference tool length was set has not been found during automatic tool length setting.
al
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
Set at least one tool length value before executing automatic tool length setting.
A
Action
IM
The tool model to be used as a reference has not been selected during tool model copying, erasing, or renaming.
Cause
A
M
Select a reference tool model before executing tool model copying, erasing, or renaming.
YA
Action
3
A registered tool name has been specified during tool model copying or renaming.
)2
Cause
(c
ht
When setting the PROGRAM LAYOUT display from the MAZATROL program was attempted, the layout of program data
C
Cause up to the first end unit has been displayed since an end unit was present at a position previous to the cursor.
Move the cursor to a position previous to the end unit, and then set the PROGRAM LAYOUT display.
Action
3-93
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Before conducting program transfer, select a different program for automatic operation.
Action
d .
ve
1438 NO SETUP DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
[SETUP DATA] has been tapped in the program listing mode when there was no registered setup data.
Cause
s
re
Select the programming mode before tapping [SETUP DATA].
ts
Action
gh
ri
1439 CANNOT CHANGE UNIT ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
Changing a unit has been attempted when a unit change in the MAZATROL program was prohibited.
.A
It is not allowed to change a unit for which data other than the unit name has been set up.
N
Cause
It is not allowed to change a unit if the current machining section is not selectable for the new unit (e.g., a unit for which
O
TI
an outside-diametral section has been selected as the machining section cannot be changed to a turning-drilling unit).
60
Action
Review the program. A
R
40
PO
29
Although moving tool data from the magazine tool list to the stored-tool list has been attempted on the TOOL DATA display
N
Cause
C
(tool layout mode), an ID number has not been set up for the corresponding tool.
al
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
Action
M
YA
Cause
)2
Action
ht
3-94
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1445 SAME SIMULTAN. NO IN RGH & FIN ( , , ) A L S Blue
Assigning a priority number to the roughing tool on the PROGRAM LAYOUT display has been attempted, but since
Cause simultaneous machining is specified in the program and the same simultaneous machining number is specified for both
roughing and finishing. Roughing cannot be prioritized with the simultaneous machining number ignored.
Review the specified simultaneous machining number and execute [ROUGH PRIORITY].
Action
Cancel the single-process mode before conducting the work number change.
Action
d .
ve
1447 RESTORE OPERATION STOPPED ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
The NC data restore process has been aborted.
s
Cause
re
ts
To conduct the restore process, perform the restore operations once again.
gh
Action
ri
1448 TOOL LENGTH OVER ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
The tool length input range has been overstepped as a result of tool measurement.
Cause
N
O
Use a tool of any tool length value falling within the range defined in parameters SU110 - SU113.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
This alarm indicates that during hard-disk program transfer to the program storage area (NC memory), as in a power-on
R
status, lack of the necessary NC memory space has been detected or the program storage capacity limit exceeded.
o.
O
N
Cause If AREA = 1 ........ indicates alarm during program transfer from the standard area to the NC memory
C
al
If AREA = 2 ........ indicates alarm during machine manufacturer macroprogram transfer to the NC memory
K
ri
ZA
If AREA = 3 ........ indicates alarm during GL pattern file transfer to the NC memory
Se
An attempt has been made to use [TEACH] for a WPC unit with the lower turret selected.
Cause
A
M
[TEACH] cannot be used for a WPC unit with the lower turret selected. Designate the upper turret.
YA
Action
3
01
Tip position memorization was attempted with the tilting table at other than the 0 position.
Cause
(c
ht
Perform tip position memory with the tilting table at the 0 position.
Action
ig
yr
The spindle condition check function judged that the spindle was in an alarm state.
C
Cause
Perform the editing or setting when the backup data has been saved.
Action
3-95
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Perform the editing or setting when the backup data has been restored.
Action
The characters \ / : * ? “ < > | cannot be used in the manufacturer name. Use other characters to assign the manufacturer
Action name.
d .
ve
1456 ILLEGAL MODEL NO. ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
Invalid characters have been used in the model number in an attempt to add a tool part model.
Cause
s
re
The characters \ / : * ? “ < > | cannot be used in the model number. Use other characters to assign the model number.
ts
Action
gh
ri
1457 CANNOT EDIT MAKER MADE DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
Editing or deleting the tool part model that the manufacturer created has been attempted.
.A
Cause
N
O
The tool part model that the manufacturer created cannot be edited or deleted.
Action
TI
60
PO
[OP.PROG. TOOL PATH] was tapped in the tape operation mode or without selecting a program for the operation.
29
Cause
R
o.
O
N
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
1459 —— ( , , )
Se
Cause ——
IM
K
Action ——
ZA
A
Calling up the VIRTUAL MACHINING display was attempted during automatic operation (when the INTELLIGENT
YA
When the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function in automatic operation mode is valid, the VIRTUAL MACHINING
01
Action display cannot be presented during automatic operation. Change the display mode after automatic operation has been
)2
completed or after making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function in automatic operation mode invalid.
(c
The data to be imported is incorrect or importable data is absent at the specified location. Make sure that the data to be
op
Action
imported is correct or that data is saved in the specified path.
C
Display the data when the condition check operation has completed.
Action
3-96
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1463 INVALID HANDLE INTERRUPT ( , , ) A L S Blue
Manual handle pulse interruption was attempted during balance cutting.
Cause
d .
1465 —— ( , , )
ve
er
Cause ——
s
re
Action ——
ts
gh
1466 ILLEGAL ATTACHMENT No. ( , , ) A L S Blue
ri
A Non-existant attachment number was specified in the MDI mode.
ll
Cause
.A
N
Check the input data.
Action
O
TI
60
While the input error prevention function was enabled, the input data or variation of tool wear offset exceeded the
PO
Cause
parameter setting range.
29
Input the tool wear offset within the maximum variation set for parameter F125 and the maximum setting set for parameter
o.
Action
N
F126.
C
al
1468 —— ( , , )
ri
ZA
Se
Cause ——
A
IM
Action ——
K
ZA
1469 —— ( , , )
A
M
Cause ——
YA
Action ——
3
01
Note :
(c
ht
–1 : Data in the error file for space error compensation to be transferred to the NC unit does not match the machine
configuration.
ig
Cause
yr
–2 : Error components in the error file for space error compensation have exceeded the specification (single direction:
128 points, both directions: 64 points).
op
3-97
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
1. Delete unnecessary G codes and addresses from the block.
ve
Action 2. For blocks to be re-edited with the add-in EIA function, the comment must be added at the end of the block.
er
3. Edit the block to include 248 characters or less.
s
re
1473 NOT AUTO MODE ( , , ) A L S Blue
ts
The restart 2 non-modal function setting was attempted in a mode other than the memory operation or hard disk operation
gh
Cause mode.
ri
Perform the restart 2 non-modal function setting in the memory operation or hard disk operation mode.
ll
Action
.A
N
1474 MEASURED RESULT MALFUNCTION ( , , ) B L S Blue
O
Measurement using the INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER function did not complete normally.
TI
Cause
60
A
R
40
Review the measurement program. Check that the dwell time is 40 seconds and that the table was rotating normally, then
Action
PO
O
N
The tool measurement conditions on the TOOL DATA display are not satisfied.
C
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
Action
A
IM
1476 —— ( , , )
K
Cause ——
ZA
A
M
Action ——
YA
A process for a head differing from the selected head has been selected in the SELECT PROCESS window for the restart
01
Action
It is also possible to avoid the alarm by setting parameter F158 bit5 = 0.
ig
yr
( , , )
op
Cause
C
Action
3-98
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1483 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
1484 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
1485 DATA GUARD ALARM (No., , ) A L S Blue
ve
The allowable operation range is restricted by the data guard function.
ser
re
No. Cause
ts
Cause 0 A user having the authority level lower than RANK “1” attempted to change the custom setting.
gh
1 to 8 The access authority level is lower than the level required for changing the data.
ri
999 Deletion of a user failed.
ll
.A
Log in the system with a user having the correct authority level.
N
Action
O
TI
1486 ILLEGAL ID OR PASSWORD (No., , ) A L S Blue
60
PO
29
No. Cause
R
o.
The user name or password set at the input and display filed for switching a user is incorrect.
O
Cause 0
N
1 The password set at the input and display filed for changing a password is incorrect.
al
2 The user name or password set at the input and display filed for adding a user is incorrect.
ri
ZA
Se
Action
K
A user name is not selected in account management operation with Data Guard.
A
M
No. Cause
YA
Cause
1 A user name is not selected at the input and display field for changing a password.
3
3 A user name is not selected at the input and display field for deleting a user.
01
)2
Action
ht
Two passwords input in account management operation with Data Guard do not match.
op
C
No. Cause
Cause
1 Mismatch of two passwords input at the input and display field for changing a password.
2 Mismatch of two passwords input at the input and display field for adding a user.
3-99
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
No. Cause
Cause 1 A character string input at the input and display field for changing a password includes illegal
characters.
2 A character string input at the input and display field for adding a user includes illegal
characters.
d .
1490 SAME ID ALREADY EXISTS (No., , ) A L S Blue
ve
A user name input in account management operation by Data Guard already exists.
s er
re
Cause No. Cause
ts
2 A user name input at the input and display field for adding a user already exists.
gh
ri
Change the input user name.
Action
ll
.A
1491 RANK NOT SELECT (No., , ) A L S Blue
N
O
In Data Guard account management operation, RANK is not selected.
TI
60
2 In the input and display field for adding a user, RANK is not selected.
PO
29
R
o.
Select RANK.
O
Action
N
C
al
ZA
Se
An attempt was made to register more than 50 users in Data Guard account management operation.
A
IM
No. Cause
Cause
K
2 An attempt was made to register more than 50 users at the input and display field for adding a
ZA
user.
A
M
The confirmation code input in Data Guard account management operation is incorrect.
)2
(c
No. Cause
Cause
ht
3 Mismatch of the confirmation code, input at the input and display field for deleting a user, with
ig
“–9999”.
yr
op
3-100
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1494 CANNOT EDIT SMC DATA (No., , ) A L S Blue
SMC data operation is performed while the SMC data editing is not allowed or for the data items that cannot be edited.
No. Cause
0 The edit menu was selected although the SMC data was not selected.
1 An attempt was made to edit SMC No. 0.
d .
registered.
ve
s er
Edit the SMC data after arranging the conditions that allow editing of the SMC data.
re
Action
ts
1495 SMC DATA NOT SETUP (No., , ) A L S Blue
gh
The SMC data that has not been set is specified in the SMC data selection window.
ri
Cause
ll
.A
Specify the SMC data that has been set.
Action
N
O
1496 ILLEGAL ITS PARAMETER ( , , ) A L S Blue
TI
60
PO
29
O
N
( , , )
al
K
ri
ZA
Cause
Se
A
IM
Action
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-101
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
3-2-6 No. 500 - No. 599, No. 1500 - No. 1599 (I/O error)
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
Check whether the contents of the external storage medium are appropriate for the Smooth system.
ve
Action
s er
re
502 CANNOT LOAD (PROG SIZE EXCEED) (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
The contents of the external storage medium are not correct.
ts
Cause
gh
(Loading of a MAZATROL program of more than 2000 lines of data has been attempted.)
ri
Either use another external storage medium, or save the program data once again. After that, carry out the load operation
Action
ll
once again.
.A
503 CANNOT LOAD (TOO MANY PROGRAMS) (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
N
O
An attempt has been made to load more machining programs than the maximum number of programs that can be
TI
Cause registered within the NC unit.
60
A
Delete unnecessary programs, or save the programs onto an external storage and then delete them. After that, load the
R
40
Action
PO
particular program.
29
O
N
An attempt has been made during automatic operation to load data other than machining programs.
C
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
Action
A
IM
Loading has been attempted although the data within the external storage medium does not match to the NC unit
Cause
ZA
Check if the data saved on the external storage medium is the data to be used for the machine currently in operation.
Action
M
YA
An attempt has been made to load the machining program that has the same work number as that of a machining program
01
Action
ht
The machining program whose saving has been attempted does not exist in the NC unit.
Cause
op
C
Check if the machining program with the specified work number exists in the NC unit.
Action
3-102
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
508 MEMORY CAPACITY EXCEEDED (WNo., , ) A (G) L (L) S (S) Blue (Blue)
1. An attempt has been made to load machining program data that exceeds the maximum available area for program
registration within the NC unit.
Cause
2. In the middle of saving onto the external storage medium, data saving exceeding the memory capacity has been made,
or the end-of-tape (or end-of-disk) code has been detected.
1. Delete unnecessary programs, or save the programs onto an external storage and then delete them. After that, load
the particular program.
Action
2. Split the data into segments according to the particular size of the free saving area within the external storage medium,
and then carry out the saving operations once again.
.
Cause
d
ve
er
Cancel the program protect function.
Action
s
re
ts
510 DATA DO NOT MATCH (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
gh
Comparison between the external storage medium contents and the NC memory contents has shown disparities in data
Cause
ri
size, type of file information, etc.
ll
1. Locate those disparities on the PROGRAM FILE display and correct them, and then make the comparison once again.
.A
Action
2. If the disparities exist in data other than machining program data, check if the data is for the machine being used.
N
O
511 PROGRAM DATA NOT SAME (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue
TI
Comparison between the cassette tape or floppy disk contents and the NC data has shown several disparities.
60
Cause A
R
40
PO
1. After correcting the disparities within the machining program, make the comparison once again.
29
2. If the disparities exist in data other than machining program data, locate those disparities on each display.
R
o.
Note :
N
Action
C
This alarm message may be displayed if data is saved prior to automatic operation and then subjected to comparison
al
with that after automatic operation. This is because execution of automatic operation may cause automatic data
ri
ZA
overriding.
Se
An attempt has been made to load an EIA/ISO program in spite of the absence of an EIA/ISO option.
Cause
K
ZA
An EIA/ISO program cannot be loaded since the system has no EIA/ISO option.
A
Action
M
YA
Cause
01
)2
Check whether the contents of the external storage medium are appropriate for the Smooth system.
(c
Action
ht
An attempt has been made to load data (other than machining program data) that differs in structure from the NC memory
Cause
op
data.
C
Check whether the contents of the external storage medium are appropriate for the Smooth system or the machine being
Action used.
3-103
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
ve
1. Check if the specified work number is for the program of display inhibition.
er
Action 2. Carry out a saving operation only after completion of the program editing operation (or the program loading operation
s
using another I/O unit).
re
518 DATA OPERATION NOT ALLOWED ( , , ) A L S Blue
ts
gh
1. An attempt has been made during automatic operation to load data other than machining program data.
Cause
ri
2. An attempt has been made to save the data being loaded using another I/O unit.
ll
3. An attempt has been made to load the data being saved using another I/O unit.
.A
Wait until automatic operation has been completed (or until the loading or saving operation using another I/O unit has been
Action
N
completed).
O
TI
519 DATA SIZE EXCEEDED (WNo., Note, ) A L S Blue
60
A
The EIA/ISO machining program includes a block that consists of more than 256 characters. (EOB or EOR does not
R
40
Cause Note :
R
o.
The number displayed next to the work number is a line number, which corresponds to the number displayed in the lower
O
N
Correct the EIA/ISO machining program. (Insert EOB within 256 characters.)
K
Action
ri
ZA
Se
Nonconvertible sections have been found when an attempt was made to convert the MAZATROL program into an EIA/ISO
Cause program.
K
ZA
Action
M
YA
Cause unit.
01
)2
An attempt has been made to load the GL setup data that has the same GL setup number as that of setup data registered
Cause within the NC unit.
op
C
Rename or erase the GL setup data within the NC unit before loading the data.
Action
3-104
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
524 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
Check if the available space within the local drive is sufficient for the purpose.
Action
.d
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-105
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
○○
d.
stopped.)
ve
04: No-exchange error (a slave station has an update error)
er
08: Critical error (communication cannot continue due to a serious network problem)
s
re
10: Not ready (NC communication is not ready)
ts
20: Timeout error (a timeout is detected during an update with each station)
gh
Master communication status
ri
Indicates the status of the master station (hexadecimal).
ll
.A
00: Off-line (being initialized)
40: Stop (I/O stopped)
N
O
80: Clear (resetting the output data from each slave station by sending “0” data)
TI
C0: Running (I/O being updated)
60
2.
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
Cause
Indicates the communication status of the slave station at which a communication error is
al
occurring (hexadecimal).
ri
ZA
Se
An appropriate data communication is being made between the master station and
IM
slave station.
Configuration with the target slave station may not be finished correctly.
A
M
02: No data communication may be being made between the master station and the
target slave station.
3
Diagnosis information from the target slave station may exist in the internal buffer of
01
03: The target slave exists on the bus. An appropriate data communication is being made
(c
Diagnosis information from the target slave station may exist in the internal buffer of
ig
Indicates the number of the slave station at which a communication error is occurring
(hexadecimal).
However, if no communication is being made with the master station, “00” is displayed.
00: No communication is being made with the master station.
01: Station No. 1
02: Station No. 2
7D: Station No. 125
Check the environment of the master station or slave station at which a communication error is occurring.
Action
3-106
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
527 ETHERNET/IP COMMUNICATION ERROR (Note 1, Note 2, ) E L M, O, Q Blue
1. Communication error has occurred during the EtherNet/IP communication using a field network expansion card.
2. EtherNet/IP connection wait time setting may not be appropriate.
Note :
1.
○○
Adaptor status
.d
0x01: Communication being made
ve
0x02: Communication stopped (communication with at least one adaptor station has
er
stopped)
s
re
ts
Scanner status
gh
0x01: Configuration not finished
ri
0x02: Stopped
Cause
ll
0x03: Idling
.A
0x04: Running
N
O
2.
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
ZA
Se
1. Check the environment of the scanner or adaptor at which a communication error is occurring.
Action
2. Review the EtherNet/IP connection wait time setting, and turn power off and then back on.
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-107
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Cause
1: The value at R19974 (field network output data top register) is out of the setting range.
2: The value at R19976 (field network input data top register) is out of the setting range.
3: The value specified at the register R for high-speed data input/output is out of the setting range.
Cause 4: The value of parameter F150 is out of the setting range.
d .
2.
ve
er
Field network expansion card type
s
re
0: Not connected
ts
1: PROFIBUS-DP unit
gh
ri
2: EtherNet/IP unit
ll
1. Review the value at R19974 (field network output data top register).
.A
2. Review the value at R19976 (field network input data top register).
N
Action
3. Review the value at the register R for high-speed data input/output.
O
TI
4. Review the value of parameter F150.
60
PO
Cause
R
o.
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
This message implies incorrect cable connection between CMT (cassette magnetic tape unit) or microdisk unit and the NC
IM
Action
M
3. Check for correct baud-rate setting. (Parameter for the NC unit: Baud rate)
YA
The machining program or another data that has been designated for the LOAD or COMPARE operation does not exist
Cause
)2
Carry out a DIRECTORY operation to check what type of data is stored on the cassette tape or floppy disk.
ht
Action
ig
yr
The cassette tape or floppy disk that has been registered for M640 series use does not contain a registered machining
Action program.
Perform checks using the M640 series NC unit.
3-108
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
534 CMT I/O ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue
A hardware error has occurred in the CMT or microdisk unit.
Cause
Check the CMT or microdisk unit baud rate setting (RS-232C setting parameter), and replace the cassette tape or floppy
Action disk.
d .
ve
(For cassette tape, fill in the hole on the tape surface with tape.)
er
536 POWER OFF DURING CMT OPERATION ( , , ) A L S Blue
s
re
Power has been turned off during operation of the CMT or microdisk unit.
Cause
ts
gh
Check the machining program being transferred. If an anomaly is found, repeat the desired operation. If this alarm state
ri
Action has occurred during loading of a machining program, erase the loaded portion of the program and then execute the loading
again.
ll
.A
537 CMT MALFUNCTION ( , , ) G L S Blue
N
Data cannot be read because of the presence of check sum errors, for example, within the cassette tape or floppy disk
O
Cause contents.
TI
60
A
Reread the data only after setting a new cassette tape or floppy disk or after saving the corresponding data.
Action
R
40
PO
29
Connection cables between the CC-LINK unit and each device are disconnected or broken.
N
Cause
C
al
K
ri
Check the data at registers SW0080 to SW0083 to identify the error station and check its cable connection.
ZA
Se
Action
A
IM
539 —— ( , , )
K
Cause ——
ZA
A
M
Action ——
YA
This message implies incorrect cable connection between tape reader or microdisk unit and the NC unit or implies a
01
Cause power-off state. In the case of microdisk unit, this message also implies incorrect setting of a floppy disk.
)2
(c
3. In the case of microdisk unit, check if the floppy disk is correctly set.
yr
This message implies incorrect cable connection between tape puncher or microdisk unit and the NC unit or implies a
C
Cause power-off state. In the case of microdisk unit, this message also implies incorrect setting of a floppy disk.
Provide the NC unit with a tape reader/puncher option. (Only with this option, tape I/O operations can be carried out.)
Action
3-109
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Call the DATA I/O display (TAPE) and designate a work number(s).
Action
.
Action
d
2. Check for differences in RS-232C parameter settings between the I/O unit and the NC unit.
ve
er
545 POWER OFF TAPE READ/PUNCH OPER. ( , , ) A L S Blue
s
Power has been turned off during operation of the tape reader/puncher or microdisk unit.
re
Cause
ts
gh
If power has been turned off during loading, check the machining program loaded. If an error(s) is found, delete the loaded
Action data and then reload the program. If power has been turned off during punching, re-punch the tape.
ri
ll
546 TAPE READER ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue
.A
A hardware error has occurred in the tape reader or the microdisk unit.
N
Cause
O
TI
Before operating the tape reader or microdisk unit, check that no differences in RS-232C parameter settings exist between
60
Action A
the tape reader or microdisk unit and the NC unit and replace the paper tape or floppy disk.
R
40
PO
29
A hardware error has occurred in the tape puncher or the microdisk unit.
o.
Cause
N
C
al
Before operating the tape puncher or microdisk unit, check that no differences in RS-232C parameter settings exist
ri
Action
ZA
between the tape puncher or microdisk unit and the NC unit and replace the paper tape or floppy disk.
Se
An attempt has been made to punch a MAZATROL program onto paper tape.
Cause
K
ZA
Action
(Only EIA/ISO programs can be punched on paper tape.)
M
YA
Cause
01
)2
Select another set of data or make a search once again from the beginning of the paper tape or floppy disk.
(c
Action
ht
The contents of the paper tape or floppy disk cannot be read since they include a parity-H error(s). (The
number of holes on tape must always be even for ISO; it must be odd for EIA).
C
Cause
Sprocket
Reading must be carried out only after replacing the paper tape or floppy disk or after re-punching the program.
Action
3-110
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
551 PARITY V ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
The contents of the paper tape or floppy disk cannot be read since they include a parity-V error(s).
E E E
O O O
Cause B B B
Make reading possible by making bit 1 of parity V-check valid/invalid parameter TAP25 invalid.
Action
. d
ve
A machining program in which EOR precedes the end M-code (M02, M30 or M99) or the next O number (work number)
was loaded.
er
Cause
s
The end-of-program condition can be changed by varying the settings of the parameter (TAP27).
re
Since the machining program has already been loaded, the PROGRAM display must be called and then one of the above
ts
Action three end M-codes must be inserted in the program.
gh
ri
553 WORK No. UNITS EXCEEDED ( , , ) B L S Blue
ll
An attempt has been made to load the program of a work number of more than four digits in spite of the fact that the
.A
Cause maximum allowable number of digits in one work number is set to four.
N
Check bit 3 of parameter TAP26.
O
Action
TI
60
PO
Cause
R
o.
O
N
Check the EIA/ISO program being converted. If an anomaly is found, erase the program and repeat the conversion.
C
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
555 —— ( , , )
Se
A
IM
Cause ——
K
ZA
Action ——
A
556 —— ( , , )
M
YA
Cause ——
3
01
Action ——
)2
(c
557 DESIGNATED DIRECTORY NOT FOUND ( , , ) B (A) I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ht
Cause
yr
op
( , , )
Cause
Action
3-111
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
564 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
.
d
ve
565 ID MIS-CONNECTED ( , , ) G L S Blue
er
Erroneous cable connection has occurred during connection of the ID unit and the NC unit, or power has remained turned
s
Cause off.
re
ts
Check for incorrect cable connections.
gh
Action
Or check if the power is turned on.
ri
566 POWER STOPPED DURING ID OPER. ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
Power has been turned off during the operation of the ID unit.
Cause
N
O
Check the current tool data, and if errors are found, operate the unit once again.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
Communication between the NC unit and the ID unit has become interrupted because of hardware trouble (such as line
R
Cause noise).
o.
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
An error occurred in bar loader communication with the IBS (intelligent bar loader system).
Note :
K
ZA
Cause 2: Writing of the material length and cut-off position does not complete.
YA
Press the RESET key and tap [SCHEDULE OPERAT.] on the BL SCHEDULE display again to highlight it.
Action
ht
ig
569 —— ( , , )
yr
op
Cause ——
C
Action ——
Provide the NC unit with a DNC option. (Only with this option, DNC operation can be carried out.)
Action
3-112
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
571 ILLEGAL FORMAT ( , , ) A L S Blue
Data other than that of the MATRIX system, Smart, or the Smooth system has been received from the host (the format of
Cause the message is incorrect).
Check whether the received data from the host is for the MATRIX system, Smart, or the Smooth system.
Action
d .
ve
573 CANNOT LOAD (TOO MANY PROGRAMS) (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
er
An attempt has been made to load more machining programs than the maximum number of programs that can be
s
Cause registered within the NC unit.
re
ts
Delete unnecessary programs, or save the programs onto an external storage and then delete them. After that, load the
gh
Action particular program.
ri
574 CANNOT LOAD (AUTO OPERATION) ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
An attempt has been made during automatic operation to load data other than machining program data.
Cause
N
O
Load such data only after completion of automatic operation.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
Loading has been attempted when the transmitted data from the host system does not match to the data or other
R
Cause parameter settings within the NC unit (mismatching in data size, etc.).
o.
O
N
Check if the data that has been transmitted from the host system is that which is to be used for the machine being used.
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
An attempt has been made to load the machining program that has the same work number as that of a machining program
Cause registered within the NC unit.
K
ZA
Check for an overlapping work number. This alarm message also implies that the parameter (DNC26, bit 2) is set for the
Action priority of the old program over a new one. If the parameter is set to 0, the old data will automatically be deleted in such a
A
case as mentioned above and the new program data can be loaded with the specified work number.
M
YA
Cause
The machining program that has been designated using a control command (work number search or program deletion)
)2
Check if the machining program with the specified work number exists in the NC unit.
ht
Action
ig
yr
An attempt has been made to load more machining programs than the maximum number of programs that can be
C
Delete unnecessary programs, or save the programs onto an external storage and then delete them. After that, load the
Action particular program.
3-113
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Cause ——
Action ——
581 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
ve
582 DESIGNATED FILE NOT TRANSFERED ( , , ) A L S Blue
er
A file different from the one that has been requested from NC unit to the host system was transferred from the latter.
s
Cause
re
ts
Check the details of the file that has been transferred from the host system.
gh
Action
ri
583 PROGRAM DATA TYPE INCORRECT ( , , ) A L S Blue
ll
.A
An attempt has been made to load a machining program that is different in structure from those stored within the NC unit.
Cause
N
O
Confirm that the program to be transferred from the host is for the MATRIX system, Smart, or the Smooth system.
TI
Action
60
Check if the contents of the file transfer message (header block) are correct.
A
R
40
An attempt has been made to load data other than machining program data and also different in structure from the data
R
Cause
N
The contents of the header block or data block in the file transfer message (including machining programs) are not
C
al
correct.
K
ri
ZA
Check if the data that has been transferred from the host system is for use with the Smooth system or for use with the
Se
Action
IM
Check the contents of the header block (version number, etc.) or data block (sequence number, etc.) in the file transfer
message.
K
This message implies incorrect cable connection between the host system and the NC unit or implies a power-off status.
A
Cause
M
YA
Action
01
There may be cases that although a DNC option is provided, DNC itself is not to be used for the time being and thus the
DNC cables are not yet connected. If this is the case, then set the appropriate parameter (DNC26, bit 1) to OFF (0). This
)2
Cause
yr
op
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center. (At this time, also please notify them of what kind of
C
Action operating procedure you had carried out before the alarm message appeared and what values were displayed in
parentheses.)
587 PROG. OPERATION NOT ALLOWED (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
1. An attempt has been made to transmit a display inhibiting program to the host system. (Program management
function)
Cause
2. An attempt has been made to transmit to the host system the program being edited (or the program being loaded using
another I/O unit).
1. Check if the specified work number is for the program of display inhibition.
Action 2. Carry out the transfer operation only after completion of the program editing (or program loading using another I/O
unit).
3-114
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
588 DATA OPERATION NOT ALLOWED ( , , ) A L S Blue
An attempt has been made during automatic operation to load data other than machining program data.
Cause An attempt has been made to transmit to the host system the data being loaded using another I/O unit.
An attempt has been made to load the data being saved using another I/O unit.
Wait until automatic operation has been completed (or until the loading or saving operation using another I/O unit has been
Action completed).
d .
The number displayed next to the work number is a line number, which corresponds to the number displayed in the lower
ve
right section of the PROGRAM display.
er
Correct the machining program. (Insert EOB within 256 characters.)
s
Action
re
ts
590 DNC COMMAND IMPOSSIBLE ( , , ) A L S Blue
gh
The particular status of the NC unit disables execution of the control command that has been requested from the host
ri
system.
ll
Cause A request for work number search has been made during automatic operation.
.A
During automatic operation, a request for deleting the machining program being used for the automatic operation has
N
been made.
O
Wait until the NC unit becomes ready for processing or until the automatic operation is completed, and then make the
TI
Action
60
An attempt has been made to load (save) the data not supported by the current option of the DNC unit.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
The control command or file transfer command that has been requested from the host system is a nonexistent
command.
K
Cause
The machine number that has been designated for the loading of data other than machining program data does not
ZA
Check the details of the command message that has been sent from the host system.
M
Action
Check if the machine number is the same as that registered within the NC unit (parameter DNC19).
YA
During use of DNC, processing has been aborted by line noise or other hardware factors.
)2
RS-232C communication parameter settings (such as those of the baud-rate, etc.) between the host system and NC
Cause
unit differ.
(c
Make line checks and hardware checks of the host system and NC unit.
yr
Match the RS-232C communication parameter settings between the host system and NC unit.
Action
op
Set the timer, number-of-retries, or other settings to those of the host system. (Parameters for the NC unit: DNC
C
parameters)
594 SEND-RECEIVE ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue
The preset number of retries has been exceeded during transmission/reception of command messages.
RS-232C communication parameter settings (such as those of the baud-rate, etc.) between the host system and NC
Cause
unit differ.
Timer, number-of-retries or other settings are not correct.
Make line checks and message checks of the host systems.
Match the RS-232C communication parameter settings between the host system and NC unit.
Action
Set the timer, number-of-retries or other settings to those of the host system. (Parameters for the NC unit: DNC
parameters)
3-115
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
Cause
ve
er
After making hardware checks of the NC and host systems and line checks, turn the NC unit power back on and then
s
Action restart the receiving operation.
re
ts
597 POWER OFF DURING DNC OPERATION ( , , ) A L S Blue
gh
Power has been turned off during DNC operation.
Cause
ri
ll
.A
Check for errors in the machining program being used, and if errors are found, carry out the DNC operation once again.
Action Note, however, that if the machining program is being loaded, then loading must be carried out once again after erasing the
N
loaded contents of the program.
O
TI
598 NO EIA/ISO OPTION ( , , ) A L S Blue
60
A
An attempt has been made to transfer EIA/ISO program although the NC unit is not provided with an EIA/ISO option.
R
40
Cause
PO
29
Action
o.
O
N
K
ri
The host system has issued a request for transmission/reception of data not existing within the NC unit.
ZA
Se
Cause A drum-tool data transfer request has been issued to the NC unit though it is not provided with a drum.
A
IM
A request for transfer of a larger volume of data than the control data stored within the NC unit has been made.
Check the contents of the command messages that have been sent from the host system.
K
Action
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-116
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
3-2-7 No. 600 - No. 699, No. 1600 - No. 1699 (MAZATROL program error)
Cause ——
Action ——
d.
Using data I/O operation, save the program data, tool data, tool file data, parameters, etc. that are currently being used.
ve
Action After that, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
s er
602 PROG. OPERATION NOT ALLOWED ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
re
An attempt has been made to start the program being transferred.
ts
Cause
gh
ri
After the transfer operation is completed, start the program.
Action
ll
.A
603 NO DESIGNATED PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
The program having the work number that has been set in the subprogram unit does not exist within the memory.
O
TI
Cause No work number has been set in the subprogram unit.
60
A
The work number that has been designated as the restart position does not exist within the memory.
R
40
Action
R
o.
604 NO PITCH IN MULTI WORKPIECES (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
Pitch X is not yet set in spite of the fact that multi-piece machining in the direction of the X-axis is to take place.
al
Cause
ri
ZA
Pitch Y is not yet set in spite of the fact that multi-piece machining in the direction of the Y-axis is to take place.
Se
Review the particular machining program and then set an appropriate multi-piece machining pitch in the common unit.
A
Action
IM
K
605 NO TOOL DATA IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA
The point-, line- or face-machining (including 3-D) unit does not contain any tool sequences.
Cause
A
M
Review the particular machining program to see if there are units that do not contain necessary tool sequences.
YA
Action
3
606 NO FIGURE IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
01
The point-, line- or face-machining (including 3-D) unit does not have any shape data.
)2
Cause
(c
ht
Review the particular machining program to see if there are units that do not contain necessary shape data.
Action
ig
yr
607 MISSING INPUT DATA (POINT) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op
Cause
Review the particular machining program, and set data if a point-machining unit lacks data.
Action
608 MISSING INPUT DATA (LINE) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A line-machining unit lacks data.
Cause
Review the particular machining program, and set data if a line-machining unit lacks data.
Action
3-117
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Review the particular machining program, and set data if a face-machining unit lacks data.
Action
610 MISSING TOOL DATA FOR POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A point-machining tool sequence lacks data.
Cause
Review the particular machining program, and set data if a point-machining tool sequence lacks data.
Action
.d
ve
611 MISSING TOOL DATA FOR LINE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
A line-machining tool sequence lacks data.
s
Cause
re
ts
Review the particular machining program, and set data if a line-machining tool sequence lacks data.
gh
Action
ri
612 MISSING TOOL DATA FOR FACE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
A face-machining (including 3-D) tool sequence lacks data.
Cause
N
O
Review the particular machining program, and set data if a face-machining tool sequence lacks data.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
613 DATA MISSING IN WPC UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
Cause
o.
O
N
Review the particular machining program, and set data if the WPC unit lacks data.
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
614 SUB PROGRAM NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
The maximum permissible number of repeats of MAZATROL program nesting has been exceeded nine.
Cause
K
ZA
Review and correct the particular machining program so that the total number of repeats of nesting does not excess nine.
Action
A
M
615 DATA MISSING IN OFFSET UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
Review the particular machining program, and set data if the offset unit lacks data.
)2
Action
(c
ht
616 DATA ERROR IN M CODE UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
Cause
op
Review the particular machining program, and input data to the M-code unit.
C
Action
617 EXECUTION IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The data processing operation cannot be performed because of contradiction in data. This condition occurs if an attempt is
Cause made to start automatic operation when the specified work number is an unregistered number.
Search out the contradictory data making reference to WNo., UNo., SNo. (which are displayed together with the alarm
Action message), and then correct the data.
3-118
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
618 POINT CUTTING PARAMETER ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The point-machining parameter setting(s) is out of its permissible range.
Cause
Action ——
619 LINE/FACE CUTTING PAR. ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The line- or face-machining parameter settings are out of their permissible ranges.
Cause
The parameter E13 is set to “0”; change it to a value other than “0”.
Action
d.
ve
620 CUTTING SPEED ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
Of tool sequence data (except for chip removal), the surface speed (C-SP) is unset or set to “0”.
s
Cause
re
ts
Review the machining program and set the desired surface speed (C-SP).
gh
Action
ri
621 FEEDRATE ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
Of tool sequence data (except for chip removal), the feedrate (FR) is unset or set to “0”.
Cause
N
O
Review the machining program and set the desired feedrate (FR).
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
The unit that has been designated as the restart position is not present in the program with the specified work number.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Review the machining program and designate the correct unit number.
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
The tool sequence that has been designated as the restart position is not present in the unit of the specified work number;
Cause two or more lines of tool sequence data are present in the line-machining chamfering unit.
K
ZA
Review the machining program and designate the correct tool sequence number.
Action
A
M
The unit that has been designated as the restart position is the end unit.
3
Cause The designated number of times of reappearance (L) is too large and the corresponding restart position is not present.
01
Action
ht
ig
625 ENDMILL DIAMETER EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr
The value of “(groove width) – (finish allowance R) × 2” of the endmill groove unit is smaller than the “tool diameter”
op
The “groove width” value of the endmill groove unit is smaller than the “tool diameter” value of the finishing tool.
Action ——
626 DESIGNATED TOOL NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The tool(s) specified in the program is not registered in the tool data.
Cause
Carry out a tool layout operation and register the necessary tool(s) on the TOOL DATA display.
Action
3-119
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Review the tool data and input the tool length or tool diameter.
Action
628 NO ASSIGNED TOOL IN TOOL FILE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The tool specified in the program is not registered on the TOOL FILE display.
Cause
Register the tool data that is to be used in the program into the tool file.
Action
d .
ve
629 TOOL FILE INPUT PROCESS ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The tool file lacks of data.
s
Cause
re
ts
Review the data on the TOOL FILE display and fill in any empty items with data.
gh
Action
ri
630 Z DEPTH OF CUT TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
Of the line- or face-machining tool sequence data, the value of the Z depth of cut is in excess of the depth of cut on the
Cause TOOL FILE display.
N
O
Review the machining program and correct the value of the Z depth of cut.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
631 STOCK REMOVAL R TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
The value of “(removal allowance R) – (finish allowance R)” in the line-machining unit is larger than the value of the tool
R
o.
The value of removal allowance R in the line-machining unit is larger than the value of the tool diameter of the finishing tool.
C
al
Review the machining program and correct the values of removal allowance R and finishing allowance R in the
ri
Action
ZA
line-machining unit.
Se
632 RADIAL DEPTH OF CUT ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM
Of line- or face-machining tool sequence data, the radial depth of cut is set to zero or smaller.
Cause
K
ZA
Review the machining program and set the radial depth of cut to the correct value.
A
Action
M
YA
633 Z DEPTH OF CUT ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Of line- or face-machining tool sequence data, the Z depth of cut is set to zero or smaller.
3
Cause
01
)2
Review the machining program and set the Z depth of cut to the correct value.
(c
Action
ht
634 FINISH DEPTH OF CUT ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
yr
The finish allowance value in the line- or face-machining unit is set to zero in spite of the fact that a finishing tool is
Cause
op
registered.
C
Review the machining program and set data in the finish allowance data item.
Action
635 TOOL DIAMETER ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Of tool data, the tool diameter setting is zero.
Cause
Review the data on the TOOL DATA display and set data in the tool diameter item.
Action
3-120
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
636 STOCK REMOVAL Z TOO SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the line- or face-machining unit, removal allowance Z is smaller than finish allowance Z.
Cause
Review the line- or face-machining unit and increase removal allowance Z to a value greater than that of finish allowance Z.
Action
637 STOCK REMOVAL R TOO SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the line- or face-machining unit, removal allowance R is smaller than finish allowance R.
Cause
Review the line- or face-machining unit and increase the value of removal allowance R to a value greater than that of finish
Action allowance R.
d.
ve
638 R DEPTH OF CUT TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
Of the face-machining tool sequence data, the setting of the radial depth of cut is smaller than the tool diameter setting on
s
Cause
re
the TOOL DATA display.
ts
Review the machining program and increase the radial depth of cut to a value greater than the tool diameter setting in the
gh
Action tool data.
ri
639 DESIGNATED PALLET NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
The pallet number that has been set in the pallet changing unit is larger than the maximum allowable number of pallets set
Cause in the parameter L46.
N
O
Review the machining program and set an allowable pallet number.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
640 ILLEGAL INDEX ANGLE INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
The data that has been set in the angle item of the indexing unit is that which cannot be divided by the parameter L37
R
Cause
o.
Action
ri
ZA
Se
641 MISSING INPUT DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
The pallet changing unit or the indexing unit lacks of unit data.
Initial point Z is not yet set in the common unit.
K
ZA
CPT-X, CPT-Z or rotational direction is not yet set in the mill-turning unit.
Cause
When "SHIFT - R.T" is set in the WPC shift unit with the machine equipped with table selection function, the rotational
A
M
Action
01
)2
642 ILLEGAL NEXT PALLET No. INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c
The same pallet number as the current pallet number has been set as the next one.
Cause
ht
ig
Review the machining program and make sure of the pallet numbers.
yr
Action
op
C
643 DATA ERROR IN MAN. PROG. UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The manual program mode unit contains a sequence that has no data.
Cause
Review the machining program, and fill in any incomplete sequence with data or erase such sequences.
Action
3-121
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Review the machining program, and set data in the nominal diameter item of the MMS unit or the manual program mode
Action unit (when a tool is set) or erase the corresponding portion.
645 PRIORITY No. OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The same priority number is assigned to different tools.
Cause
Within one process, the same priority number must not be assigned to different tools.
Action
Change the priority number.
d.
ve
(WNo., UNo., SNo.)*
646 ILLEGAL PRIORITY NUMBER B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
(LNo. 1, LNo. 2, )**
s
re
The priority numbering order within a unit is not correct.
ts
* During setting the priority numbers on the PROGRAM display.
Cause
gh
** During setting the priority numbers on the PROGRAM LAYOUT display - data in the layout lines LNo. 1 and LNo. 2 are
ri
not correct.
ll
The machining order within one unit has been reversed by the incorrect priority numbering.
.A
Action
Change the priority numbers.
N
647 END UNIT NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
O
TI
The end unit is not present in the program.
60
Cause A
R
40
PO
Review the machining program and set the end unit at the end of the program.
29
Action
R
o.
O
N
648 MULTI OFFSET DATA TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
C
al
More than 10 sets of offset data have been input for multi-piece machining.
K
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
The machining program is in an abnormal state. If the program is already saved onto cassette tape, floppy disk or other
IM
Action media, erase the program and then reload it. If the program is not yet saved, make corrections with the editing function and
fully scan for more data errors.
K
ZA
649 MEASURING SEQUENCE INCOMPLETE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The measurement sequence lacks of data.
A
Cause
M
YA
Review the machining program, and input data to the measurement sequence to make it complete.
Action
3
01
650 CHAMFERING IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2
Cutting is impossible because the chamfering cutter is likely to come into contact with the wall or bottom of the workpiece
(c
The data of the specified chamfering cutter on the TOOL DATA or TOOL FILE display is not appropriate.
ig
Review the machining program or the tool file, and correct inappropriate data.
yr
Action
op
C
651 GEAR PARAMETER ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An attempt has been made to execute the point-, line- or face-machining MAZATROL program when the setting of
Cause parameter SA51 was “5” or more.
3-122
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
652 GEAR SHIFT DATA ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The tool sequence data contains an unavailable milling spindle gear-shift M-code(s).
Cause
653 ILLEGAL TOOL DESIGNATED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Tools that cannot be used have been designated.
Cause
d.
ve
Review the machining program and designate tools that are usable.
er
Action
s
re
654 TOOL DATA ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ts
The tool length and tool diameter settings on the TOOL DATA display are negative.
gh
Cause
ri
ll
Set positive tool length and tool diameter values.
.A
Action
N
655 PROGRAM DATA CORRUPT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
O
TI
The program is destroyed.
60
Cause A
R
40
PO
Erase a part of the program and then re-create the destroyed part; or erase the entire program and then carry out a loading
29
O
N
656 MEASURING SEQ. DATA NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
C
al
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
Create one or more lines of sequence data in the corresponding measurement unit, or erase the unit.
IM
Action
K
657 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA
Cause
M
YA
658 INITIAL Z < MATERIAL DEPTH (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2
The setting of the material height in the 3-D machining unit is greater than that of initial point Z in the common unit.
Cause
(c
ht
Change the program to give a material height value smaller than the initial point Z value.
ig
Action
yr
op
The tool path check cannot be performed since I/O operation (loading) is in progress.
Cause
Make the tool path check after the I/O operation has been completed.
Action
Clear the Y-axis or Z-axis data of the index position by tapping the cancel key.
Action
3-123
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
M195 cannot be executed on MAZATROL programs. Delete that command code from the program.
Action
662 NO INCLINED PLANE OPTION (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An attempt has been made to execute the inclined-plane machining program in the absence of an inclined-plane machining
Cause option.
Inclined-plane machining is not possible because of the absence of an inclined-plane machining option.
Action
d.
ve
663 WRONG HEAD ANGLE (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
1. A corner-face unit or plane inclination measurement has been designated in unit data other than inclined-plane
s
machining unit data.
re
2. Table rotational machining has been designated in spite of the fact that the facial angle data in the face definition
ts
sequence is not for the top plane.
gh
3. Calibration measurement has been designated for the top plane or an inclined plane.
ri
4. Groove center, hole center, boss center, and step width measurements have been designated for an inclined plane.
ll
Cause
.A
5. Machining at the work hand side “↓Z” (B-axis at 90, approach in the Z-axis) has been specified for the direction of
the geometry sequence in coordinate measurement.
N
O
6. Machining at the work hand side “↓Z” (B-axis at 90, approach in the Z-axis) has been specified for the direction of
TI
the geometry sequence in workpiece measurement.
60
A
7. Measurement at the work hand side has been attempted with the parameter setting of L106 bit5 = 0 (B-axis
R
40
1. A corner-face unit and plane inclination measurement can be designated only for an inclined plane.
R
o.
2. Table rotational machining can be executed only for the top plane.
O
N
4. Only reference plane measurement and plane inclination measurement are possible for inclined planes.
ri
ZA
5. Change the direction setting of the geometry sequence in coordinate measurement to “↓X” (B-axis at 90, approach in
Se
Alternatively, select “↓X”, “←Z”, or “←X” for measurement with the B-axis at 0.
6. Change the direction setting of the geometry sequence in workpiece measurement to “↓X” (B-axis at 90, approach in
K
the X-axis).
ZA
Alternatively, select “↓X”, “←Z”, or “←X” for measurement with the B-axis at 0.
A
664 3-D UNIT NOT FOUND IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A 3-D machining unit has been set in the program in spite of the fact that 3-D machining option is not provided.
3
Cause
01
)2
665 ILLEGAL DATA IN 3-D UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
yr
Review the machining program and set necessary data in the 3-D machining unit.
Action
666 PLANE DATA NOT FOUND IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The 3-D machining unit lacks of plane definition data.
Cause
Review the machining program and set plane definition data in the 3-D machining unit.
Action
3-124
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
667 CHECK SURFACE DATA NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The 3-D machining unit lacks of check surface data.
Cause
Review the machining program and set check surface data in the 3-D machining unit.
Action
668 ILLEGAL PLANE DATA IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The plane definition data in the 3-D machining unit is not complete.
Cause
Review the machining program and set data in the plane definition data item.
Action
d.
ve
669 ILLEGAL TOLERANCE DATA INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The value of the tolerance parameter that has been designated in the tool sequence is “0”.
s
Cause
re
ts
Check the parameters E67 through E75, and set a value other than “0” in the parameter whose setting is “0”.
gh
Action
ri
670 ILLEGAL SEQUENCE DATA IN PRG. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
The tool sequence in the 3-D machining unit lacks of data.
Cause
N
O
Review the machining program and input data to the tool sequence.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
671 ILLEGAL MOVE SURFACE DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
The coordinate conversion data in the 3-D machining unit is not complete.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Review the machining program and make the coordinate conversion data complete.
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
672 ILLEGAL AREA DATA INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
In the check surface data of the 3-D machining unit, the setting of the maximum value is smaller than that of the minimum
Cause value.
K
ZA
Review the check surface data, and make corrections so that the setting of the maximum value is equal to or greater than
Action that of the minimum value for each axis.
A
M
673 FL NUMBER EXCEEDED (3-D UNIT) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
In the ruled-surface unit, the number of FLs is in excess of 20, or in the line- or face-machining unit, the number of defined
Cause
3
figures is in excess of 2.
01
)2
674 NO 5FACE CUTTING OPTION (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
An attempt has been made to execute a five-surface machining program when the five-surface machining option was not
yr
Cause present.
op
C
675 ILLEGAL CUTTING FACE DESIGNATED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
A face that cannot be cut with the selected head has been designated.
Cause
3-125
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d .
machining at the work hand side.
ve
6. Workpiece measurement has been executed with the work hand at 0 other than in the workpiece transfer unit.
er
7. An attempt was made to execute an engraving unit on a machine that does not feature the engraving function option.
s
re
1. Remove all illegal units and sequences from the machining program.
ts
2. MMS measurement is not possible while table rotational machining is effective.
gh
3. The mill-turning unit cannot be executed without a mill-turning option.
ri
4. With the machine not equipped with table selection function, correct the program into a program without table selection
ll
Action unit. With the machine equipped with table selection function, make table selection valid (parameter D106 bit 4 = 1)
.A
and check the program and tool path before starting machining.
N
5. Delete the C-axis machining unit and turning unit at the work hand side.
O
TI
6. Set the work hand angle to 0 in the workpiece transfer unit.
60
A
7. No engraving unit can be executed since the engraving function option is not featured.
R
40
677 UNREGISTERED HEAD DATA (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
Head data corresponding to the head of the designated head number does not exist.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
In the line- or face-machining unit, the coordinates of the intersection point of figures cannot be obtained because of
Cause shortage of, or contradiction, in the free-shape data.
K
ZA
Action ——
A
M
679 CONNECTING CORNER IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
The figures cannot be connected smoothly at corner R because of contradiction in the data of corner R or in the data of the
Cause
3
Review the machining program and check the value of corner R of the free shapes.
Action
(c
ht
680 NUMBER OF HOLES EXCEEDED (>500) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
The point-machining units include one(s) that has more than 500 holes defined in it.
yr
Cause
op
Review the point-machining units, and make corrections so that the total number of hole settings in one point-machining
C
681 CORNER R/C DEFINED AT SPT/FPT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Corner rounding or corner chamfering has been set at the starting or ending point of a figure when defining figures in the
Cause central linear machining, right-hand linear machining, left-hand linear machining, right-hand chamfering or left-hand
chamfering units.
Review the machining program and correct it so that the corner rounding or corner chamfering is not set at the starting or
Action ending point.
3-126
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
682 ILLEGAL REPEAT FIGURE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Contradiction presides in the figure rotation or figure shift data that has been set during defining free figures in the line- or
Cause face-machining unit.
683 UNDEFINED CORNER (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The specified size of corner rounding or chamfering is inadmissible.
Example :
This alarm does not occur in general unless the specified size of rounding or chamfering exceeds the length of one of the
two sides of the corner concerned. As for a rectangular line- or face-machining shape described with the aid of
.
[SQUARE], in particular, the size in question for corners CN1 (starting point) and CN4 (ending point) must not exceed
d
ve
half the length of the side between them since the cutting start position will be set in actual machining to the mid-point of
er
that side.
s
Specified
re
Starting point
Cause chamfering size
Cutting start position
ts
Ending point CN1
gh
CN4
ri
Sides of the corner
ll
to be rounded or
.A
chamfered
N
O
CN3 CN2
TI
60
A
Check the shape sequence data in question to correct the size of corner rounding or chamfering.
R
40
Action
PO
In the above-mentioned particular case of rectangular shape, use [ARBITRY], instead of [SQUARE], to describe the
29
684 POINT CUTTING PATTERN ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
Action
IM
685 SQUARE CANNOT BE DEFINED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ZA
When the shape pattern is “square”, the input data cannot be used to make shape definitions.
Cause
A
M
Action
3
686 NO STARTING POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
01
During input of free-shape data (open-figure data) to the line-machining unit, “?” has been set as the definition of the
)2
Review the machining program and set the coordinates of the starting point of the free shape.
Action
ig
yr
687 NO FINISH POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op
During input of free-shape data (open-figure data) to the line-machining unit, “?” has been set as the definition of the ending
C
Cause point.
Review the machining program and set the coordinates of the ending point of the free shape.
Action
688 INSUFFICIENT INPUT DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The coordinates of the intersection point cannot be calculated since the free-shape input data in the line- or face-machining
Cause unit is incomplete.
Review the corresponding shape data and set data that is wanting.
Action
3-127
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
690 ILLEGAL RADIUS (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Contradiction exists in the free-shape data that have been set to define arc in the line- or face-machining units.
Cause
.
Action
d
ve
er
691 MOUNT (VALLEY) SHAPE ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
s
The second figures (inside figures) are not yet defined in the endmilling-mountain (STEP), pocket milling-mountain or
re
Cause pocket milling-valley unit.
ts
gh
Review the machining program, and define the second shape in the endmilling-mountain (STEP), pocket milling-mountain
Action or pocket milling-valley unit.
ri
ll
692 MAX POINT NUMBER EXCEEDED (>200) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
.A
The number of points which are necessary to define the shapes designated in the line- or face-machining unit exceeds 200.
N
Cause
O
TI
Review the machining program, and reduce the number of shapes within one line- or face-machining unit.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
29
693 NUMBER OF SHAPES TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R
Among the line- or face-machining units is one(s) that contains more shapes than allowable within one unit.
o.
Cause
N
C
al
Review the corresponding shape data and check the number of shapes.
ri
ZA
Action
Se
694 FIXED FIGURE DESIGNATED ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM
Fixed shapes are included in the shape data (open figures) of the central linear machining, right-hand linear machining,
K
Cause left-hand linear machining, right-hand chamfering, left-hand chamfering or endmilling-groove units.
ZA
Action
M
YA
695 POINT INSIDE CIRCLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3
It is not possible to draw a tangent line from point P1 since it is inside the arc.
01
Cause
)2
Action
ht
ig
696 ILLEGAL DIRECTION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr
“Left” or “right” is set for the crossing point (P), though “up” or “down” should have been set.
op
Cause
C
Review the machining program and check the value of the crossing point (P).
Action
697 DATUM <P> REQUIRED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The crossing point (P) is not yet input in spite of the fact that there are more than two points of intersection with the arc.
Cause
Review the machining program and set the crossing point (P).
Action
3-128
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
698 TWO POINTS OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The coordinate values of the start point and end point are the same.
Cause
For the pattern of straight line, the data of X/Y are set to exactly the same end point coordinate values as X/Y present on
Action the preceding line of the program; delete these data.
699 PARALLEL LINE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The two straight lines are parallel to each other, and thus the coordinates of their intersection point cannot be obtained.
Cause
d.
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
60
A
R
40
PO
29
R
o.
O
N
C
al
K
ri
ZA
Se
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-129
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
ATC mode ID number 5 can be set only in subprograms. Set ATC mode ID number 0 to 4 in the main program.
Action
1602 SET INDEX UNIT BEFORE MACHINING (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The position of W-axis is not specified in the index unit preceding the machining unit.
Cause
Review the machining program and set the position of the W-axis in the index unit.
Action
d.
ve
1603 PROGRAM IS NOT WPC. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The main MAZATROL program of the initial-point scheme has been executed under the setting of the machine model with
s
Cause
re
MAZATROL-based control of the lower turret.
ts
Re-create the main MAZATROL program into a program of the workpiece scheme.
gh
Action
ri
1604 ILLEGAL TOOL DIRECTION (INDEX B) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
There is a mismatch in workpiece scheme data settings between the machining direction for index unit POS-B and the
Cause machining direction for the machining section of the lower-turret milling tool.
N
O
Insert an index unit in front of the desired milling unit. Next, set the value to POS-B appropriate for the lower-turret milling
TI
60
Action tool machining section, or select the appropriate lower-turret milling tool according to the particular machining direction for
POS-B of the index unit.
A
R
40
PO
1605 LOW TUR CANNOT EXECUTE MIRROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
29
Either lower-turret turning unit, the measuring unit, the manual program mode unit, or subprogram EIA call has been
o.
Cause
O
executed with MIRROR of the WPC shift unit made valid in a program of the workpiece scheme.
N
C
al
Insert the WPC shift unit in front of the desired unit and then make MIRROR invalid.
K
Action
ri
ZA
Se
1606 ILLEGAL CUTTING ANGLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM
Action
Change the B-axis machining angle.
M
YA
Cause
01
1608 NEED SELECT TABLE UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
yr
When table selection is valid (parameter D106 bit 4 = 1), no table selection unit is set before the WPC, WPC shift or
Cause
op
indexing unit.
C
Set a table selection unit before the WPC, WPC shift or indexing unit.
Action
1609 CANNOT SET WPC IN 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A basic coordinates sytem unit (WPC) is set in the program section for the two-workpiece machining sequence.
Cause
3-130
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1610 SET INDEX UNIT IN 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Machining units in the two-workpiece machining section are not preceded by an index unit.
Cause
1611 SET INDEX UNIT AFTER 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Machining units after the two-workpiece machining section are not preceded by an index unit.
Cause
.
d
ve
1612 SET HEAD UNIT AFTER 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
Machining units after the two-workpiece machining section are not preceded by a head selection unit.
s
Cause
re
ts
Set a head selection unit.
gh
Action
ri
1613 SET HEAD UNIT IN 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
Machining units in the two-workpiece machining section are not preceded by a head selection unit.
Cause
N
O
Set a head selection unit.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
1614 NO TABLE ROTATION AXIS (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
Index unit is set while NO USE is selected for ROT. AXIS in table selection unit on the machine not equipped with spindle
R
Cause
o.
Action
ri
ZA
Se
1615 TABLE ROTATION CENTER NOT AGREE (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
The ROT.CENTER setting in the table selection unit does not match the TABLE-CT. setting in the FRM unit.
Cause
K
ZA
Review either the ROT.CENTER setting in the table selection unit or the TABLE-CT. setting in the FRM unit.
Action
A
M
1616 CYLINDER CHAMFERING N/A (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program although the smooth chamfering function is not provided.
Cause
3
01
The smooth chamfering program cannot be executed because the smooth chamfering function is not provided.
)2
Action
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-131
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
. d
slot unit or point machining unit.
ve
er
1. Delete the smooth chamfering program.
s
2. Set an index unit before the machining unit that includes smooth chamfering and set angle B to +90°.
re
3. Set the machining face to the cylindrical surface in the C-axis point machining unit.
ts
Action
4. Set HOLE-DEP in the chamfering tool sequence to 0.
gh
5. Input the correct cylinder radius value in the end milling slot unit.
ri
6. Input the correct value for CHMF.
ll
.A
1618 —— ( , , )
N
O
Cause ——
TI
60
Action ——
A
R
40
PO
29
1619 ILLEGAL APPROACH SCHEME (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R
o.
In the selection of the approach scheme for INTELLIGENT POCKET MILLING (IPM), “TAPER” or “PECKING” was
O
Cause
N
selected.
C
al
ZA
Action
Se
( , , )
IM
Cause
K
ZA
Action
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-132
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
3-2-8 No. 700 - No. 799, No. 1700 - No. 1799 (MAZATROL program error)
Cause ——
Action ——
d .
ve
Change the shape compensation clearance (parameter E13) to an appropriate value: or use a tool of smaller diameter.
Action
ser
re
702 FIGURE DEFINITION ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K O Blue
ts
1. The input shape is contradictory to logic, that is, the radius of the arc, for example, does not agree with the distance
from the center.
gh
Cause
2. An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program when CHMF in the end milling slot unit is set to other
ri
than 0, when an arc is specified or when the shape sequence is specified in three or more lines.
ll
.A
1. Such contradiction usually results from arithmetic errors. Change the radial depth of cut by some micro, or use a tool of
smaller diameter.
N
Action
O
2. When executing the smooth chamfering program, set a linear shape, whose angle formed with the X-axis is 0 degrees,
TI
in two lines (start point line and end point line).
60
PO
The machining conditions are incorrect (for example, the radial depth of cut is zero).
29
Cause
R
o.
Action
al
K
ri
ZA
In area machining, the tool diameter with respect to the figure is too large.
Cause
IM
K
Replace the tool with one that has a smaller diameter; or select the M2 mode endmilling-mountain (STEP) machining
Action
ZA
pattern with setting bit 7 of parameter E91 if this error occurs in the outside machining endmilling-mountain (STEP).
A
1. Reduce the tool diameter, the approach amount (parameters E1, E2) and/or the overlap amount (parameter E21).
Action
)2
The shape has been separated into three segments or more as a result of offsetting.
ig
The inside form does not contain the center of the outside form for outside-related fixed path.
yr
Cause
The outside form is concave for inside-related fixed path.
op
Change the machining pattern (from inversed type to fixed type, for example); or divide the machining shape in advance so
Action that it will not be separated by offsetting.
3-133
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Divide the block so that one block contains 248 characters or less.
Action
Change the radial depth of cut in the tool sequence by some micro.
Action
d.
ve
710 CORNER ROUNDING CUTTER DIA ERR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B L S Blue
er
The programmed amount of round chamfering differs from the following:
s
Cause
re
(NOM- – MIN-)/2.
where NOM- and MIN- are the setting values of the selected tool on the TOOL FILE display.
ts
Select a tool appropriate to the chamfering amount.
gh
Action
ri
ll
711 UNIT DATA NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
.A
Unset unit data exists for the unit you have made an attempt to execute.
N
Cause
O
TI
Set all data.
60
Action A
R
40
PO
712 ILLEGAL UNIT DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
29
Sequence data for the unit you have made an attempt to execute does not match to the unit data.
o.
Cause
O
N
C
al
Delete the sequence data, and then set correct sequence data.
K
Action
ri
ZA
Se
713 SEQUENCE DATA NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM
1. No sequence data exists for the unit you have made an attempt to execute.
Cause
K
2. The machine was operated or a tool path check was performed with “DEP-1” or “FR” set to “?”.
ZA
Action 2. Set a numeric value for “DEP-1” and “FR”. Or, press the [AUTO SET] menu key after checking that all setting items in
M
714 ILLEGAL SEQUENCE DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3
Data out of the allowable setting range exists in the sequence data of the unit you have made an attempt to execute.
01
Cause
)2
Action
ht
ig
715 ILLEGAL CUTTING POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr
The specified infeed point is outside the profile of the workpiece (approximate workpiece shape designated by common
op
Cause unit).
C
716 ILLEGAL CUTTING START POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The relative position of the starting or ending point specified by the sequence data with respect to the specified infeed point
Cause is not appropriate.
Change the position of the starting or ending point of the sequence data, or change the position of the infeed point.
Action
3-134
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
717 SHAPE EXCEEDS MATERIAL SIZE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The starting or ending point is outside the profile of the workpiece (approximate workpiece shape specified by common
Cause unit).
718 CUTTING DIRECTION NOT DEFINED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The direction of machining (forward/backward) cannot be determined using the specified infeed point and sequence data.
Cause
. d
ve
719 REVERSE SHAPE CONTOUR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
Part of the defined shape is opposite in direction of machining with respect to the reference axis movement direction.
s
Cause
re
ts
Correct the position of the starting or ending point.
gh
Action
ri
720 DOUBLE SHAPE CONTOUR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
The defined workpiece shape has overlaps.
Cause
N
O
Correct the position of the starting or ending point.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
721 ILLEGAL RADIUS (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
Cause That is, the relationship between the starting point, ending point, and radius of the arc is incorrect.
O
N
Correct the starting-point data, ending-point data, or radius data of the arc.
ri
ZA
Action
Se
A
IM
722 ILLEGAL CORNER DEFINITION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
There are the following errors related to the designated corner C data:
K
Cause The arc length of the block present before or after corner C is smaller than that of corner C.
A
<T. GROOV>
M
Correct either the length of corner C or the sequence data set before or after corner C.
Action
3
01
Action
op
724 EXCEEDS NUMBER OF VALLEY SHAPES (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
C
3-135
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
726 ILLEGAL COMMON DATA (AXIAL) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
LENGTH, WORK FACE and FIN-LENGTH do not satisfy the following condition:
Cause
LENGTH WORK FACE + FIN-LENGTH > 0
Set correct data to LENGTH, WORK FACE and FIN-LENGTH.
Action
. d
ve
727 MATERIAL SHAPE CROSSING (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
There is a data overlap between the inside diameter side (IN) and outside diameter side (OUT) of the workpiece shape
s
Cause
re
which has been designated in the MATERIAL unit.
ts
Change the IN or OUT shape data.
gh
Action
ri
728 EXCESSIVE FINISH ALLOWANCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
The area to be rough-cut does not exist since the designated finishing allowance is larger than the shape defined by the
Cause sequence data.
N
O
Either change the finishing allowance or cancel rough-cutting.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
729 ILLEGAL SHAPE DESIGNATED (CNR) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
In the CORNER unit data, the relationship between the starting point and the ending point is wrong.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
730 ILLEGAL SHAPE DESIGNATED (EDG) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
In the FACING unit data, the relationship between the starting point and the ending point is wrong.
Cause
K
ZA
731 ILLEGAL NUM. OF PATHS (THR) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
The designated number of cutting times for #0, #3 thread type is less than 3.
Cause
3
01
)2
Change the number of cutting times to 3 or more, or change the thread type.
Action
(c
ht
732 ACCELERATION DISTANCE EXCEED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
Cause
op
C
Change the related parameter setting value or reduce the surface speed to its minimum permissible value.
Action
733 ILLEGAL SHAPE DESIGNATED (GRV) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the T. GROOV unit data, the relationship between the starting point and the ending point is wrong.
Cause
3-136
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
734 ILLEGAL SHAPE EXCEEDS MTRL SIZE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
For machining of multiple grooves, the second and subsequent grooves are outside the workpiece profile defined by
Cause common unit.
735 ILLEGAL DESIGNATED TL WID (GRV) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The designated tool width does not match to the groove shape specified in the T. GROOV unit.
Cause
Designate some other tool, or correct the width of the designated tool.
Action
d .
ve
736 ILLEGAL OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The parameter-set amount of grooving overlap is larger than the width or diameter of the designated tool.
s
Cause
re
ts
Either designate some other tool, correct the width or diameter of the designated tool, or change the parameter setting
gh
Action (TC75).
ri
737 ILLEGAL DRILLING DIRECTION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
In the T-DRILL or T-TAP unit data, the relationship between the starting point and the ending point is wrong.
Cause
N
O
Set the correct data to SPT-Z and FPT-Z.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
738 CORNER (R/C) DESIGNATED OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
In the unit (BAR, CPY, etc.), different types of corners (R and C) have been designated for portions that are identical in
R
Cause
o.
shape.
O
N
Check the designated corner portions and delete one of the corners.
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
739 ILLEGAL FINISHING ALLOWANCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
In the #0, #0 type of THREAD unit data, the following condition exists:
K
Cause
A
Calculated from the height (HGT) and the number of times (NUMBER) in unit data.
M
740 ILLEGAL ANGLE IN FIRST SEQUENCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c
The relationship between the thread shape and threading angle that are defined by the first sequence data of the THREAD
Cause unit is incorrect.
ht
ig
Change the threading angle, or change the coordinates of the starting or ending point of the first sequence.
yr
Action
op
C
741 ILLEGAL THREAD ANGLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the machining type that requires the designation of a threading angle, the following condition is not satisfied.
Cause
(Tool tip angle) (Threading angle)
Change either the threading angle or the data of the tool to be used.
Action
3-137
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
743 INTERSECTION NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
No automatic calculations of intersection were obtained since there are shape sequence data disparities.
.
Cause
d
ve
er
Correct the shape sequence data.
Action
s
re
744 DATA MISSING (INTERSECTION) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ts
gh
No automatic calculations of intersection were obtained since there are lack of data to automatically calculate a point of
Cause intersection.
ri
ll
Correct the unit data or the sequence data.
.A
Action
N
O
745 INTERSECTION CALCULATE IMPOSS. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
TI
No automatic calculations of intersection were obtained since there are illegal data in the program.
60
Cause A
R
40
PO
29
O
N
746 NO DEPTH OF CUT INFO. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
al
A cutting depth cannot be determined for the tool since the DEPTH or CUT ANGLE data item on the TOOL DATA display
ri
ZA
Action
K
747 CHIP BREAKING CYCLE N/A (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA
Executing the chip-cutting cycle program has been attempted in spite of the chip-cutting cycle option being absent.
A
Cause
M
The chip-cutting cycle option must be present before the chip-cutting cycle program can be executed.
Action
(Assign either 0, 1, or 2 to PAT. in the roughing tool sequence.)
3
01
748 CANNOT MAKE T-PATH (CHK DEPTH) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2
1. A normal path cannot be created since the cutting area is wider than twice the depth of cut per pass.
(c
2. When the cutting area is equal to the clearance, a normal path cannot be created since the cutting area is wider than
ht
3. A normal path cannot be created since the cutting area overlaps the deceleration distance and is wider than the depth
yr
1. Increase the cutting depth to be set in the tool sequence, or narrow down the cutting area.
C
2. Increase the cutting depth to be set in the tool sequence, or reduce the clearance.
Action
3. Two overlapping areas must not be present. Narrow down PRE-DIA (deceleration distance) to be set in the tool
sequence, or narrow down the cutting area, or increase the cutting depth to be set in the tool sequence.
749 CANNOT DRAW FIGURE ( , , ) A L S Blue
1. Shape drawing of the program set with workpiece placement error correction was attempted on the TRACE display.
Cause 2. Shape drawing of a main program that does not contain turning operation but calls a subprogram containing turning
operation was attempted on a VARIAXIS machine featuring the turning function.
Action ——
3-138
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
750 ——
Cause ——
Action ——
751 CURVE DEFINITION ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Blue
A curved surface that cannot be machined has been defined.
Cause
No corrective actions can be taken against this error; define a curved surface that can be machined.
Action
d.
ve
752 DESIGNATED AREA DATA IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Blue
er
The check surface values are incorrect.
s
re
1. For rough-machining 1 or 2: Check surface Z min. material height
Cause
ts
2. For finishing: Check surface Z min. initial Z
gh
3. Check surface X min. X max., or Y min. Y max., or Z min. Z max.
ri
Set the check surface values as follows:
ll
1. For rough-machining 1 or 2: Check surface Z min. material height
.A
Action
2. For finishing: Check surface Z min. initial Z
N
3. Check surface X min. X max., and Y min. Y max., and Z min. Z max.
O
TI
753 SMALL TOOL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Blue
60
A
In rough-machining 2, the tool diameter is extremely small in comparison with the dimensions of the defined 3-D figure.
R
40
Cause
PO
29
Use tools whose diameters are no less than 1/100 of the distance between the maximum and minimum dimensions of the
R
o.
Action
O
3-D figure.
N
C
al
754 LARGE TOOL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ri
ZA
Cause
A
IM
Set the approach path and the tool size so that the interference does not occur.
Action
K
ZA
755 R DIRECTION PITCH SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
In rough-machining 2, the pitch in the radial direction is extremely small in comparison with the dimensions of the defined
M
Set the radial-direction pitch to a value no less than 1/200 of the distance between the maximum and minimum dimensions
3
756 Z DIRECTION PITCH SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c
In rough-machining 2, the pitch in the Z direction is extremely small in comparison with the dimensions of the defined 3-D
ht
Cause figure.
ig
yr
Set the Z-direction pitch to a value no less than 1/250 of (material height – height of the Z bottom of the 3-D figure).
Action
op
C
757 CURVE DEFINITION LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. For rough-machining 2 with designation of workpiece size, the dimensions of the defined figure are larger than those of
the workpiece.
Cause 2. For rough-machining 2, a material height smaller than “(height of the Z bottom of the 3-D figure) + (height of a
machining area outside the figure)” [parameters E84, E89] has been set irrespective of designating the offset amount
or the workpiece size.
Change the E84 and E89 parameter settings so that: for the offset amount designation, “(height of the bottom of the 3-D
Action figure) + E84 < material height”, and; for the workpiece size designation, “(height of the bottom of the 3-D figure) + E89 <
material height”.
3-139
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
759 WPC UNIT NOT FOUND (MILL & TURN) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The workpiece shape cannot be defined since, in a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC setting, no
Cause WPC unit is prepared before machining units.
Create a WPC unit before the machining units and then enter the correct data.
Action
.
d
ve
760 NO T. CENTER POINT IN WPC UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
1. In a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC setting, the workpiece origin specified in the WPC unit
s
re
Cause which precedes C-axis point/line machining or turning units does not correspond to the axis of turning.
2. Additional basic coordinate system or work offset value is set in the WPC unit preceded by the common unit.
ts
gh
1. Before creating C-axis machining or turning unit, create a WPC unit with reference to the axis of turning.
Action
ri
2. Instead of additional basic coordinate system or work offset value, specify T. CENTER to set the WPC-zero point to the
turning center in the WPC unit preceded by the common unit.
ll
.A
761 HEAD ANGLE INCORRECT (C-AXIS) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
In a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC setting, the machining section specified in a C-axis point/line
O
Cause machining or turning unit does not correspond to the B-axis angle specified in an index unit.
TI
60
A
Before creating C-axis machining or turning unit, create an index unit to specify the B-axis angle appropriate for the section
R
40
Action to be machined.
PO
29
762 PROGRAM IS NOT MILL & TURN TYPE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R
o.
It was attempted to set a turning or C-axis point/line machining unit in a program of initial-point scheme (ONLY MILL).
N
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
Delete the turning or C-axis point/line machining unit, or set it in a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC
Se
Action setting.
A
IM
763 START PROCESS ILLEGAL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
It was attempted to execute restart operation from, or single-process operation of, an unsuitable unit.
Cause
ZA
A
Action
YA
764 MAIN PRG/SUB PRG TYPE MISMATCH (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3
01
There are programming units of workpiece scheme with WPC setting and of the same scheme with Z-offset setting
Cause prepared in one and the same program.
)2
(c
765 Z-OFFSET NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr
op
The indispensable Z-offset is not yet set for a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with Z-offset setting.
Cause
C
766 MAXIMUM NO.OF LAYOUTS EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
It was attempted to run a program which contains a process with more than 4000 layout data items.
Cause The number of repetitions exceeds 9999990 for a program (CONTI. = 1 in the END unit) without workpiece transfer unit.
Reduce the number of layout data items for one process to no larger than 4000.
Action Modify the program to reduce the number of repetitions to no larger than 9999990.
3-140
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
767 ILLEGAL ESCAPE TOOL No. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The setting in the parameter for the retraction tool is not correct.
Cause
768 4 AXIS MACHINING PROGRAM ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The setting for simultaneous machining is not correct.
Cause (Example : Only the upper or the lower turret is specified for simultaneous machining.)
Review the program and perform corrections as required (e. g. to change the turret to be used for the particular tool
Action sequence of the unit concerned).
.d
ve
769 ILLEGAL TOOL DIRECTION/SPDL ROT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The specification of the direction of turning spindle rotation differs between those tools on the upper and lower turrets which
s
Cause
re
are to be used for simultaneous machining.
ts
Select another tool, or change the specification in question, on either side for the same direction of turning spindle rotation
gh
Action as for the other tool.
ri
770 FIN LEN ERROR (CHECK COM UNIT) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
For the execution of a composite program: The settings in the common unit do not satisfy the following condition:
Cause FIN-LENGTH LENGTH – WORK FACE.
N
O
Reduce the FIN-LENGTH setting to satisfy the above condition.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
771 ILLEGAL LOW TUR COMMON UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
A unit of machining with the lower turret (or including a command for its retraction) is created within a program whose
R
Cause
o.
common unit declares (under LOW TURR) that the lower turret is “not used”.
O
N
Change over the LOW TURR setting, or modify the machining unit concerned in the turret selection.
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
772 NO HEAD UNIT IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
1. For the execution of a composite program: Machining units are not preceded by a head selection unit (HEAD).
Cause
2. For the execution of a composite program: The workpiece transfer unit (TRANSFER) is not followed by a HEAD unit.
K
ZA
1. Set a HEAD unit to specify the turning spindle to be used for the succeeding machining units.
Action
A
2. Set a HEAD unit after the TRANSFER unit to specify the turning spindle to be used for the succeeding machining units.
M
773 TRANSFER UNIT IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
For the execution of an independent program: A workpiece transfer unit (TRANSFER) is erroneously set in a program to be
Cause
3
774 HEAD UNIT IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
For the execution of an independent program: A head selection unit (HEAD) is erroneously set in a program to be run
yr
775 TOOL CANNOT PERFORM FACING (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
For tool selection on a turret-type tool-post: The section to be machined by the selected tool differs from the corresponding
Cause setting in the unit data line.
Change the setting in the unit data line with respect to the tool, or select another tool as required.
Action
3-141
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Delete the inappropriate machining unit from the program, or describe the particular machining process without using the
Action Y-axis control.
777 INCORRECT POSIT. CANNOT RESTART (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The restarting function has been started from the balanced-cutting with the lower turret.
Cause
Specify the upper turret to execute the restarting function from balanced cutting.
Action
. d
ve
778 INCORRECT POSIT. CANNOT START (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The single-process function has been applied to the balanced-cutting with the lower turret.
s
Cause
re
ts
Specify the upper turret to execute the single-process function for balanced cutting.
gh
Action
ri
779 —— ( , , )
ll
.A
Cause ——
N
O
TI
Action ——
60
A
R
40
780 APPROACH PATH INTERFERENCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
The programmed shape of the approach path and/or retraction path interferes with the workpiece (programmed machining
R
Cause
o.
Reduce the amount of approach and/or the amount of overlap or the tool diameter.
al
Action
Or specify another position as the approach point.
ri
ZA
Se
781 DBL SPDL OPER ILLEGAL TUR ASIGN (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
In a 2 WORKPC unit the selection of the turret in the tool sequence does not correspond to the selection of the spindle
Cause (SP1 or SP2) in the unit data line.
K
ZA
782 DBL SPDL OPER NO TRANS UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
783 DBL SPDL OP ILLEGAL SIMUL OP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
Cause
op
C
784 DBL SPDL OP ILLEGAL BALANCE CUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
There is an instruction of balanced cutting given in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.
Cause
3-142
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
785 DBL SPDL OPER ILLEGAL TUR ESC (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
There is an instruction of retraction given in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.
Cause
786 DBL SPDL OP ILLEGAL MEASUREMENT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
There is a measurement unit inserted in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.
Cause
Temporarily cancel the mode of “2 Workpiece” machining to execute the required in-process measurement.
Action
.d
ve
787 DBL SPDL OPER ILLEGAL TRANSFER (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
There is a workpiece transfer unit inserted in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.
s
Cause
re
ts
Temporarily cancel the mode of “2 Workpiece” machining to execute the required workpiece transfer.
gh
Action
ri
788 DBL SPDL OPER ILLEGAL HEAD UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
The head selection unit in the mode of “2 Workpiece” machining has another setting than SINGLE under TYPE.
Cause
N
O
Temporarily cancel the mode of “2 Workpiece” machining to execute synchronous rotation of both spindles (by selecting
TI
Action
60
SYNCH.). A
R
40
789 DBL SPDL OPER UNIT ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
1. For a flow of “2 Workpiece” machining an end instruction is given before the start instruction.
R
o.
2. For a flow of “2 Workpiece” machining a restart instruction is given before the end instruction.
O
Cause
N
3. In a flow of “2 Workpiece” machining, only one spindle is specified in the head selection unit and machining instruction
al
ZA
3. Review the program for “2 Workpiece” machining. In a “2 Workpiece” machining unit, be sure to set two head selection
units so that machining is performed with two spindles.
K
ZA
790 ILLEGAL BALANCE CUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
Cause 2. Tools different in shape (nose angle, infeed angle and nose R) are designated for the upper and lower turret in
YA
balanced cutting.
1. Add another tool sequence line to use the other turret symmetrically for balanced cutting.
3
01
Action 2. Specify tools identical in shape (nose angle, infeed angle and nose R) for the upper and lower turret in balanced
)2
cutting.
(c
791 MUST INPUT CUTTING SPEED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ht
The surface speed data set in the tool sequence contains an invalid value.
Cause
ig
yr
Action
C
792 MUST INPUT FEEDRATE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The feed data set in the tool sequence contains an invalid value.
Cause
3-143
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
. d
2. Set the milling spindle speed to a value lower than its maximum spindle speed.
Action
ve
3. Reduce the spindle speed for the turning spindle.
er
4. Reduce the spindle speed for the turning spindle.
s
re
794 INCORRECT B AXIS POSITION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ts
For ATC (BA47 = 0) turret type machines with B-axis (BA48 = B), the direction of “part to be machined” set with the turning
gh
Cause drilling unit does not match with the B-axis angle set with the index unit.
ri
Reset the B-axis angle for the index unit defined prior to setting the turning drilling unit to either 0 or 180°.
ll
Action
.A
N
795 SHIFT-Y TOO LARGE ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
O
When the amount of SHIFT-Y is not equal to zero in the mill-turning unit, the amount of SHIFT-Y is smaller than the radius
TI
Cause
60
Modify the program so that the amount of SHIFT-Y is equal to or greater than the radius of the tool or equal to or smaller
PO
Action
29
796 NO MAZATROL L TURRET OPT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
An attempt was made to execute a MAZATROL program with lower turret control enabled although the MAZATROL lower
al
ZA
Se
The MAZATROL program cannot be executed because the MAZATROL lower turret control option is unavailable.
A
Action
IM
797 BARRIER CANCEL ON (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ZA
The cycle start button has been pressed when the barrier was canceled.
Cause
A
M
Action
3
01
798 JAW NO NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2
The cycle start button has been pressed when a jaw No. was not assigned.
Cause
(c
ht
799 —— ( , , )
op
C
Cause ——
Action ——
3-144
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
( , , )
Cause
. d
Action
ve
er
1705 AVOIDANCE DISTANCE EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
s
re
For the reciprocating grooving pattern, any of the conditions indicated below is met.
ts
1. The value “tool nose width + 2 (finishing allowance)” is larger than the value “groove width – tool load avoidance
gh
distance (TC156)”.
ri
Cause 2. The value “2 nose R” is larger than the value “groove width – tool load avoidance distance (TC156)”.
ll
3. The value “tool nose width – 2 nose R” is larger than the value “groove width – rear corner factor – tool load
.A
avoidance distance (TC156)”.
N
4. The tool load avoidance distance (TC156) is larger than the depth of cut.
O
Review the program or change the value set at parameter TC156 smaller.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
PO
In intelligent pocket milling (IPM), the engage angle is too large for the tool nose R.
o.
Cause
O
N
C
al
Action
ZA
Or, make the uncut check function invalid by setting E108 bit 1 = 0.
Se
A
IM
Cause
ZA
A
Set a corner rounding path, larger than the value set at E115, to the shape.
M
Action
YA
In intelligent pocket milling (IPM), a tool path that has a constant engage angle cannot be generated.
Cause
)2
(c
Action
ig
yr
1709 ILLEGAL CUTTING FACE (C-AXIS) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
op
A machining face where machining is not possible is specified in the C-axis machining unit.
C
Cause
( , , )
Cause
Action
3-145
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
3-2-9 No. 800 - No. 899, No. 1800 - No. 1899 (EIA/ISO program error)
Cause ——
Action ——
801 SIMULTANEOUS AXIS EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The number of axis motion commands given in one block is in excess of the number of simultaneously controllable axes.
Cause
d.
Modify the program with respect to the specification concerned.
ve
Action
s er
802 ILLEGAL AXIS NAME (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
re
1. The axis address names assigned in the program are different from those which have been parametrized.
ts
Cause
gh
2. Bit 4 of parameter M17 for the shaping control axis (the axis specified in parameter K3) is set to ‘0’ (linear axis).
ri
1. Correct the axis address names in the program.
Action
ll
2. Set bit 4 of parameter M17 for the shaping control axis (the axis specified in parameter K3) to ‘1’ (rotational axis).
.A
803 DIVIDED COMMAND ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
O
A distance of axis movement that cannot be divided by the preset command unit has been assigned.
Cause
TI
60
Action
PO
29
804 PARITY H ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
o.
O
N
On paper tape, the number of holes per character is even for EIA code or odd for ISO code.
C
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
Action
A
IM
805 PARITY V ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
Cause
A
M
Make even the hole quantity per block on the paper tape; or turn off the bit 1 of the parameter TAP25 used for parity-V
Action selection.
YA
806 ILLEGAL ADDRESS (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3
01
Check and correct the corresponding address in the program, and also check the specifications.
ht
Action
ig
yr
op
C
3-146
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
807 ILLEGAL FORMAT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. The format in which the data has been designated in the program is incorrect.
2. Under the condition of workpiece placement error correction, or tool tip point control, an axis address other than those
for the five controlled axes concerned (as specified in parameters K114, K115, K116, K121, and K125) was used in a
motion command block.
Cause 3. The engraving program contains a format error.
A text string containing 100 characters or more was specified.
A character that cannot be engraved was specified.
Engraving was specified with another command in the same block.
1. Review the program.
2. Do not use an axis address other than those for the five controlled axes concerned (as specified in parameters K114,
.
d
Action K115, K116, K121, and K125) in a motion command block under the condition of workpiece placement error
ve
correction, or tool tip point control.
er
3. Review the program.
s
re
808 MIS-SET G CODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ts
A G-code that is not covered in the specifications has been designated.
gh
Cause
ri
Check and correct the corresponding G-code address in the program.
ll
Action
.A
N
809 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
O
The assigned data for the address is out of the allowable setting range.
TI
Cause
60
A
R
40
Action
29
R
o.
810 PROGRAM END NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
For the main program, set M02 or M30 at the end of the program. For subprograms, set M99 at the end of the program.
A
Action
IM
811 ILLEGAL O/N NUMBER (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ZA
Delete zero from N (sequence) or O (program) numbers of the program; or change O-No. (program numbers) to between 1
YA
812 ERROR IN BUFFER BLOCK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
01
)2
An error has been found to exist in the pre-read block during execution of tool diameter offset.
Cause
(c
ht
813 INCH/METRIC OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op
The inch/metric selection command has been issued using the G-code although a G-code inch/metric selection function is
C
814 INTERPOLATION OVERFLOW (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The specified moving distance is too long.
Cause
3-147
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Check the software specifications and change the program command G60 to G00.
Action
816 FEEDRATE ZERO (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The feedrate command has not been input.
Cause
Specify feedrate F for the movement command. (Since modal move command G01 is automatically set at power-on, axis
Action movement in the modal mode is started by input of a move command, even if G01 is not designated in the program).
d.
ve
817 INCORRECT ARC DATA (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The relationship between the starting and ending points of the arc and the center of the arc is not appropriate.
s
Cause
re
ts
Check the values of the starting/ending points and the address values of center of the arc in the program, and check the
gh
Action address values for the correct direction (minus or plus).
ri
818 MISSING CENTER (NO DATA) (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
For arc interpolation by R designation, the coordinates of the center of the arc cannot be calculated.
N
Cause Axis moving by manual interruption is specified in immediate front of the arc command. The arc cannot be defined
O
since the relationship between the starting point, ending point, and radius of the arc becomes incorrect.
TI
Correct the value of each address in the program.
60
Action
Restart the program after pressing the RESET key.
A
R
40
PO
29
819 HELICAL OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R
The helical interpolation command has been issued although such an interpolation function is not provided.
o.
Cause
N
C
al
Check the specifications, and if such an interpolation function is not available, correct the data of the block in which the arc
ri
ZA
Action interpolation command has been issued with designation of three axes.
Se
820 G02.1, G03.1 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM
The spiral interpolation command (G02.1 or G03.1) has been issued although such an interpolation function is not
K
Cause provided.
ZA
Action
M
YA
821 G07 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3
The virtual-axis command (G07) has been issued although there are not virtual-axis specifications.
01
Cause
)2
Action
ht
ig
822 ILLEGAL MODAL (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr
Cause
C
823 G17 - G19 COMMAND IN M98 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) has been issued during figure rotation.
Cause
Delete the plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) from the figure rotation subprogram.
Action
3-148
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
824 G17 - G19 COMMAND IN G68 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) has been specified in the coordinates rotation command (G68).
Cause
IF G68 has been issued, execute the coordinates rotation cancel command (G69) before specifying the plane selection
Action command (G17, G18 or G19).
825 G17 - G19 COMMAND IN G38 - G42 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) has been specified during tool diameter offset (G41 or G42).
Cause
Specify the plane selection command after the tool diameter offset command has been canceled by G40.
Action
d .
ve
826 G95 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The synchronous feed command (G95) has been specified although such feed specifications are not provided.
s
Cause
re
ts
After checking the specifications, change the synchronous feed command (G95) to the feed-in-minutes command (G94).
gh
Action Also change the F command value.
ri
827 F0 COMMAND IN G02, G03 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
The F 1-digit rapid-feed command (F0) has been specified during arc interpolation (G02 or G03).
Cause
N
O
Since rapid feed cannot be ordered for arc interpolation, specify an F 1-digit command other than F0. Specify G0 or G1 if
TI
Action
60
828 NO AUTO CORNER OVERRIDE OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
The automatic corner override command (G62) has been specified although such an override function is not available.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Check the specifications, and delete the G62 command from the program.
al
Action
ri
ZA
Se
829 ILLEGAL 2ND M CODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
The secondary auxiliary function address that has been specified in the program is different from the corresponding
Cause address that has been parameterized.
K
ZA
Check and correct the secondary auxiliary function address that has been specified in the program.
Action
A
M
830 G96 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
The constant surface speed command (G96) has been specified although such specifications are not provided.
Cause
3
01
–1
)2
Check the specifications and change the constant surface speed command (G96) to the speed command (min ).
Action
(c
ht
831 G45, 46, 47, 48 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
A tool-position compensation command (G45 to G48) has been specified although such specifications are not provided.
yr
Cause
op
C
832 G45 - G49 COMMAND IN G98 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Tool-position compensation has been specified during figure rotation or coordinates rotation.
Cause
3-149
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
834 G40, G41, G42 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A tool diameter offset command (G41 or G42) has been specified although such specifications are not provided.
Cause
d .
ve
835 G41, G42, FORMAT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
A compensation command (G40, G41, G42) has been specified during the arc mode (G02 or G03 command).
s
Cause
re
ts
Set either the linear command (G01) or the rapid-feed command (G00) into the compensation command block or the
gh
Action cancellation block. (That is, set the modal status to linear interpolation).
ri
836 NO INTERSECTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
In tool diameter offset (G41 or G42), the coordinates of the intersection point existing when a block was skipped in
Cause processing of interference blocks cannot be calculated.
N
O
Review the program.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
837 TOOL OFFSET INTERFERENCE ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
An interference error has occurred during execution of tool diameter offset (G41 or G42).
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
838 3-D OFFSET OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
The three-dimensional compensation command has been designated although such compensation specifications are not
Cause provided.
K
ZA
839 ILLEGAL OFFSET No. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
A compensation command (G41 or G42) has been designated without a compensation number (D); or the
Cause
3
compensation number is larger than the maximum number of sets of compensation numbers available in the specifications.
01
)2
Check the maximum available number of sets of compensation numbers, and designate a compensation number smaller
Action than that.
(c
ht
840 CANNED CYCLE OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
A fixed-cycle G-code has been designated although fixed-cycle specifications are not provided.
yr
Cause
op
C
841 DESIGNATED TOOL NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The tools that are not yet registered on the TOOL DATA display are specified using T-code command in an EIA/ISO
Cause program.
Check the program and register the necessary tools on the TOOL DATA display.
Action
3-150
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
842 SUB PROGRAM NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. The total number of sequential calls of subprogram has exceeded eight.
2. Execution of a program that includes an “M99” command was attempted in the direct operation mode using HD or
Cause
Ethernet.
3. The program in the HD or host called a program stored in the HD or host.
1. Check the number of subprogram calls, and correct the program so that the number of calls does not exceed eight.
Action 2. Do not include an “M99” command in the main program to be executed in the direct operation mode.
3. Do not call a subprogram stored in the HD or host from a program stored in the HD or host.
843 DESIGNATED SNo. NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The sequence number for subprogram call, for return from a subprogram or for the GOTO designation is not yet set.
Cause
.
d
ve
Set the sequence number in the appropriate block.
er
Action
s
re
844 PROGRAM No. NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ts
An attempt was made to call a subprogram which was not yet registered.
gh
Cause
ri
ll
Register the subprogram.
.A
Action
N
845 ILLEGAL VARIABLE COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
O
TI
A variables number has been designated although variables number (#) specifications are not provided.
60
Cause A
R
40
PO
Action
R
o.
846 DESIGNATED NUMBER NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
C
al
The designated variables number is larger than the maximum variables number permitted by the specifications.
K
Cause
ri
ZA
Se
847 NO “=” CODE IN PROGRAM (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA
A figure rotation command has been designated although figure rotation specifications are not provided.
Cause
(c
ht
Action
yr
op
One figure rotation command has been designated during execution of another such command.
Cause
850 G68 AND M98 COMMANDS SAME BLOCK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A figure rotation command and a coordinates rotation command are designated at the same time.
Cause
3-151
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
852 USER MACRO OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Macro specifications have been designated although such specifications are not provided.
Cause
d .
ve
853 EXTERNAL MACRO OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
A user macro interruption command has been designated although such interruption specifications are not provided.
s
Cause
re
ts
Check the specifications.
gh
Action
ri
854 INCORRECT USERMACRO PROGRAMMING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
An NC statement and a macro statement are present in one block.
Cause
N
O
Review the program and give the NC statement and the macro statement in separate blocks.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
855 USER MACRO NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
The maximum permissible degree of multiplicity of user macro calls has been exceeded.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Review the program and correct it so that the number of user macro calls does not exceed the maximum number of calls
al
ZA
Se
856 USER MACRO ARGUMENT EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
The number of sets of user macro call arguments of type is too large.
Cause
K
ZA
857 INCORRECT USER MACRO G67 PROG. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
Command G67 has been designated when G66 command modal state was not yet set.
Cause
3
01
)2
The G67 command is the call cancellation command; after reviewing the program, designate firstly the G66 command and
Action then the G67 command.
(c
ht
858 USER MACRO “[“ NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
The total number of “[” and “]” within one block has become more than five.
yr
Cause
op
C
Review the program, and correct it so that the total number of “[“ and “]” within one block does not exceed five.
Action
859 NUMBER OF PARENTHESIS MIS-MATCH (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The total number of “[” and “]” within one block differ.
Cause
Review the program, and correct it so that the total number of “[“ and of “]” become the same.
Action
3-152
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
860 CALCULATION IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The operation expression is not correct.
Cause
861 DIVISION BY ZERO (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The denominator in the division expression is zero.
Cause
Review the program and correct it so that the denominator in the division expression does not become zero.
Action
.
d
ve
862 INTEGER VALUE OVERFLOW (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
31 31
The integral value has overstepped –2 (2 –1) in the operation process.
s
Cause
re
ts
Review the operation expression written in the program, and correct it so that after operation, the value of the integer does
gh
Action 31
not overstep –2 .
ri
863 REAL VALUE OVERFLOW (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
The variables data is overflowing.
Cause
N
O
Review the variables data in the program.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
864 “IF” STATEMENT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
Cause
o.
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
865 “WHILE” STATEMENT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
866 “SETVN” STATEMENT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
Review the program and correct it so that the variables name in the SETVN statement consists of seven characters or less.
Action
(c
ht
867 DO-END NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
Of WHILE [<conditional expression>] DO ~ END, DO ~ END has appeared more than 27 times (degree of multiplicity).
yr
Cause
op
C
Review the program and correct it to reduce the degree of multiplicity of DO ~ END to no larger than 27 (27 times).
Action
868 DO-END MIS-MATCH (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The DO's and END's are not formed in pairs.
Cause
Review the program and correct it to give DO's and END's in pairs.
Action
3-153
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Execute the program in the memory operation mode since blocks containing a macro command (WHILE, DO, END, IF,
Action GOTO, POPEN, PCLOS, BPRNT or DPRNT) cannot be executed during tape operation.
870 ILLEGAL VARIABLE NAME (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The designated variables name is not correct.
Cause
Review the variables names in the program and correct the corresponding variables name.
Action
d.
ve
871 VARIABLE NAME EXISTS (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
There are overlapping variables names.
s
Cause
re
ts
Correct the program so that variables names do not overlap.
gh
Action
ri
872 G51 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
A scaling command (G50 or G51) has been designated although scaling specifications are not provided.
Cause
N
O
Check the specifications.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
873 G51.1 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
A mirror image command (G50.1 or G51.1) has been designated although programmable mirror image specifications are
R
Cause
o.
not provided.
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
874 CORNER R/C OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
Corner chamfering or corner rounding/ has been designated although such specifications are not provided.
Cause
K
ZA
Check the specifications and delete corner rounding or corner chamfering from the program.
Action
A
M
875 NOT FOUND GEOMETRIC OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
The geometric command has been designated although geometric specifications are not provided.
Cause
3
01
)2
876 NOT FOUND GEOMETRIC OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
Cause
op
C
877 G15 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The polar coordinates command (G16) has been designated although such command specifications are not provided.
Cause
3-154
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
878 ADDRESS CHANGE OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Absolute/incremental axis address conversion has been designated although such conversion specifications are not
Cause provided.
879 G10 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Program data input has been designated although such input specifications are not provided.
Cause
d.
ve
880 AXIS NOT ZERO RETURNED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
er
A move command other than that for reference-point return has been designated for the axis that was not returned to its
s
Cause
re
reference point.
ts
Manually return the axis to its reference point.
gh
Action
ri
881 G30 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ll
.A
Second, third or fourth reference-point return has been designated although such reference-point returning specifications
Cause are not provided.
N
O
Check the specifications.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
882 ILLEGAL COMMAND CROSS MACHINING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
29
The program section under the mode of cross machining contains an incompatible G-code.
R
Cause
o.
O
N
Action
ri
ZA
Se
883 ILLEGAL CROSS MACHINING COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
1. A G110 command is given under modal conditions not suitable to cross machining control.
Cause
2. An unsuitable axis (since it cannot be used successfully for the counterpart) is specified for cross machining control.
K
ZA
884 REFERENCE POINT RETURN CHECK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
An axis had not returned to the zero-point when the zero-point check command (G27) was executed.
Cause
3
01
)2
885 G22 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
The before-movement stroke check function (G22) has been designated although such function specifications are not
yr
Cause provided.
op
C
886 BEYOND AREA OF G22 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
This alarm message is displayed before execution of a movement block to indicate that the ending point of the axis
Cause movement designated in the block is likely to enter the forbidden area which has been designated using the
before-movement stroke check function (G22).
Review the axis-address coordinate values in the program.
Action
3-155
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
. d
Action Change the file size setting at parameter DPR8 to a value larger than the text file.
ve
er
Reduce the size of the text file to be output to within the file size setting at parameter DPR8.
s
If a value other than “0” is displayed for the detailed error code in the parentheses, note the number and contact
re
the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
ts
888 FILE I/O ERROR ( , , ) E I O Red (Blue)
gh
The machining program file cannot be read.
ri
Cause
ll
.A
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
N
Action
O
TI
889 G37 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
60
A
The automatic tool-length measurement command (G37) has been designated although such measurement specifications
R
40
Action
O
N
C
al
890 G31 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ri
ZA
The skip command (G31) has been designated although skip specifications are not provided.
Se
Cause
A
IM
891 G31.1 - G31.3 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
A multi-step skip command (G31.1, G31.2 or G31.3) has been designated although such skip specifications are not
M
Cause provided.
YA
Action
01
)2
892 AUTO PROGRAMMING FAILURE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c
A trouble has occurred with the software of auto program during the operation.
ht
Cause
ig
yr
Review the program and set the number of the macro program to be called to argument P.
Action
3-156
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
894 MAZATROL PROGRAM DESIGNATED ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. An attempt has been made to call a MAZATROL program from an EIA/ISO program which was designated as a
subprogram of MAZATROL program.
Cause
2. A MAZATROL program has been specified using G65 command (subprogram call) in the manual program mode unit of
the MAZATROL program.
In cases 1 and 2 above, a MAZATROL program cannot be called as a subprogram. Review the program.
Action
895 —— ( , , )
Cause ——
.d
ve
Action ——
er
896 ILLEGAL CHAMFERING ( , , ) B J P Red
s
re
1. In the thread cutting cycle command, designation for chamfering is incorrect.
ts
Cause
2. The current plane differs from the plane of chamfering.
gh
1. Set chamfering data that ensures termination of the operation of the tool within the cycle.
ri
Action
2. Select the same plane as that of chamfering.
ll
.A
897 LAP CYCLE BLOCK NUMBER EXCEED ( , , ) B J P Red
N
The number of blocks in the shape data of the turning fixed-cycle (G270 through G273) exceeds 100 blocks.
O
Cause
TI
60
A
Reduce below 100 the number of blocks in the shape data of the turning fixed-cycle (G270 through G273).
R
40
Action
PO
29
The shape defined in the turning fixed-cycle (G270 through G273) is not the shape for correct cutting.
N
Cause
al
K
ri
ZA
Recheck the shape data specified by the turning fixed-cycle (G270 through G273).
Se
Action
A
IM
In the fixed-cycle (G290, G294), designation for the taper length or the taper height is incorrect.
ZA
Cause
A
Set the taper length or the taper height for the fixed-cycle (G290, G294) smaller than the travel of the axis.
M
Action
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C
3-157
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
1801 ILLEGAL COMMD TIME CONST. CHANGE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I P Red
The G10 command has been set during time constant changeover (non-M880 mode).
Cause
. d
Review and correct the program.
ve
Action
s er
1802 ILLEGAL STARTUP CONDITION G12.1 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
re
1. The G12.1 command is set when the current position of the No. 1 axis (linear axis) on the plane is present on the
ts
Cause negative side.
gh
2. The No. 2 axis (rotational axis) on the plane is not a rotating type of rotational axis.
ri
1. Move the current position of the No. 1 axis (linear axis) on the plane into the positive side before setting the G12.1
ll
command.
.A
Action
2. Specify a rotating type of rotational axis as the No. 2 axis on the plane.
N
Example : G17X_C_; G12.1; …
O
TI
1803 ILL GCODE (2ND SPDL POS ONLY) (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
60
A
A G-code whose usage for the secondary spindle is prohibited has been entered when the secondary spindle
R
40
When the secondary spindle high-accuracy index option is valid, an interpolation command cannot be issued for the
o.
Action
O
C
al
ZA
With F165 bit 6 = 1 (Z-offset data presence check for EIA automatic operation), Z-offset value was missing in setup data
Se
Cause when the G53.5 command (initial G53.5 included) was entered for EIA automatic operation.
A
IM
Set the Z-offset value in the setup data or change the setting of F165 bit 6 from 1 to 0.
Action
K
ZA
1805 G68.2 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
Executing the program has been attempted despite an inclined-surface machining option being absent.
M
Cause
YA
The program for inclined-surface machining cannot be executed without the inclined-surface machining option.
3
Action
01
)2
1806 ILLEGAL CMD TILTED PLANE CMD (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c
A command (G-command or T-command) that cannot be used for inclined-surface machining has been specified during
ht
Cancel inclined-surface machining before executing a G-command or T-command that cannot be used during
yr
1807 CANNOT USE G68.2 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. Inclined-surface machining has been specified in the mode that prohibits the specification of inclined-surface
machining.
Cause
2. A G68.4 command (for incremental coordinate system establishment) was given with the inclined-surface machining
mode being cancelled.
1. Cancel the mode that prohibits the specification of inclined-surface machining.
Action 2. With the inclined-surface machining mode being cancelled, use G68.2, instead of G68.4, to establish a particular
coordinate system for ease of programming.
3-158
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1808 CANNOT USE G53.1 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Inclined-surface machining has been specified in the mode that prohibits the specification of tool axial control.
Cause
Cancel the mode that prohibits the specification of tool axial control.
Action
1809 TILTED PLANE CMD FORMAT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) A L S Blue
The inclined-surface machining command address is wrong.
Cause
d.
ve
1810 TILTED PLANE CANNOT BE DEFINED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) A L S Blue
er
The inclined surface cannot be defined with the specified data.
s
Cause
re
ts
Correct the program.
Action
gh
ri
1811 CANNOT USE G43.1 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B L O Red
ll
.A
“Tool length correction in the tool axial direction” has been specified in the mode that does not permit that command.
Cause
N
O
Cancel modes that cannot be used with “Tool length correction in the tool axial direction”.
TI
Action
60
A
R
40
An incorrect command (such as a G-command or a T-command) has been entered during “Tool length correction in the
Cause
R
O
N
Cancel “Tool length correction in the tool axial direction” to execute the G- or T-command.
al
Action
K
ri
ZA
Se
1813 G54.4 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
The workpiece placement error correction cannot be used without the workpiece placement error correction option.
Action
A
M
1814 ILLEGAL CMD IN G54.4 MODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
An incorrect command (such as a G-command or a T-command) has been entered during the workpiece placement error
Cause correction.
3
01
With parameter F156 bit 2 set to 1, even when the movement is separated between rotary axis and linear axis during the
(c
Action workpiece placement error correction, this separation is not possible if tool radius compensation is used concurrently.
ht
With parameter F156 bit 2 set to 1, when the movement of rotary axis and linear axis is separated during the workpiece
ig
placement error correction, the MSTB command cannot be included in the same block.
yr
1815 CANNOT USE G54.4 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op
The workpiece placement error correction has been specified in the mode that does not permit the workpiece placement
C
Cancel modes that cannot be used with the workpiece placement error correction.
Action
1816 CANNOT USE G18.1/G18.2/G18.3 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The mode existing during plane selection (with G18.2/G18.3/G18.4) for turning, or during plane cancellation (with G18.1)
Cause for turning is not valid.
3-159
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
d.
ve
1819 ILLEGAL C/S (SAFETY SHIELD) ( , , ) B L N Red
er
1. The program of either the hard disk operation or Ethernet operation area was specified as subprogram when automatic
s
operation interference check was valid.
re
Cause
2. The program to be called up as a subprogram is not registered in the memory.
ts
gh
1. Make the Automatic Operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function invalid, or before specifying the program of
either the hard disk operation or Ethernet operation area as subprogram, set the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD
ri
Action function invalid M-code in the main program, to make the automatic operation interference check function invalid.
ll
.A
2. Register the required program.
B I (L) O (S)
N
1820 ILLEGAL COMMD IN G54.4 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) Red (Blue)
O
1. Such a command has been assigned that the travel on a rotational axis exceeds an angle of 180° before or after the
TI
correction of the tool direction.
60
Cause A
2. The distance of correcting motion on the primary or secondary rotational axis for workpiece placement error correction
R
40
1. Divide the move command so that the angular motion, whether it be before or after being corrected, will be up to 180°
R
o.
Action
N
2. Modify the settings of angular errors (a, b, c) in order that the distance of correcting motion on the primary or
C
al
ZA
1821 UNWRITABLE SYSTEM VARIABLE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Se
Cause
K
Action
A
1822 —— ( , , )
M
YA
Cause ——
3
01
Action ——
)2
(c
1823 NOT POSSIBLE SETTING ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ht
The workpiece setup error correction command has been issued in a MAZATROL program under inadequate conditions.
ig
Cause
yr
op
Set the part count value before starting the operation, or perform automatic operation with the SAFETY SHIELD function
Action set invalid.
3-160
Serial No. 294060
ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1825 ILLEGAL M CODE ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
M711 to M714 was specified in the manual program unit, TPC, or tool sequence.
Cause
1826 HEAD-AXIS ILLEGAL COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I O (S) Red (Blue)
A G-code command that cannot be used for the head indexing axis has been specified.
Cause
. d
ve
1827 HEAD-AXIS ANGLE INCORRECT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I O (S) Red (Blue)
er
The angular value given for indexing the head cannot be divided by the L17 parameter setting (minimum angle of head
s
Cause index command).
re
ts
Review and correct the program.
Action
gh
ri
1828 —— ( , , )
ll
.A
Cause ——
N
O
TI
Action ——
60
A
R
40
Tool tip point control or high-speed smoothing control is made valid in the G61.2 mode when the 5-axis spline interpolation
Cause
R
O
N
When the 5-axis spline interpolation is not provided, 5-axis spline interpolation is not available.
al
Action
K
ri
ZA
Se
1830 CANNOT USE 5AXIS SPLINE CUTTING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM
The 5-axis spline interpolation mode is made valid during the uniaxial rotation interpolation (when bit 3 of parameter F85 is
Cause set to 0).
K
ZA
To use the 5-axis spline interpolation, select the joint interpolation (set bit 3 of parameter F85 to 1).
Action
A
M
1831 ILLEGAL CHOPPING CONDITION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA
1. The top dead point and the bottom dead point are the same.
3
Cause 4. An illegal value (other than 0 to 2) is set for the chopping offset method.
(c
5. An illegal value (other than 0 to 7) is set for the chopping offset number.
ht
6. The chopping record M-code is issued when the offset update method is selected.
ig
Take action below to remove the cause, and press the RESET key or tap the alarm clear button.
op
C
1. Review the command for the top dead point or bottom dead point.
2. Review the chopping feed rate command.
3. Issue the chopping command in the chopping command possible mode.
Action
4. Set a correct value (0 to 2) for the chopping offset method.
5. Set a correct value (0 to 7) for the chopping offset number.
6. Do not issue the chopping record M-code when the offset update method is selected.
7. Specify the chopping speed value so that on overflow will not occur during writing.
3-161
Serial No. 294060
3 ALARM
Change the program so that the inhibited command is not issued during chopping.
Action
Then press the RESET key or tap the alarm clear button.
1833 ILLEGAL COND. CORRECT LENGTH.C (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Tool length compensation G43P3 is issued under any of the following conditions.
1. Pinch cut or Y-axis turning option is invalid.
2. The machine is not equipped with tool length C compensation, or tool length C compensation is made invalid.
Cause
(Parameter BA131 bit 1 = 0)
d .
3. MAZATROL tool length is invalid. (Parameter F93 bit 3 = 0)
ve
4. Tool length A, B or C is not set for the current tool in MAZATROL tool data.
er
1. Pinch cut or Y-axis turning option must be purchased.
s
re
2. If the machine is not equipped with tool length C compensation, correct the program so that the G43P3 command is not
ts
used. If the machine is equipped with tool length C compensation, make tool length C compensation valid. (Parameter
Action
gh
BA131 bit 1 = 1)
ri
3. Make MAZATROL tool length valid. (Parameter F93 bit 3 = 1)
ll
4. Set tool length A, B and C for the current tool in MAZATROL tool data.
.A
1834 CORRECTING LENGTH.C (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N
1. The X-, Y- or Z-axis movement command is issued before the head rotary axis (B-axis) is turned to the 90-degree
O
position after the tool length compensation G43P3 command was issued (or after tool change to a tool with tool length
TI
Cause
60
C setting).
A
R
40
2. A G-code command that is prohibited in the tool length compensation G43P3 mode is issued.
PO
29
1. When the axis movement command is issued with tool length C compensation valid, the head rotary axis (B-axis) must
Action be turned to the 90-degree position in advance.
R
o.
K
r